1 //===--- SemaDecl.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Declarations ----------------===// 2 // 3 // Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions. 4 // See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information. 5 // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception 6 // 7 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 8 // 9 // This file implements semantic analysis for declarations. 10 // 11 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 12 13 #include "TypeLocBuilder.h" 14 #include "clang/AST/ASTConsumer.h" 15 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h" 16 #include "clang/AST/ASTLambda.h" 17 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h" 18 #include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h" 19 #include "clang/AST/CommentDiagnostic.h" 20 #include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h" 21 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h" 22 #include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h" 23 #include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h" 24 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h" 25 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h" 26 #include "clang/AST/NonTrivialTypeVisitor.h" 27 #include "clang/AST/Randstruct.h" 28 #include "clang/AST/StmtCXX.h" 29 #include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h" 30 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h" 31 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h" 32 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h" 33 #include "clang/Lex/HeaderSearch.h" // TODO: Sema shouldn't depend on Lex 34 #include "clang/Lex/Lexer.h" // TODO: Extract static functions to fix layering. 35 #include "clang/Lex/ModuleLoader.h" // TODO: Sema shouldn't depend on Lex 36 #include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h" // Included for isCodeCompletionEnabled() 37 #include "clang/Sema/CXXFieldCollector.h" 38 #include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h" 39 #include "clang/Sema/DelayedDiagnostic.h" 40 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h" 41 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h" 42 #include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h" 43 #include "clang/Sema/Scope.h" 44 #include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h" 45 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h" 46 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h" 47 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h" 48 #include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h" 49 #include <algorithm> 50 #include <cstring> 51 #include <functional> 52 #include <unordered_map> 53 54 using namespace clang; 55 using namespace sema; 56 57 Sema::DeclGroupPtrTy Sema::ConvertDeclToDeclGroup(Decl *Ptr, Decl *OwnedType) { 58 if (OwnedType) { 59 Decl *Group[2] = { OwnedType, Ptr }; 60 return DeclGroupPtrTy::make(DeclGroupRef::Create(Context, Group, 2)); 61 } 62 63 return DeclGroupPtrTy::make(DeclGroupRef(Ptr)); 64 } 65 66 namespace { 67 68 class TypeNameValidatorCCC final : public CorrectionCandidateCallback { 69 public: 70 TypeNameValidatorCCC(bool AllowInvalid, bool WantClass = false, 71 bool AllowTemplates = false, 72 bool AllowNonTemplates = true) 73 : AllowInvalidDecl(AllowInvalid), WantClassName(WantClass), 74 AllowTemplates(AllowTemplates), AllowNonTemplates(AllowNonTemplates) { 75 WantExpressionKeywords = false; 76 WantCXXNamedCasts = false; 77 WantRemainingKeywords = false; 78 } 79 80 bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) override { 81 if (NamedDecl *ND = candidate.getCorrectionDecl()) { 82 if (!AllowInvalidDecl && ND->isInvalidDecl()) 83 return false; 84 85 if (getAsTypeTemplateDecl(ND)) 86 return AllowTemplates; 87 88 bool IsType = isa<TypeDecl>(ND) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND); 89 if (!IsType) 90 return false; 91 92 if (AllowNonTemplates) 93 return true; 94 95 // An injected-class-name of a class template (specialization) is valid 96 // as a template or as a non-template. 97 if (AllowTemplates) { 98 auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ND); 99 if (!RD || !RD->isInjectedClassName()) 100 return false; 101 RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getDeclContext()); 102 return RD->getDescribedClassTemplate() || 103 isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD); 104 } 105 106 return false; 107 } 108 109 return !WantClassName && candidate.isKeyword(); 110 } 111 112 std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> clone() override { 113 return std::make_unique<TypeNameValidatorCCC>(*this); 114 } 115 116 private: 117 bool AllowInvalidDecl; 118 bool WantClassName; 119 bool AllowTemplates; 120 bool AllowNonTemplates; 121 }; 122 123 } // end anonymous namespace 124 125 /// Determine whether the token kind starts a simple-type-specifier. 126 bool Sema::isSimpleTypeSpecifier(tok::TokenKind Kind) const { 127 switch (Kind) { 128 // FIXME: Take into account the current language when deciding whether a 129 // token kind is a valid type specifier 130 case tok::kw_short: 131 case tok::kw_long: 132 case tok::kw___int64: 133 case tok::kw___int128: 134 case tok::kw_signed: 135 case tok::kw_unsigned: 136 case tok::kw_void: 137 case tok::kw_char: 138 case tok::kw_int: 139 case tok::kw_half: 140 case tok::kw_float: 141 case tok::kw_double: 142 case tok::kw___bf16: 143 case tok::kw__Float16: 144 case tok::kw___float128: 145 case tok::kw___ibm128: 146 case tok::kw_wchar_t: 147 case tok::kw_bool: 148 case tok::kw___underlying_type: 149 case tok::kw___auto_type: 150 return true; 151 152 case tok::annot_typename: 153 case tok::kw_char16_t: 154 case tok::kw_char32_t: 155 case tok::kw_typeof: 156 case tok::annot_decltype: 157 case tok::kw_decltype: 158 return getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 159 160 case tok::kw_char8_t: 161 return getLangOpts().Char8; 162 163 default: 164 break; 165 } 166 167 return false; 168 } 169 170 namespace { 171 enum class UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult { 172 NotFound, 173 FoundNonType, 174 FoundType 175 }; 176 } // end anonymous namespace 177 178 /// Tries to perform unqualified lookup of the type decls in bases for 179 /// dependent class. 180 /// \return \a NotFound if no any decls is found, \a FoundNotType if found not a 181 /// type decl, \a FoundType if only type decls are found. 182 static UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult 183 lookupUnqualifiedTypeNameInBase(Sema &S, const IdentifierInfo &II, 184 SourceLocation NameLoc, 185 const CXXRecordDecl *RD) { 186 if (!RD->hasDefinition()) 187 return UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound; 188 // Look for type decls in base classes. 189 UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult FoundTypeDecl = 190 UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound; 191 for (const auto &Base : RD->bases()) { 192 const CXXRecordDecl *BaseRD = nullptr; 193 if (auto *BaseTT = Base.getType()->getAs<TagType>()) 194 BaseRD = BaseTT->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 195 else if (auto *TST = Base.getType()->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) { 196 // Look for type decls in dependent base classes that have known primary 197 // templates. 198 if (!TST || !TST->isDependentType()) 199 continue; 200 auto *TD = TST->getTemplateName().getAsTemplateDecl(); 201 if (!TD) 202 continue; 203 if (auto *BasePrimaryTemplate = 204 dyn_cast_or_null<CXXRecordDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl())) { 205 if (BasePrimaryTemplate->getCanonicalDecl() != RD->getCanonicalDecl()) 206 BaseRD = BasePrimaryTemplate; 207 else if (auto *CTD = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateDecl>(TD)) { 208 if (const ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *PS = 209 CTD->findPartialSpecialization(Base.getType())) 210 if (PS->getCanonicalDecl() != RD->getCanonicalDecl()) 211 BaseRD = PS; 212 } 213 } 214 } 215 if (BaseRD) { 216 for (NamedDecl *ND : BaseRD->lookup(&II)) { 217 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(ND)) 218 return UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundNonType; 219 FoundTypeDecl = UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType; 220 } 221 if (FoundTypeDecl == UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound) { 222 switch (lookupUnqualifiedTypeNameInBase(S, II, NameLoc, BaseRD)) { 223 case UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundNonType: 224 return UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundNonType; 225 case UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType: 226 FoundTypeDecl = UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType; 227 break; 228 case UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound: 229 break; 230 } 231 } 232 } 233 } 234 235 return FoundTypeDecl; 236 } 237 238 static ParsedType recoverFromTypeInKnownDependentBase(Sema &S, 239 const IdentifierInfo &II, 240 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 241 // Lookup in the parent class template context, if any. 242 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = nullptr; 243 UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult FoundTypeDecl = 244 UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound; 245 for (DeclContext *DC = S.CurContext; 246 DC && FoundTypeDecl == UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound; 247 DC = DC->getParent()) { 248 // Look for type decls in dependent base classes that have known primary 249 // templates. 250 RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC); 251 if (RD && RD->getDescribedClassTemplate()) 252 FoundTypeDecl = lookupUnqualifiedTypeNameInBase(S, II, NameLoc, RD); 253 } 254 if (FoundTypeDecl != UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType) 255 return nullptr; 256 257 // We found some types in dependent base classes. Recover as if the user 258 // wrote 'typename MyClass::II' instead of 'II'. We'll fully resolve the 259 // lookup during template instantiation. 260 S.Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_found_in_dependent_base) << &II; 261 262 ASTContext &Context = S.Context; 263 auto *NNS = NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, false, 264 cast<Type>(Context.getRecordType(RD))); 265 QualType T = Context.getDependentNameType(ETK_Typename, NNS, &II); 266 267 CXXScopeSpec SS; 268 SS.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc)); 269 270 TypeLocBuilder Builder; 271 DependentNameTypeLoc DepTL = Builder.push<DependentNameTypeLoc>(T); 272 DepTL.setNameLoc(NameLoc); 273 DepTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 274 DepTL.setQualifierLoc(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context)); 275 return S.CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T)); 276 } 277 278 /// If the identifier refers to a type name within this scope, 279 /// return the declaration of that type. 280 /// 281 /// This routine performs ordinary name lookup of the identifier II 282 /// within the given scope, with optional C++ scope specifier SS, to 283 /// determine whether the name refers to a type. If so, returns an 284 /// opaque pointer (actually a QualType) corresponding to that 285 /// type. Otherwise, returns NULL. 286 ParsedType Sema::getTypeName(const IdentifierInfo &II, SourceLocation NameLoc, 287 Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec *SS, 288 bool isClassName, bool HasTrailingDot, 289 ParsedType ObjectTypePtr, 290 bool IsCtorOrDtorName, 291 bool WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo, 292 bool IsClassTemplateDeductionContext, 293 IdentifierInfo **CorrectedII) { 294 // FIXME: Consider allowing this outside C++1z mode as an extension. 295 bool AllowDeducedTemplate = IsClassTemplateDeductionContext && 296 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 && !IsCtorOrDtorName && 297 !isClassName && !HasTrailingDot; 298 299 // Determine where we will perform name lookup. 300 DeclContext *LookupCtx = nullptr; 301 if (ObjectTypePtr) { 302 QualType ObjectType = ObjectTypePtr.get(); 303 if (ObjectType->isRecordType()) 304 LookupCtx = computeDeclContext(ObjectType); 305 } else if (SS && SS->isNotEmpty()) { 306 LookupCtx = computeDeclContext(*SS, false); 307 308 if (!LookupCtx) { 309 if (isDependentScopeSpecifier(*SS)) { 310 // C++ [temp.res]p3: 311 // A qualified-id that refers to a type and in which the 312 // nested-name-specifier depends on a template-parameter (14.6.2) 313 // shall be prefixed by the keyword typename to indicate that the 314 // qualified-id denotes a type, forming an 315 // elaborated-type-specifier (7.1.5.3). 316 // 317 // We therefore do not perform any name lookup if the result would 318 // refer to a member of an unknown specialization. 319 if (!isClassName && !IsCtorOrDtorName) 320 return nullptr; 321 322 // We know from the grammar that this name refers to a type, 323 // so build a dependent node to describe the type. 324 if (WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo) 325 return ActOnTypenameType(S, SourceLocation(), *SS, II, NameLoc).get(); 326 327 NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = SS->getWithLocInContext(Context); 328 QualType T = CheckTypenameType(ETK_None, SourceLocation(), QualifierLoc, 329 II, NameLoc); 330 return ParsedType::make(T); 331 } 332 333 return nullptr; 334 } 335 336 if (!LookupCtx->isDependentContext() && 337 RequireCompleteDeclContext(*SS, LookupCtx)) 338 return nullptr; 339 } 340 341 // FIXME: LookupNestedNameSpecifierName isn't the right kind of 342 // lookup for class-names. 343 LookupNameKind Kind = isClassName ? LookupNestedNameSpecifierName : 344 LookupOrdinaryName; 345 LookupResult Result(*this, &II, NameLoc, Kind); 346 if (LookupCtx) { 347 // Perform "qualified" name lookup into the declaration context we 348 // computed, which is either the type of the base of a member access 349 // expression or the declaration context associated with a prior 350 // nested-name-specifier. 351 LookupQualifiedName(Result, LookupCtx); 352 353 if (ObjectTypePtr && Result.empty()) { 354 // C++ [basic.lookup.classref]p3: 355 // If the unqualified-id is ~type-name, the type-name is looked up 356 // in the context of the entire postfix-expression. If the type T of 357 // the object expression is of a class type C, the type-name is also 358 // looked up in the scope of class C. At least one of the lookups shall 359 // find a name that refers to (possibly cv-qualified) T. 360 LookupName(Result, S); 361 } 362 } else { 363 // Perform unqualified name lookup. 364 LookupName(Result, S); 365 366 // For unqualified lookup in a class template in MSVC mode, look into 367 // dependent base classes where the primary class template is known. 368 if (Result.empty() && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && (!SS || SS->isEmpty())) { 369 if (ParsedType TypeInBase = 370 recoverFromTypeInKnownDependentBase(*this, II, NameLoc)) 371 return TypeInBase; 372 } 373 } 374 375 NamedDecl *IIDecl = nullptr; 376 UsingShadowDecl *FoundUsingShadow = nullptr; 377 switch (Result.getResultKind()) { 378 case LookupResult::NotFound: 379 case LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation: 380 if (CorrectedII) { 381 TypeNameValidatorCCC CCC(/*AllowInvalid=*/true, isClassName, 382 AllowDeducedTemplate); 383 TypoCorrection Correction = CorrectTypo(Result.getLookupNameInfo(), Kind, 384 S, SS, CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery); 385 IdentifierInfo *NewII = Correction.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(); 386 TemplateTy Template; 387 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization; 388 UnqualifiedId TemplateName; 389 TemplateName.setIdentifier(NewII, NameLoc); 390 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS = Correction.getCorrectionSpecifier(); 391 CXXScopeSpec NewSS, *NewSSPtr = SS; 392 if (SS && NNS) { 393 NewSS.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc)); 394 NewSSPtr = &NewSS; 395 } 396 if (Correction && (NNS || NewII != &II) && 397 // Ignore a correction to a template type as the to-be-corrected 398 // identifier is not a template (typo correction for template names 399 // is handled elsewhere). 400 !(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NewSSPtr && 401 isTemplateName(S, *NewSSPtr, false, TemplateName, nullptr, false, 402 Template, MemberOfUnknownSpecialization))) { 403 ParsedType Ty = getTypeName(*NewII, NameLoc, S, NewSSPtr, 404 isClassName, HasTrailingDot, ObjectTypePtr, 405 IsCtorOrDtorName, 406 WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo, 407 IsClassTemplateDeductionContext); 408 if (Ty) { 409 diagnoseTypo(Correction, 410 PDiag(diag::err_unknown_type_or_class_name_suggest) 411 << Result.getLookupName() << isClassName); 412 if (SS && NNS) 413 SS->MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc)); 414 *CorrectedII = NewII; 415 return Ty; 416 } 417 } 418 } 419 // If typo correction failed or was not performed, fall through 420 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 421 case LookupResult::FoundOverloaded: 422 case LookupResult::FoundUnresolvedValue: 423 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 424 return nullptr; 425 426 case LookupResult::Ambiguous: 427 // Recover from type-hiding ambiguities by hiding the type. We'll 428 // do the lookup again when looking for an object, and we can 429 // diagnose the error then. If we don't do this, then the error 430 // about hiding the type will be immediately followed by an error 431 // that only makes sense if the identifier was treated like a type. 432 if (Result.getAmbiguityKind() == LookupResult::AmbiguousTagHiding) { 433 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 434 return nullptr; 435 } 436 437 // Look to see if we have a type anywhere in the list of results. 438 for (LookupResult::iterator Res = Result.begin(), ResEnd = Result.end(); 439 Res != ResEnd; ++Res) { 440 NamedDecl *RealRes = (*Res)->getUnderlyingDecl(); 441 if (isa<TypeDecl, ObjCInterfaceDecl, UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>( 442 RealRes) || 443 (AllowDeducedTemplate && getAsTypeTemplateDecl(RealRes))) { 444 if (!IIDecl || 445 // Make the selection of the recovery decl deterministic. 446 RealRes->getLocation() < IIDecl->getLocation()) { 447 IIDecl = RealRes; 448 FoundUsingShadow = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*Res); 449 } 450 } 451 } 452 453 if (!IIDecl) { 454 // None of the entities we found is a type, so there is no way 455 // to even assume that the result is a type. In this case, don't 456 // complain about the ambiguity. The parser will either try to 457 // perform this lookup again (e.g., as an object name), which 458 // will produce the ambiguity, or will complain that it expected 459 // a type name. 460 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 461 return nullptr; 462 } 463 464 // We found a type within the ambiguous lookup; diagnose the 465 // ambiguity and then return that type. This might be the right 466 // answer, or it might not be, but it suppresses any attempt to 467 // perform the name lookup again. 468 break; 469 470 case LookupResult::Found: 471 IIDecl = Result.getFoundDecl(); 472 FoundUsingShadow = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*Result.begin()); 473 break; 474 } 475 476 assert(IIDecl && "Didn't find decl"); 477 478 QualType T; 479 if (TypeDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypeDecl>(IIDecl)) { 480 // C++ [class.qual]p2: A lookup that would find the injected-class-name 481 // instead names the constructors of the class, except when naming a class. 482 // This is ill-formed when we're not actually forming a ctor or dtor name. 483 auto *LookupRD = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXRecordDecl>(LookupCtx); 484 auto *FoundRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TD); 485 if (!isClassName && !IsCtorOrDtorName && LookupRD && FoundRD && 486 FoundRD->isInjectedClassName() && 487 declaresSameEntity(LookupRD, cast<Decl>(FoundRD->getParent()))) 488 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_out_of_line_qualified_id_type_names_constructor) 489 << &II << /*Type*/1; 490 491 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IIDecl, NameLoc); 492 493 T = Context.getTypeDeclType(TD); 494 MarkAnyDeclReferenced(TD->getLocation(), TD, /*OdrUse=*/false); 495 } else if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(IIDecl)) { 496 (void)DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IDecl, NameLoc); 497 if (!HasTrailingDot) 498 T = Context.getObjCInterfaceType(IDecl); 499 FoundUsingShadow = nullptr; // FIXME: Target must be a TypeDecl. 500 } else if (auto *UD = dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>(IIDecl)) { 501 (void)DiagnoseUseOfDecl(UD, NameLoc); 502 // Recover with 'int' 503 T = Context.IntTy; 504 FoundUsingShadow = nullptr; 505 } else if (AllowDeducedTemplate) { 506 if (auto *TD = getAsTypeTemplateDecl(IIDecl)) { 507 assert(!FoundUsingShadow || FoundUsingShadow->getTargetDecl() == TD); 508 TemplateName Template = 509 FoundUsingShadow ? TemplateName(FoundUsingShadow) : TemplateName(TD); 510 T = Context.getDeducedTemplateSpecializationType(Template, QualType(), 511 false); 512 // Don't wrap in a further UsingType. 513 FoundUsingShadow = nullptr; 514 } 515 } 516 517 if (T.isNull()) { 518 // If it's not plausibly a type, suppress diagnostics. 519 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 520 return nullptr; 521 } 522 523 if (FoundUsingShadow) 524 T = Context.getUsingType(FoundUsingShadow, T); 525 526 // NOTE: avoid constructing an ElaboratedType(Loc) if this is a 527 // constructor or destructor name (in such a case, the scope specifier 528 // will be attached to the enclosing Expr or Decl node). 529 if (SS && SS->isNotEmpty() && !IsCtorOrDtorName && 530 !isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl, UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>(IIDecl)) { 531 if (WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo) { 532 // Construct a type with type-source information. 533 TypeLocBuilder Builder; 534 Builder.pushTypeSpec(T).setNameLoc(NameLoc); 535 536 T = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, *SS, T); 537 ElaboratedTypeLoc ElabTL = Builder.push<ElaboratedTypeLoc>(T); 538 ElabTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 539 ElabTL.setQualifierLoc(SS->getWithLocInContext(Context)); 540 return CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T)); 541 } else { 542 T = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, *SS, T); 543 } 544 } 545 546 return ParsedType::make(T); 547 } 548 549 // Builds a fake NNS for the given decl context. 550 static NestedNameSpecifier * 551 synthesizeCurrentNestedNameSpecifier(ASTContext &Context, DeclContext *DC) { 552 for (;; DC = DC->getLookupParent()) { 553 DC = DC->getPrimaryContext(); 554 auto *ND = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(DC); 555 if (ND && !ND->isInline() && !ND->isAnonymousNamespace()) 556 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, ND); 557 else if (auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) 558 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, RD->isTemplateDecl(), 559 RD->getTypeForDecl()); 560 else if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(DC)) 561 return NestedNameSpecifier::GlobalSpecifier(Context); 562 } 563 llvm_unreachable("something isn't in TU scope?"); 564 } 565 566 /// Find the parent class with dependent bases of the innermost enclosing method 567 /// context. Do not look for enclosing CXXRecordDecls directly, or we will end 568 /// up allowing unqualified dependent type names at class-level, which MSVC 569 /// correctly rejects. 570 static const CXXRecordDecl * 571 findRecordWithDependentBasesOfEnclosingMethod(const DeclContext *DC) { 572 for (; DC && DC->isDependentContext(); DC = DC->getLookupParent()) { 573 DC = DC->getPrimaryContext(); 574 if (const auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) 575 if (MD->getParent()->hasAnyDependentBases()) 576 return MD->getParent(); 577 } 578 return nullptr; 579 } 580 581 ParsedType Sema::ActOnMSVCUnknownTypeName(const IdentifierInfo &II, 582 SourceLocation NameLoc, 583 bool IsTemplateTypeArg) { 584 assert(getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && "shouldn't be called in non-MSVC mode"); 585 586 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS = nullptr; 587 if (IsTemplateTypeArg && getCurScope()->isTemplateParamScope()) { 588 // If we weren't able to parse a default template argument, delay lookup 589 // until instantiation time by making a non-dependent DependentTypeName. We 590 // pretend we saw a NestedNameSpecifier referring to the current scope, and 591 // lookup is retried. 592 // FIXME: This hurts our diagnostic quality, since we get errors like "no 593 // type named 'Foo' in 'current_namespace'" when the user didn't write any 594 // name specifiers. 595 NNS = synthesizeCurrentNestedNameSpecifier(Context, CurContext); 596 Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_ms_delayed_template_argument) << &II; 597 } else if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = 598 findRecordWithDependentBasesOfEnclosingMethod(CurContext)) { 599 // Build a DependentNameType that will perform lookup into RD at 600 // instantiation time. 601 NNS = NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, RD->isTemplateDecl(), 602 RD->getTypeForDecl()); 603 604 // Diagnose that this identifier was undeclared, and retry the lookup during 605 // template instantiation. 606 Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_undeclared_unqual_id_with_dependent_base) << &II 607 << RD; 608 } else { 609 // This is not a situation that we should recover from. 610 return ParsedType(); 611 } 612 613 QualType T = Context.getDependentNameType(ETK_None, NNS, &II); 614 615 // Build type location information. We synthesized the qualifier, so we have 616 // to build a fake NestedNameSpecifierLoc. 617 NestedNameSpecifierLocBuilder NNSLocBuilder; 618 NNSLocBuilder.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc)); 619 NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = NNSLocBuilder.getWithLocInContext(Context); 620 621 TypeLocBuilder Builder; 622 DependentNameTypeLoc DepTL = Builder.push<DependentNameTypeLoc>(T); 623 DepTL.setNameLoc(NameLoc); 624 DepTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 625 DepTL.setQualifierLoc(QualifierLoc); 626 return CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T)); 627 } 628 629 /// isTagName() - This method is called *for error recovery purposes only* 630 /// to determine if the specified name is a valid tag name ("struct foo"). If 631 /// so, this returns the TST for the tag corresponding to it (TST_enum, 632 /// TST_union, TST_struct, TST_interface, TST_class). This is used to diagnose 633 /// cases in C where the user forgot to specify the tag. 634 DeclSpec::TST Sema::isTagName(IdentifierInfo &II, Scope *S) { 635 // Do a tag name lookup in this scope. 636 LookupResult R(*this, &II, SourceLocation(), LookupTagName); 637 LookupName(R, S, false); 638 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 639 if (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::Found) 640 if (const TagDecl *TD = R.getAsSingle<TagDecl>()) { 641 switch (TD->getTagKind()) { 642 case TTK_Struct: return DeclSpec::TST_struct; 643 case TTK_Interface: return DeclSpec::TST_interface; 644 case TTK_Union: return DeclSpec::TST_union; 645 case TTK_Class: return DeclSpec::TST_class; 646 case TTK_Enum: return DeclSpec::TST_enum; 647 } 648 } 649 650 return DeclSpec::TST_unspecified; 651 } 652 653 /// isMicrosoftMissingTypename - In Microsoft mode, within class scope, 654 /// if a CXXScopeSpec's type is equal to the type of one of the base classes 655 /// then downgrade the missing typename error to a warning. 656 /// This is needed for MSVC compatibility; Example: 657 /// @code 658 /// template<class T> class A { 659 /// public: 660 /// typedef int TYPE; 661 /// }; 662 /// template<class T> class B : public A<T> { 663 /// public: 664 /// A<T>::TYPE a; // no typename required because A<T> is a base class. 665 /// }; 666 /// @endcode 667 bool Sema::isMicrosoftMissingTypename(const CXXScopeSpec *SS, Scope *S) { 668 if (CurContext->isRecord()) { 669 if (SS->getScopeRep()->getKind() == NestedNameSpecifier::Super) 670 return true; 671 672 const Type *Ty = SS->getScopeRep()->getAsType(); 673 674 CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext); 675 for (const auto &Base : RD->bases()) 676 if (Ty && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(Ty, 1), Base.getType())) 677 return true; 678 return S->isFunctionPrototypeScope(); 679 } 680 return CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod() || S->isFunctionPrototypeScope(); 681 } 682 683 void Sema::DiagnoseUnknownTypeName(IdentifierInfo *&II, 684 SourceLocation IILoc, 685 Scope *S, 686 CXXScopeSpec *SS, 687 ParsedType &SuggestedType, 688 bool IsTemplateName) { 689 // Don't report typename errors for editor placeholders. 690 if (II->isEditorPlaceholder()) 691 return; 692 // We don't have anything to suggest (yet). 693 SuggestedType = nullptr; 694 695 // There may have been a typo in the name of the type. Look up typo 696 // results, in case we have something that we can suggest. 697 TypeNameValidatorCCC CCC(/*AllowInvalid=*/false, /*WantClass=*/false, 698 /*AllowTemplates=*/IsTemplateName, 699 /*AllowNonTemplates=*/!IsTemplateName); 700 if (TypoCorrection Corrected = 701 CorrectTypo(DeclarationNameInfo(II, IILoc), LookupOrdinaryName, S, SS, 702 CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery)) { 703 // FIXME: Support error recovery for the template-name case. 704 bool CanRecover = !IsTemplateName; 705 if (Corrected.isKeyword()) { 706 // We corrected to a keyword. 707 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, 708 PDiag(IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_template_suggest 709 : diag::err_unknown_typename_suggest) 710 << II); 711 II = Corrected.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(); 712 } else { 713 // We found a similarly-named type or interface; suggest that. 714 if (!SS || !SS->isSet()) { 715 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, 716 PDiag(IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_template_suggest 717 : diag::err_unknown_typename_suggest) 718 << II, CanRecover); 719 } else if (DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(*SS, false)) { 720 std::string CorrectedStr(Corrected.getAsString(getLangOpts())); 721 bool DroppedSpecifier = Corrected.WillReplaceSpecifier() && 722 II->getName().equals(CorrectedStr); 723 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, 724 PDiag(IsTemplateName 725 ? diag::err_no_member_template_suggest 726 : diag::err_unknown_nested_typename_suggest) 727 << II << DC << DroppedSpecifier << SS->getRange(), 728 CanRecover); 729 } else { 730 llvm_unreachable("could not have corrected a typo here"); 731 } 732 733 if (!CanRecover) 734 return; 735 736 CXXScopeSpec tmpSS; 737 if (Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier()) 738 tmpSS.MakeTrivial(Context, Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier(), 739 SourceRange(IILoc)); 740 // FIXME: Support class template argument deduction here. 741 SuggestedType = 742 getTypeName(*Corrected.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(), IILoc, S, 743 tmpSS.isSet() ? &tmpSS : SS, false, false, nullptr, 744 /*IsCtorOrDtorName=*/false, 745 /*WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo=*/true); 746 } 747 return; 748 } 749 750 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !IsTemplateName) { 751 // See if II is a class template that the user forgot to pass arguments to. 752 UnqualifiedId Name; 753 Name.setIdentifier(II, IILoc); 754 CXXScopeSpec EmptySS; 755 TemplateTy TemplateResult; 756 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization; 757 if (isTemplateName(S, SS ? *SS : EmptySS, /*hasTemplateKeyword=*/false, 758 Name, nullptr, true, TemplateResult, 759 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization) == TNK_Type_template) { 760 diagnoseMissingTemplateArguments(TemplateResult.get(), IILoc); 761 return; 762 } 763 } 764 765 // FIXME: Should we move the logic that tries to recover from a missing tag 766 // (struct, union, enum) from Parser::ParseImplicitInt here, instead? 767 768 if (!SS || (!SS->isSet() && !SS->isInvalid())) 769 Diag(IILoc, IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_template 770 : diag::err_unknown_typename) 771 << II; 772 else if (DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(*SS, false)) 773 Diag(IILoc, IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_member_template 774 : diag::err_typename_nested_not_found) 775 << II << DC << SS->getRange(); 776 else if (SS->isValid() && SS->getScopeRep()->containsErrors()) { 777 SuggestedType = 778 ActOnTypenameType(S, SourceLocation(), *SS, *II, IILoc).get(); 779 } else if (isDependentScopeSpecifier(*SS)) { 780 unsigned DiagID = diag::err_typename_missing; 781 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && isMicrosoftMissingTypename(SS, S)) 782 DiagID = diag::ext_typename_missing; 783 784 Diag(SS->getRange().getBegin(), DiagID) 785 << SS->getScopeRep() << II->getName() 786 << SourceRange(SS->getRange().getBegin(), IILoc) 787 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SS->getRange().getBegin(), "typename "); 788 SuggestedType = ActOnTypenameType(S, SourceLocation(), 789 *SS, *II, IILoc).get(); 790 } else { 791 assert(SS && SS->isInvalid() && 792 "Invalid scope specifier has already been diagnosed"); 793 } 794 } 795 796 /// Determine whether the given result set contains either a type name 797 /// or 798 static bool isResultTypeOrTemplate(LookupResult &R, const Token &NextToken) { 799 bool CheckTemplate = R.getSema().getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 800 NextToken.is(tok::less); 801 802 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), IEnd = R.end(); I != IEnd; ++I) { 803 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*I) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*I)) 804 return true; 805 806 if (CheckTemplate && isa<TemplateDecl>(*I)) 807 return true; 808 } 809 810 return false; 811 } 812 813 static bool isTagTypeWithMissingTag(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &Result, 814 Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, 815 IdentifierInfo *&Name, 816 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 817 LookupResult R(SemaRef, Name, NameLoc, Sema::LookupTagName); 818 SemaRef.LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS); 819 if (TagDecl *Tag = R.getAsSingle<TagDecl>()) { 820 StringRef FixItTagName; 821 switch (Tag->getTagKind()) { 822 case TTK_Class: 823 FixItTagName = "class "; 824 break; 825 826 case TTK_Enum: 827 FixItTagName = "enum "; 828 break; 829 830 case TTK_Struct: 831 FixItTagName = "struct "; 832 break; 833 834 case TTK_Interface: 835 FixItTagName = "__interface "; 836 break; 837 838 case TTK_Union: 839 FixItTagName = "union "; 840 break; 841 } 842 843 StringRef TagName = FixItTagName.drop_back(); 844 SemaRef.Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_use_of_tag_name_without_tag) 845 << Name << TagName << SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 846 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(NameLoc, FixItTagName); 847 848 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Result.begin(), IEnd = Result.end(); 849 I != IEnd; ++I) 850 SemaRef.Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_decl_hiding_tag_type) 851 << Name << TagName; 852 853 // Replace lookup results with just the tag decl. 854 Result.clear(Sema::LookupTagName); 855 SemaRef.LookupParsedName(Result, S, &SS); 856 return true; 857 } 858 859 return false; 860 } 861 862 Sema::NameClassification Sema::ClassifyName(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, 863 IdentifierInfo *&Name, 864 SourceLocation NameLoc, 865 const Token &NextToken, 866 CorrectionCandidateCallback *CCC) { 867 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(Name, NameLoc); 868 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl(); 869 870 assert(NextToken.isNot(tok::coloncolon) && 871 "parse nested name specifiers before calling ClassifyName"); 872 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && SS.isSet() && 873 isCurrentClassName(*Name, S, &SS)) { 874 // Per [class.qual]p2, this names the constructors of SS, not the 875 // injected-class-name. We don't have a classification for that. 876 // There's not much point caching this result, since the parser 877 // will reject it later. 878 return NameClassification::Unknown(); 879 } 880 881 LookupResult Result(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 882 LookupParsedName(Result, S, &SS, !CurMethod); 883 884 if (SS.isInvalid()) 885 return NameClassification::Error(); 886 887 // For unqualified lookup in a class template in MSVC mode, look into 888 // dependent base classes where the primary class template is known. 889 if (Result.empty() && SS.isEmpty() && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) { 890 if (ParsedType TypeInBase = 891 recoverFromTypeInKnownDependentBase(*this, *Name, NameLoc)) 892 return TypeInBase; 893 } 894 895 // Perform lookup for Objective-C instance variables (including automatically 896 // synthesized instance variables), if we're in an Objective-C method. 897 // FIXME: This lookup really, really needs to be folded in to the normal 898 // unqualified lookup mechanism. 899 if (SS.isEmpty() && CurMethod && !isResultTypeOrTemplate(Result, NextToken)) { 900 DeclResult Ivar = LookupIvarInObjCMethod(Result, S, Name); 901 if (Ivar.isInvalid()) 902 return NameClassification::Error(); 903 if (Ivar.isUsable()) 904 return NameClassification::NonType(cast<NamedDecl>(Ivar.get())); 905 906 // We defer builtin creation until after ivar lookup inside ObjC methods. 907 if (Result.empty()) 908 LookupBuiltin(Result); 909 } 910 911 bool SecondTry = false; 912 bool IsFilteredTemplateName = false; 913 914 Corrected: 915 switch (Result.getResultKind()) { 916 case LookupResult::NotFound: 917 // If an unqualified-id is followed by a '(', then we have a function 918 // call. 919 if (SS.isEmpty() && NextToken.is(tok::l_paren)) { 920 // In C++, this is an ADL-only call. 921 // FIXME: Reference? 922 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 923 return NameClassification::UndeclaredNonType(); 924 925 // C90 6.3.2.2: 926 // If the expression that precedes the parenthesized argument list in a 927 // function call consists solely of an identifier, and if no 928 // declaration is visible for this identifier, the identifier is 929 // implicitly declared exactly as if, in the innermost block containing 930 // the function call, the declaration 931 // 932 // extern int identifier (); 933 // 934 // appeared. 935 // 936 // We also allow this in C99 as an extension. However, this is not 937 // allowed in all language modes as functions without prototypes may not 938 // be supported. 939 if (getLangOpts().implicitFunctionsAllowed()) { 940 if (NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *Name, S)) 941 return NameClassification::NonType(D); 942 } 943 } 944 945 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 && SS.isEmpty() && NextToken.is(tok::less)) { 946 // In C++20 onwards, this could be an ADL-only call to a function 947 // template, and we're required to assume that this is a template name. 948 // 949 // FIXME: Find a way to still do typo correction in this case. 950 TemplateName Template = 951 Context.getAssumedTemplateName(NameInfo.getName()); 952 return NameClassification::UndeclaredTemplate(Template); 953 } 954 955 // In C, we first see whether there is a tag type by the same name, in 956 // which case it's likely that the user just forgot to write "enum", 957 // "struct", or "union". 958 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !SecondTry && 959 isTagTypeWithMissingTag(*this, Result, S, SS, Name, NameLoc)) { 960 break; 961 } 962 963 // Perform typo correction to determine if there is another name that is 964 // close to this name. 965 if (!SecondTry && CCC) { 966 SecondTry = true; 967 if (TypoCorrection Corrected = 968 CorrectTypo(Result.getLookupNameInfo(), Result.getLookupKind(), S, 969 &SS, *CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery)) { 970 unsigned UnqualifiedDiag = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest; 971 unsigned QualifiedDiag = diag::err_no_member_suggest; 972 973 NamedDecl *FirstDecl = Corrected.getFoundDecl(); 974 NamedDecl *UnderlyingFirstDecl = Corrected.getCorrectionDecl(); 975 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NextToken.is(tok::less) && 976 UnderlyingFirstDecl && isa<TemplateDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl)) { 977 UnqualifiedDiag = diag::err_no_template_suggest; 978 QualifiedDiag = diag::err_no_member_template_suggest; 979 } else if (UnderlyingFirstDecl && 980 (isa<TypeDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl) || 981 isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl) || 982 isa<ObjCCompatibleAliasDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl))) { 983 UnqualifiedDiag = diag::err_unknown_typename_suggest; 984 QualifiedDiag = diag::err_unknown_nested_typename_suggest; 985 } 986 987 if (SS.isEmpty()) { 988 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(UnqualifiedDiag) << Name); 989 } else {// FIXME: is this even reachable? Test it. 990 std::string CorrectedStr(Corrected.getAsString(getLangOpts())); 991 bool DroppedSpecifier = Corrected.WillReplaceSpecifier() && 992 Name->getName().equals(CorrectedStr); 993 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(QualifiedDiag) 994 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) 995 << DroppedSpecifier << SS.getRange()); 996 } 997 998 // Update the name, so that the caller has the new name. 999 Name = Corrected.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(); 1000 1001 // Typo correction corrected to a keyword. 1002 if (Corrected.isKeyword()) 1003 return Name; 1004 1005 // Also update the LookupResult... 1006 // FIXME: This should probably go away at some point 1007 Result.clear(); 1008 Result.setLookupName(Corrected.getCorrection()); 1009 if (FirstDecl) 1010 Result.addDecl(FirstDecl); 1011 1012 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let 1013 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to 1014 // reference the ivar. 1015 // FIXME: This is a gross hack. 1016 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = Result.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) { 1017 DeclResult R = 1018 LookupIvarInObjCMethod(Result, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()); 1019 if (R.isInvalid()) 1020 return NameClassification::Error(); 1021 if (R.isUsable()) 1022 return NameClassification::NonType(Ivar); 1023 } 1024 1025 goto Corrected; 1026 } 1027 } 1028 1029 // We failed to correct; just fall through and let the parser deal with it. 1030 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 1031 return NameClassification::Unknown(); 1032 1033 case LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation: { 1034 // We performed name lookup into the current instantiation, and there were 1035 // dependent bases, so we treat this result the same way as any other 1036 // dependent nested-name-specifier. 1037 1038 // C++ [temp.res]p2: 1039 // A name used in a template declaration or definition and that is 1040 // dependent on a template-parameter is assumed not to name a type 1041 // unless the applicable name lookup finds a type name or the name is 1042 // qualified by the keyword typename. 1043 // 1044 // FIXME: If the next token is '<', we might want to ask the parser to 1045 // perform some heroics to see if we actually have a 1046 // template-argument-list, which would indicate a missing 'template' 1047 // keyword here. 1048 return NameClassification::DependentNonType(); 1049 } 1050 1051 case LookupResult::Found: 1052 case LookupResult::FoundOverloaded: 1053 case LookupResult::FoundUnresolvedValue: 1054 break; 1055 1056 case LookupResult::Ambiguous: 1057 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NextToken.is(tok::less) && 1058 hasAnyAcceptableTemplateNames(Result, /*AllowFunctionTemplates=*/true, 1059 /*AllowDependent=*/false)) { 1060 // C++ [temp.local]p3: 1061 // A lookup that finds an injected-class-name (10.2) can result in an 1062 // ambiguity in certain cases (for example, if it is found in more than 1063 // one base class). If all of the injected-class-names that are found 1064 // refer to specializations of the same class template, and if the name 1065 // is followed by a template-argument-list, the reference refers to the 1066 // class template itself and not a specialization thereof, and is not 1067 // ambiguous. 1068 // 1069 // This filtering can make an ambiguous result into an unambiguous one, 1070 // so try again after filtering out template names. 1071 FilterAcceptableTemplateNames(Result); 1072 if (!Result.isAmbiguous()) { 1073 IsFilteredTemplateName = true; 1074 break; 1075 } 1076 } 1077 1078 // Diagnose the ambiguity and return an error. 1079 return NameClassification::Error(); 1080 } 1081 1082 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NextToken.is(tok::less) && 1083 (IsFilteredTemplateName || 1084 hasAnyAcceptableTemplateNames( 1085 Result, /*AllowFunctionTemplates=*/true, 1086 /*AllowDependent=*/false, 1087 /*AllowNonTemplateFunctions*/ SS.isEmpty() && 1088 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20))) { 1089 // C++ [temp.names]p3: 1090 // After name lookup (3.4) finds that a name is a template-name or that 1091 // an operator-function-id or a literal- operator-id refers to a set of 1092 // overloaded functions any member of which is a function template if 1093 // this is followed by a <, the < is always taken as the delimiter of a 1094 // template-argument-list and never as the less-than operator. 1095 // C++2a [temp.names]p2: 1096 // A name is also considered to refer to a template if it is an 1097 // unqualified-id followed by a < and name lookup finds either one 1098 // or more functions or finds nothing. 1099 if (!IsFilteredTemplateName) 1100 FilterAcceptableTemplateNames(Result); 1101 1102 bool IsFunctionTemplate; 1103 bool IsVarTemplate; 1104 TemplateName Template; 1105 if (Result.end() - Result.begin() > 1) { 1106 IsFunctionTemplate = true; 1107 Template = Context.getOverloadedTemplateName(Result.begin(), 1108 Result.end()); 1109 } else if (!Result.empty()) { 1110 auto *TD = cast<TemplateDecl>(getAsTemplateNameDecl( 1111 *Result.begin(), /*AllowFunctionTemplates=*/true, 1112 /*AllowDependent=*/false)); 1113 IsFunctionTemplate = isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(TD); 1114 IsVarTemplate = isa<VarTemplateDecl>(TD); 1115 1116 UsingShadowDecl *FoundUsingShadow = 1117 dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*Result.begin()); 1118 assert(!FoundUsingShadow || 1119 TD == cast<TemplateDecl>(FoundUsingShadow->getTargetDecl())); 1120 Template = 1121 FoundUsingShadow ? TemplateName(FoundUsingShadow) : TemplateName(TD); 1122 if (SS.isNotEmpty()) 1123 Template = Context.getQualifiedTemplateName(SS.getScopeRep(), 1124 /*TemplateKeyword=*/false, 1125 Template); 1126 } else { 1127 // All results were non-template functions. This is a function template 1128 // name. 1129 IsFunctionTemplate = true; 1130 Template = Context.getAssumedTemplateName(NameInfo.getName()); 1131 } 1132 1133 if (IsFunctionTemplate) { 1134 // Function templates always go through overload resolution, at which 1135 // point we'll perform the various checks (e.g., accessibility) we need 1136 // to based on which function we selected. 1137 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 1138 1139 return NameClassification::FunctionTemplate(Template); 1140 } 1141 1142 return IsVarTemplate ? NameClassification::VarTemplate(Template) 1143 : NameClassification::TypeTemplate(Template); 1144 } 1145 1146 auto BuildTypeFor = [&](TypeDecl *Type, NamedDecl *Found) { 1147 QualType T = Context.getTypeDeclType(Type); 1148 if (const auto *USD = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Found)) 1149 T = Context.getUsingType(USD, T); 1150 1151 if (SS.isEmpty()) // No elaborated type, trivial location info 1152 return ParsedType::make(T); 1153 1154 TypeLocBuilder Builder; 1155 Builder.pushTypeSpec(T).setNameLoc(NameLoc); 1156 T = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, SS, T); 1157 ElaboratedTypeLoc ElabTL = Builder.push<ElaboratedTypeLoc>(T); 1158 ElabTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 1159 ElabTL.setQualifierLoc(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context)); 1160 return CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T)); 1161 }; 1162 1163 NamedDecl *FirstDecl = (*Result.begin())->getUnderlyingDecl(); 1164 if (TypeDecl *Type = dyn_cast<TypeDecl>(FirstDecl)) { 1165 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Type, NameLoc); 1166 MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Type->getLocation(), Type, /*OdrUse=*/false); 1167 return BuildTypeFor(Type, *Result.begin()); 1168 } 1169 1170 ObjCInterfaceDecl *Class = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(FirstDecl); 1171 if (!Class) { 1172 // FIXME: It's unfortunate that we don't have a Type node for handling this. 1173 if (ObjCCompatibleAliasDecl *Alias = 1174 dyn_cast<ObjCCompatibleAliasDecl>(FirstDecl)) 1175 Class = Alias->getClassInterface(); 1176 } 1177 1178 if (Class) { 1179 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Class, NameLoc); 1180 1181 if (NextToken.is(tok::period)) { 1182 // Interface. <something> is parsed as a property reference expression. 1183 // Just return "unknown" as a fall-through for now. 1184 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 1185 return NameClassification::Unknown(); 1186 } 1187 1188 QualType T = Context.getObjCInterfaceType(Class); 1189 return ParsedType::make(T); 1190 } 1191 1192 if (isa<ConceptDecl>(FirstDecl)) 1193 return NameClassification::Concept( 1194 TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(FirstDecl))); 1195 1196 if (auto *EmptyD = dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>(FirstDecl)) { 1197 (void)DiagnoseUseOfDecl(EmptyD, NameLoc); 1198 return NameClassification::Error(); 1199 } 1200 1201 // We can have a type template here if we're classifying a template argument. 1202 if (isa<TemplateDecl>(FirstDecl) && !isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(FirstDecl) && 1203 !isa<VarTemplateDecl>(FirstDecl)) 1204 return NameClassification::TypeTemplate( 1205 TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(FirstDecl))); 1206 1207 // Check for a tag type hidden by a non-type decl in a few cases where it 1208 // seems likely a type is wanted instead of the non-type that was found. 1209 bool NextIsOp = NextToken.isOneOf(tok::amp, tok::star); 1210 if ((NextToken.is(tok::identifier) || 1211 (NextIsOp && 1212 FirstDecl->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate())) && 1213 isTagTypeWithMissingTag(*this, Result, S, SS, Name, NameLoc)) { 1214 TypeDecl *Type = Result.getAsSingle<TypeDecl>(); 1215 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Type, NameLoc); 1216 return BuildTypeFor(Type, *Result.begin()); 1217 } 1218 1219 // If we already know which single declaration is referenced, just annotate 1220 // that declaration directly. Defer resolving even non-overloaded class 1221 // member accesses, as we need to defer certain access checks until we know 1222 // the context. 1223 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, Result, NextToken.is(tok::l_paren)); 1224 if (Result.isSingleResult() && !ADL && !FirstDecl->isCXXClassMember()) 1225 return NameClassification::NonType(Result.getRepresentativeDecl()); 1226 1227 // Otherwise, this is an overload set that we will need to resolve later. 1228 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 1229 return NameClassification::OverloadSet(UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create( 1230 Context, Result.getNamingClass(), SS.getWithLocInContext(Context), 1231 Result.getLookupNameInfo(), ADL, Result.isOverloadedResult(), 1232 Result.begin(), Result.end())); 1233 } 1234 1235 ExprResult 1236 Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsUndeclaredNonType(IdentifierInfo *Name, 1237 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 1238 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "ADL-only call in C?"); 1239 CXXScopeSpec SS; 1240 LookupResult Result(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 1241 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, Result, /*ADL=*/true); 1242 } 1243 1244 ExprResult 1245 Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsDependentNonType(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, 1246 IdentifierInfo *Name, 1247 SourceLocation NameLoc, 1248 bool IsAddressOfOperand) { 1249 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(Name, NameLoc); 1250 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(), 1251 NameInfo, IsAddressOfOperand, 1252 /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr); 1253 } 1254 1255 ExprResult Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsNonType(Scope *S, const CXXScopeSpec &SS, 1256 NamedDecl *Found, 1257 SourceLocation NameLoc, 1258 const Token &NextToken) { 1259 if (getCurMethodDecl() && SS.isEmpty()) 1260 if (auto *Ivar = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl())) 1261 return BuildIvarRefExpr(S, NameLoc, Ivar); 1262 1263 // Reconstruct the lookup result. 1264 LookupResult Result(*this, Found->getDeclName(), NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 1265 Result.addDecl(Found); 1266 Result.resolveKind(); 1267 1268 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, Result, NextToken.is(tok::l_paren)); 1269 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, Result, ADL); 1270 } 1271 1272 ExprResult Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsOverloadSet(Scope *S, Expr *E) { 1273 // For an implicit class member access, transform the result into a member 1274 // access expression if necessary. 1275 auto *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E); 1276 if ((*ULE->decls_begin())->isCXXClassMember()) { 1277 CXXScopeSpec SS; 1278 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc()); 1279 1280 // Reconstruct the lookup result. 1281 LookupResult Result(*this, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(), 1282 LookupOrdinaryName); 1283 Result.setNamingClass(ULE->getNamingClass()); 1284 for (auto I = ULE->decls_begin(), E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) 1285 Result.addDecl(*I, I.getAccess()); 1286 Result.resolveKind(); 1287 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, SourceLocation(), Result, 1288 nullptr, S); 1289 } 1290 1291 // Otherwise, this is already in the form we needed, and no further checks 1292 // are necessary. 1293 return ULE; 1294 } 1295 1296 Sema::TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics 1297 Sema::getTemplateNameKindForDiagnostics(TemplateName Name) { 1298 auto *TD = Name.getAsTemplateDecl(); 1299 if (!TD) 1300 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::DependentTemplate; 1301 if (isa<ClassTemplateDecl>(TD)) 1302 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::ClassTemplate; 1303 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(TD)) 1304 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::FunctionTemplate; 1305 if (isa<VarTemplateDecl>(TD)) 1306 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::VarTemplate; 1307 if (isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(TD)) 1308 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::AliasTemplate; 1309 if (isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(TD)) 1310 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::TemplateTemplateParam; 1311 if (isa<ConceptDecl>(TD)) 1312 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::Concept; 1313 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::DependentTemplate; 1314 } 1315 1316 void Sema::PushDeclContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) { 1317 assert(DC->getLexicalParent() == CurContext && 1318 "The next DeclContext should be lexically contained in the current one."); 1319 CurContext = DC; 1320 S->setEntity(DC); 1321 } 1322 1323 void Sema::PopDeclContext() { 1324 assert(CurContext && "DeclContext imbalance!"); 1325 1326 CurContext = CurContext->getLexicalParent(); 1327 assert(CurContext && "Popped translation unit!"); 1328 } 1329 1330 Sema::SkippedDefinitionContext Sema::ActOnTagStartSkippedDefinition(Scope *S, 1331 Decl *D) { 1332 // Unlike PushDeclContext, the context to which we return is not necessarily 1333 // the containing DC of TD, because the new context will be some pre-existing 1334 // TagDecl definition instead of a fresh one. 1335 auto Result = static_cast<SkippedDefinitionContext>(CurContext); 1336 CurContext = cast<TagDecl>(D)->getDefinition(); 1337 assert(CurContext && "skipping definition of undefined tag"); 1338 // Start lookups from the parent of the current context; we don't want to look 1339 // into the pre-existing complete definition. 1340 S->setEntity(CurContext->getLookupParent()); 1341 return Result; 1342 } 1343 1344 void Sema::ActOnTagFinishSkippedDefinition(SkippedDefinitionContext Context) { 1345 CurContext = static_cast<decltype(CurContext)>(Context); 1346 } 1347 1348 /// EnterDeclaratorContext - Used when we must lookup names in the context 1349 /// of a declarator's nested name specifier. 1350 /// 1351 void Sema::EnterDeclaratorContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) { 1352 // C++0x [basic.lookup.unqual]p13: 1353 // A name used in the definition of a static data member of class 1354 // X (after the qualified-id of the static member) is looked up as 1355 // if the name was used in a member function of X. 1356 // C++0x [basic.lookup.unqual]p14: 1357 // If a variable member of a namespace is defined outside of the 1358 // scope of its namespace then any name used in the definition of 1359 // the variable member (after the declarator-id) is looked up as 1360 // if the definition of the variable member occurred in its 1361 // namespace. 1362 // Both of these imply that we should push a scope whose context 1363 // is the semantic context of the declaration. We can't use 1364 // PushDeclContext here because that context is not necessarily 1365 // lexically contained in the current context. Fortunately, 1366 // the containing scope should have the appropriate information. 1367 1368 assert(!S->getEntity() && "scope already has entity"); 1369 1370 #ifndef NDEBUG 1371 Scope *Ancestor = S->getParent(); 1372 while (!Ancestor->getEntity()) Ancestor = Ancestor->getParent(); 1373 assert(Ancestor->getEntity() == CurContext && "ancestor context mismatch"); 1374 #endif 1375 1376 CurContext = DC; 1377 S->setEntity(DC); 1378 1379 if (S->getParent()->isTemplateParamScope()) { 1380 // Also set the corresponding entities for all immediately-enclosing 1381 // template parameter scopes. 1382 EnterTemplatedContext(S->getParent(), DC); 1383 } 1384 } 1385 1386 void Sema::ExitDeclaratorContext(Scope *S) { 1387 assert(S->getEntity() == CurContext && "Context imbalance!"); 1388 1389 // Switch back to the lexical context. The safety of this is 1390 // enforced by an assert in EnterDeclaratorContext. 1391 Scope *Ancestor = S->getParent(); 1392 while (!Ancestor->getEntity()) Ancestor = Ancestor->getParent(); 1393 CurContext = Ancestor->getEntity(); 1394 1395 // We don't need to do anything with the scope, which is going to 1396 // disappear. 1397 } 1398 1399 void Sema::EnterTemplatedContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) { 1400 assert(S->isTemplateParamScope() && 1401 "expected to be initializing a template parameter scope"); 1402 1403 // C++20 [temp.local]p7: 1404 // In the definition of a member of a class template that appears outside 1405 // of the class template definition, the name of a member of the class 1406 // template hides the name of a template-parameter of any enclosing class 1407 // templates (but not a template-parameter of the member if the member is a 1408 // class or function template). 1409 // C++20 [temp.local]p9: 1410 // In the definition of a class template or in the definition of a member 1411 // of such a template that appears outside of the template definition, for 1412 // each non-dependent base class (13.8.2.1), if the name of the base class 1413 // or the name of a member of the base class is the same as the name of a 1414 // template-parameter, the base class name or member name hides the 1415 // template-parameter name (6.4.10). 1416 // 1417 // This means that a template parameter scope should be searched immediately 1418 // after searching the DeclContext for which it is a template parameter 1419 // scope. For example, for 1420 // template<typename T> template<typename U> template<typename V> 1421 // void N::A<T>::B<U>::f(...) 1422 // we search V then B<U> (and base classes) then U then A<T> (and base 1423 // classes) then T then N then ::. 1424 unsigned ScopeDepth = getTemplateDepth(S); 1425 for (; S && S->isTemplateParamScope(); S = S->getParent(), --ScopeDepth) { 1426 DeclContext *SearchDCAfterScope = DC; 1427 for (; DC; DC = DC->getLookupParent()) { 1428 if (const TemplateParameterList *TPL = 1429 cast<Decl>(DC)->getDescribedTemplateParams()) { 1430 unsigned DCDepth = TPL->getDepth() + 1; 1431 if (DCDepth > ScopeDepth) 1432 continue; 1433 if (ScopeDepth == DCDepth) 1434 SearchDCAfterScope = DC = DC->getLookupParent(); 1435 break; 1436 } 1437 } 1438 S->setLookupEntity(SearchDCAfterScope); 1439 } 1440 } 1441 1442 void Sema::ActOnReenterFunctionContext(Scope* S, Decl *D) { 1443 // We assume that the caller has already called 1444 // ActOnReenterTemplateScope so getTemplatedDecl() works. 1445 FunctionDecl *FD = D->getAsFunction(); 1446 if (!FD) 1447 return; 1448 1449 // Same implementation as PushDeclContext, but enters the context 1450 // from the lexical parent, rather than the top-level class. 1451 assert(CurContext == FD->getLexicalParent() && 1452 "The next DeclContext should be lexically contained in the current one."); 1453 CurContext = FD; 1454 S->setEntity(CurContext); 1455 1456 for (unsigned P = 0, NumParams = FD->getNumParams(); P < NumParams; ++P) { 1457 ParmVarDecl *Param = FD->getParamDecl(P); 1458 // If the parameter has an identifier, then add it to the scope 1459 if (Param->getIdentifier()) { 1460 S->AddDecl(Param); 1461 IdResolver.AddDecl(Param); 1462 } 1463 } 1464 } 1465 1466 void Sema::ActOnExitFunctionContext() { 1467 // Same implementation as PopDeclContext, but returns to the lexical parent, 1468 // rather than the top-level class. 1469 assert(CurContext && "DeclContext imbalance!"); 1470 CurContext = CurContext->getLexicalParent(); 1471 assert(CurContext && "Popped translation unit!"); 1472 } 1473 1474 /// Determine whether overloading is allowed for a new function 1475 /// declaration considering prior declarations of the same name. 1476 /// 1477 /// This routine determines whether overloading is possible, not 1478 /// whether a new declaration actually overloads a previous one. 1479 /// It will return true in C++ (where overloads are alway permitted) 1480 /// or, as a C extension, when either the new declaration or a 1481 /// previous one is declared with the 'overloadable' attribute. 1482 static bool AllowOverloadingOfFunction(const LookupResult &Previous, 1483 ASTContext &Context, 1484 const FunctionDecl *New) { 1485 if (Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || New->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>()) 1486 return true; 1487 1488 // Multiversion function declarations are not overloads in the 1489 // usual sense of that term, but lookup will report that an 1490 // overload set was found if more than one multiversion function 1491 // declaration is present for the same name. It is therefore 1492 // inadequate to assume that some prior declaration(s) had 1493 // the overloadable attribute; checking is required. Since one 1494 // declaration is permitted to omit the attribute, it is necessary 1495 // to check at least two; hence the 'any_of' check below. Note that 1496 // the overloadable attribute is implicitly added to declarations 1497 // that were required to have it but did not. 1498 if (Previous.getResultKind() == LookupResult::FoundOverloaded) { 1499 return llvm::any_of(Previous, [](const NamedDecl *ND) { 1500 return ND->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 1501 }); 1502 } else if (Previous.getResultKind() == LookupResult::Found) 1503 return Previous.getFoundDecl()->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 1504 1505 return false; 1506 } 1507 1508 /// Add this decl to the scope shadowed decl chains. 1509 void Sema::PushOnScopeChains(NamedDecl *D, Scope *S, bool AddToContext) { 1510 // Move up the scope chain until we find the nearest enclosing 1511 // non-transparent context. The declaration will be introduced into this 1512 // scope. 1513 while (S->getEntity() && S->getEntity()->isTransparentContext()) 1514 S = S->getParent(); 1515 1516 // Add scoped declarations into their context, so that they can be 1517 // found later. Declarations without a context won't be inserted 1518 // into any context. 1519 if (AddToContext) 1520 CurContext->addDecl(D); 1521 1522 // Out-of-line definitions shouldn't be pushed into scope in C++, unless they 1523 // are function-local declarations. 1524 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && D->isOutOfLine() && !S->getFnParent()) 1525 return; 1526 1527 // Template instantiations should also not be pushed into scope. 1528 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D) && 1529 cast<FunctionDecl>(D)->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization()) 1530 return; 1531 1532 // If this replaces anything in the current scope, 1533 IdentifierResolver::iterator I = IdResolver.begin(D->getDeclName()), 1534 IEnd = IdResolver.end(); 1535 for (; I != IEnd; ++I) { 1536 if (S->isDeclScope(*I) && D->declarationReplaces(*I)) { 1537 S->RemoveDecl(*I); 1538 IdResolver.RemoveDecl(*I); 1539 1540 // Should only need to replace one decl. 1541 break; 1542 } 1543 } 1544 1545 S->AddDecl(D); 1546 1547 if (isa<LabelDecl>(D) && !cast<LabelDecl>(D)->isGnuLocal()) { 1548 // Implicitly-generated labels may end up getting generated in an order that 1549 // isn't strictly lexical, which breaks name lookup. Be careful to insert 1550 // the label at the appropriate place in the identifier chain. 1551 for (I = IdResolver.begin(D->getDeclName()); I != IEnd; ++I) { 1552 DeclContext *IDC = (*I)->getLexicalDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 1553 if (IDC == CurContext) { 1554 if (!S->isDeclScope(*I)) 1555 continue; 1556 } else if (IDC->Encloses(CurContext)) 1557 break; 1558 } 1559 1560 IdResolver.InsertDeclAfter(I, D); 1561 } else { 1562 IdResolver.AddDecl(D); 1563 } 1564 warnOnReservedIdentifier(D); 1565 } 1566 1567 bool Sema::isDeclInScope(NamedDecl *D, DeclContext *Ctx, Scope *S, 1568 bool AllowInlineNamespace) { 1569 return IdResolver.isDeclInScope(D, Ctx, S, AllowInlineNamespace); 1570 } 1571 1572 Scope *Sema::getScopeForDeclContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) { 1573 DeclContext *TargetDC = DC->getPrimaryContext(); 1574 do { 1575 if (DeclContext *ScopeDC = S->getEntity()) 1576 if (ScopeDC->getPrimaryContext() == TargetDC) 1577 return S; 1578 } while ((S = S->getParent())); 1579 1580 return nullptr; 1581 } 1582 1583 static bool isOutOfScopePreviousDeclaration(NamedDecl *, 1584 DeclContext*, 1585 ASTContext&); 1586 1587 /// Filters out lookup results that don't fall within the given scope 1588 /// as determined by isDeclInScope. 1589 void Sema::FilterLookupForScope(LookupResult &R, DeclContext *Ctx, Scope *S, 1590 bool ConsiderLinkage, 1591 bool AllowInlineNamespace) { 1592 LookupResult::Filter F = R.makeFilter(); 1593 while (F.hasNext()) { 1594 NamedDecl *D = F.next(); 1595 1596 if (isDeclInScope(D, Ctx, S, AllowInlineNamespace)) 1597 continue; 1598 1599 if (ConsiderLinkage && isOutOfScopePreviousDeclaration(D, Ctx, Context)) 1600 continue; 1601 1602 F.erase(); 1603 } 1604 1605 F.done(); 1606 } 1607 1608 /// We've determined that \p New is a redeclaration of \p Old. Check that they 1609 /// have compatible owning modules. 1610 bool Sema::CheckRedeclarationModuleOwnership(NamedDecl *New, NamedDecl *Old) { 1611 // [module.interface]p7: 1612 // A declaration is attached to a module as follows: 1613 // - If the declaration is a non-dependent friend declaration that nominates a 1614 // function with a declarator-id that is a qualified-id or template-id or that 1615 // nominates a class other than with an elaborated-type-specifier with neither 1616 // a nested-name-specifier nor a simple-template-id, it is attached to the 1617 // module to which the friend is attached ([basic.link]). 1618 if (New->getFriendObjectKind() && 1619 Old->getOwningModuleForLinkage() != New->getOwningModuleForLinkage()) { 1620 New->setLocalOwningModule(Old->getOwningModule()); 1621 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(New); 1622 return false; 1623 } 1624 1625 Module *NewM = New->getOwningModule(); 1626 Module *OldM = Old->getOwningModule(); 1627 1628 if (NewM && NewM->Kind == Module::PrivateModuleFragment) 1629 NewM = NewM->Parent; 1630 if (OldM && OldM->Kind == Module::PrivateModuleFragment) 1631 OldM = OldM->Parent; 1632 1633 // If we have a decl in a module partition, it is part of the containing 1634 // module (which is the only thing that can be importing it). 1635 if (NewM && OldM && 1636 (OldM->Kind == Module::ModulePartitionInterface || 1637 OldM->Kind == Module::ModulePartitionImplementation)) { 1638 return false; 1639 } 1640 1641 if (NewM == OldM) 1642 return false; 1643 1644 bool NewIsModuleInterface = NewM && NewM->isModulePurview(); 1645 bool OldIsModuleInterface = OldM && OldM->isModulePurview(); 1646 if (NewIsModuleInterface || OldIsModuleInterface) { 1647 // C++ Modules TS [basic.def.odr] 6.2/6.7 [sic]: 1648 // if a declaration of D [...] appears in the purview of a module, all 1649 // other such declarations shall appear in the purview of the same module 1650 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_mismatched_owning_module) 1651 << New 1652 << NewIsModuleInterface 1653 << (NewIsModuleInterface ? NewM->getFullModuleName() : "") 1654 << OldIsModuleInterface 1655 << (OldIsModuleInterface ? OldM->getFullModuleName() : ""); 1656 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 1657 New->setInvalidDecl(); 1658 return true; 1659 } 1660 1661 return false; 1662 } 1663 1664 // [module.interface]p6: 1665 // A redeclaration of an entity X is implicitly exported if X was introduced by 1666 // an exported declaration; otherwise it shall not be exported. 1667 bool Sema::CheckRedeclarationExported(NamedDecl *New, NamedDecl *Old) { 1668 // [module.interface]p1: 1669 // An export-declaration shall inhabit a namespace scope. 1670 // 1671 // So it is meaningless to talk about redeclaration which is not at namespace 1672 // scope. 1673 if (!New->getLexicalDeclContext() 1674 ->getNonTransparentContext() 1675 ->isFileContext() || 1676 !Old->getLexicalDeclContext() 1677 ->getNonTransparentContext() 1678 ->isFileContext()) 1679 return false; 1680 1681 bool IsNewExported = New->isInExportDeclContext(); 1682 bool IsOldExported = Old->isInExportDeclContext(); 1683 1684 // It should be irrevelant if both of them are not exported. 1685 if (!IsNewExported && !IsOldExported) 1686 return false; 1687 1688 if (IsOldExported) 1689 return false; 1690 1691 assert(IsNewExported); 1692 1693 auto Lk = Old->getFormalLinkage(); 1694 int S = 0; 1695 if (Lk == Linkage::InternalLinkage) 1696 S = 1; 1697 else if (Lk == Linkage::ModuleLinkage) 1698 S = 2; 1699 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redeclaration_non_exported) << New << S; 1700 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 1701 return true; 1702 } 1703 1704 // A wrapper function for checking the semantic restrictions of 1705 // a redeclaration within a module. 1706 bool Sema::CheckRedeclarationInModule(NamedDecl *New, NamedDecl *Old) { 1707 if (CheckRedeclarationModuleOwnership(New, Old)) 1708 return true; 1709 1710 if (CheckRedeclarationExported(New, Old)) 1711 return true; 1712 1713 return false; 1714 } 1715 1716 static bool isUsingDecl(NamedDecl *D) { 1717 return isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) || 1718 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(D) || 1719 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(D); 1720 } 1721 1722 /// Removes using shadow declarations from the lookup results. 1723 static void RemoveUsingDecls(LookupResult &R) { 1724 LookupResult::Filter F = R.makeFilter(); 1725 while (F.hasNext()) 1726 if (isUsingDecl(F.next())) 1727 F.erase(); 1728 1729 F.done(); 1730 } 1731 1732 /// Check for this common pattern: 1733 /// @code 1734 /// class S { 1735 /// S(const S&); // DO NOT IMPLEMENT 1736 /// void operator=(const S&); // DO NOT IMPLEMENT 1737 /// }; 1738 /// @endcode 1739 static bool IsDisallowedCopyOrAssign(const CXXMethodDecl *D) { 1740 // FIXME: Should check for private access too but access is set after we get 1741 // the decl here. 1742 if (D->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody()) 1743 return false; 1744 1745 if (const CXXConstructorDecl *CD = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) 1746 return CD->isCopyConstructor(); 1747 return D->isCopyAssignmentOperator(); 1748 } 1749 1750 // We need this to handle 1751 // 1752 // typedef struct { 1753 // void *foo() { return 0; } 1754 // } A; 1755 // 1756 // When we see foo we don't know if after the typedef we will get 'A' or '*A' 1757 // for example. If 'A', foo will have external linkage. If we have '*A', 1758 // foo will have no linkage. Since we can't know until we get to the end 1759 // of the typedef, this function finds out if D might have non-external linkage. 1760 // Callers should verify at the end of the TU if it D has external linkage or 1761 // not. 1762 bool Sema::mightHaveNonExternalLinkage(const DeclaratorDecl *D) { 1763 const DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext(); 1764 while (!DC->isTranslationUnit()) { 1765 if (const RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(DC)){ 1766 if (!RD->hasNameForLinkage()) 1767 return true; 1768 } 1769 DC = DC->getParent(); 1770 } 1771 1772 return !D->isExternallyVisible(); 1773 } 1774 1775 // FIXME: This needs to be refactored; some other isInMainFile users want 1776 // these semantics. 1777 static bool isMainFileLoc(const Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) { 1778 if (S.TUKind != TU_Complete) 1779 return false; 1780 return S.SourceMgr.isInMainFile(Loc); 1781 } 1782 1783 bool Sema::ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(const DeclaratorDecl *D) const { 1784 assert(D); 1785 1786 if (D->isInvalidDecl() || D->isUsed() || D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) 1787 return false; 1788 1789 // Ignore all entities declared within templates, and out-of-line definitions 1790 // of members of class templates. 1791 if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext() || 1792 D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isDependentContext()) 1793 return false; 1794 1795 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 1796 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) 1797 return false; 1798 // A non-out-of-line declaration of a member specialization was implicitly 1799 // instantiated; it's the out-of-line declaration that we're interested in. 1800 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization && 1801 FD->getMemberSpecializationInfo() && !FD->isOutOfLine()) 1802 return false; 1803 1804 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) { 1805 if (MD->isVirtual() || IsDisallowedCopyOrAssign(MD)) 1806 return false; 1807 } else { 1808 // 'static inline' functions are defined in headers; don't warn. 1809 if (FD->isInlined() && !isMainFileLoc(*this, FD->getLocation())) 1810 return false; 1811 } 1812 1813 if (FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody() && 1814 Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(FD)) 1815 return false; 1816 } else if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 1817 // Constants and utility variables are defined in headers with internal 1818 // linkage; don't warn. (Unlike functions, there isn't a convenient marker 1819 // like "inline".) 1820 if (!isMainFileLoc(*this, VD->getLocation())) 1821 return false; 1822 1823 if (Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(VD)) 1824 return false; 1825 1826 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() && 1827 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) 1828 return false; 1829 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() && 1830 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization && 1831 VD->getMemberSpecializationInfo() && !VD->isOutOfLine()) 1832 return false; 1833 1834 if (VD->isInline() && !isMainFileLoc(*this, VD->getLocation())) 1835 return false; 1836 } else { 1837 return false; 1838 } 1839 1840 // Only warn for unused decls internal to the translation unit. 1841 // FIXME: This seems like a bogus check; it suppresses -Wunused-function 1842 // for inline functions defined in the main source file, for instance. 1843 return mightHaveNonExternalLinkage(D); 1844 } 1845 1846 void Sema::MarkUnusedFileScopedDecl(const DeclaratorDecl *D) { 1847 if (!D) 1848 return; 1849 1850 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 1851 const FunctionDecl *First = FD->getFirstDecl(); 1852 if (FD != First && ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(First)) 1853 return; // First should already be in the vector. 1854 } 1855 1856 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 1857 const VarDecl *First = VD->getFirstDecl(); 1858 if (VD != First && ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(First)) 1859 return; // First should already be in the vector. 1860 } 1861 1862 if (ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(D)) 1863 UnusedFileScopedDecls.push_back(D); 1864 } 1865 1866 static bool ShouldDiagnoseUnusedDecl(const NamedDecl *D) { 1867 if (D->isInvalidDecl()) 1868 return false; 1869 1870 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(D)) { 1871 // For a decomposition declaration, warn if none of the bindings are 1872 // referenced, instead of if the variable itself is referenced (which 1873 // it is, by the bindings' expressions). 1874 for (auto *BD : DD->bindings()) 1875 if (BD->isReferenced()) 1876 return false; 1877 } else if (!D->getDeclName()) { 1878 return false; 1879 } else if (D->isReferenced() || D->isUsed()) { 1880 return false; 1881 } 1882 1883 if (D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>() || D->hasAttr<ObjCPreciseLifetimeAttr>()) 1884 return false; 1885 1886 if (isa<LabelDecl>(D)) 1887 return true; 1888 1889 // Except for labels, we only care about unused decls that are local to 1890 // functions. 1891 bool WithinFunction = D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod(); 1892 if (const auto *R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext())) 1893 // For dependent types, the diagnostic is deferred. 1894 WithinFunction = 1895 WithinFunction || (R->isLocalClass() && !R->isDependentType()); 1896 if (!WithinFunction) 1897 return false; 1898 1899 if (isa<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) 1900 return true; 1901 1902 // White-list anything that isn't a local variable. 1903 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) || isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) || isa<ImplicitParamDecl>(D)) 1904 return false; 1905 1906 // Types of valid local variables should be complete, so this should succeed. 1907 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 1908 1909 const Expr *Init = VD->getInit(); 1910 if (const auto *Cleanups = dyn_cast_or_null<ExprWithCleanups>(Init)) 1911 Init = Cleanups->getSubExpr(); 1912 1913 const auto *Ty = VD->getType().getTypePtr(); 1914 1915 // Only look at the outermost level of typedef. 1916 if (const TypedefType *TT = Ty->getAs<TypedefType>()) { 1917 // Allow anything marked with __attribute__((unused)). 1918 if (TT->getDecl()->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) 1919 return false; 1920 } 1921 1922 // Warn for reference variables whose initializtion performs lifetime 1923 // extension. 1924 if (const auto *MTE = dyn_cast_or_null<MaterializeTemporaryExpr>(Init)) { 1925 if (MTE->getExtendingDecl()) { 1926 Ty = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType().getTypePtr(); 1927 Init = MTE->getSubExpr()->IgnoreImplicitAsWritten(); 1928 } 1929 } 1930 1931 // If we failed to complete the type for some reason, or if the type is 1932 // dependent, don't diagnose the variable. 1933 if (Ty->isIncompleteType() || Ty->isDependentType()) 1934 return false; 1935 1936 // Look at the element type to ensure that the warning behaviour is 1937 // consistent for both scalars and arrays. 1938 Ty = Ty->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe(); 1939 1940 if (const TagType *TT = Ty->getAs<TagType>()) { 1941 const TagDecl *Tag = TT->getDecl(); 1942 if (Tag->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) 1943 return false; 1944 1945 if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag)) { 1946 if (!RD->hasTrivialDestructor() && !RD->hasAttr<WarnUnusedAttr>()) 1947 return false; 1948 1949 if (Init) { 1950 const CXXConstructExpr *Construct = 1951 dyn_cast<CXXConstructExpr>(Init); 1952 if (Construct && !Construct->isElidable()) { 1953 CXXConstructorDecl *CD = Construct->getConstructor(); 1954 if (!CD->isTrivial() && !RD->hasAttr<WarnUnusedAttr>() && 1955 (VD->getInit()->isValueDependent() || !VD->evaluateValue())) 1956 return false; 1957 } 1958 1959 // Suppress the warning if we don't know how this is constructed, and 1960 // it could possibly be non-trivial constructor. 1961 if (Init->isTypeDependent()) { 1962 for (const CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor : RD->ctors()) 1963 if (!Ctor->isTrivial()) 1964 return false; 1965 } 1966 1967 // Suppress the warning if the constructor is unresolved because 1968 // its arguments are dependent. 1969 if (isa<CXXUnresolvedConstructExpr>(Init)) 1970 return false; 1971 } 1972 } 1973 } 1974 1975 // TODO: __attribute__((unused)) templates? 1976 } 1977 1978 return true; 1979 } 1980 1981 static void GenerateFixForUnusedDecl(const NamedDecl *D, ASTContext &Ctx, 1982 FixItHint &Hint) { 1983 if (isa<LabelDecl>(D)) { 1984 SourceLocation AfterColon = Lexer::findLocationAfterToken( 1985 D->getEndLoc(), tok::colon, Ctx.getSourceManager(), Ctx.getLangOpts(), 1986 true); 1987 if (AfterColon.isInvalid()) 1988 return; 1989 Hint = FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 1990 CharSourceRange::getCharRange(D->getBeginLoc(), AfterColon)); 1991 } 1992 } 1993 1994 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedNestedTypedefs(const RecordDecl *D) { 1995 if (D->getTypeForDecl()->isDependentType()) 1996 return; 1997 1998 for (auto *TmpD : D->decls()) { 1999 if (const auto *T = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(TmpD)) 2000 DiagnoseUnusedDecl(T); 2001 else if(const auto *R = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(TmpD)) 2002 DiagnoseUnusedNestedTypedefs(R); 2003 } 2004 } 2005 2006 /// DiagnoseUnusedDecl - Emit warnings about declarations that are not used 2007 /// unless they are marked attr(unused). 2008 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedDecl(const NamedDecl *D) { 2009 if (!ShouldDiagnoseUnusedDecl(D)) 2010 return; 2011 2012 if (auto *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) { 2013 // typedefs can be referenced later on, so the diagnostics are emitted 2014 // at end-of-translation-unit. 2015 UnusedLocalTypedefNameCandidates.insert(TD); 2016 return; 2017 } 2018 2019 FixItHint Hint; 2020 GenerateFixForUnusedDecl(D, Context, Hint); 2021 2022 unsigned DiagID; 2023 if (isa<VarDecl>(D) && cast<VarDecl>(D)->isExceptionVariable()) 2024 DiagID = diag::warn_unused_exception_param; 2025 else if (isa<LabelDecl>(D)) 2026 DiagID = diag::warn_unused_label; 2027 else 2028 DiagID = diag::warn_unused_variable; 2029 2030 Diag(D->getLocation(), DiagID) << D << Hint; 2031 } 2032 2033 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedButSetDecl(const VarDecl *VD) { 2034 // If it's not referenced, it can't be set. If it has the Cleanup attribute, 2035 // it's not really unused. 2036 if (!VD->isReferenced() || !VD->getDeclName() || VD->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>() || 2037 VD->hasAttr<CleanupAttr>()) 2038 return; 2039 2040 const auto *Ty = VD->getType().getTypePtr()->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe(); 2041 2042 if (Ty->isReferenceType() || Ty->isDependentType()) 2043 return; 2044 2045 if (const TagType *TT = Ty->getAs<TagType>()) { 2046 const TagDecl *Tag = TT->getDecl(); 2047 if (Tag->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) 2048 return; 2049 // In C++, don't warn for record types that don't have WarnUnusedAttr, to 2050 // mimic gcc's behavior. 2051 if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag)) { 2052 if (!RD->hasAttr<WarnUnusedAttr>()) 2053 return; 2054 } 2055 } 2056 2057 // Don't warn about __block Objective-C pointer variables, as they might 2058 // be assigned in the block but not used elsewhere for the purpose of lifetime 2059 // extension. 2060 if (VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() && Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 2061 return; 2062 2063 // Don't warn about Objective-C pointer variables with precise lifetime 2064 // semantics; they can be used to ensure ARC releases the object at a known 2065 // time, which may mean assignment but no other references. 2066 if (VD->hasAttr<ObjCPreciseLifetimeAttr>() && Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 2067 return; 2068 2069 auto iter = RefsMinusAssignments.find(VD); 2070 if (iter == RefsMinusAssignments.end()) 2071 return; 2072 2073 assert(iter->getSecond() >= 0 && 2074 "Found a negative number of references to a VarDecl"); 2075 if (iter->getSecond() != 0) 2076 return; 2077 unsigned DiagID = isa<ParmVarDecl>(VD) ? diag::warn_unused_but_set_parameter 2078 : diag::warn_unused_but_set_variable; 2079 Diag(VD->getLocation(), DiagID) << VD; 2080 } 2081 2082 static void CheckPoppedLabel(LabelDecl *L, Sema &S) { 2083 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto 2084 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it. Label fwd 2085 // definitions are indicated with a null substmt which is also not a resolved 2086 // MS inline assembly label name. 2087 bool Diagnose = false; 2088 if (L->isMSAsmLabel()) 2089 Diagnose = !L->isResolvedMSAsmLabel(); 2090 else 2091 Diagnose = L->getStmt() == nullptr; 2092 if (Diagnose) 2093 S.Diag(L->getLocation(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L; 2094 } 2095 2096 void Sema::ActOnPopScope(SourceLocation Loc, Scope *S) { 2097 S->mergeNRVOIntoParent(); 2098 2099 if (S->decl_empty()) return; 2100 assert((S->getFlags() & (Scope::DeclScope | Scope::TemplateParamScope)) && 2101 "Scope shouldn't contain decls!"); 2102 2103 for (auto *TmpD : S->decls()) { 2104 assert(TmpD && "This decl didn't get pushed??"); 2105 2106 assert(isa<NamedDecl>(TmpD) && "Decl isn't NamedDecl?"); 2107 NamedDecl *D = cast<NamedDecl>(TmpD); 2108 2109 // Diagnose unused variables in this scope. 2110 if (!S->hasUnrecoverableErrorOccurred()) { 2111 DiagnoseUnusedDecl(D); 2112 if (const auto *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(D)) 2113 DiagnoseUnusedNestedTypedefs(RD); 2114 if (VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 2115 DiagnoseUnusedButSetDecl(VD); 2116 RefsMinusAssignments.erase(VD); 2117 } 2118 } 2119 2120 if (!D->getDeclName()) continue; 2121 2122 // If this was a forward reference to a label, verify it was defined. 2123 if (LabelDecl *LD = dyn_cast<LabelDecl>(D)) 2124 CheckPoppedLabel(LD, *this); 2125 2126 // Remove this name from our lexical scope, and warn on it if we haven't 2127 // already. 2128 IdResolver.RemoveDecl(D); 2129 auto ShadowI = ShadowingDecls.find(D); 2130 if (ShadowI != ShadowingDecls.end()) { 2131 if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(ShadowI->second)) { 2132 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::warn_ctor_parm_shadows_field) 2133 << D << FD << FD->getParent(); 2134 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 2135 } 2136 ShadowingDecls.erase(ShadowI); 2137 } 2138 } 2139 } 2140 2141 /// Look for an Objective-C class in the translation unit. 2142 /// 2143 /// \param Id The name of the Objective-C class we're looking for. If 2144 /// typo-correction fixes this name, the Id will be updated 2145 /// to the fixed name. 2146 /// 2147 /// \param IdLoc The location of the name in the translation unit. 2148 /// 2149 /// \param DoTypoCorrection If true, this routine will attempt typo correction 2150 /// if there is no class with the given name. 2151 /// 2152 /// \returns The declaration of the named Objective-C class, or NULL if the 2153 /// class could not be found. 2154 ObjCInterfaceDecl *Sema::getObjCInterfaceDecl(IdentifierInfo *&Id, 2155 SourceLocation IdLoc, 2156 bool DoTypoCorrection) { 2157 // The third "scope" argument is 0 since we aren't enabling lazy built-in 2158 // creation from this context. 2159 NamedDecl *IDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, Id, IdLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 2160 2161 if (!IDecl && DoTypoCorrection) { 2162 // Perform typo correction at the given location, but only if we 2163 // find an Objective-C class name. 2164 DeclFilterCCC<ObjCInterfaceDecl> CCC{}; 2165 if (TypoCorrection C = 2166 CorrectTypo(DeclarationNameInfo(Id, IdLoc), LookupOrdinaryName, 2167 TUScope, nullptr, CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery)) { 2168 diagnoseTypo(C, PDiag(diag::err_undef_interface_suggest) << Id); 2169 IDecl = C.getCorrectionDeclAs<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(); 2170 Id = IDecl->getIdentifier(); 2171 } 2172 } 2173 ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(IDecl); 2174 // This routine must always return a class definition, if any. 2175 if (Def && Def->getDefinition()) 2176 Def = Def->getDefinition(); 2177 return Def; 2178 } 2179 2180 /// getNonFieldDeclScope - Retrieves the innermost scope, starting 2181 /// from S, where a non-field would be declared. This routine copes 2182 /// with the difference between C and C++ scoping rules in structs and 2183 /// unions. For example, the following code is well-formed in C but 2184 /// ill-formed in C++: 2185 /// @code 2186 /// struct S6 { 2187 /// enum { BAR } e; 2188 /// }; 2189 /// 2190 /// void test_S6() { 2191 /// struct S6 a; 2192 /// a.e = BAR; 2193 /// } 2194 /// @endcode 2195 /// For the declaration of BAR, this routine will return a different 2196 /// scope. The scope S will be the scope of the unnamed enumeration 2197 /// within S6. In C++, this routine will return the scope associated 2198 /// with S6, because the enumeration's scope is a transparent 2199 /// context but structures can contain non-field names. In C, this 2200 /// routine will return the translation unit scope, since the 2201 /// enumeration's scope is a transparent context and structures cannot 2202 /// contain non-field names. 2203 Scope *Sema::getNonFieldDeclScope(Scope *S) { 2204 while (((S->getFlags() & Scope::DeclScope) == 0) || 2205 (S->getEntity() && S->getEntity()->isTransparentContext()) || 2206 (S->isClassScope() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)) 2207 S = S->getParent(); 2208 return S; 2209 } 2210 2211 static StringRef getHeaderName(Builtin::Context &BuiltinInfo, unsigned ID, 2212 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError Error) { 2213 switch (Error) { 2214 case ASTContext::GE_None: 2215 return ""; 2216 case ASTContext::GE_Missing_type: 2217 return BuiltinInfo.getHeaderName(ID); 2218 case ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio: 2219 return "stdio.h"; 2220 case ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp: 2221 return "setjmp.h"; 2222 case ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext: 2223 return "ucontext.h"; 2224 } 2225 llvm_unreachable("unhandled error kind"); 2226 } 2227 2228 FunctionDecl *Sema::CreateBuiltin(IdentifierInfo *II, QualType Type, 2229 unsigned ID, SourceLocation Loc) { 2230 DeclContext *Parent = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl(); 2231 2232 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 2233 LinkageSpecDecl *CLinkageDecl = LinkageSpecDecl::Create( 2234 Context, Parent, Loc, Loc, LinkageSpecDecl::lang_c, false); 2235 CLinkageDecl->setImplicit(); 2236 Parent->addDecl(CLinkageDecl); 2237 Parent = CLinkageDecl; 2238 } 2239 2240 FunctionDecl *New = FunctionDecl::Create(Context, Parent, Loc, Loc, II, Type, 2241 /*TInfo=*/nullptr, SC_Extern, 2242 getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), 2243 false, Type->isFunctionProtoType()); 2244 New->setImplicit(); 2245 New->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ID)); 2246 2247 // Create Decl objects for each parameter, adding them to the 2248 // FunctionDecl. 2249 if (const FunctionProtoType *FT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Type)) { 2250 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl *, 16> Params; 2251 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FT->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) { 2252 ParmVarDecl *parm = ParmVarDecl::Create( 2253 Context, New, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), nullptr, 2254 FT->getParamType(i), /*TInfo=*/nullptr, SC_None, nullptr); 2255 parm->setScopeInfo(0, i); 2256 Params.push_back(parm); 2257 } 2258 New->setParams(Params); 2259 } 2260 2261 AddKnownFunctionAttributes(New); 2262 return New; 2263 } 2264 2265 /// LazilyCreateBuiltin - The specified Builtin-ID was first used at 2266 /// file scope. lazily create a decl for it. ForRedeclaration is true 2267 /// if we're creating this built-in in anticipation of redeclaring the 2268 /// built-in. 2269 NamedDecl *Sema::LazilyCreateBuiltin(IdentifierInfo *II, unsigned ID, 2270 Scope *S, bool ForRedeclaration, 2271 SourceLocation Loc) { 2272 LookupNecessaryTypesForBuiltin(S, ID); 2273 2274 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError Error; 2275 QualType R = Context.GetBuiltinType(ID, Error); 2276 if (Error) { 2277 if (!ForRedeclaration) 2278 return nullptr; 2279 2280 // If we have a builtin without an associated type we should not emit a 2281 // warning when we were not able to find a type for it. 2282 if (Error == ASTContext::GE_Missing_type || 2283 Context.BuiltinInfo.allowTypeMismatch(ID)) 2284 return nullptr; 2285 2286 // If we could not find a type for setjmp it is because the jmp_buf type was 2287 // not defined prior to the setjmp declaration. 2288 if (Error == ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp) { 2289 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_implicit_decl_no_jmp_buf) 2290 << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID); 2291 return nullptr; 2292 } 2293 2294 // Generally, we emit a warning that the declaration requires the 2295 // appropriate header. 2296 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_implicit_decl_requires_sysheader) 2297 << getHeaderName(Context.BuiltinInfo, ID, Error) 2298 << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID); 2299 return nullptr; 2300 } 2301 2302 if (!ForRedeclaration && 2303 (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(ID) || 2304 Context.BuiltinInfo.isHeaderDependentFunction(ID))) { 2305 Diag(Loc, LangOpts.C99 ? diag::ext_implicit_lib_function_decl_c99 2306 : diag::ext_implicit_lib_function_decl) 2307 << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID) << R; 2308 if (const char *Header = Context.BuiltinInfo.getHeaderName(ID)) 2309 Diag(Loc, diag::note_include_header_or_declare) 2310 << Header << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID); 2311 } 2312 2313 if (R.isNull()) 2314 return nullptr; 2315 2316 FunctionDecl *New = CreateBuiltin(II, R, ID, Loc); 2317 RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(New, S); 2318 2319 // TUScope is the translation-unit scope to insert this function into. 2320 // FIXME: This is hideous. We need to teach PushOnScopeChains to 2321 // relate Scopes to DeclContexts, and probably eliminate CurContext 2322 // entirely, but we're not there yet. 2323 DeclContext *SavedContext = CurContext; 2324 CurContext = New->getDeclContext(); 2325 PushOnScopeChains(New, TUScope); 2326 CurContext = SavedContext; 2327 return New; 2328 } 2329 2330 /// Typedef declarations don't have linkage, but they still denote the same 2331 /// entity if their types are the same. 2332 /// FIXME: This is notionally doing the same thing as ASTReaderDecl's 2333 /// isSameEntity. 2334 static void filterNonConflictingPreviousTypedefDecls(Sema &S, 2335 TypedefNameDecl *Decl, 2336 LookupResult &Previous) { 2337 // This is only interesting when modules are enabled. 2338 if (!S.getLangOpts().Modules && !S.getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility) 2339 return; 2340 2341 // Empty sets are uninteresting. 2342 if (Previous.empty()) 2343 return; 2344 2345 LookupResult::Filter Filter = Previous.makeFilter(); 2346 while (Filter.hasNext()) { 2347 NamedDecl *Old = Filter.next(); 2348 2349 // Non-hidden declarations are never ignored. 2350 if (S.isVisible(Old)) 2351 continue; 2352 2353 // Declarations of the same entity are not ignored, even if they have 2354 // different linkages. 2355 if (auto *OldTD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) { 2356 if (S.Context.hasSameType(OldTD->getUnderlyingType(), 2357 Decl->getUnderlyingType())) 2358 continue; 2359 2360 // If both declarations give a tag declaration a typedef name for linkage 2361 // purposes, then they declare the same entity. 2362 if (OldTD->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName(/*AnyRedecl*/true) && 2363 Decl->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName()) 2364 continue; 2365 } 2366 2367 Filter.erase(); 2368 } 2369 2370 Filter.done(); 2371 } 2372 2373 bool Sema::isIncompatibleTypedef(TypeDecl *Old, TypedefNameDecl *New) { 2374 QualType OldType; 2375 if (TypedefNameDecl *OldTypedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) 2376 OldType = OldTypedef->getUnderlyingType(); 2377 else 2378 OldType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Old); 2379 QualType NewType = New->getUnderlyingType(); 2380 2381 if (NewType->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 2382 // Must not redefine a typedef with a variably-modified type. 2383 int Kind = isa<TypeAliasDecl>(Old) ? 1 : 0; 2384 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_variably_modified_typedef) 2385 << Kind << NewType; 2386 if (Old->getLocation().isValid()) 2387 notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation()); 2388 New->setInvalidDecl(); 2389 return true; 2390 } 2391 2392 if (OldType != NewType && 2393 !OldType->isDependentType() && 2394 !NewType->isDependentType() && 2395 !Context.hasSameType(OldType, NewType)) { 2396 int Kind = isa<TypeAliasDecl>(Old) ? 1 : 0; 2397 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_typedef) 2398 << Kind << NewType << OldType; 2399 if (Old->getLocation().isValid()) 2400 notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation()); 2401 New->setInvalidDecl(); 2402 return true; 2403 } 2404 return false; 2405 } 2406 2407 /// MergeTypedefNameDecl - We just parsed a typedef 'New' which has the 2408 /// same name and scope as a previous declaration 'Old'. Figure out 2409 /// how to resolve this situation, merging decls or emitting 2410 /// diagnostics as appropriate. If there was an error, set New to be invalid. 2411 /// 2412 void Sema::MergeTypedefNameDecl(Scope *S, TypedefNameDecl *New, 2413 LookupResult &OldDecls) { 2414 // If the new decl is known invalid already, don't bother doing any 2415 // merging checks. 2416 if (New->isInvalidDecl()) return; 2417 2418 // Allow multiple definitions for ObjC built-in typedefs. 2419 // FIXME: Verify the underlying types are equivalent! 2420 if (getLangOpts().ObjC) { 2421 const IdentifierInfo *TypeID = New->getIdentifier(); 2422 switch (TypeID->getLength()) { 2423 default: break; 2424 case 2: 2425 { 2426 if (!TypeID->isStr("id")) 2427 break; 2428 QualType T = New->getUnderlyingType(); 2429 if (!T->isPointerType()) 2430 break; 2431 if (!T->isVoidPointerType()) { 2432 QualType PT = T->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 2433 if (!PT->isStructureType()) 2434 break; 2435 } 2436 Context.setObjCIdRedefinitionType(T); 2437 // Install the built-in type for 'id', ignoring the current definition. 2438 New->setTypeForDecl(Context.getObjCIdType().getTypePtr()); 2439 return; 2440 } 2441 case 5: 2442 if (!TypeID->isStr("Class")) 2443 break; 2444 Context.setObjCClassRedefinitionType(New->getUnderlyingType()); 2445 // Install the built-in type for 'Class', ignoring the current definition. 2446 New->setTypeForDecl(Context.getObjCClassType().getTypePtr()); 2447 return; 2448 case 3: 2449 if (!TypeID->isStr("SEL")) 2450 break; 2451 Context.setObjCSelRedefinitionType(New->getUnderlyingType()); 2452 // Install the built-in type for 'SEL', ignoring the current definition. 2453 New->setTypeForDecl(Context.getObjCSelType().getTypePtr()); 2454 return; 2455 } 2456 // Fall through - the typedef name was not a builtin type. 2457 } 2458 2459 // Verify the old decl was also a type. 2460 TypeDecl *Old = OldDecls.getAsSingle<TypeDecl>(); 2461 if (!Old) { 2462 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_kind) 2463 << New->getDeclName(); 2464 2465 NamedDecl *OldD = OldDecls.getRepresentativeDecl(); 2466 if (OldD->getLocation().isValid()) 2467 notePreviousDefinition(OldD, New->getLocation()); 2468 2469 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 2470 } 2471 2472 // If the old declaration is invalid, just give up here. 2473 if (Old->isInvalidDecl()) 2474 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 2475 2476 if (auto *OldTD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) { 2477 auto *OldTag = OldTD->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName(/*AnyRedecl*/true); 2478 auto *NewTag = New->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName(); 2479 NamedDecl *Hidden = nullptr; 2480 if (OldTag && NewTag && 2481 OldTag->getCanonicalDecl() != NewTag->getCanonicalDecl() && 2482 !hasVisibleDefinition(OldTag, &Hidden)) { 2483 // There is a definition of this tag, but it is not visible. Use it 2484 // instead of our tag. 2485 New->setTypeForDecl(OldTD->getTypeForDecl()); 2486 if (OldTD->isModed()) 2487 New->setModedTypeSourceInfo(OldTD->getTypeSourceInfo(), 2488 OldTD->getUnderlyingType()); 2489 else 2490 New->setTypeSourceInfo(OldTD->getTypeSourceInfo()); 2491 2492 // Make the old tag definition visible. 2493 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(Hidden); 2494 2495 // If this was an unscoped enumeration, yank all of its enumerators 2496 // out of the scope. 2497 if (isa<EnumDecl>(NewTag)) { 2498 Scope *EnumScope = getNonFieldDeclScope(S); 2499 for (auto *D : NewTag->decls()) { 2500 auto *ED = cast<EnumConstantDecl>(D); 2501 assert(EnumScope->isDeclScope(ED)); 2502 EnumScope->RemoveDecl(ED); 2503 IdResolver.RemoveDecl(ED); 2504 ED->getLexicalDeclContext()->removeDecl(ED); 2505 } 2506 } 2507 } 2508 } 2509 2510 // If the typedef types are not identical, reject them in all languages and 2511 // with any extensions enabled. 2512 if (isIncompatibleTypedef(Old, New)) 2513 return; 2514 2515 // The types match. Link up the redeclaration chain and merge attributes if 2516 // the old declaration was a typedef. 2517 if (TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) { 2518 New->setPreviousDecl(Typedef); 2519 mergeDeclAttributes(New, Old); 2520 } 2521 2522 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) 2523 return; 2524 2525 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 2526 // C++ [dcl.typedef]p2: 2527 // In a given non-class scope, a typedef specifier can be used to 2528 // redefine the name of any type declared in that scope to refer 2529 // to the type to which it already refers. 2530 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext)) 2531 return; 2532 2533 // C++0x [dcl.typedef]p4: 2534 // In a given class scope, a typedef specifier can be used to redefine 2535 // any class-name declared in that scope that is not also a typedef-name 2536 // to refer to the type to which it already refers. 2537 // 2538 // This wording came in via DR424, which was a correction to the 2539 // wording in DR56, which accidentally banned code like: 2540 // 2541 // struct S { 2542 // typedef struct A { } A; 2543 // }; 2544 // 2545 // in the C++03 standard. We implement the C++0x semantics, which 2546 // allow the above but disallow 2547 // 2548 // struct S { 2549 // typedef int I; 2550 // typedef int I; 2551 // }; 2552 // 2553 // since that was the intent of DR56. 2554 if (!isa<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) 2555 return; 2556 2557 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) 2558 << New->getDeclName(); 2559 notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation()); 2560 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 2561 } 2562 2563 // Modules always permit redefinition of typedefs, as does C11. 2564 if (getLangOpts().Modules || getLangOpts().C11) 2565 return; 2566 2567 // If we have a redefinition of a typedef in C, emit a warning. This warning 2568 // is normally mapped to an error, but can be controlled with 2569 // -Wtypedef-redefinition. If either the original or the redefinition is 2570 // in a system header, don't emit this for compatibility with GCC. 2571 if (getDiagnostics().getSuppressSystemWarnings() && 2572 // Some standard types are defined implicitly in Clang (e.g. OpenCL). 2573 (Old->isImplicit() || 2574 Context.getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(Old->getLocation()) || 2575 Context.getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(New->getLocation()))) 2576 return; 2577 2578 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_redefinition_of_typedef) 2579 << New->getDeclName(); 2580 notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation()); 2581 } 2582 2583 /// DeclhasAttr - returns true if decl Declaration already has the target 2584 /// attribute. 2585 static bool DeclHasAttr(const Decl *D, const Attr *A) { 2586 const OwnershipAttr *OA = dyn_cast<OwnershipAttr>(A); 2587 const AnnotateAttr *Ann = dyn_cast<AnnotateAttr>(A); 2588 for (const auto *i : D->attrs()) 2589 if (i->getKind() == A->getKind()) { 2590 if (Ann) { 2591 if (Ann->getAnnotation() == cast<AnnotateAttr>(i)->getAnnotation()) 2592 return true; 2593 continue; 2594 } 2595 // FIXME: Don't hardcode this check 2596 if (OA && isa<OwnershipAttr>(i)) 2597 return OA->getOwnKind() == cast<OwnershipAttr>(i)->getOwnKind(); 2598 return true; 2599 } 2600 2601 return false; 2602 } 2603 2604 static bool isAttributeTargetADefinition(Decl *D) { 2605 if (VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) 2606 return VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition(); 2607 if (TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) 2608 return TD->isCompleteDefinition() || TD->isBeingDefined(); 2609 return true; 2610 } 2611 2612 /// Merge alignment attributes from \p Old to \p New, taking into account the 2613 /// special semantics of C11's _Alignas specifier and C++11's alignas attribute. 2614 /// 2615 /// \return \c true if any attributes were added to \p New. 2616 static bool mergeAlignedAttrs(Sema &S, NamedDecl *New, Decl *Old) { 2617 // Look for alignas attributes on Old, and pick out whichever attribute 2618 // specifies the strictest alignment requirement. 2619 AlignedAttr *OldAlignasAttr = nullptr; 2620 AlignedAttr *OldStrictestAlignAttr = nullptr; 2621 unsigned OldAlign = 0; 2622 for (auto *I : Old->specific_attrs<AlignedAttr>()) { 2623 // FIXME: We have no way of representing inherited dependent alignments 2624 // in a case like: 2625 // template<int A, int B> struct alignas(A) X; 2626 // template<int A, int B> struct alignas(B) X {}; 2627 // For now, we just ignore any alignas attributes which are not on the 2628 // definition in such a case. 2629 if (I->isAlignmentDependent()) 2630 return false; 2631 2632 if (I->isAlignas()) 2633 OldAlignasAttr = I; 2634 2635 unsigned Align = I->getAlignment(S.Context); 2636 if (Align > OldAlign) { 2637 OldAlign = Align; 2638 OldStrictestAlignAttr = I; 2639 } 2640 } 2641 2642 // Look for alignas attributes on New. 2643 AlignedAttr *NewAlignasAttr = nullptr; 2644 unsigned NewAlign = 0; 2645 for (auto *I : New->specific_attrs<AlignedAttr>()) { 2646 if (I->isAlignmentDependent()) 2647 return false; 2648 2649 if (I->isAlignas()) 2650 NewAlignasAttr = I; 2651 2652 unsigned Align = I->getAlignment(S.Context); 2653 if (Align > NewAlign) 2654 NewAlign = Align; 2655 } 2656 2657 if (OldAlignasAttr && NewAlignasAttr && OldAlign != NewAlign) { 2658 // Both declarations have 'alignas' attributes. We require them to match. 2659 // C++11 [dcl.align]p6 and C11 6.7.5/7 both come close to saying this, but 2660 // fall short. (If two declarations both have alignas, they must both match 2661 // every definition, and so must match each other if there is a definition.) 2662 2663 // If either declaration only contains 'alignas(0)' specifiers, then it 2664 // specifies the natural alignment for the type. 2665 if (OldAlign == 0 || NewAlign == 0) { 2666 QualType Ty; 2667 if (ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(New)) 2668 Ty = VD->getType(); 2669 else 2670 Ty = S.Context.getTagDeclType(cast<TagDecl>(New)); 2671 2672 if (OldAlign == 0) 2673 OldAlign = S.Context.getTypeAlign(Ty); 2674 if (NewAlign == 0) 2675 NewAlign = S.Context.getTypeAlign(Ty); 2676 } 2677 2678 if (OldAlign != NewAlign) { 2679 S.Diag(NewAlignasAttr->getLocation(), diag::err_alignas_mismatch) 2680 << (unsigned)S.Context.toCharUnitsFromBits(OldAlign).getQuantity() 2681 << (unsigned)S.Context.toCharUnitsFromBits(NewAlign).getQuantity(); 2682 S.Diag(OldAlignasAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 2683 } 2684 } 2685 2686 if (OldAlignasAttr && !NewAlignasAttr && isAttributeTargetADefinition(New)) { 2687 // C++11 [dcl.align]p6: 2688 // if any declaration of an entity has an alignment-specifier, 2689 // every defining declaration of that entity shall specify an 2690 // equivalent alignment. 2691 // C11 6.7.5/7: 2692 // If the definition of an object does not have an alignment 2693 // specifier, any other declaration of that object shall also 2694 // have no alignment specifier. 2695 S.Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_alignas_missing_on_definition) 2696 << OldAlignasAttr; 2697 S.Diag(OldAlignasAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_alignas_on_declaration) 2698 << OldAlignasAttr; 2699 } 2700 2701 bool AnyAdded = false; 2702 2703 // Ensure we have an attribute representing the strictest alignment. 2704 if (OldAlign > NewAlign) { 2705 AlignedAttr *Clone = OldStrictestAlignAttr->clone(S.Context); 2706 Clone->setInherited(true); 2707 New->addAttr(Clone); 2708 AnyAdded = true; 2709 } 2710 2711 // Ensure we have an alignas attribute if the old declaration had one. 2712 if (OldAlignasAttr && !NewAlignasAttr && 2713 !(AnyAdded && OldStrictestAlignAttr->isAlignas())) { 2714 AlignedAttr *Clone = OldAlignasAttr->clone(S.Context); 2715 Clone->setInherited(true); 2716 New->addAttr(Clone); 2717 AnyAdded = true; 2718 } 2719 2720 return AnyAdded; 2721 } 2722 2723 #define WANT_DECL_MERGE_LOGIC 2724 #include "clang/Sema/AttrParsedAttrImpl.inc" 2725 #undef WANT_DECL_MERGE_LOGIC 2726 2727 static bool mergeDeclAttribute(Sema &S, NamedDecl *D, 2728 const InheritableAttr *Attr, 2729 Sema::AvailabilityMergeKind AMK) { 2730 // Diagnose any mutual exclusions between the attribute that we want to add 2731 // and attributes that already exist on the declaration. 2732 if (!DiagnoseMutualExclusions(S, D, Attr)) 2733 return false; 2734 2735 // This function copies an attribute Attr from a previous declaration to the 2736 // new declaration D if the new declaration doesn't itself have that attribute 2737 // yet or if that attribute allows duplicates. 2738 // If you're adding a new attribute that requires logic different from 2739 // "use explicit attribute on decl if present, else use attribute from 2740 // previous decl", for example if the attribute needs to be consistent 2741 // between redeclarations, you need to call a custom merge function here. 2742 InheritableAttr *NewAttr = nullptr; 2743 if (const auto *AA = dyn_cast<AvailabilityAttr>(Attr)) 2744 NewAttr = S.mergeAvailabilityAttr( 2745 D, *AA, AA->getPlatform(), AA->isImplicit(), AA->getIntroduced(), 2746 AA->getDeprecated(), AA->getObsoleted(), AA->getUnavailable(), 2747 AA->getMessage(), AA->getStrict(), AA->getReplacement(), AMK, 2748 AA->getPriority()); 2749 else if (const auto *VA = dyn_cast<VisibilityAttr>(Attr)) 2750 NewAttr = S.mergeVisibilityAttr(D, *VA, VA->getVisibility()); 2751 else if (const auto *VA = dyn_cast<TypeVisibilityAttr>(Attr)) 2752 NewAttr = S.mergeTypeVisibilityAttr(D, *VA, VA->getVisibility()); 2753 else if (const auto *ImportA = dyn_cast<DLLImportAttr>(Attr)) 2754 NewAttr = S.mergeDLLImportAttr(D, *ImportA); 2755 else if (const auto *ExportA = dyn_cast<DLLExportAttr>(Attr)) 2756 NewAttr = S.mergeDLLExportAttr(D, *ExportA); 2757 else if (const auto *EA = dyn_cast<ErrorAttr>(Attr)) 2758 NewAttr = S.mergeErrorAttr(D, *EA, EA->getUserDiagnostic()); 2759 else if (const auto *FA = dyn_cast<FormatAttr>(Attr)) 2760 NewAttr = S.mergeFormatAttr(D, *FA, FA->getType(), FA->getFormatIdx(), 2761 FA->getFirstArg()); 2762 else if (const auto *SA = dyn_cast<SectionAttr>(Attr)) 2763 NewAttr = S.mergeSectionAttr(D, *SA, SA->getName()); 2764 else if (const auto *CSA = dyn_cast<CodeSegAttr>(Attr)) 2765 NewAttr = S.mergeCodeSegAttr(D, *CSA, CSA->getName()); 2766 else if (const auto *IA = dyn_cast<MSInheritanceAttr>(Attr)) 2767 NewAttr = S.mergeMSInheritanceAttr(D, *IA, IA->getBestCase(), 2768 IA->getInheritanceModel()); 2769 else if (const auto *AA = dyn_cast<AlwaysInlineAttr>(Attr)) 2770 NewAttr = S.mergeAlwaysInlineAttr(D, *AA, 2771 &S.Context.Idents.get(AA->getSpelling())); 2772 else if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && isa<FunctionDecl>(D) && 2773 (isa<CUDAHostAttr>(Attr) || isa<CUDADeviceAttr>(Attr) || 2774 isa<CUDAGlobalAttr>(Attr))) { 2775 // CUDA target attributes are part of function signature for 2776 // overloading purposes and must not be merged. 2777 return false; 2778 } else if (const auto *MA = dyn_cast<MinSizeAttr>(Attr)) 2779 NewAttr = S.mergeMinSizeAttr(D, *MA); 2780 else if (const auto *SNA = dyn_cast<SwiftNameAttr>(Attr)) 2781 NewAttr = S.mergeSwiftNameAttr(D, *SNA, SNA->getName()); 2782 else if (const auto *OA = dyn_cast<OptimizeNoneAttr>(Attr)) 2783 NewAttr = S.mergeOptimizeNoneAttr(D, *OA); 2784 else if (const auto *InternalLinkageA = dyn_cast<InternalLinkageAttr>(Attr)) 2785 NewAttr = S.mergeInternalLinkageAttr(D, *InternalLinkageA); 2786 else if (isa<AlignedAttr>(Attr)) 2787 // AlignedAttrs are handled separately, because we need to handle all 2788 // such attributes on a declaration at the same time. 2789 NewAttr = nullptr; 2790 else if ((isa<DeprecatedAttr>(Attr) || isa<UnavailableAttr>(Attr)) && 2791 (AMK == Sema::AMK_Override || 2792 AMK == Sema::AMK_ProtocolImplementation || 2793 AMK == Sema::AMK_OptionalProtocolImplementation)) 2794 NewAttr = nullptr; 2795 else if (const auto *UA = dyn_cast<UuidAttr>(Attr)) 2796 NewAttr = S.mergeUuidAttr(D, *UA, UA->getGuid(), UA->getGuidDecl()); 2797 else if (const auto *IMA = dyn_cast<WebAssemblyImportModuleAttr>(Attr)) 2798 NewAttr = S.mergeImportModuleAttr(D, *IMA); 2799 else if (const auto *INA = dyn_cast<WebAssemblyImportNameAttr>(Attr)) 2800 NewAttr = S.mergeImportNameAttr(D, *INA); 2801 else if (const auto *TCBA = dyn_cast<EnforceTCBAttr>(Attr)) 2802 NewAttr = S.mergeEnforceTCBAttr(D, *TCBA); 2803 else if (const auto *TCBLA = dyn_cast<EnforceTCBLeafAttr>(Attr)) 2804 NewAttr = S.mergeEnforceTCBLeafAttr(D, *TCBLA); 2805 else if (const auto *BTFA = dyn_cast<BTFDeclTagAttr>(Attr)) 2806 NewAttr = S.mergeBTFDeclTagAttr(D, *BTFA); 2807 else if (const auto *NT = dyn_cast<HLSLNumThreadsAttr>(Attr)) 2808 NewAttr = 2809 S.mergeHLSLNumThreadsAttr(D, *NT, NT->getX(), NT->getY(), NT->getZ()); 2810 else if (const auto *SA = dyn_cast<HLSLShaderAttr>(Attr)) 2811 NewAttr = S.mergeHLSLShaderAttr(D, *SA, SA->getType()); 2812 else if (Attr->shouldInheritEvenIfAlreadyPresent() || !DeclHasAttr(D, Attr)) 2813 NewAttr = cast<InheritableAttr>(Attr->clone(S.Context)); 2814 2815 if (NewAttr) { 2816 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 2817 D->addAttr(NewAttr); 2818 if (isa<MSInheritanceAttr>(NewAttr)) 2819 S.Consumer.AssignInheritanceModel(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)); 2820 return true; 2821 } 2822 2823 return false; 2824 } 2825 2826 static const NamedDecl *getDefinition(const Decl *D) { 2827 if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) 2828 return TD->getDefinition(); 2829 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 2830 const VarDecl *Def = VD->getDefinition(); 2831 if (Def) 2832 return Def; 2833 return VD->getActingDefinition(); 2834 } 2835 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 2836 const FunctionDecl *Def = nullptr; 2837 if (FD->isDefined(Def, true)) 2838 return Def; 2839 } 2840 return nullptr; 2841 } 2842 2843 static bool hasAttribute(const Decl *D, attr::Kind Kind) { 2844 for (const auto *Attribute : D->attrs()) 2845 if (Attribute->getKind() == Kind) 2846 return true; 2847 return false; 2848 } 2849 2850 /// checkNewAttributesAfterDef - If we already have a definition, check that 2851 /// there are no new attributes in this declaration. 2852 static void checkNewAttributesAfterDef(Sema &S, Decl *New, const Decl *Old) { 2853 if (!New->hasAttrs()) 2854 return; 2855 2856 const NamedDecl *Def = getDefinition(Old); 2857 if (!Def || Def == New) 2858 return; 2859 2860 AttrVec &NewAttributes = New->getAttrs(); 2861 for (unsigned I = 0, E = NewAttributes.size(); I != E;) { 2862 const Attr *NewAttribute = NewAttributes[I]; 2863 2864 if (isa<AliasAttr>(NewAttribute) || isa<IFuncAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2865 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(New)) { 2866 Sema::SkipBodyInfo SkipBody; 2867 S.CheckForFunctionRedefinition(FD, cast<FunctionDecl>(Def), &SkipBody); 2868 2869 // If we're skipping this definition, drop the "alias" attribute. 2870 if (SkipBody.ShouldSkip) { 2871 NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I); 2872 --E; 2873 continue; 2874 } 2875 } else { 2876 VarDecl *VD = cast<VarDecl>(New); 2877 unsigned Diag = cast<VarDecl>(Def)->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == 2878 VarDecl::TentativeDefinition 2879 ? diag::err_alias_after_tentative 2880 : diag::err_redefinition; 2881 S.Diag(VD->getLocation(), Diag) << VD->getDeclName(); 2882 if (Diag == diag::err_redefinition) 2883 S.notePreviousDefinition(Def, VD->getLocation()); 2884 else 2885 S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 2886 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 2887 } 2888 ++I; 2889 continue; 2890 } 2891 2892 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Def)) { 2893 // Tentative definitions are only interesting for the alias check above. 2894 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() != VarDecl::Definition) { 2895 ++I; 2896 continue; 2897 } 2898 } 2899 2900 if (hasAttribute(Def, NewAttribute->getKind())) { 2901 ++I; 2902 continue; // regular attr merging will take care of validating this. 2903 } 2904 2905 if (isa<C11NoReturnAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2906 // C's _Noreturn is allowed to be added to a function after it is defined. 2907 ++I; 2908 continue; 2909 } else if (isa<UuidAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2910 // msvc will allow a subsequent definition to add an uuid to a class 2911 ++I; 2912 continue; 2913 } else if (const AlignedAttr *AA = dyn_cast<AlignedAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2914 if (AA->isAlignas()) { 2915 // C++11 [dcl.align]p6: 2916 // if any declaration of an entity has an alignment-specifier, 2917 // every defining declaration of that entity shall specify an 2918 // equivalent alignment. 2919 // C11 6.7.5/7: 2920 // If the definition of an object does not have an alignment 2921 // specifier, any other declaration of that object shall also 2922 // have no alignment specifier. 2923 S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::err_alignas_missing_on_definition) 2924 << AA; 2925 S.Diag(NewAttribute->getLocation(), diag::note_alignas_on_declaration) 2926 << AA; 2927 NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I); 2928 --E; 2929 continue; 2930 } 2931 } else if (isa<LoaderUninitializedAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2932 // If there is a C definition followed by a redeclaration with this 2933 // attribute then there are two different definitions. In C++, prefer the 2934 // standard diagnostics. 2935 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 2936 S.Diag(NewAttribute->getLocation(), 2937 diag::err_loader_uninitialized_redeclaration); 2938 S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 2939 NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I); 2940 --E; 2941 continue; 2942 } 2943 } else if (isa<SelectAnyAttr>(NewAttribute) && 2944 cast<VarDecl>(New)->isInline() && 2945 !cast<VarDecl>(New)->isInlineSpecified()) { 2946 // Don't warn about applying selectany to implicitly inline variables. 2947 // Older compilers and language modes would require the use of selectany 2948 // to make such variables inline, and it would have no effect if we 2949 // honored it. 2950 ++I; 2951 continue; 2952 } else if (isa<OMPDeclareVariantAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2953 // We allow to add OMP[Begin]DeclareVariantAttr to be added to 2954 // declarations after defintions. 2955 ++I; 2956 continue; 2957 } 2958 2959 S.Diag(NewAttribute->getLocation(), 2960 diag::warn_attribute_precede_definition); 2961 S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 2962 NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I); 2963 --E; 2964 } 2965 } 2966 2967 static void diagnoseMissingConstinit(Sema &S, const VarDecl *InitDecl, 2968 const ConstInitAttr *CIAttr, 2969 bool AttrBeforeInit) { 2970 SourceLocation InsertLoc = InitDecl->getInnerLocStart(); 2971 2972 // Figure out a good way to write this specifier on the old declaration. 2973 // FIXME: We should just use the spelling of CIAttr, but we don't preserve 2974 // enough of the attribute list spelling information to extract that without 2975 // heroics. 2976 std::string SuitableSpelling; 2977 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20) 2978 SuitableSpelling = std::string( 2979 S.PP.getLastMacroWithSpelling(InsertLoc, {tok::kw_constinit})); 2980 if (SuitableSpelling.empty() && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 2981 SuitableSpelling = std::string(S.PP.getLastMacroWithSpelling( 2982 InsertLoc, {tok::l_square, tok::l_square, 2983 S.PP.getIdentifierInfo("clang"), tok::coloncolon, 2984 S.PP.getIdentifierInfo("require_constant_initialization"), 2985 tok::r_square, tok::r_square})); 2986 if (SuitableSpelling.empty()) 2987 SuitableSpelling = std::string(S.PP.getLastMacroWithSpelling( 2988 InsertLoc, {tok::kw___attribute, tok::l_paren, tok::r_paren, 2989 S.PP.getIdentifierInfo("require_constant_initialization"), 2990 tok::r_paren, tok::r_paren})); 2991 if (SuitableSpelling.empty() && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20) 2992 SuitableSpelling = "constinit"; 2993 if (SuitableSpelling.empty() && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 2994 SuitableSpelling = "[[clang::require_constant_initialization]]"; 2995 if (SuitableSpelling.empty()) 2996 SuitableSpelling = "__attribute__((require_constant_initialization))"; 2997 SuitableSpelling += " "; 2998 2999 if (AttrBeforeInit) { 3000 // extern constinit int a; 3001 // int a = 0; // error (missing 'constinit'), accepted as extension 3002 assert(CIAttr->isConstinit() && "should not diagnose this for attribute"); 3003 S.Diag(InitDecl->getLocation(), diag::ext_constinit_missing) 3004 << InitDecl << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(InsertLoc, SuitableSpelling); 3005 S.Diag(CIAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_constinit_specified_here); 3006 } else { 3007 // int a = 0; 3008 // constinit extern int a; // error (missing 'constinit') 3009 S.Diag(CIAttr->getLocation(), 3010 CIAttr->isConstinit() ? diag::err_constinit_added_too_late 3011 : diag::warn_require_const_init_added_too_late) 3012 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(SourceRange(CIAttr->getLocation())); 3013 S.Diag(InitDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_constinit_missing_here) 3014 << CIAttr->isConstinit() 3015 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(InsertLoc, SuitableSpelling); 3016 } 3017 } 3018 3019 /// mergeDeclAttributes - Copy attributes from the Old decl to the New one. 3020 void Sema::mergeDeclAttributes(NamedDecl *New, Decl *Old, 3021 AvailabilityMergeKind AMK) { 3022 if (UsedAttr *OldAttr = Old->getMostRecentDecl()->getAttr<UsedAttr>()) { 3023 UsedAttr *NewAttr = OldAttr->clone(Context); 3024 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 3025 New->addAttr(NewAttr); 3026 } 3027 if (RetainAttr *OldAttr = Old->getMostRecentDecl()->getAttr<RetainAttr>()) { 3028 RetainAttr *NewAttr = OldAttr->clone(Context); 3029 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 3030 New->addAttr(NewAttr); 3031 } 3032 3033 if (!Old->hasAttrs() && !New->hasAttrs()) 3034 return; 3035 3036 // [dcl.constinit]p1: 3037 // If the [constinit] specifier is applied to any declaration of a 3038 // variable, it shall be applied to the initializing declaration. 3039 const auto *OldConstInit = Old->getAttr<ConstInitAttr>(); 3040 const auto *NewConstInit = New->getAttr<ConstInitAttr>(); 3041 if (bool(OldConstInit) != bool(NewConstInit)) { 3042 const auto *OldVD = cast<VarDecl>(Old); 3043 auto *NewVD = cast<VarDecl>(New); 3044 3045 // Find the initializing declaration. Note that we might not have linked 3046 // the new declaration into the redeclaration chain yet. 3047 const VarDecl *InitDecl = OldVD->getInitializingDeclaration(); 3048 if (!InitDecl && 3049 (NewVD->hasInit() || NewVD->isThisDeclarationADefinition())) 3050 InitDecl = NewVD; 3051 3052 if (InitDecl == NewVD) { 3053 // This is the initializing declaration. If it would inherit 'constinit', 3054 // that's ill-formed. (Note that we do not apply this to the attribute 3055 // form). 3056 if (OldConstInit && OldConstInit->isConstinit()) 3057 diagnoseMissingConstinit(*this, NewVD, OldConstInit, 3058 /*AttrBeforeInit=*/true); 3059 } else if (NewConstInit) { 3060 // This is the first time we've been told that this declaration should 3061 // have a constant initializer. If we already saw the initializing 3062 // declaration, this is too late. 3063 if (InitDecl && InitDecl != NewVD) { 3064 diagnoseMissingConstinit(*this, InitDecl, NewConstInit, 3065 /*AttrBeforeInit=*/false); 3066 NewVD->dropAttr<ConstInitAttr>(); 3067 } 3068 } 3069 } 3070 3071 // Attributes declared post-definition are currently ignored. 3072 checkNewAttributesAfterDef(*this, New, Old); 3073 3074 if (AsmLabelAttr *NewA = New->getAttr<AsmLabelAttr>()) { 3075 if (AsmLabelAttr *OldA = Old->getAttr<AsmLabelAttr>()) { 3076 if (!OldA->isEquivalent(NewA)) { 3077 // This redeclaration changes __asm__ label. 3078 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_asm_label); 3079 Diag(OldA->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3080 } 3081 } else if (Old->isUsed()) { 3082 // This redeclaration adds an __asm__ label to a declaration that has 3083 // already been ODR-used. 3084 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_late_asm_label_name) 3085 << isa<FunctionDecl>(Old) << New->getAttr<AsmLabelAttr>()->getRange(); 3086 } 3087 } 3088 3089 // Re-declaration cannot add abi_tag's. 3090 if (const auto *NewAbiTagAttr = New->getAttr<AbiTagAttr>()) { 3091 if (const auto *OldAbiTagAttr = Old->getAttr<AbiTagAttr>()) { 3092 for (const auto &NewTag : NewAbiTagAttr->tags()) { 3093 if (!llvm::is_contained(OldAbiTagAttr->tags(), NewTag)) { 3094 Diag(NewAbiTagAttr->getLocation(), 3095 diag::err_new_abi_tag_on_redeclaration) 3096 << NewTag; 3097 Diag(OldAbiTagAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3098 } 3099 } 3100 } else { 3101 Diag(NewAbiTagAttr->getLocation(), diag::err_abi_tag_on_redeclaration); 3102 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3103 } 3104 } 3105 3106 // This redeclaration adds a section attribute. 3107 if (New->hasAttr<SectionAttr>() && !Old->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) { 3108 if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(New)) { 3109 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly) { 3110 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_section_on_redeclaration); 3111 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3112 } 3113 } 3114 } 3115 3116 // Redeclaration adds code-seg attribute. 3117 const auto *NewCSA = New->getAttr<CodeSegAttr>(); 3118 if (NewCSA && !Old->hasAttr<CodeSegAttr>() && 3119 !NewCSA->isImplicit() && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(New)) { 3120 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_mismatched_section) 3121 << 0 /*codeseg*/; 3122 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3123 } 3124 3125 if (!Old->hasAttrs()) 3126 return; 3127 3128 bool foundAny = New->hasAttrs(); 3129 3130 // Ensure that any moving of objects within the allocated map is done before 3131 // we process them. 3132 if (!foundAny) New->setAttrs(AttrVec()); 3133 3134 for (auto *I : Old->specific_attrs<InheritableAttr>()) { 3135 // Ignore deprecated/unavailable/availability attributes if requested. 3136 AvailabilityMergeKind LocalAMK = AMK_None; 3137 if (isa<DeprecatedAttr>(I) || 3138 isa<UnavailableAttr>(I) || 3139 isa<AvailabilityAttr>(I)) { 3140 switch (AMK) { 3141 case AMK_None: 3142 continue; 3143 3144 case AMK_Redeclaration: 3145 case AMK_Override: 3146 case AMK_ProtocolImplementation: 3147 case AMK_OptionalProtocolImplementation: 3148 LocalAMK = AMK; 3149 break; 3150 } 3151 } 3152 3153 // Already handled. 3154 if (isa<UsedAttr>(I) || isa<RetainAttr>(I)) 3155 continue; 3156 3157 if (mergeDeclAttribute(*this, New, I, LocalAMK)) 3158 foundAny = true; 3159 } 3160 3161 if (mergeAlignedAttrs(*this, New, Old)) 3162 foundAny = true; 3163 3164 if (!foundAny) New->dropAttrs(); 3165 } 3166 3167 /// mergeParamDeclAttributes - Copy attributes from the old parameter 3168 /// to the new one. 3169 static void mergeParamDeclAttributes(ParmVarDecl *newDecl, 3170 const ParmVarDecl *oldDecl, 3171 Sema &S) { 3172 // C++11 [dcl.attr.depend]p2: 3173 // The first declaration of a function shall specify the 3174 // carries_dependency attribute for its declarator-id if any declaration 3175 // of the function specifies the carries_dependency attribute. 3176 const CarriesDependencyAttr *CDA = newDecl->getAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>(); 3177 if (CDA && !oldDecl->hasAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>()) { 3178 S.Diag(CDA->getLocation(), 3179 diag::err_carries_dependency_missing_on_first_decl) << 1/*Param*/; 3180 // Find the first declaration of the parameter. 3181 // FIXME: Should we build redeclaration chains for function parameters? 3182 const FunctionDecl *FirstFD = 3183 cast<FunctionDecl>(oldDecl->getDeclContext())->getFirstDecl(); 3184 const ParmVarDecl *FirstVD = 3185 FirstFD->getParamDecl(oldDecl->getFunctionScopeIndex()); 3186 S.Diag(FirstVD->getLocation(), 3187 diag::note_carries_dependency_missing_first_decl) << 1/*Param*/; 3188 } 3189 3190 if (!oldDecl->hasAttrs()) 3191 return; 3192 3193 bool foundAny = newDecl->hasAttrs(); 3194 3195 // Ensure that any moving of objects within the allocated map is 3196 // done before we process them. 3197 if (!foundAny) newDecl->setAttrs(AttrVec()); 3198 3199 for (const auto *I : oldDecl->specific_attrs<InheritableParamAttr>()) { 3200 if (!DeclHasAttr(newDecl, I)) { 3201 InheritableAttr *newAttr = 3202 cast<InheritableParamAttr>(I->clone(S.Context)); 3203 newAttr->setInherited(true); 3204 newDecl->addAttr(newAttr); 3205 foundAny = true; 3206 } 3207 } 3208 3209 if (!foundAny) newDecl->dropAttrs(); 3210 } 3211 3212 static void mergeParamDeclTypes(ParmVarDecl *NewParam, 3213 const ParmVarDecl *OldParam, 3214 Sema &S) { 3215 if (auto Oldnullability = OldParam->getType()->getNullability(S.Context)) { 3216 if (auto Newnullability = NewParam->getType()->getNullability(S.Context)) { 3217 if (*Oldnullability != *Newnullability) { 3218 S.Diag(NewParam->getLocation(), diag::warn_mismatched_nullability_attr) 3219 << DiagNullabilityKind( 3220 *Newnullability, 3221 ((NewParam->getObjCDeclQualifier() & Decl::OBJC_TQ_CSNullability) 3222 != 0)) 3223 << DiagNullabilityKind( 3224 *Oldnullability, 3225 ((OldParam->getObjCDeclQualifier() & Decl::OBJC_TQ_CSNullability) 3226 != 0)); 3227 S.Diag(OldParam->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3228 } 3229 } else { 3230 QualType NewT = NewParam->getType(); 3231 NewT = S.Context.getAttributedType( 3232 AttributedType::getNullabilityAttrKind(*Oldnullability), 3233 NewT, NewT); 3234 NewParam->setType(NewT); 3235 } 3236 } 3237 } 3238 3239 namespace { 3240 3241 /// Used in MergeFunctionDecl to keep track of function parameters in 3242 /// C. 3243 struct GNUCompatibleParamWarning { 3244 ParmVarDecl *OldParm; 3245 ParmVarDecl *NewParm; 3246 QualType PromotedType; 3247 }; 3248 3249 } // end anonymous namespace 3250 3251 // Determine whether the previous declaration was a definition, implicit 3252 // declaration, or a declaration. 3253 template <typename T> 3254 static std::pair<diag::kind, SourceLocation> 3255 getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(const T *Old, const T *New) { 3256 diag::kind PrevDiag; 3257 SourceLocation OldLocation = Old->getLocation(); 3258 if (Old->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) 3259 PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_definition; 3260 else if (Old->isImplicit()) { 3261 PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_implicit_declaration; 3262 if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Old)) { 3263 if (FD->getBuiltinID()) 3264 PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration; 3265 } 3266 if (OldLocation.isInvalid()) 3267 OldLocation = New->getLocation(); 3268 } else 3269 PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_declaration; 3270 return std::make_pair(PrevDiag, OldLocation); 3271 } 3272 3273 /// canRedefineFunction - checks if a function can be redefined. Currently, 3274 /// only extern inline functions can be redefined, and even then only in 3275 /// GNU89 mode. 3276 static bool canRedefineFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD, 3277 const LangOptions& LangOpts) { 3278 return ((FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>() || LangOpts.GNUInline) && 3279 !LangOpts.CPlusPlus && 3280 FD->isInlineSpecified() && 3281 FD->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern); 3282 } 3283 3284 const AttributedType *Sema::getCallingConvAttributedType(QualType T) const { 3285 const AttributedType *AT = T->getAs<AttributedType>(); 3286 while (AT && !AT->isCallingConv()) 3287 AT = AT->getModifiedType()->getAs<AttributedType>(); 3288 return AT; 3289 } 3290 3291 template <typename T> 3292 static bool haveIncompatibleLanguageLinkages(const T *Old, const T *New) { 3293 const DeclContext *DC = Old->getDeclContext(); 3294 if (DC->isRecord()) 3295 return false; 3296 3297 LanguageLinkage OldLinkage = Old->getLanguageLinkage(); 3298 if (OldLinkage == CXXLanguageLinkage && New->isInExternCContext()) 3299 return true; 3300 if (OldLinkage == CLanguageLinkage && New->isInExternCXXContext()) 3301 return true; 3302 return false; 3303 } 3304 3305 template<typename T> static bool isExternC(T *D) { return D->isExternC(); } 3306 static bool isExternC(VarTemplateDecl *) { return false; } 3307 static bool isExternC(FunctionTemplateDecl *) { return false; } 3308 3309 /// Check whether a redeclaration of an entity introduced by a 3310 /// using-declaration is valid, given that we know it's not an overload 3311 /// (nor a hidden tag declaration). 3312 template<typename ExpectedDecl> 3313 static bool checkUsingShadowRedecl(Sema &S, UsingShadowDecl *OldS, 3314 ExpectedDecl *New) { 3315 // C++11 [basic.scope.declarative]p4: 3316 // Given a set of declarations in a single declarative region, each of 3317 // which specifies the same unqualified name, 3318 // -- they shall all refer to the same entity, or all refer to functions 3319 // and function templates; or 3320 // -- exactly one declaration shall declare a class name or enumeration 3321 // name that is not a typedef name and the other declarations shall all 3322 // refer to the same variable or enumerator, or all refer to functions 3323 // and function templates; in this case the class name or enumeration 3324 // name is hidden (3.3.10). 3325 3326 // C++11 [namespace.udecl]p14: 3327 // If a function declaration in namespace scope or block scope has the 3328 // same name and the same parameter-type-list as a function introduced 3329 // by a using-declaration, and the declarations do not declare the same 3330 // function, the program is ill-formed. 3331 3332 auto *Old = dyn_cast<ExpectedDecl>(OldS->getTargetDecl()); 3333 if (Old && 3334 !Old->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->Equals( 3335 New->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()) && 3336 !(isExternC(Old) && isExternC(New))) 3337 Old = nullptr; 3338 3339 if (!Old) { 3340 S.Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_using_decl_conflict_reverse); 3341 S.Diag(OldS->getTargetDecl()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl_target); 3342 S.Diag(OldS->getIntroducer()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl) << 0; 3343 return true; 3344 } 3345 return false; 3346 } 3347 3348 static bool hasIdenticalPassObjectSizeAttrs(const FunctionDecl *A, 3349 const FunctionDecl *B) { 3350 assert(A->getNumParams() == B->getNumParams()); 3351 3352 auto AttrEq = [](const ParmVarDecl *A, const ParmVarDecl *B) { 3353 const auto *AttrA = A->getAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>(); 3354 const auto *AttrB = B->getAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>(); 3355 if (AttrA == AttrB) 3356 return true; 3357 return AttrA && AttrB && AttrA->getType() == AttrB->getType() && 3358 AttrA->isDynamic() == AttrB->isDynamic(); 3359 }; 3360 3361 return std::equal(A->param_begin(), A->param_end(), B->param_begin(), AttrEq); 3362 } 3363 3364 /// If necessary, adjust the semantic declaration context for a qualified 3365 /// declaration to name the correct inline namespace within the qualifier. 3366 static void adjustDeclContextForDeclaratorDecl(DeclaratorDecl *NewD, 3367 DeclaratorDecl *OldD) { 3368 // The only case where we need to update the DeclContext is when 3369 // redeclaration lookup for a qualified name finds a declaration 3370 // in an inline namespace within the context named by the qualifier: 3371 // 3372 // inline namespace N { int f(); } 3373 // int ::f(); // Sema DC needs adjusting from :: to N::. 3374 // 3375 // For unqualified declarations, the semantic context *can* change 3376 // along the redeclaration chain (for local extern declarations, 3377 // extern "C" declarations, and friend declarations in particular). 3378 if (!NewD->getQualifier()) 3379 return; 3380 3381 // NewD is probably already in the right context. 3382 auto *NamedDC = NewD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 3383 auto *SemaDC = OldD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 3384 if (NamedDC->Equals(SemaDC)) 3385 return; 3386 3387 assert((NamedDC->InEnclosingNamespaceSetOf(SemaDC) || 3388 NewD->isInvalidDecl() || OldD->isInvalidDecl()) && 3389 "unexpected context for redeclaration"); 3390 3391 auto *LexDC = NewD->getLexicalDeclContext(); 3392 auto FixSemaDC = [=](NamedDecl *D) { 3393 if (!D) 3394 return; 3395 D->setDeclContext(SemaDC); 3396 D->setLexicalDeclContext(LexDC); 3397 }; 3398 3399 FixSemaDC(NewD); 3400 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(NewD)) 3401 FixSemaDC(FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()); 3402 else if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(NewD)) 3403 FixSemaDC(VD->getDescribedVarTemplate()); 3404 } 3405 3406 /// MergeFunctionDecl - We just parsed a function 'New' from 3407 /// declarator D which has the same name and scope as a previous 3408 /// declaration 'Old'. Figure out how to resolve this situation, 3409 /// merging decls or emitting diagnostics as appropriate. 3410 /// 3411 /// In C++, New and Old must be declarations that are not 3412 /// overloaded. Use IsOverload to determine whether New and Old are 3413 /// overloaded, and to select the Old declaration that New should be 3414 /// merged with. 3415 /// 3416 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise. 3417 bool Sema::MergeFunctionDecl(FunctionDecl *New, NamedDecl *&OldD, Scope *S, 3418 bool MergeTypeWithOld, bool NewDeclIsDefn) { 3419 // Verify the old decl was also a function. 3420 FunctionDecl *Old = OldD->getAsFunction(); 3421 if (!Old) { 3422 if (UsingShadowDecl *Shadow = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) { 3423 if (New->getFriendObjectKind()) { 3424 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_using_decl_friend); 3425 Diag(Shadow->getTargetDecl()->getLocation(), 3426 diag::note_using_decl_target); 3427 Diag(Shadow->getIntroducer()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl) 3428 << 0; 3429 return true; 3430 } 3431 3432 // Check whether the two declarations might declare the same function or 3433 // function template. 3434 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = 3435 New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) { 3436 if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*this, Shadow, 3437 NewTemplate)) 3438 return true; 3439 OldD = Old = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Shadow->getTargetDecl()) 3440 ->getAsFunction(); 3441 } else { 3442 if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<FunctionDecl>(*this, Shadow, New)) 3443 return true; 3444 OldD = Old = cast<FunctionDecl>(Shadow->getTargetDecl()); 3445 } 3446 } else { 3447 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_kind) 3448 << New->getDeclName(); 3449 notePreviousDefinition(OldD, New->getLocation()); 3450 return true; 3451 } 3452 } 3453 3454 // If the old declaration was found in an inline namespace and the new 3455 // declaration was qualified, update the DeclContext to match. 3456 adjustDeclContextForDeclaratorDecl(New, Old); 3457 3458 // If the old declaration is invalid, just give up here. 3459 if (Old->isInvalidDecl()) 3460 return true; 3461 3462 // Disallow redeclaration of some builtins. 3463 if (!getASTContext().canBuiltinBeRedeclared(Old)) { 3464 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_builtin_redeclare) << Old->getDeclName(); 3465 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration) 3466 << Old << Old->getType(); 3467 return true; 3468 } 3469 3470 diag::kind PrevDiag; 3471 SourceLocation OldLocation; 3472 std::tie(PrevDiag, OldLocation) = 3473 getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(Old, New); 3474 3475 // Don't complain about this if we're in GNU89 mode and the old function 3476 // is an extern inline function. 3477 // Don't complain about specializations. They are not supposed to have 3478 // storage classes. 3479 if (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(New) && !isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Old) && 3480 New->getStorageClass() == SC_Static && 3481 Old->hasExternalFormalLinkage() && 3482 !New->getTemplateSpecializationInfo() && 3483 !canRedefineFunction(Old, getLangOpts())) { 3484 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) { 3485 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_static_non_static) << New; 3486 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3487 } else { 3488 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_static_non_static) << New; 3489 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3490 return true; 3491 } 3492 } 3493 3494 if (const auto *ILA = New->getAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>()) 3495 if (!Old->hasAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>()) { 3496 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_missing_on_first_decl) 3497 << ILA; 3498 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3499 New->dropAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>(); 3500 } 3501 3502 if (auto *EA = New->getAttr<ErrorAttr>()) { 3503 if (!Old->hasAttr<ErrorAttr>()) { 3504 Diag(EA->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_missing_on_first_decl) << EA; 3505 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3506 New->dropAttr<ErrorAttr>(); 3507 } 3508 } 3509 3510 if (CheckRedeclarationInModule(New, Old)) 3511 return true; 3512 3513 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 3514 bool OldOvl = Old->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 3515 if (OldOvl != New->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>() && !Old->isImplicit()) { 3516 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_overloadable_mismatch) 3517 << New << OldOvl; 3518 3519 // Try our best to find a decl that actually has the overloadable 3520 // attribute for the note. In most cases (e.g. programs with only one 3521 // broken declaration/definition), this won't matter. 3522 // 3523 // FIXME: We could do this if we juggled some extra state in 3524 // OverloadableAttr, rather than just removing it. 3525 const Decl *DiagOld = Old; 3526 if (OldOvl) { 3527 auto OldIter = llvm::find_if(Old->redecls(), [](const Decl *D) { 3528 const auto *A = D->getAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 3529 return A && !A->isImplicit(); 3530 }); 3531 // If we've implicitly added *all* of the overloadable attrs to this 3532 // chain, emitting a "previous redecl" note is pointless. 3533 DiagOld = OldIter == Old->redecls_end() ? nullptr : *OldIter; 3534 } 3535 3536 if (DiagOld) 3537 Diag(DiagOld->getLocation(), 3538 diag::note_attribute_overloadable_prev_overload) 3539 << OldOvl; 3540 3541 if (OldOvl) 3542 New->addAttr(OverloadableAttr::CreateImplicit(Context)); 3543 else 3544 New->dropAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 3545 } 3546 } 3547 3548 // If a function is first declared with a calling convention, but is later 3549 // declared or defined without one, all following decls assume the calling 3550 // convention of the first. 3551 // 3552 // It's OK if a function is first declared without a calling convention, 3553 // but is later declared or defined with the default calling convention. 3554 // 3555 // To test if either decl has an explicit calling convention, we look for 3556 // AttributedType sugar nodes on the type as written. If they are missing or 3557 // were canonicalized away, we assume the calling convention was implicit. 3558 // 3559 // Note also that we DO NOT return at this point, because we still have 3560 // other tests to run. 3561 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType()); 3562 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType()); 3563 const FunctionType *OldType = cast<FunctionType>(OldQType); 3564 const FunctionType *NewType = cast<FunctionType>(NewQType); 3565 FunctionType::ExtInfo OldTypeInfo = OldType->getExtInfo(); 3566 FunctionType::ExtInfo NewTypeInfo = NewType->getExtInfo(); 3567 bool RequiresAdjustment = false; 3568 3569 if (OldTypeInfo.getCC() != NewTypeInfo.getCC()) { 3570 FunctionDecl *First = Old->getFirstDecl(); 3571 const FunctionType *FT = 3572 First->getType().getCanonicalType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 3573 FunctionType::ExtInfo FI = FT->getExtInfo(); 3574 bool NewCCExplicit = getCallingConvAttributedType(New->getType()); 3575 if (!NewCCExplicit) { 3576 // Inherit the CC from the previous declaration if it was specified 3577 // there but not here. 3578 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withCallingConv(OldTypeInfo.getCC()); 3579 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3580 } else if (Old->getBuiltinID()) { 3581 // Builtin attribute isn't propagated to the new one yet at this point, 3582 // so we check if the old one is a builtin. 3583 3584 // Calling Conventions on a Builtin aren't really useful and setting a 3585 // default calling convention and cdecl'ing some builtin redeclarations is 3586 // common, so warn and ignore the calling convention on the redeclaration. 3587 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_cconv_unsupported) 3588 << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(NewTypeInfo.getCC()) 3589 << (int)CallingConventionIgnoredReason::BuiltinFunction; 3590 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withCallingConv(OldTypeInfo.getCC()); 3591 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3592 } else { 3593 // Calling conventions aren't compatible, so complain. 3594 bool FirstCCExplicit = getCallingConvAttributedType(First->getType()); 3595 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_cconv_change) 3596 << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(NewTypeInfo.getCC()) 3597 << !FirstCCExplicit 3598 << (!FirstCCExplicit ? "" : 3599 FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(FI.getCC())); 3600 3601 // Put the note on the first decl, since it is the one that matters. 3602 Diag(First->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3603 return true; 3604 } 3605 } 3606 3607 // FIXME: diagnose the other way around? 3608 if (OldTypeInfo.getNoReturn() && !NewTypeInfo.getNoReturn()) { 3609 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withNoReturn(true); 3610 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3611 } 3612 3613 // Merge regparm attribute. 3614 if (OldTypeInfo.getHasRegParm() != NewTypeInfo.getHasRegParm() || 3615 OldTypeInfo.getRegParm() != NewTypeInfo.getRegParm()) { 3616 if (NewTypeInfo.getHasRegParm()) { 3617 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_regparm_mismatch) 3618 << NewType->getRegParmType() 3619 << OldType->getRegParmType(); 3620 Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_declaration); 3621 return true; 3622 } 3623 3624 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withRegParm(OldTypeInfo.getRegParm()); 3625 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3626 } 3627 3628 // Merge ns_returns_retained attribute. 3629 if (OldTypeInfo.getProducesResult() != NewTypeInfo.getProducesResult()) { 3630 if (NewTypeInfo.getProducesResult()) { 3631 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_function_attribute_mismatch) 3632 << "'ns_returns_retained'"; 3633 Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_declaration); 3634 return true; 3635 } 3636 3637 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withProducesResult(true); 3638 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3639 } 3640 3641 if (OldTypeInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs() != 3642 NewTypeInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs()) { 3643 if (NewTypeInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs()) { 3644 AnyX86NoCallerSavedRegistersAttr *Attr = 3645 New->getAttr<AnyX86NoCallerSavedRegistersAttr>(); 3646 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_function_attribute_mismatch) << Attr; 3647 Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_declaration); 3648 return true; 3649 } 3650 3651 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withNoCallerSavedRegs(true); 3652 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3653 } 3654 3655 if (RequiresAdjustment) { 3656 const FunctionType *AdjustedType = New->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>(); 3657 AdjustedType = Context.adjustFunctionType(AdjustedType, NewTypeInfo); 3658 New->setType(QualType(AdjustedType, 0)); 3659 NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType()); 3660 } 3661 3662 // If this redeclaration makes the function inline, we may need to add it to 3663 // UndefinedButUsed. 3664 if (!Old->isInlined() && New->isInlined() && 3665 !New->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>() && 3666 !getLangOpts().GNUInline && 3667 Old->isUsed(false) && 3668 !Old->isDefined() && !New->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) 3669 UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Old->getCanonicalDecl(), 3670 SourceLocation())); 3671 3672 // If this redeclaration makes it newly gnu_inline, we don't want to warn 3673 // about it. 3674 if (New->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>() && 3675 Old->isInlined() && !Old->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) { 3676 UndefinedButUsed.erase(Old->getCanonicalDecl()); 3677 } 3678 3679 // If pass_object_size params don't match up perfectly, this isn't a valid 3680 // redeclaration. 3681 if (Old->getNumParams() > 0 && Old->getNumParams() == New->getNumParams() && 3682 !hasIdenticalPassObjectSizeAttrs(Old, New)) { 3683 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_pass_object_size_params) 3684 << New->getDeclName(); 3685 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType(); 3686 return true; 3687 } 3688 3689 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 3690 // C++1z [over.load]p2 3691 // Certain function declarations cannot be overloaded: 3692 // -- Function declarations that differ only in the return type, 3693 // the exception specification, or both cannot be overloaded. 3694 3695 // Check the exception specifications match. This may recompute the type of 3696 // both Old and New if it resolved exception specifications, so grab the 3697 // types again after this. Because this updates the type, we do this before 3698 // any of the other checks below, which may update the "de facto" NewQType 3699 // but do not necessarily update the type of New. 3700 if (CheckEquivalentExceptionSpec(Old, New)) 3701 return true; 3702 OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType()); 3703 NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType()); 3704 3705 // Go back to the type source info to compare the declared return types, 3706 // per C++1y [dcl.type.auto]p13: 3707 // Redeclarations or specializations of a function or function template 3708 // with a declared return type that uses a placeholder type shall also 3709 // use that placeholder, not a deduced type. 3710 QualType OldDeclaredReturnType = Old->getDeclaredReturnType(); 3711 QualType NewDeclaredReturnType = New->getDeclaredReturnType(); 3712 if (!Context.hasSameType(OldDeclaredReturnType, NewDeclaredReturnType) && 3713 canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(New, Old, NewDeclaredReturnType, 3714 OldDeclaredReturnType)) { 3715 QualType ResQT; 3716 if (NewDeclaredReturnType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 3717 OldDeclaredReturnType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 3718 // FIXME: This does the wrong thing for a deduced return type. 3719 ResQT = Context.mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewQType, OldQType); 3720 if (ResQT.isNull()) { 3721 if (New->isCXXClassMember() && New->isOutOfLine()) 3722 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_member_def_does_not_match_ret_type) 3723 << New << New->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 3724 else 3725 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_ovl_diff_return_type) 3726 << New->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 3727 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType() 3728 << Old->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 3729 return true; 3730 } 3731 else 3732 NewQType = ResQT; 3733 } 3734 3735 QualType OldReturnType = OldType->getReturnType(); 3736 QualType NewReturnType = cast<FunctionType>(NewQType)->getReturnType(); 3737 if (OldReturnType != NewReturnType) { 3738 // If this function has a deduced return type and has already been 3739 // defined, copy the deduced value from the old declaration. 3740 AutoType *OldAT = Old->getReturnType()->getContainedAutoType(); 3741 if (OldAT && OldAT->isDeduced()) { 3742 QualType DT = OldAT->getDeducedType(); 3743 if (DT.isNull()) { 3744 New->setType(SubstAutoTypeDependent(New->getType())); 3745 NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(SubstAutoTypeDependent(NewQType)); 3746 } else { 3747 New->setType(SubstAutoType(New->getType(), DT)); 3748 NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(SubstAutoType(NewQType, DT)); 3749 } 3750 } 3751 } 3752 3753 const CXXMethodDecl *OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old); 3754 CXXMethodDecl *NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New); 3755 if (OldMethod && NewMethod) { 3756 // Preserve triviality. 3757 NewMethod->setTrivial(OldMethod->isTrivial()); 3758 3759 // MSVC allows explicit template specialization at class scope: 3760 // 2 CXXMethodDecls referring to the same function will be injected. 3761 // We don't want a redeclaration error. 3762 bool IsClassScopeExplicitSpecialization = 3763 OldMethod->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization() && 3764 NewMethod->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization(); 3765 bool isFriend = NewMethod->getFriendObjectKind(); 3766 3767 if (!isFriend && NewMethod->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord() && 3768 !IsClassScopeExplicitSpecialization) { 3769 // -- Member function declarations with the same name and the 3770 // same parameter types cannot be overloaded if any of them 3771 // is a static member function declaration. 3772 if (OldMethod->isStatic() != NewMethod->isStatic()) { 3773 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_ovl_static_nonstatic_member); 3774 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType(); 3775 return true; 3776 } 3777 3778 // C++ [class.mem]p1: 3779 // [...] A member shall not be declared twice in the 3780 // member-specification, except that a nested class or member 3781 // class template can be declared and then later defined. 3782 if (!inTemplateInstantiation()) { 3783 unsigned NewDiag; 3784 if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(OldMethod)) 3785 NewDiag = diag::err_constructor_redeclared; 3786 else if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewMethod)) 3787 NewDiag = diag::err_destructor_redeclared; 3788 else if (isa<CXXConversionDecl>(NewMethod)) 3789 NewDiag = diag::err_conv_function_redeclared; 3790 else 3791 NewDiag = diag::err_member_redeclared; 3792 3793 Diag(New->getLocation(), NewDiag); 3794 } else { 3795 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_member_redeclared_in_instantiation) 3796 << New << New->getType(); 3797 } 3798 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType(); 3799 return true; 3800 3801 // Complain if this is an explicit declaration of a special 3802 // member that was initially declared implicitly. 3803 // 3804 // As an exception, it's okay to befriend such methods in order 3805 // to permit the implicit constructor/destructor/operator calls. 3806 } else if (OldMethod->isImplicit()) { 3807 if (isFriend) { 3808 NewMethod->setImplicit(); 3809 } else { 3810 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), 3811 diag::err_definition_of_implicitly_declared_member) 3812 << New << getSpecialMember(OldMethod); 3813 return true; 3814 } 3815 } else if (OldMethod->getFirstDecl()->isExplicitlyDefaulted() && !isFriend) { 3816 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), 3817 diag::err_definition_of_explicitly_defaulted_member) 3818 << getSpecialMember(OldMethod); 3819 return true; 3820 } 3821 } 3822 3823 // C++11 [dcl.attr.noreturn]p1: 3824 // The first declaration of a function shall specify the noreturn 3825 // attribute if any declaration of that function specifies the noreturn 3826 // attribute. 3827 if (const auto *NRA = New->getAttr<CXX11NoReturnAttr>()) 3828 if (!Old->hasAttr<CXX11NoReturnAttr>()) { 3829 Diag(NRA->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_missing_on_first_decl) 3830 << NRA; 3831 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3832 } 3833 3834 // C++11 [dcl.attr.depend]p2: 3835 // The first declaration of a function shall specify the 3836 // carries_dependency attribute for its declarator-id if any declaration 3837 // of the function specifies the carries_dependency attribute. 3838 const CarriesDependencyAttr *CDA = New->getAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>(); 3839 if (CDA && !Old->hasAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>()) { 3840 Diag(CDA->getLocation(), 3841 diag::err_carries_dependency_missing_on_first_decl) << 0/*Function*/; 3842 Diag(Old->getFirstDecl()->getLocation(), 3843 diag::note_carries_dependency_missing_first_decl) << 0/*Function*/; 3844 } 3845 3846 // (C++98 8.3.5p3): 3847 // All declarations for a function shall agree exactly in both the 3848 // return type and the parameter-type-list. 3849 // We also want to respect all the extended bits except noreturn. 3850 3851 // noreturn should now match unless the old type info didn't have it. 3852 QualType OldQTypeForComparison = OldQType; 3853 if (!OldTypeInfo.getNoReturn() && NewTypeInfo.getNoReturn()) { 3854 auto *OldType = OldQType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 3855 const FunctionType *OldTypeForComparison 3856 = Context.adjustFunctionType(OldType, OldTypeInfo.withNoReturn(true)); 3857 OldQTypeForComparison = QualType(OldTypeForComparison, 0); 3858 assert(OldQTypeForComparison.isCanonical()); 3859 } 3860 3861 if (haveIncompatibleLanguageLinkages(Old, New)) { 3862 // As a special case, retain the language linkage from previous 3863 // declarations of a friend function as an extension. 3864 // 3865 // This liberal interpretation of C++ [class.friend]p3 matches GCC/MSVC 3866 // and is useful because there's otherwise no way to specify language 3867 // linkage within class scope. 3868 // 3869 // Check cautiously as the friend object kind isn't yet complete. 3870 if (New->getFriendObjectKind() != Decl::FOK_None) { 3871 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_retained_language_linkage) << New; 3872 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3873 } else { 3874 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_language_linkage) << New; 3875 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3876 return true; 3877 } 3878 } 3879 3880 // If the function types are compatible, merge the declarations. Ignore the 3881 // exception specifier because it was already checked above in 3882 // CheckEquivalentExceptionSpec, and we don't want follow-on diagnostics 3883 // about incompatible types under -fms-compatibility. 3884 if (Context.hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringExceptionSpec(OldQTypeForComparison, 3885 NewQType)) 3886 return MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(New, Old, S, MergeTypeWithOld); 3887 3888 // If the types are imprecise (due to dependent constructs in friends or 3889 // local extern declarations), it's OK if they differ. We'll check again 3890 // during instantiation. 3891 if (!canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(New, Old, NewQType, OldQType)) 3892 return false; 3893 3894 // Fall through for conflicting redeclarations and redefinitions. 3895 } 3896 3897 // C: Function types need to be compatible, not identical. This handles 3898 // duplicate function decls like "void f(int); void f(enum X);" properly. 3899 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 3900 // C99 6.7.5.3p15: ...If one type has a parameter type list and the other 3901 // type is specified by a function definition that contains a (possibly 3902 // empty) identifier list, both shall agree in the number of parameters 3903 // and the type of each parameter shall be compatible with the type that 3904 // results from the application of default argument promotions to the 3905 // type of the corresponding identifier. ... 3906 // This cannot be handled by ASTContext::typesAreCompatible() because that 3907 // doesn't know whether the function type is for a definition or not when 3908 // eventually calling ASTContext::mergeFunctionTypes(). The only situation 3909 // we need to cover here is that the number of arguments agree as the 3910 // default argument promotion rules were already checked by 3911 // ASTContext::typesAreCompatible(). 3912 if (Old->hasPrototype() && !New->hasWrittenPrototype() && NewDeclIsDefn && 3913 Old->getNumParams() != New->getNumParams()) { 3914 if (Old->hasInheritedPrototype()) 3915 Old = Old->getCanonicalDecl(); 3916 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_conflicting_types) << New; 3917 Diag(Old->getLocation(), PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType(); 3918 return true; 3919 } 3920 3921 // If we are merging two functions where only one of them has a prototype, 3922 // we may have enough information to decide to issue a diagnostic that the 3923 // function without a protoype will change behavior in C2x. This handles 3924 // cases like: 3925 // void i(); void i(int j); 3926 // void i(int j); void i(); 3927 // void i(); void i(int j) {} 3928 // See ActOnFinishFunctionBody() for other cases of the behavior change 3929 // diagnostic. See GetFullTypeForDeclarator() for handling of a function 3930 // type without a prototype. 3931 if (New->hasWrittenPrototype() != Old->hasWrittenPrototype() && 3932 !New->isImplicit() && !Old->isImplicit()) { 3933 const FunctionDecl *WithProto, *WithoutProto; 3934 if (New->hasWrittenPrototype()) { 3935 WithProto = New; 3936 WithoutProto = Old; 3937 } else { 3938 WithProto = Old; 3939 WithoutProto = New; 3940 } 3941 3942 if (WithProto->getNumParams() != 0) { 3943 if (WithoutProto->getBuiltinID() == 0 && !WithoutProto->isImplicit()) { 3944 // The one without the prototype will be changing behavior in C2x, so 3945 // warn about that one so long as it's a user-visible declaration. 3946 bool IsWithoutProtoADef = false, IsWithProtoADef = false; 3947 if (WithoutProto == New) 3948 IsWithoutProtoADef = NewDeclIsDefn; 3949 else 3950 IsWithProtoADef = NewDeclIsDefn; 3951 Diag(WithoutProto->getLocation(), 3952 diag::warn_non_prototype_changes_behavior) 3953 << IsWithoutProtoADef << (WithoutProto->getNumParams() ? 0 : 1) 3954 << (WithoutProto == Old) << IsWithProtoADef; 3955 3956 // The reason the one without the prototype will be changing behavior 3957 // is because of the one with the prototype, so note that so long as 3958 // it's a user-visible declaration. There is one exception to this: 3959 // when the new declaration is a definition without a prototype, the 3960 // old declaration with a prototype is not the cause of the issue, 3961 // and that does not need to be noted because the one with a 3962 // prototype will not change behavior in C2x. 3963 if (WithProto->getBuiltinID() == 0 && !WithProto->isImplicit() && 3964 !IsWithoutProtoADef) 3965 Diag(WithProto->getLocation(), diag::note_conflicting_prototype); 3966 } 3967 } 3968 } 3969 3970 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(OldQType, NewQType)) { 3971 const FunctionType *OldFuncType = OldQType->getAs<FunctionType>(); 3972 const FunctionType *NewFuncType = NewQType->getAs<FunctionType>(); 3973 const FunctionProtoType *OldProto = nullptr; 3974 if (MergeTypeWithOld && isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewFuncType) && 3975 (OldProto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldFuncType))) { 3976 // The old declaration provided a function prototype, but the 3977 // new declaration does not. Merge in the prototype. 3978 assert(!OldProto->hasExceptionSpec() && "Exception spec in C"); 3979 SmallVector<QualType, 16> ParamTypes(OldProto->param_types()); 3980 NewQType = 3981 Context.getFunctionType(NewFuncType->getReturnType(), ParamTypes, 3982 OldProto->getExtProtoInfo()); 3983 New->setType(NewQType); 3984 New->setHasInheritedPrototype(); 3985 3986 // Synthesize parameters with the same types. 3987 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl *, 16> Params; 3988 for (const auto &ParamType : OldProto->param_types()) { 3989 ParmVarDecl *Param = ParmVarDecl::Create( 3990 Context, New, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), nullptr, 3991 ParamType, /*TInfo=*/nullptr, SC_None, nullptr); 3992 Param->setScopeInfo(0, Params.size()); 3993 Param->setImplicit(); 3994 Params.push_back(Param); 3995 } 3996 3997 New->setParams(Params); 3998 } 3999 4000 return MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(New, Old, S, MergeTypeWithOld); 4001 } 4002 } 4003 4004 // Check if the function types are compatible when pointer size address 4005 // spaces are ignored. 4006 if (Context.hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringPtrSizes(OldQType, NewQType)) 4007 return false; 4008 4009 // GNU C permits a K&R definition to follow a prototype declaration 4010 // if the declared types of the parameters in the K&R definition 4011 // match the types in the prototype declaration, even when the 4012 // promoted types of the parameters from the K&R definition differ 4013 // from the types in the prototype. GCC then keeps the types from 4014 // the prototype. 4015 // 4016 // If a variadic prototype is followed by a non-variadic K&R definition, 4017 // the K&R definition becomes variadic. This is sort of an edge case, but 4018 // it's legal per the standard depending on how you read C99 6.7.5.3p15 and 4019 // C99 6.9.1p8. 4020 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 4021 Old->hasPrototype() && !New->hasPrototype() && 4022 New->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>() && 4023 Old->getNumParams() == New->getNumParams()) { 4024 SmallVector<QualType, 16> ArgTypes; 4025 SmallVector<GNUCompatibleParamWarning, 16> Warnings; 4026 const FunctionProtoType *OldProto 4027 = Old->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 4028 const FunctionProtoType *NewProto 4029 = New->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 4030 4031 // Determine whether this is the GNU C extension. 4032 QualType MergedReturn = Context.mergeTypes(OldProto->getReturnType(), 4033 NewProto->getReturnType()); 4034 bool LooseCompatible = !MergedReturn.isNull(); 4035 for (unsigned Idx = 0, End = Old->getNumParams(); 4036 LooseCompatible && Idx != End; ++Idx) { 4037 ParmVarDecl *OldParm = Old->getParamDecl(Idx); 4038 ParmVarDecl *NewParm = New->getParamDecl(Idx); 4039 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(OldParm->getType(), 4040 NewProto->getParamType(Idx))) { 4041 ArgTypes.push_back(NewParm->getType()); 4042 } else if (Context.typesAreCompatible(OldParm->getType(), 4043 NewParm->getType(), 4044 /*CompareUnqualified=*/true)) { 4045 GNUCompatibleParamWarning Warn = { OldParm, NewParm, 4046 NewProto->getParamType(Idx) }; 4047 Warnings.push_back(Warn); 4048 ArgTypes.push_back(NewParm->getType()); 4049 } else 4050 LooseCompatible = false; 4051 } 4052 4053 if (LooseCompatible) { 4054 for (unsigned Warn = 0; Warn < Warnings.size(); ++Warn) { 4055 Diag(Warnings[Warn].NewParm->getLocation(), 4056 diag::ext_param_promoted_not_compatible_with_prototype) 4057 << Warnings[Warn].PromotedType 4058 << Warnings[Warn].OldParm->getType(); 4059 if (Warnings[Warn].OldParm->getLocation().isValid()) 4060 Diag(Warnings[Warn].OldParm->getLocation(), 4061 diag::note_previous_declaration); 4062 } 4063 4064 if (MergeTypeWithOld) 4065 New->setType(Context.getFunctionType(MergedReturn, ArgTypes, 4066 OldProto->getExtProtoInfo())); 4067 return MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(New, Old, S, MergeTypeWithOld); 4068 } 4069 4070 // Fall through to diagnose conflicting types. 4071 } 4072 4073 // A function that has already been declared has been redeclared or 4074 // defined with a different type; show an appropriate diagnostic. 4075 4076 // If the previous declaration was an implicitly-generated builtin 4077 // declaration, then at the very least we should use a specialized note. 4078 unsigned BuiltinID; 4079 if (Old->isImplicit() && (BuiltinID = Old->getBuiltinID())) { 4080 // If it's actually a library-defined builtin function like 'malloc' 4081 // or 'printf', just warn about the incompatible redeclaration. 4082 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID)) { 4083 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_redecl_library_builtin) << New; 4084 Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration) 4085 << Old << Old->getType(); 4086 return false; 4087 } 4088 4089 PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration; 4090 } 4091 4092 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_conflicting_types) << New->getDeclName(); 4093 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType(); 4094 return true; 4095 } 4096 4097 /// Completes the merge of two function declarations that are 4098 /// known to be compatible. 4099 /// 4100 /// This routine handles the merging of attributes and other 4101 /// properties of function declarations from the old declaration to 4102 /// the new declaration, once we know that New is in fact a 4103 /// redeclaration of Old. 4104 /// 4105 /// \returns false 4106 bool Sema::MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old, 4107 Scope *S, bool MergeTypeWithOld) { 4108 // Merge the attributes 4109 mergeDeclAttributes(New, Old); 4110 4111 // Merge "pure" flag. 4112 if (Old->isPure()) 4113 New->setPure(); 4114 4115 // Merge "used" flag. 4116 if (Old->getMostRecentDecl()->isUsed(false)) 4117 New->setIsUsed(); 4118 4119 // Merge attributes from the parameters. These can mismatch with K&R 4120 // declarations. 4121 if (New->getNumParams() == Old->getNumParams()) 4122 for (unsigned i = 0, e = New->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) { 4123 ParmVarDecl *NewParam = New->getParamDecl(i); 4124 ParmVarDecl *OldParam = Old->getParamDecl(i); 4125 mergeParamDeclAttributes(NewParam, OldParam, *this); 4126 mergeParamDeclTypes(NewParam, OldParam, *this); 4127 } 4128 4129 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 4130 return MergeCXXFunctionDecl(New, Old, S); 4131 4132 // Merge the function types so the we get the composite types for the return 4133 // and argument types. Per C11 6.2.7/4, only update the type if the old decl 4134 // was visible. 4135 QualType Merged = Context.mergeTypes(Old->getType(), New->getType()); 4136 if (!Merged.isNull() && MergeTypeWithOld) 4137 New->setType(Merged); 4138 4139 return false; 4140 } 4141 4142 void Sema::mergeObjCMethodDecls(ObjCMethodDecl *newMethod, 4143 ObjCMethodDecl *oldMethod) { 4144 // Merge the attributes, including deprecated/unavailable 4145 AvailabilityMergeKind MergeKind = 4146 isa<ObjCProtocolDecl>(oldMethod->getDeclContext()) 4147 ? (oldMethod->isOptional() ? AMK_OptionalProtocolImplementation 4148 : AMK_ProtocolImplementation) 4149 : isa<ObjCImplDecl>(newMethod->getDeclContext()) ? AMK_Redeclaration 4150 : AMK_Override; 4151 4152 mergeDeclAttributes(newMethod, oldMethod, MergeKind); 4153 4154 // Merge attributes from the parameters. 4155 ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator oi = oldMethod->param_begin(), 4156 oe = oldMethod->param_end(); 4157 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator 4158 ni = newMethod->param_begin(), ne = newMethod->param_end(); 4159 ni != ne && oi != oe; ++ni, ++oi) 4160 mergeParamDeclAttributes(*ni, *oi, *this); 4161 4162 CheckObjCMethodOverride(newMethod, oldMethod); 4163 } 4164 4165 static void diagnoseVarDeclTypeMismatch(Sema &S, VarDecl *New, VarDecl* Old) { 4166 assert(!S.Context.hasSameType(New->getType(), Old->getType())); 4167 4168 S.Diag(New->getLocation(), New->isThisDeclarationADefinition() 4169 ? diag::err_redefinition_different_type 4170 : diag::err_redeclaration_different_type) 4171 << New->getDeclName() << New->getType() << Old->getType(); 4172 4173 diag::kind PrevDiag; 4174 SourceLocation OldLocation; 4175 std::tie(PrevDiag, OldLocation) 4176 = getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(Old, New); 4177 S.Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4178 New->setInvalidDecl(); 4179 } 4180 4181 /// MergeVarDeclTypes - We parsed a variable 'New' which has the same name and 4182 /// scope as a previous declaration 'Old'. Figure out how to merge their types, 4183 /// emitting diagnostics as appropriate. 4184 /// 4185 /// Declarations using the auto type specifier (C++ [decl.spec.auto]) call back 4186 /// to here in AddInitializerToDecl. We can't check them before the initializer 4187 /// is attached. 4188 void Sema::MergeVarDeclTypes(VarDecl *New, VarDecl *Old, 4189 bool MergeTypeWithOld) { 4190 if (New->isInvalidDecl() || Old->isInvalidDecl()) 4191 return; 4192 4193 QualType MergedT; 4194 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 4195 if (New->getType()->isUndeducedType()) { 4196 // We don't know what the new type is until the initializer is attached. 4197 return; 4198 } else if (Context.hasSameType(New->getType(), Old->getType())) { 4199 // These could still be something that needs exception specs checked. 4200 return MergeVarDeclExceptionSpecs(New, Old); 4201 } 4202 // C++ [basic.link]p10: 4203 // [...] the types specified by all declarations referring to a given 4204 // object or function shall be identical, except that declarations for an 4205 // array object can specify array types that differ by the presence or 4206 // absence of a major array bound (8.3.4). 4207 else if (Old->getType()->isArrayType() && New->getType()->isArrayType()) { 4208 const ArrayType *OldArray = Context.getAsArrayType(Old->getType()); 4209 const ArrayType *NewArray = Context.getAsArrayType(New->getType()); 4210 4211 // We are merging a variable declaration New into Old. If it has an array 4212 // bound, and that bound differs from Old's bound, we should diagnose the 4213 // mismatch. 4214 if (!NewArray->isIncompleteArrayType() && !NewArray->isDependentType()) { 4215 for (VarDecl *PrevVD = Old->getMostRecentDecl(); PrevVD; 4216 PrevVD = PrevVD->getPreviousDecl()) { 4217 QualType PrevVDTy = PrevVD->getType(); 4218 if (PrevVDTy->isIncompleteArrayType() || PrevVDTy->isDependentType()) 4219 continue; 4220 4221 if (!Context.hasSameType(New->getType(), PrevVDTy)) 4222 return diagnoseVarDeclTypeMismatch(*this, New, PrevVD); 4223 } 4224 } 4225 4226 if (OldArray->isIncompleteArrayType() && NewArray->isArrayType()) { 4227 if (Context.hasSameType(OldArray->getElementType(), 4228 NewArray->getElementType())) 4229 MergedT = New->getType(); 4230 } 4231 // FIXME: Check visibility. New is hidden but has a complete type. If New 4232 // has no array bound, it should not inherit one from Old, if Old is not 4233 // visible. 4234 else if (OldArray->isArrayType() && NewArray->isIncompleteArrayType()) { 4235 if (Context.hasSameType(OldArray->getElementType(), 4236 NewArray->getElementType())) 4237 MergedT = Old->getType(); 4238 } 4239 } 4240 else if (New->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 4241 Old->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 4242 MergedT = Context.mergeObjCGCQualifiers(New->getType(), 4243 Old->getType()); 4244 } 4245 } else { 4246 // C 6.2.7p2: 4247 // All declarations that refer to the same object or function shall have 4248 // compatible type. 4249 MergedT = Context.mergeTypes(New->getType(), Old->getType()); 4250 } 4251 if (MergedT.isNull()) { 4252 // It's OK if we couldn't merge types if either type is dependent, for a 4253 // block-scope variable. In other cases (static data members of class 4254 // templates, variable templates, ...), we require the types to be 4255 // equivalent. 4256 // FIXME: The C++ standard doesn't say anything about this. 4257 if ((New->getType()->isDependentType() || 4258 Old->getType()->isDependentType()) && New->isLocalVarDecl()) { 4259 // If the old type was dependent, we can't merge with it, so the new type 4260 // becomes dependent for now. We'll reproduce the original type when we 4261 // instantiate the TypeSourceInfo for the variable. 4262 if (!New->getType()->isDependentType() && MergeTypeWithOld) 4263 New->setType(Context.DependentTy); 4264 return; 4265 } 4266 return diagnoseVarDeclTypeMismatch(*this, New, Old); 4267 } 4268 4269 // Don't actually update the type on the new declaration if the old 4270 // declaration was an extern declaration in a different scope. 4271 if (MergeTypeWithOld) 4272 New->setType(MergedT); 4273 } 4274 4275 static bool mergeTypeWithPrevious(Sema &S, VarDecl *NewVD, VarDecl *OldVD, 4276 LookupResult &Previous) { 4277 // C11 6.2.7p4: 4278 // For an identifier with internal or external linkage declared 4279 // in a scope in which a prior declaration of that identifier is 4280 // visible, if the prior declaration specifies internal or 4281 // external linkage, the type of the identifier at the later 4282 // declaration becomes the composite type. 4283 // 4284 // If the variable isn't visible, we do not merge with its type. 4285 if (Previous.isShadowed()) 4286 return false; 4287 4288 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 4289 // C++11 [dcl.array]p3: 4290 // If there is a preceding declaration of the entity in the same 4291 // scope in which the bound was specified, an omitted array bound 4292 // is taken to be the same as in that earlier declaration. 4293 return NewVD->isPreviousDeclInSameBlockScope() || 4294 (!OldVD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod() && 4295 !NewVD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()); 4296 } else { 4297 // If the old declaration was function-local, don't merge with its 4298 // type unless we're in the same function. 4299 return !OldVD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod() || 4300 OldVD->getLexicalDeclContext() == NewVD->getLexicalDeclContext(); 4301 } 4302 } 4303 4304 /// MergeVarDecl - We just parsed a variable 'New' which has the same name 4305 /// and scope as a previous declaration 'Old'. Figure out how to resolve this 4306 /// situation, merging decls or emitting diagnostics as appropriate. 4307 /// 4308 /// Tentative definition rules (C99 6.9.2p2) are checked by 4309 /// FinalizeDeclaratorGroup. Unfortunately, we can't analyze tentative 4310 /// definitions here, since the initializer hasn't been attached. 4311 /// 4312 void Sema::MergeVarDecl(VarDecl *New, LookupResult &Previous) { 4313 // If the new decl is already invalid, don't do any other checking. 4314 if (New->isInvalidDecl()) 4315 return; 4316 4317 if (!shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(Previous, New)) 4318 return; 4319 4320 VarTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedVarTemplate(); 4321 4322 // Verify the old decl was also a variable or variable template. 4323 VarDecl *Old = nullptr; 4324 VarTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = nullptr; 4325 if (Previous.isSingleResult()) { 4326 if (NewTemplate) { 4327 OldTemplate = dyn_cast<VarTemplateDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl()); 4328 Old = OldTemplate ? OldTemplate->getTemplatedDecl() : nullptr; 4329 4330 if (auto *Shadow = 4331 dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Previous.getRepresentativeDecl())) 4332 if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<VarTemplateDecl>(*this, Shadow, NewTemplate)) 4333 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4334 } else { 4335 Old = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl()); 4336 4337 if (auto *Shadow = 4338 dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Previous.getRepresentativeDecl())) 4339 if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<VarDecl>(*this, Shadow, New)) 4340 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4341 } 4342 } 4343 if (!Old) { 4344 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_kind) 4345 << New->getDeclName(); 4346 notePreviousDefinition(Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(), 4347 New->getLocation()); 4348 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4349 } 4350 4351 // If the old declaration was found in an inline namespace and the new 4352 // declaration was qualified, update the DeclContext to match. 4353 adjustDeclContextForDeclaratorDecl(New, Old); 4354 4355 // Ensure the template parameters are compatible. 4356 if (NewTemplate && 4357 !TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 4358 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 4359 /*Complain=*/true, TPL_TemplateMatch)) 4360 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4361 4362 // C++ [class.mem]p1: 4363 // A member shall not be declared twice in the member-specification [...] 4364 // 4365 // Here, we need only consider static data members. 4366 if (Old->isStaticDataMember() && !New->isOutOfLine()) { 4367 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_duplicate_member) 4368 << New->getIdentifier(); 4369 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 4370 New->setInvalidDecl(); 4371 } 4372 4373 mergeDeclAttributes(New, Old); 4374 // Warn if an already-declared variable is made a weak_import in a subsequent 4375 // declaration 4376 if (New->hasAttr<WeakImportAttr>() && 4377 Old->getStorageClass() == SC_None && 4378 !Old->hasAttr<WeakImportAttr>()) { 4379 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_weak_import) << New->getDeclName(); 4380 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 4381 // Remove weak_import attribute on new declaration. 4382 New->dropAttr<WeakImportAttr>(); 4383 } 4384 4385 if (const auto *ILA = New->getAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>()) 4386 if (!Old->hasAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>()) { 4387 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_missing_on_first_decl) 4388 << ILA; 4389 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 4390 New->dropAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>(); 4391 } 4392 4393 // Merge the types. 4394 VarDecl *MostRecent = Old->getMostRecentDecl(); 4395 if (MostRecent != Old) { 4396 MergeVarDeclTypes(New, MostRecent, 4397 mergeTypeWithPrevious(*this, New, MostRecent, Previous)); 4398 if (New->isInvalidDecl()) 4399 return; 4400 } 4401 4402 MergeVarDeclTypes(New, Old, mergeTypeWithPrevious(*this, New, Old, Previous)); 4403 if (New->isInvalidDecl()) 4404 return; 4405 4406 diag::kind PrevDiag; 4407 SourceLocation OldLocation; 4408 std::tie(PrevDiag, OldLocation) = 4409 getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(Old, New); 4410 4411 // [dcl.stc]p8: Check if we have a non-static decl followed by a static. 4412 if (New->getStorageClass() == SC_Static && 4413 !New->isStaticDataMember() && 4414 Old->hasExternalFormalLinkage()) { 4415 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) { 4416 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_static_non_static) 4417 << New->getDeclName(); 4418 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4419 } else { 4420 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_static_non_static) 4421 << New->getDeclName(); 4422 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4423 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4424 } 4425 } 4426 // C99 6.2.2p4: 4427 // For an identifier declared with the storage-class specifier 4428 // extern in a scope in which a prior declaration of that 4429 // identifier is visible,23) if the prior declaration specifies 4430 // internal or external linkage, the linkage of the identifier at 4431 // the later declaration is the same as the linkage specified at 4432 // the prior declaration. If no prior declaration is visible, or 4433 // if the prior declaration specifies no linkage, then the 4434 // identifier has external linkage. 4435 if (New->hasExternalStorage() && Old->hasLinkage()) 4436 /* Okay */; 4437 else if (New->getCanonicalDecl()->getStorageClass() != SC_Static && 4438 !New->isStaticDataMember() && 4439 Old->getCanonicalDecl()->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) { 4440 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_non_static_static) << New->getDeclName(); 4441 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4442 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4443 } 4444 4445 // Check if extern is followed by non-extern and vice-versa. 4446 if (New->hasExternalStorage() && 4447 !Old->hasLinkage() && Old->isLocalVarDeclOrParm()) { 4448 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_extern_non_extern) << New->getDeclName(); 4449 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4450 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4451 } 4452 if (Old->hasLinkage() && New->isLocalVarDeclOrParm() && 4453 !New->hasExternalStorage()) { 4454 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_non_extern_extern) << New->getDeclName(); 4455 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4456 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4457 } 4458 4459 if (CheckRedeclarationInModule(New, Old)) 4460 return; 4461 4462 // Variables with external linkage are analyzed in FinalizeDeclaratorGroup. 4463 4464 // FIXME: The test for external storage here seems wrong? We still 4465 // need to check for mismatches. 4466 if (!New->hasExternalStorage() && !New->isFileVarDecl() && 4467 // Don't complain about out-of-line definitions of static members. 4468 !(Old->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord() && 4469 !New->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord())) { 4470 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) << New->getDeclName(); 4471 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4472 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4473 } 4474 4475 if (New->isInline() && !Old->getMostRecentDecl()->isInline()) { 4476 if (VarDecl *Def = Old->getDefinition()) { 4477 // C++1z [dcl.fcn.spec]p4: 4478 // If the definition of a variable appears in a translation unit before 4479 // its first declaration as inline, the program is ill-formed. 4480 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_inline_decl_follows_def) << New; 4481 Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 4482 } 4483 } 4484 4485 // If this redeclaration makes the variable inline, we may need to add it to 4486 // UndefinedButUsed. 4487 if (!Old->isInline() && New->isInline() && Old->isUsed(false) && 4488 !Old->getDefinition() && !New->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) 4489 UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Old->getCanonicalDecl(), 4490 SourceLocation())); 4491 4492 if (New->getTLSKind() != Old->getTLSKind()) { 4493 if (!Old->getTLSKind()) { 4494 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_thread_non_thread) << New->getDeclName(); 4495 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4496 } else if (!New->getTLSKind()) { 4497 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_non_thread_thread) << New->getDeclName(); 4498 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4499 } else { 4500 // Do not allow redeclaration to change the variable between requiring 4501 // static and dynamic initialization. 4502 // FIXME: GCC allows this, but uses the TLS keyword on the first 4503 // declaration to determine the kind. Do we need to be compatible here? 4504 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_thread_thread_different_kind) 4505 << New->getDeclName() << (New->getTLSKind() == VarDecl::TLS_Dynamic); 4506 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4507 } 4508 } 4509 4510 // C++ doesn't have tentative definitions, so go right ahead and check here. 4511 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 4512 if (Old->isStaticDataMember() && Old->getCanonicalDecl()->isInline() && 4513 Old->getCanonicalDecl()->isConstexpr()) { 4514 // This definition won't be a definition any more once it's been merged. 4515 Diag(New->getLocation(), 4516 diag::warn_deprecated_redundant_constexpr_static_def); 4517 } else if (New->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::Definition) { 4518 VarDecl *Def = Old->getDefinition(); 4519 if (Def && checkVarDeclRedefinition(Def, New)) 4520 return; 4521 } 4522 } 4523 4524 if (haveIncompatibleLanguageLinkages(Old, New)) { 4525 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_language_linkage) << New; 4526 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4527 New->setInvalidDecl(); 4528 return; 4529 } 4530 4531 // Merge "used" flag. 4532 if (Old->getMostRecentDecl()->isUsed(false)) 4533 New->setIsUsed(); 4534 4535 // Keep a chain of previous declarations. 4536 New->setPreviousDecl(Old); 4537 if (NewTemplate) 4538 NewTemplate->setPreviousDecl(OldTemplate); 4539 4540 // Inherit access appropriately. 4541 New->setAccess(Old->getAccess()); 4542 if (NewTemplate) 4543 NewTemplate->setAccess(New->getAccess()); 4544 4545 if (Old->isInline()) 4546 New->setImplicitlyInline(); 4547 } 4548 4549 void Sema::notePreviousDefinition(const NamedDecl *Old, SourceLocation New) { 4550 SourceManager &SrcMgr = getSourceManager(); 4551 auto FNewDecLoc = SrcMgr.getDecomposedLoc(New); 4552 auto FOldDecLoc = SrcMgr.getDecomposedLoc(Old->getLocation()); 4553 auto *FNew = SrcMgr.getFileEntryForID(FNewDecLoc.first); 4554 auto *FOld = SrcMgr.getFileEntryForID(FOldDecLoc.first); 4555 auto &HSI = PP.getHeaderSearchInfo(); 4556 StringRef HdrFilename = 4557 SrcMgr.getFilename(SrcMgr.getSpellingLoc(Old->getLocation())); 4558 4559 auto noteFromModuleOrInclude = [&](Module *Mod, 4560 SourceLocation IncLoc) -> bool { 4561 // Redefinition errors with modules are common with non modular mapped 4562 // headers, example: a non-modular header H in module A that also gets 4563 // included directly in a TU. Pointing twice to the same header/definition 4564 // is confusing, try to get better diagnostics when modules is on. 4565 if (IncLoc.isValid()) { 4566 if (Mod) { 4567 Diag(IncLoc, diag::note_redefinition_modules_same_file) 4568 << HdrFilename.str() << Mod->getFullModuleName(); 4569 if (!Mod->DefinitionLoc.isInvalid()) 4570 Diag(Mod->DefinitionLoc, diag::note_defined_here) 4571 << Mod->getFullModuleName(); 4572 } else { 4573 Diag(IncLoc, diag::note_redefinition_include_same_file) 4574 << HdrFilename.str(); 4575 } 4576 return true; 4577 } 4578 4579 return false; 4580 }; 4581 4582 // Is it the same file and same offset? Provide more information on why 4583 // this leads to a redefinition error. 4584 if (FNew == FOld && FNewDecLoc.second == FOldDecLoc.second) { 4585 SourceLocation OldIncLoc = SrcMgr.getIncludeLoc(FOldDecLoc.first); 4586 SourceLocation NewIncLoc = SrcMgr.getIncludeLoc(FNewDecLoc.first); 4587 bool EmittedDiag = 4588 noteFromModuleOrInclude(Old->getOwningModule(), OldIncLoc); 4589 EmittedDiag |= noteFromModuleOrInclude(getCurrentModule(), NewIncLoc); 4590 4591 // If the header has no guards, emit a note suggesting one. 4592 if (FOld && !HSI.isFileMultipleIncludeGuarded(FOld)) 4593 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_use_ifdef_guards); 4594 4595 if (EmittedDiag) 4596 return; 4597 } 4598 4599 // Redefinition coming from different files or couldn't do better above. 4600 if (Old->getLocation().isValid()) 4601 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 4602 } 4603 4604 /// We've just determined that \p Old and \p New both appear to be definitions 4605 /// of the same variable. Either diagnose or fix the problem. 4606 bool Sema::checkVarDeclRedefinition(VarDecl *Old, VarDecl *New) { 4607 if (!hasVisibleDefinition(Old) && 4608 (New->getFormalLinkage() == InternalLinkage || 4609 New->isInline() || 4610 New->getDescribedVarTemplate() || 4611 New->getNumTemplateParameterLists() || 4612 New->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext())) { 4613 // The previous definition is hidden, and multiple definitions are 4614 // permitted (in separate TUs). Demote this to a declaration. 4615 New->demoteThisDefinitionToDeclaration(); 4616 4617 // Make the canonical definition visible. 4618 if (auto *OldTD = Old->getDescribedVarTemplate()) 4619 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(OldTD); 4620 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(Old); 4621 return false; 4622 } else { 4623 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) << New; 4624 notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation()); 4625 New->setInvalidDecl(); 4626 return true; 4627 } 4628 } 4629 4630 /// ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec - This method is invoked when a declspec with 4631 /// no declarator (e.g. "struct foo;") is parsed. 4632 Decl *Sema::ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec(Scope *S, AccessSpecifier AS, 4633 DeclSpec &DS, 4634 const ParsedAttributesView &DeclAttrs, 4635 RecordDecl *&AnonRecord) { 4636 return ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec( 4637 S, AS, DS, DeclAttrs, MultiTemplateParamsArg(), false, AnonRecord); 4638 } 4639 4640 // The MS ABI changed between VS2013 and VS2015 with regard to numbers used to 4641 // disambiguate entities defined in different scopes. 4642 // While the VS2015 ABI fixes potential miscompiles, it is also breaks 4643 // compatibility. 4644 // We will pick our mangling number depending on which version of MSVC is being 4645 // targeted. 4646 static unsigned getMSManglingNumber(const LangOptions &LO, Scope *S) { 4647 return LO.isCompatibleWithMSVC(LangOptions::MSVC2015) 4648 ? S->getMSCurManglingNumber() 4649 : S->getMSLastManglingNumber(); 4650 } 4651 4652 void Sema::handleTagNumbering(const TagDecl *Tag, Scope *TagScope) { 4653 if (!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 4654 return; 4655 4656 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag->getParent())) { 4657 // If this tag is the direct child of a class, number it if 4658 // it is anonymous. 4659 if (!Tag->getName().empty() || Tag->getTypedefNameForAnonDecl()) 4660 return; 4661 MangleNumberingContext &MCtx = 4662 Context.getManglingNumberContext(Tag->getParent()); 4663 Context.setManglingNumber( 4664 Tag, MCtx.getManglingNumber( 4665 Tag, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), TagScope))); 4666 return; 4667 } 4668 4669 // If this tag isn't a direct child of a class, number it if it is local. 4670 MangleNumberingContext *MCtx; 4671 Decl *ManglingContextDecl; 4672 std::tie(MCtx, ManglingContextDecl) = 4673 getCurrentMangleNumberContext(Tag->getDeclContext()); 4674 if (MCtx) { 4675 Context.setManglingNumber( 4676 Tag, MCtx->getManglingNumber( 4677 Tag, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), TagScope))); 4678 } 4679 } 4680 4681 namespace { 4682 struct NonCLikeKind { 4683 enum { 4684 None, 4685 BaseClass, 4686 DefaultMemberInit, 4687 Lambda, 4688 Friend, 4689 OtherMember, 4690 Invalid, 4691 } Kind = None; 4692 SourceRange Range; 4693 4694 explicit operator bool() { return Kind != None; } 4695 }; 4696 } 4697 4698 /// Determine whether a class is C-like, according to the rules of C++ 4699 /// [dcl.typedef] for anonymous classes with typedef names for linkage. 4700 static NonCLikeKind getNonCLikeKindForAnonymousStruct(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) { 4701 if (RD->isInvalidDecl()) 4702 return {NonCLikeKind::Invalid, {}}; 4703 4704 // C++ [dcl.typedef]p9: [P1766R1] 4705 // An unnamed class with a typedef name for linkage purposes shall not 4706 // 4707 // -- have any base classes 4708 if (RD->getNumBases()) 4709 return {NonCLikeKind::BaseClass, 4710 SourceRange(RD->bases_begin()->getBeginLoc(), 4711 RD->bases_end()[-1].getEndLoc())}; 4712 bool Invalid = false; 4713 for (Decl *D : RD->decls()) { 4714 // Don't complain about things we already diagnosed. 4715 if (D->isInvalidDecl()) { 4716 Invalid = true; 4717 continue; 4718 } 4719 4720 // -- have any [...] default member initializers 4721 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(D)) { 4722 if (FD->hasInClassInitializer()) { 4723 auto *Init = FD->getInClassInitializer(); 4724 return {NonCLikeKind::DefaultMemberInit, 4725 Init ? Init->getSourceRange() : D->getSourceRange()}; 4726 } 4727 continue; 4728 } 4729 4730 // FIXME: We don't allow friend declarations. This violates the wording of 4731 // P1766, but not the intent. 4732 if (isa<FriendDecl>(D)) 4733 return {NonCLikeKind::Friend, D->getSourceRange()}; 4734 4735 // -- declare any members other than non-static data members, member 4736 // enumerations, or member classes, 4737 if (isa<StaticAssertDecl>(D) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(D) || 4738 isa<EnumDecl>(D)) 4739 continue; 4740 auto *MemberRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D); 4741 if (!MemberRD) { 4742 if (D->isImplicit()) 4743 continue; 4744 return {NonCLikeKind::OtherMember, D->getSourceRange()}; 4745 } 4746 4747 // -- contain a lambda-expression, 4748 if (MemberRD->isLambda()) 4749 return {NonCLikeKind::Lambda, MemberRD->getSourceRange()}; 4750 4751 // and all member classes shall also satisfy these requirements 4752 // (recursively). 4753 if (MemberRD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) { 4754 if (auto Kind = getNonCLikeKindForAnonymousStruct(MemberRD)) 4755 return Kind; 4756 } 4757 } 4758 4759 return {Invalid ? NonCLikeKind::Invalid : NonCLikeKind::None, {}}; 4760 } 4761 4762 void Sema::setTagNameForLinkagePurposes(TagDecl *TagFromDeclSpec, 4763 TypedefNameDecl *NewTD) { 4764 if (TagFromDeclSpec->isInvalidDecl()) 4765 return; 4766 4767 // Do nothing if the tag already has a name for linkage purposes. 4768 if (TagFromDeclSpec->hasNameForLinkage()) 4769 return; 4770 4771 // A well-formed anonymous tag must always be a TUK_Definition. 4772 assert(TagFromDeclSpec->isThisDeclarationADefinition()); 4773 4774 // The type must match the tag exactly; no qualifiers allowed. 4775 if (!Context.hasSameType(NewTD->getUnderlyingType(), 4776 Context.getTagDeclType(TagFromDeclSpec))) { 4777 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 4778 Context.addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TagFromDeclSpec, NewTD); 4779 return; 4780 } 4781 4782 // C++ [dcl.typedef]p9: [P1766R1, applied as DR] 4783 // An unnamed class with a typedef name for linkage purposes shall [be 4784 // C-like]. 4785 // 4786 // FIXME: Also diagnose if we've already computed the linkage. That ideally 4787 // shouldn't happen, but there are constructs that the language rule doesn't 4788 // disallow for which we can't reasonably avoid computing linkage early. 4789 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TagFromDeclSpec); 4790 NonCLikeKind NonCLike = RD ? getNonCLikeKindForAnonymousStruct(RD) 4791 : NonCLikeKind(); 4792 bool ChangesLinkage = TagFromDeclSpec->hasLinkageBeenComputed(); 4793 if (NonCLike || ChangesLinkage) { 4794 if (NonCLike.Kind == NonCLikeKind::Invalid) 4795 return; 4796 4797 unsigned DiagID = diag::ext_non_c_like_anon_struct_in_typedef; 4798 if (ChangesLinkage) { 4799 // If the linkage changes, we can't accept this as an extension. 4800 if (NonCLike.Kind == NonCLikeKind::None) 4801 DiagID = diag::err_typedef_changes_linkage; 4802 else 4803 DiagID = diag::err_non_c_like_anon_struct_in_typedef; 4804 } 4805 4806 SourceLocation FixitLoc = 4807 getLocForEndOfToken(TagFromDeclSpec->getInnerLocStart()); 4808 llvm::SmallString<40> TextToInsert; 4809 TextToInsert += ' '; 4810 TextToInsert += NewTD->getIdentifier()->getName(); 4811 4812 Diag(FixitLoc, DiagID) 4813 << isa<TypeAliasDecl>(NewTD) 4814 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FixitLoc, TextToInsert); 4815 if (NonCLike.Kind != NonCLikeKind::None) { 4816 Diag(NonCLike.Range.getBegin(), diag::note_non_c_like_anon_struct) 4817 << NonCLike.Kind - 1 << NonCLike.Range; 4818 } 4819 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::note_typedef_for_linkage_here) 4820 << NewTD << isa<TypeAliasDecl>(NewTD); 4821 4822 if (ChangesLinkage) 4823 return; 4824 } 4825 4826 // Otherwise, set this as the anon-decl typedef for the tag. 4827 TagFromDeclSpec->setTypedefNameForAnonDecl(NewTD); 4828 } 4829 4830 static unsigned GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(DeclSpec::TST T) { 4831 switch (T) { 4832 case DeclSpec::TST_class: 4833 return 0; 4834 case DeclSpec::TST_struct: 4835 return 1; 4836 case DeclSpec::TST_interface: 4837 return 2; 4838 case DeclSpec::TST_union: 4839 return 3; 4840 case DeclSpec::TST_enum: 4841 return 4; 4842 default: 4843 llvm_unreachable("unexpected type specifier"); 4844 } 4845 } 4846 4847 /// ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec - This method is invoked when a declspec with 4848 /// no declarator (e.g. "struct foo;") is parsed. It also accepts template 4849 /// parameters to cope with template friend declarations. 4850 Decl *Sema::ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec(Scope *S, AccessSpecifier AS, 4851 DeclSpec &DS, 4852 const ParsedAttributesView &DeclAttrs, 4853 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParams, 4854 bool IsExplicitInstantiation, 4855 RecordDecl *&AnonRecord) { 4856 Decl *TagD = nullptr; 4857 TagDecl *Tag = nullptr; 4858 if (DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_class || 4859 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_struct || 4860 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_interface || 4861 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_union || 4862 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_enum) { 4863 TagD = DS.getRepAsDecl(); 4864 4865 if (!TagD) // We probably had an error 4866 return nullptr; 4867 4868 // Note that the above type specs guarantee that the 4869 // type rep is a Decl, whereas in many of the others 4870 // it's a Type. 4871 if (isa<TagDecl>(TagD)) 4872 Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD); 4873 else if (ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateDecl>(TagD)) 4874 Tag = CTD->getTemplatedDecl(); 4875 } 4876 4877 if (Tag) { 4878 handleTagNumbering(Tag, S); 4879 Tag->setFreeStanding(); 4880 if (Tag->isInvalidDecl()) 4881 return Tag; 4882 } 4883 4884 if (unsigned TypeQuals = DS.getTypeQualifiers()) { 4885 // Enforce C99 6.7.3p2: "Types other than pointer types derived from object 4886 // or incomplete types shall not be restrict-qualified." 4887 if (TypeQuals & DeclSpec::TQ_restrict) 4888 Diag(DS.getRestrictSpecLoc(), 4889 diag::err_typecheck_invalid_restrict_not_pointer_noarg) 4890 << DS.getSourceRange(); 4891 } 4892 4893 if (DS.isInlineSpecified()) 4894 Diag(DS.getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function) 4895 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17; 4896 4897 if (DS.hasConstexprSpecifier()) { 4898 // C++0x [dcl.constexpr]p1: constexpr can only be applied to declarations 4899 // and definitions of functions and variables. 4900 // C++2a [dcl.constexpr]p1: The consteval specifier shall be applied only to 4901 // the declaration of a function or function template 4902 if (Tag) 4903 Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_tag) 4904 << GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(DS.getTypeSpecType()) 4905 << static_cast<int>(DS.getConstexprSpecifier()); 4906 else 4907 Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_wrong_decl_kind) 4908 << static_cast<int>(DS.getConstexprSpecifier()); 4909 // Don't emit warnings after this error. 4910 return TagD; 4911 } 4912 4913 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(DS); 4914 4915 if (DS.isFriendSpecified()) { 4916 // If we're dealing with a decl but not a TagDecl, assume that 4917 // whatever routines created it handled the friendship aspect. 4918 if (TagD && !Tag) 4919 return nullptr; 4920 return ActOnFriendTypeDecl(S, DS, TemplateParams); 4921 } 4922 4923 const CXXScopeSpec &SS = DS.getTypeSpecScope(); 4924 bool IsExplicitSpecialization = 4925 !TemplateParams.empty() && TemplateParams.back()->size() == 0; 4926 if (Tag && SS.isNotEmpty() && !Tag->isCompleteDefinition() && 4927 !IsExplicitInstantiation && !IsExplicitSpecialization && 4928 !isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(Tag)) { 4929 // Per C++ [dcl.type.elab]p1, a class declaration cannot have a 4930 // nested-name-specifier unless it is an explicit instantiation 4931 // or an explicit specialization. 4932 // 4933 // FIXME: We allow class template partial specializations here too, per the 4934 // obvious intent of DR1819. 4935 // 4936 // Per C++ [dcl.enum]p1, an opaque-enum-declaration can't either. 4937 Diag(SS.getBeginLoc(), diag::err_standalone_class_nested_name_specifier) 4938 << GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(DS.getTypeSpecType()) << SS.getRange(); 4939 return nullptr; 4940 } 4941 4942 // Track whether this decl-specifier declares anything. 4943 bool DeclaresAnything = true; 4944 4945 // Handle anonymous struct definitions. 4946 if (RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast_or_null<RecordDecl>(Tag)) { 4947 if (!Record->getDeclName() && Record->isCompleteDefinition() && 4948 DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) { 4949 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || 4950 Record->getDeclContext()->isRecord()) { 4951 // If CurContext is a DeclContext that can contain statements, 4952 // RecursiveASTVisitor won't visit the decls that 4953 // BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion() will put into CurContext. 4954 // Also store them here so that they can be part of the 4955 // DeclStmt that gets created in this case. 4956 // FIXME: Also return the IndirectFieldDecls created by 4957 // BuildAnonymousStructOr union, for the same reason? 4958 if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) 4959 AnonRecord = Record; 4960 return BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion(S, DS, AS, Record, 4961 Context.getPrintingPolicy()); 4962 } 4963 4964 DeclaresAnything = false; 4965 } 4966 } 4967 4968 // C11 6.7.2.1p2: 4969 // A struct-declaration that does not declare an anonymous structure or 4970 // anonymous union shall contain a struct-declarator-list. 4971 // 4972 // This rule also existed in C89 and C99; the grammar for struct-declaration 4973 // did not permit a struct-declaration without a struct-declarator-list. 4974 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && CurContext->isRecord() && 4975 DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified) { 4976 // Check for Microsoft C extension: anonymous struct/union member. 4977 // Handle 2 kinds of anonymous struct/union: 4978 // struct STRUCT; 4979 // union UNION; 4980 // and 4981 // STRUCT_TYPE; <- where STRUCT_TYPE is a typedef struct. 4982 // UNION_TYPE; <- where UNION_TYPE is a typedef union. 4983 if ((Tag && Tag->getDeclName()) || 4984 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_typename) { 4985 RecordDecl *Record = nullptr; 4986 if (Tag) 4987 Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag); 4988 else if (const RecordType *RT = 4989 DS.getRepAsType().get()->getAsStructureType()) 4990 Record = RT->getDecl(); 4991 else if (const RecordType *UT = DS.getRepAsType().get()->getAsUnionType()) 4992 Record = UT->getDecl(); 4993 4994 if (Record && getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) { 4995 Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_ms_anonymous_record) 4996 << Record->isUnion() << DS.getSourceRange(); 4997 return BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct(S, DS, Record); 4998 } 4999 5000 DeclaresAnything = false; 5001 } 5002 } 5003 5004 // Skip all the checks below if we have a type error. 5005 if (DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_error || 5006 (TagD && TagD->isInvalidDecl())) 5007 return TagD; 5008 5009 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 5010 DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) 5011 if (EnumDecl *Enum = dyn_cast_or_null<EnumDecl>(Tag)) 5012 if (Enum->enumerator_begin() == Enum->enumerator_end() && 5013 !Enum->getIdentifier() && !Enum->isInvalidDecl()) 5014 DeclaresAnything = false; 5015 5016 if (!DS.isMissingDeclaratorOk()) { 5017 // Customize diagnostic for a typedef missing a name. 5018 if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) 5019 Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_typedef_without_a_name) 5020 << DS.getSourceRange(); 5021 else 5022 DeclaresAnything = false; 5023 } 5024 5025 if (DS.isModulePrivateSpecified() && 5026 Tag && Tag->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()) 5027 Diag(DS.getModulePrivateSpecLoc(), diag::err_module_private_local_class) 5028 << Tag->getTagKind() 5029 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 5030 5031 ActOnDocumentableDecl(TagD); 5032 5033 // C 6.7/2: 5034 // A declaration [...] shall declare at least a declarator [...], a tag, 5035 // or the members of an enumeration. 5036 // C++ [dcl.dcl]p3: 5037 // [If there are no declarators], and except for the declaration of an 5038 // unnamed bit-field, the decl-specifier-seq shall introduce one or more 5039 // names into the program, or shall redeclare a name introduced by a 5040 // previous declaration. 5041 if (!DeclaresAnything) { 5042 // In C, we allow this as a (popular) extension / bug. Don't bother 5043 // producing further diagnostics for redundant qualifiers after this. 5044 Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), (IsExplicitInstantiation || !TemplateParams.empty()) 5045 ? diag::err_no_declarators 5046 : diag::ext_no_declarators) 5047 << DS.getSourceRange(); 5048 return TagD; 5049 } 5050 5051 // C++ [dcl.stc]p1: 5052 // If a storage-class-specifier appears in a decl-specifier-seq, [...] the 5053 // init-declarator-list of the declaration shall not be empty. 5054 // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p1: 5055 // If a cv-qualifier appears in a decl-specifier-seq, the 5056 // init-declarator-list of the declaration shall not be empty. 5057 // 5058 // Spurious qualifiers here appear to be valid in C. 5059 unsigned DiagID = diag::warn_standalone_specifier; 5060 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 5061 DiagID = diag::ext_standalone_specifier; 5062 5063 // Note that a linkage-specification sets a storage class, but 5064 // 'extern "C" struct foo;' is actually valid and not theoretically 5065 // useless. 5066 if (DeclSpec::SCS SCS = DS.getStorageClassSpec()) { 5067 if (SCS == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable) 5068 // Since mutable is not a viable storage class specifier in C, there is 5069 // no reason to treat it as an extension. Instead, diagnose as an error. 5070 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), diag::err_mutable_nonmember); 5071 else if (!DS.isExternInLinkageSpec() && SCS != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) 5072 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), DiagID) 5073 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(SCS); 5074 } 5075 5076 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = DS.getThreadStorageClassSpec()) 5077 Diag(DS.getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), DiagID) 5078 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 5079 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers()) { 5080 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_const) 5081 Diag(DS.getConstSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "const"; 5082 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_volatile) 5083 Diag(DS.getConstSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "volatile"; 5084 // Restrict is covered above. 5085 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_atomic) 5086 Diag(DS.getAtomicSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "_Atomic"; 5087 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_unaligned) 5088 Diag(DS.getUnalignedSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "__unaligned"; 5089 } 5090 5091 // Warn about ignored type attributes, for example: 5092 // __attribute__((aligned)) struct A; 5093 // Attributes should be placed after tag to apply to type declaration. 5094 if (!DS.getAttributes().empty() || !DeclAttrs.empty()) { 5095 DeclSpec::TST TypeSpecType = DS.getTypeSpecType(); 5096 if (TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_class || 5097 TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_struct || 5098 TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_interface || 5099 TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_union || 5100 TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_enum) { 5101 for (const ParsedAttr &AL : DS.getAttributes()) 5102 Diag(AL.getLoc(), diag::warn_declspec_attribute_ignored) 5103 << AL << GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(TypeSpecType); 5104 for (const ParsedAttr &AL : DeclAttrs) 5105 Diag(AL.getLoc(), diag::warn_declspec_attribute_ignored) 5106 << AL << GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(TypeSpecType); 5107 } 5108 } 5109 5110 return TagD; 5111 } 5112 5113 /// We are trying to inject an anonymous member into the given scope; 5114 /// check if there's an existing declaration that can't be overloaded. 5115 /// 5116 /// \return true if this is a forbidden redeclaration 5117 static bool CheckAnonMemberRedeclaration(Sema &SemaRef, 5118 Scope *S, 5119 DeclContext *Owner, 5120 DeclarationName Name, 5121 SourceLocation NameLoc, 5122 bool IsUnion) { 5123 LookupResult R(SemaRef, Name, NameLoc, Sema::LookupMemberName, 5124 Sema::ForVisibleRedeclaration); 5125 if (!SemaRef.LookupName(R, S)) return false; 5126 5127 // Pick a representative declaration. 5128 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = R.getRepresentativeDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl(); 5129 assert(PrevDecl && "Expected a non-null Decl"); 5130 5131 if (!SemaRef.isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, Owner, S)) 5132 return false; 5133 5134 SemaRef.Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_anonymous_record_member_redecl) 5135 << IsUnion << Name; 5136 SemaRef.Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 5137 5138 return true; 5139 } 5140 5141 /// InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers - Inject the members of the 5142 /// anonymous struct or union AnonRecord into the owning context Owner 5143 /// and scope S. This routine will be invoked just after we realize 5144 /// that an unnamed union or struct is actually an anonymous union or 5145 /// struct, e.g., 5146 /// 5147 /// @code 5148 /// union { 5149 /// int i; 5150 /// float f; 5151 /// }; // InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers called here to inject i and 5152 /// // f into the surrounding scope.x 5153 /// @endcode 5154 /// 5155 /// This routine is recursive, injecting the names of nested anonymous 5156 /// structs/unions into the owning context and scope as well. 5157 static bool 5158 InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, DeclContext *Owner, 5159 RecordDecl *AnonRecord, AccessSpecifier AS, 5160 SmallVectorImpl<NamedDecl *> &Chaining) { 5161 bool Invalid = false; 5162 5163 // Look every FieldDecl and IndirectFieldDecl with a name. 5164 for (auto *D : AnonRecord->decls()) { 5165 if ((isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(D)) && 5166 cast<NamedDecl>(D)->getDeclName()) { 5167 ValueDecl *VD = cast<ValueDecl>(D); 5168 if (CheckAnonMemberRedeclaration(SemaRef, S, Owner, VD->getDeclName(), 5169 VD->getLocation(), 5170 AnonRecord->isUnion())) { 5171 // C++ [class.union]p2: 5172 // The names of the members of an anonymous union shall be 5173 // distinct from the names of any other entity in the 5174 // scope in which the anonymous union is declared. 5175 Invalid = true; 5176 } else { 5177 // C++ [class.union]p2: 5178 // For the purpose of name lookup, after the anonymous union 5179 // definition, the members of the anonymous union are 5180 // considered to have been defined in the scope in which the 5181 // anonymous union is declared. 5182 unsigned OldChainingSize = Chaining.size(); 5183 if (IndirectFieldDecl *IF = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(VD)) 5184 Chaining.append(IF->chain_begin(), IF->chain_end()); 5185 else 5186 Chaining.push_back(VD); 5187 5188 assert(Chaining.size() >= 2); 5189 NamedDecl **NamedChain = 5190 new (SemaRef.Context)NamedDecl*[Chaining.size()]; 5191 for (unsigned i = 0; i < Chaining.size(); i++) 5192 NamedChain[i] = Chaining[i]; 5193 5194 IndirectFieldDecl *IndirectField = IndirectFieldDecl::Create( 5195 SemaRef.Context, Owner, VD->getLocation(), VD->getIdentifier(), 5196 VD->getType(), {NamedChain, Chaining.size()}); 5197 5198 for (const auto *Attr : VD->attrs()) 5199 IndirectField->addAttr(Attr->clone(SemaRef.Context)); 5200 5201 IndirectField->setAccess(AS); 5202 IndirectField->setImplicit(); 5203 SemaRef.PushOnScopeChains(IndirectField, S); 5204 5205 // That includes picking up the appropriate access specifier. 5206 if (AS != AS_none) IndirectField->setAccess(AS); 5207 5208 Chaining.resize(OldChainingSize); 5209 } 5210 } 5211 } 5212 5213 return Invalid; 5214 } 5215 5216 /// StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass - Maps a DeclSpec::SCS to 5217 /// a VarDecl::StorageClass. Any error reporting is up to the caller: 5218 /// illegal input values are mapped to SC_None. 5219 static StorageClass 5220 StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass(const DeclSpec &DS) { 5221 DeclSpec::SCS StorageClassSpec = DS.getStorageClassSpec(); 5222 assert(StorageClassSpec != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef && 5223 "Parser allowed 'typedef' as storage class VarDecl."); 5224 switch (StorageClassSpec) { 5225 case DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified: return SC_None; 5226 case DeclSpec::SCS_extern: 5227 if (DS.isExternInLinkageSpec()) 5228 return SC_None; 5229 return SC_Extern; 5230 case DeclSpec::SCS_static: return SC_Static; 5231 case DeclSpec::SCS_auto: return SC_Auto; 5232 case DeclSpec::SCS_register: return SC_Register; 5233 case DeclSpec::SCS_private_extern: return SC_PrivateExtern; 5234 // Illegal SCSs map to None: error reporting is up to the caller. 5235 case DeclSpec::SCS_mutable: // Fall through. 5236 case DeclSpec::SCS_typedef: return SC_None; 5237 } 5238 llvm_unreachable("unknown storage class specifier"); 5239 } 5240 5241 static SourceLocation findDefaultInitializer(const CXXRecordDecl *Record) { 5242 assert(Record->hasInClassInitializer()); 5243 5244 for (const auto *I : Record->decls()) { 5245 const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(I); 5246 if (const auto *IFD = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(I)) 5247 FD = IFD->getAnonField(); 5248 if (FD && FD->hasInClassInitializer()) 5249 return FD->getLocation(); 5250 } 5251 5252 llvm_unreachable("couldn't find in-class initializer"); 5253 } 5254 5255 static void checkDuplicateDefaultInit(Sema &S, CXXRecordDecl *Parent, 5256 SourceLocation DefaultInitLoc) { 5257 if (!Parent->isUnion() || !Parent->hasInClassInitializer()) 5258 return; 5259 5260 S.Diag(DefaultInitLoc, diag::err_multiple_mem_union_initialization); 5261 S.Diag(findDefaultInitializer(Parent), diag::note_previous_initializer) << 0; 5262 } 5263 5264 static void checkDuplicateDefaultInit(Sema &S, CXXRecordDecl *Parent, 5265 CXXRecordDecl *AnonUnion) { 5266 if (!Parent->isUnion() || !Parent->hasInClassInitializer()) 5267 return; 5268 5269 checkDuplicateDefaultInit(S, Parent, findDefaultInitializer(AnonUnion)); 5270 } 5271 5272 /// BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion - Handle the declaration of an 5273 /// anonymous structure or union. Anonymous unions are a C++ feature 5274 /// (C++ [class.union]) and a C11 feature; anonymous structures 5275 /// are a C11 feature and GNU C++ extension. 5276 Decl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion(Scope *S, DeclSpec &DS, 5277 AccessSpecifier AS, 5278 RecordDecl *Record, 5279 const PrintingPolicy &Policy) { 5280 DeclContext *Owner = Record->getDeclContext(); 5281 5282 // Diagnose whether this anonymous struct/union is an extension. 5283 if (Record->isUnion() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !getLangOpts().C11) 5284 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::ext_anonymous_union); 5285 else if (!Record->isUnion() && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 5286 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::ext_gnu_anonymous_struct); 5287 else if (!Record->isUnion() && !getLangOpts().C11) 5288 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::ext_c11_anonymous_struct); 5289 5290 // C and C++ require different kinds of checks for anonymous 5291 // structs/unions. 5292 bool Invalid = false; 5293 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 5294 const char *PrevSpec = nullptr; 5295 if (Record->isUnion()) { 5296 // C++ [class.union]p6: 5297 // C++17 [class.union.anon]p2: 5298 // Anonymous unions declared in a named namespace or in the 5299 // global namespace shall be declared static. 5300 unsigned DiagID; 5301 DeclContext *OwnerScope = Owner->getRedeclContext(); 5302 if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_static && 5303 (OwnerScope->isTranslationUnit() || 5304 (OwnerScope->isNamespace() && 5305 !cast<NamespaceDecl>(OwnerScope)->isAnonymousNamespace()))) { 5306 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_union_not_static) 5307 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Record->getLocation(), "static "); 5308 5309 // Recover by adding 'static'. 5310 DS.SetStorageClassSpec(*this, DeclSpec::SCS_static, SourceLocation(), 5311 PrevSpec, DiagID, Policy); 5312 } 5313 // C++ [class.union]p6: 5314 // A storage class is not allowed in a declaration of an 5315 // anonymous union in a class scope. 5316 else if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified && 5317 isa<RecordDecl>(Owner)) { 5318 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 5319 diag::err_anonymous_union_with_storage_spec) 5320 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 5321 5322 // Recover by removing the storage specifier. 5323 DS.SetStorageClassSpec(*this, DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified, 5324 SourceLocation(), 5325 PrevSpec, DiagID, Context.getPrintingPolicy()); 5326 } 5327 } 5328 5329 // Ignore const/volatile/restrict qualifiers. 5330 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers()) { 5331 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_const) 5332 Diag(DS.getConstSpecLoc(), diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified) 5333 << Record->isUnion() << "const" 5334 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getConstSpecLoc()); 5335 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_volatile) 5336 Diag(DS.getVolatileSpecLoc(), 5337 diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified) 5338 << Record->isUnion() << "volatile" 5339 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getVolatileSpecLoc()); 5340 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_restrict) 5341 Diag(DS.getRestrictSpecLoc(), 5342 diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified) 5343 << Record->isUnion() << "restrict" 5344 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getRestrictSpecLoc()); 5345 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_atomic) 5346 Diag(DS.getAtomicSpecLoc(), 5347 diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified) 5348 << Record->isUnion() << "_Atomic" 5349 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getAtomicSpecLoc()); 5350 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_unaligned) 5351 Diag(DS.getUnalignedSpecLoc(), 5352 diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified) 5353 << Record->isUnion() << "__unaligned" 5354 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getUnalignedSpecLoc()); 5355 5356 DS.ClearTypeQualifiers(); 5357 } 5358 5359 // C++ [class.union]p2: 5360 // The member-specification of an anonymous union shall only 5361 // define non-static data members. [Note: nested types and 5362 // functions cannot be declared within an anonymous union. ] 5363 for (auto *Mem : Record->decls()) { 5364 // Ignore invalid declarations; we already diagnosed them. 5365 if (Mem->isInvalidDecl()) 5366 continue; 5367 5368 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(Mem)) { 5369 // C++ [class.union]p3: 5370 // An anonymous union shall not have private or protected 5371 // members (clause 11). 5372 assert(FD->getAccess() != AS_none); 5373 if (FD->getAccess() != AS_public) { 5374 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_record_nonpublic_member) 5375 << Record->isUnion() << (FD->getAccess() == AS_protected); 5376 Invalid = true; 5377 } 5378 5379 // C++ [class.union]p1 5380 // An object of a class with a non-trivial constructor, a non-trivial 5381 // copy constructor, a non-trivial destructor, or a non-trivial copy 5382 // assignment operator cannot be a member of a union, nor can an 5383 // array of such objects. 5384 if (CheckNontrivialField(FD)) 5385 Invalid = true; 5386 } else if (Mem->isImplicit()) { 5387 // Any implicit members are fine. 5388 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(Mem) && Mem->getDeclContext() != Record) { 5389 // This is a type that showed up in an 5390 // elaborated-type-specifier inside the anonymous struct or 5391 // union, but which actually declares a type outside of the 5392 // anonymous struct or union. It's okay. 5393 } else if (auto *MemRecord = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Mem)) { 5394 if (!MemRecord->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() && 5395 MemRecord->getDeclName()) { 5396 // Visual C++ allows type definition in anonymous struct or union. 5397 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) 5398 Diag(MemRecord->getLocation(), diag::ext_anonymous_record_with_type) 5399 << Record->isUnion(); 5400 else { 5401 // This is a nested type declaration. 5402 Diag(MemRecord->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_record_with_type) 5403 << Record->isUnion(); 5404 Invalid = true; 5405 } 5406 } else { 5407 // This is an anonymous type definition within another anonymous type. 5408 // This is a popular extension, provided by Plan9, MSVC and GCC, but 5409 // not part of standard C++. 5410 Diag(MemRecord->getLocation(), 5411 diag::ext_anonymous_record_with_anonymous_type) 5412 << Record->isUnion(); 5413 } 5414 } else if (isa<AccessSpecDecl>(Mem)) { 5415 // Any access specifier is fine. 5416 } else if (isa<StaticAssertDecl>(Mem)) { 5417 // In C++1z, static_assert declarations are also fine. 5418 } else { 5419 // We have something that isn't a non-static data 5420 // member. Complain about it. 5421 unsigned DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_bad_member; 5422 if (isa<TypeDecl>(Mem)) 5423 DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_with_type; 5424 else if (isa<FunctionDecl>(Mem)) 5425 DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_with_function; 5426 else if (isa<VarDecl>(Mem)) 5427 DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_with_static; 5428 5429 // Visual C++ allows type definition in anonymous struct or union. 5430 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && 5431 DK == diag::err_anonymous_record_with_type) 5432 Diag(Mem->getLocation(), diag::ext_anonymous_record_with_type) 5433 << Record->isUnion(); 5434 else { 5435 Diag(Mem->getLocation(), DK) << Record->isUnion(); 5436 Invalid = true; 5437 } 5438 } 5439 } 5440 5441 // C++11 [class.union]p8 (DR1460): 5442 // At most one variant member of a union may have a 5443 // brace-or-equal-initializer. 5444 if (cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record)->hasInClassInitializer() && 5445 Owner->isRecord()) 5446 checkDuplicateDefaultInit(*this, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Owner), 5447 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record)); 5448 } 5449 5450 if (!Record->isUnion() && !Owner->isRecord()) { 5451 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_struct_not_member) 5452 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 5453 Invalid = true; 5454 } 5455 5456 // C++ [dcl.dcl]p3: 5457 // [If there are no declarators], and except for the declaration of an 5458 // unnamed bit-field, the decl-specifier-seq shall introduce one or more 5459 // names into the program 5460 // C++ [class.mem]p2: 5461 // each such member-declaration shall either declare at least one member 5462 // name of the class or declare at least one unnamed bit-field 5463 // 5464 // For C this is an error even for a named struct, and is diagnosed elsewhere. 5465 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Record->field_empty()) 5466 Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_no_declarators) << DS.getSourceRange(); 5467 5468 // Mock up a declarator. 5469 Declarator Dc(DS, ParsedAttributesView::none(), DeclaratorContext::Member); 5470 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(Dc, S); 5471 assert(TInfo && "couldn't build declarator info for anonymous struct/union"); 5472 5473 // Create a declaration for this anonymous struct/union. 5474 NamedDecl *Anon = nullptr; 5475 if (RecordDecl *OwningClass = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Owner)) { 5476 Anon = FieldDecl::Create( 5477 Context, OwningClass, DS.getBeginLoc(), Record->getLocation(), 5478 /*IdentifierInfo=*/nullptr, Context.getTypeDeclType(Record), TInfo, 5479 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, 5480 /*InitStyle=*/ICIS_NoInit); 5481 Anon->setAccess(AS); 5482 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, Anon, Dc); 5483 5484 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 5485 FieldCollector->Add(cast<FieldDecl>(Anon)); 5486 } else { 5487 DeclSpec::SCS SCSpec = DS.getStorageClassSpec(); 5488 StorageClass SC = StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass(DS); 5489 if (SCSpec == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable) { 5490 // mutable can only appear on non-static class members, so it's always 5491 // an error here 5492 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_mutable_nonmember); 5493 Invalid = true; 5494 SC = SC_None; 5495 } 5496 5497 assert(DS.getAttributes().empty() && "No attribute expected"); 5498 Anon = VarDecl::Create(Context, Owner, DS.getBeginLoc(), 5499 Record->getLocation(), /*IdentifierInfo=*/nullptr, 5500 Context.getTypeDeclType(Record), TInfo, SC); 5501 5502 // Default-initialize the implicit variable. This initialization will be 5503 // trivial in almost all cases, except if a union member has an in-class 5504 // initializer: 5505 // union { int n = 0; }; 5506 ActOnUninitializedDecl(Anon); 5507 } 5508 Anon->setImplicit(); 5509 5510 // Mark this as an anonymous struct/union type. 5511 Record->setAnonymousStructOrUnion(true); 5512 5513 // Add the anonymous struct/union object to the current 5514 // context. We'll be referencing this object when we refer to one of 5515 // its members. 5516 Owner->addDecl(Anon); 5517 5518 // Inject the members of the anonymous struct/union into the owning 5519 // context and into the identifier resolver chain for name lookup 5520 // purposes. 5521 SmallVector<NamedDecl*, 2> Chain; 5522 Chain.push_back(Anon); 5523 5524 if (InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers(*this, S, Owner, Record, AS, Chain)) 5525 Invalid = true; 5526 5527 if (VarDecl *NewVD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Anon)) { 5528 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NewVD->isStaticLocal()) { 5529 MangleNumberingContext *MCtx; 5530 Decl *ManglingContextDecl; 5531 std::tie(MCtx, ManglingContextDecl) = 5532 getCurrentMangleNumberContext(NewVD->getDeclContext()); 5533 if (MCtx) { 5534 Context.setManglingNumber( 5535 NewVD, MCtx->getManglingNumber( 5536 NewVD, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), S))); 5537 Context.setStaticLocalNumber(NewVD, MCtx->getStaticLocalNumber(NewVD)); 5538 } 5539 } 5540 } 5541 5542 if (Invalid) 5543 Anon->setInvalidDecl(); 5544 5545 return Anon; 5546 } 5547 5548 /// BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct - Handle the declaration of an 5549 /// Microsoft C anonymous structure. 5550 /// Ref: http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/z2cx9y4f.aspx 5551 /// Example: 5552 /// 5553 /// struct A { int a; }; 5554 /// struct B { struct A; int b; }; 5555 /// 5556 /// void foo() { 5557 /// B var; 5558 /// var.a = 3; 5559 /// } 5560 /// 5561 Decl *Sema::BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct(Scope *S, DeclSpec &DS, 5562 RecordDecl *Record) { 5563 assert(Record && "expected a record!"); 5564 5565 // Mock up a declarator. 5566 Declarator Dc(DS, ParsedAttributesView::none(), DeclaratorContext::TypeName); 5567 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(Dc, S); 5568 assert(TInfo && "couldn't build declarator info for anonymous struct"); 5569 5570 auto *ParentDecl = cast<RecordDecl>(CurContext); 5571 QualType RecTy = Context.getTypeDeclType(Record); 5572 5573 // Create a declaration for this anonymous struct. 5574 NamedDecl *Anon = 5575 FieldDecl::Create(Context, ParentDecl, DS.getBeginLoc(), DS.getBeginLoc(), 5576 /*IdentifierInfo=*/nullptr, RecTy, TInfo, 5577 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, 5578 /*InitStyle=*/ICIS_NoInit); 5579 Anon->setImplicit(); 5580 5581 // Add the anonymous struct object to the current context. 5582 CurContext->addDecl(Anon); 5583 5584 // Inject the members of the anonymous struct into the current 5585 // context and into the identifier resolver chain for name lookup 5586 // purposes. 5587 SmallVector<NamedDecl*, 2> Chain; 5588 Chain.push_back(Anon); 5589 5590 RecordDecl *RecordDef = Record->getDefinition(); 5591 if (RequireCompleteSizedType(Anon->getLocation(), RecTy, 5592 diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless) || 5593 InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers(*this, S, CurContext, RecordDef, 5594 AS_none, Chain)) { 5595 Anon->setInvalidDecl(); 5596 ParentDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 5597 } 5598 5599 return Anon; 5600 } 5601 5602 /// GetNameForDeclarator - Determine the full declaration name for the 5603 /// given Declarator. 5604 DeclarationNameInfo Sema::GetNameForDeclarator(Declarator &D) { 5605 return GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(D.getName()); 5606 } 5607 5608 /// Retrieves the declaration name from a parsed unqualified-id. 5609 DeclarationNameInfo 5610 Sema::GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(const UnqualifiedId &Name) { 5611 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo; 5612 NameInfo.setLoc(Name.StartLocation); 5613 5614 switch (Name.getKind()) { 5615 5616 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ImplicitSelfParam: 5617 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_Identifier: 5618 NameInfo.setName(Name.Identifier); 5619 return NameInfo; 5620 5621 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DeductionGuideName: { 5622 // C++ [temp.deduct.guide]p3: 5623 // The simple-template-id shall name a class template specialization. 5624 // The template-name shall be the same identifier as the template-name 5625 // of the simple-template-id. 5626 // These together intend to imply that the template-name shall name a 5627 // class template. 5628 // FIXME: template<typename T> struct X {}; 5629 // template<typename T> using Y = X<T>; 5630 // Y(int) -> Y<int>; 5631 // satisfies these rules but does not name a class template. 5632 TemplateName TN = Name.TemplateName.get().get(); 5633 auto *Template = TN.getAsTemplateDecl(); 5634 if (!Template || !isa<ClassTemplateDecl>(Template)) { 5635 Diag(Name.StartLocation, 5636 diag::err_deduction_guide_name_not_class_template) 5637 << (int)getTemplateNameKindForDiagnostics(TN) << TN; 5638 if (Template) 5639 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here); 5640 return DeclarationNameInfo(); 5641 } 5642 5643 NameInfo.setName( 5644 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDeductionGuideName(Template)); 5645 return NameInfo; 5646 } 5647 5648 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_OperatorFunctionId: 5649 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName( 5650 Name.OperatorFunctionId.Operator)); 5651 NameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange( 5652 Name.OperatorFunctionId.SymbolLocations[0], Name.EndLocation)); 5653 return NameInfo; 5654 5655 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_LiteralOperatorId: 5656 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName( 5657 Name.Identifier)); 5658 NameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(Name.EndLocation); 5659 return NameInfo; 5660 5661 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConversionFunctionId: { 5662 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 5663 QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Name.ConversionFunctionId, &TInfo); 5664 if (Ty.isNull()) 5665 return DeclarationNameInfo(); 5666 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXConversionFunctionName( 5667 Context.getCanonicalType(Ty))); 5668 NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(TInfo); 5669 return NameInfo; 5670 } 5671 5672 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorName: { 5673 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 5674 QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Name.ConstructorName, &TInfo); 5675 if (Ty.isNull()) 5676 return DeclarationNameInfo(); 5677 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXConstructorName( 5678 Context.getCanonicalType(Ty))); 5679 NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(TInfo); 5680 return NameInfo; 5681 } 5682 5683 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorTemplateId: { 5684 // In well-formed code, we can only have a constructor 5685 // template-id that refers to the current context, so go there 5686 // to find the actual type being constructed. 5687 CXXRecordDecl *CurClass = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext); 5688 if (!CurClass || CurClass->getIdentifier() != Name.TemplateId->Name) 5689 return DeclarationNameInfo(); 5690 5691 // Determine the type of the class being constructed. 5692 QualType CurClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(CurClass); 5693 5694 // FIXME: Check two things: that the template-id names the same type as 5695 // CurClassType, and that the template-id does not occur when the name 5696 // was qualified. 5697 5698 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXConstructorName( 5699 Context.getCanonicalType(CurClassType))); 5700 // FIXME: should we retrieve TypeSourceInfo? 5701 NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(nullptr); 5702 return NameInfo; 5703 } 5704 5705 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DestructorName: { 5706 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 5707 QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Name.DestructorName, &TInfo); 5708 if (Ty.isNull()) 5709 return DeclarationNameInfo(); 5710 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDestructorName( 5711 Context.getCanonicalType(Ty))); 5712 NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(TInfo); 5713 return NameInfo; 5714 } 5715 5716 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId: { 5717 TemplateName TName = Name.TemplateId->Template.get(); 5718 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Name.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc; 5719 return Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc); 5720 } 5721 5722 } // switch (Name.getKind()) 5723 5724 llvm_unreachable("Unknown name kind"); 5725 } 5726 5727 static QualType getCoreType(QualType Ty) { 5728 do { 5729 if (Ty->isPointerType() || Ty->isReferenceType()) 5730 Ty = Ty->getPointeeType(); 5731 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) 5732 Ty = Ty->castAsArrayTypeUnsafe()->getElementType(); 5733 else 5734 return Ty.withoutLocalFastQualifiers(); 5735 } while (true); 5736 } 5737 5738 /// hasSimilarParameters - Determine whether the C++ functions Declaration 5739 /// and Definition have "nearly" matching parameters. This heuristic is 5740 /// used to improve diagnostics in the case where an out-of-line function 5741 /// definition doesn't match any declaration within the class or namespace. 5742 /// Also sets Params to the list of indices to the parameters that differ 5743 /// between the declaration and the definition. If hasSimilarParameters 5744 /// returns true and Params is empty, then all of the parameters match. 5745 static bool hasSimilarParameters(ASTContext &Context, 5746 FunctionDecl *Declaration, 5747 FunctionDecl *Definition, 5748 SmallVectorImpl<unsigned> &Params) { 5749 Params.clear(); 5750 if (Declaration->param_size() != Definition->param_size()) 5751 return false; 5752 for (unsigned Idx = 0; Idx < Declaration->param_size(); ++Idx) { 5753 QualType DeclParamTy = Declaration->getParamDecl(Idx)->getType(); 5754 QualType DefParamTy = Definition->getParamDecl(Idx)->getType(); 5755 5756 // The parameter types are identical 5757 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(DefParamTy, DeclParamTy)) 5758 continue; 5759 5760 QualType DeclParamBaseTy = getCoreType(DeclParamTy); 5761 QualType DefParamBaseTy = getCoreType(DefParamTy); 5762 const IdentifierInfo *DeclTyName = DeclParamBaseTy.getBaseTypeIdentifier(); 5763 const IdentifierInfo *DefTyName = DefParamBaseTy.getBaseTypeIdentifier(); 5764 5765 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(DeclParamBaseTy, DefParamBaseTy) || 5766 (DeclTyName && DeclTyName == DefTyName)) 5767 Params.push_back(Idx); 5768 else // The two parameters aren't even close 5769 return false; 5770 } 5771 5772 return true; 5773 } 5774 5775 /// RebuildDeclaratorInCurrentInstantiation - Checks whether the given 5776 /// declarator needs to be rebuilt in the current instantiation. 5777 /// Any bits of declarator which appear before the name are valid for 5778 /// consideration here. That's specifically the type in the decl spec 5779 /// and the base type in any member-pointer chunks. 5780 static bool RebuildDeclaratorInCurrentInstantiation(Sema &S, Declarator &D, 5781 DeclarationName Name) { 5782 // The types we specifically need to rebuild are: 5783 // - typenames, typeofs, and decltypes 5784 // - types which will become injected class names 5785 // Of course, we also need to rebuild any type referencing such a 5786 // type. It's safest to just say "dependent", but we call out a 5787 // few cases here. 5788 5789 DeclSpec &DS = D.getMutableDeclSpec(); 5790 switch (DS.getTypeSpecType()) { 5791 case DeclSpec::TST_typename: 5792 case DeclSpec::TST_typeofType: 5793 case DeclSpec::TST_underlyingType: 5794 case DeclSpec::TST_atomic: { 5795 // Grab the type from the parser. 5796 TypeSourceInfo *TSI = nullptr; 5797 QualType T = S.GetTypeFromParser(DS.getRepAsType(), &TSI); 5798 if (T.isNull() || !T->isInstantiationDependentType()) break; 5799 5800 // Make sure there's a type source info. This isn't really much 5801 // of a waste; most dependent types should have type source info 5802 // attached already. 5803 if (!TSI) 5804 TSI = S.Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T, DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc()); 5805 5806 // Rebuild the type in the current instantiation. 5807 TSI = S.RebuildTypeInCurrentInstantiation(TSI, D.getIdentifierLoc(), Name); 5808 if (!TSI) return true; 5809 5810 // Store the new type back in the decl spec. 5811 ParsedType LocType = S.CreateParsedType(TSI->getType(), TSI); 5812 DS.UpdateTypeRep(LocType); 5813 break; 5814 } 5815 5816 case DeclSpec::TST_decltype: 5817 case DeclSpec::TST_typeofExpr: { 5818 Expr *E = DS.getRepAsExpr(); 5819 ExprResult Result = S.RebuildExprInCurrentInstantiation(E); 5820 if (Result.isInvalid()) return true; 5821 DS.UpdateExprRep(Result.get()); 5822 break; 5823 } 5824 5825 default: 5826 // Nothing to do for these decl specs. 5827 break; 5828 } 5829 5830 // It doesn't matter what order we do this in. 5831 for (unsigned I = 0, E = D.getNumTypeObjects(); I != E; ++I) { 5832 DeclaratorChunk &Chunk = D.getTypeObject(I); 5833 5834 // The only type information in the declarator which can come 5835 // before the declaration name is the base type of a member 5836 // pointer. 5837 if (Chunk.Kind != DeclaratorChunk::MemberPointer) 5838 continue; 5839 5840 // Rebuild the scope specifier in-place. 5841 CXXScopeSpec &SS = Chunk.Mem.Scope(); 5842 if (S.RebuildNestedNameSpecifierInCurrentInstantiation(SS)) 5843 return true; 5844 } 5845 5846 return false; 5847 } 5848 5849 /// Returns true if the declaration is declared in a system header or from a 5850 /// system macro. 5851 static bool isFromSystemHeader(SourceManager &SM, const Decl *D) { 5852 return SM.isInSystemHeader(D->getLocation()) || 5853 SM.isInSystemMacro(D->getLocation()); 5854 } 5855 5856 void Sema::warnOnReservedIdentifier(const NamedDecl *D) { 5857 // Avoid warning twice on the same identifier, and don't warn on redeclaration 5858 // of system decl. 5859 if (D->getPreviousDecl() || D->isImplicit()) 5860 return; 5861 ReservedIdentifierStatus Status = D->isReserved(getLangOpts()); 5862 if (Status != ReservedIdentifierStatus::NotReserved && 5863 !isFromSystemHeader(Context.getSourceManager(), D)) { 5864 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::warn_reserved_extern_symbol) 5865 << D << static_cast<int>(Status); 5866 } 5867 } 5868 5869 Decl *Sema::ActOnDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D) { 5870 D.setFunctionDefinitionKind(FunctionDefinitionKind::Declaration); 5871 Decl *Dcl = HandleDeclarator(S, D, MultiTemplateParamsArg()); 5872 5873 if (OriginalLexicalContext && OriginalLexicalContext->isObjCContainer() && 5874 Dcl && Dcl->getDeclContext()->isFileContext()) 5875 Dcl->setTopLevelDeclInObjCContainer(); 5876 5877 return Dcl; 5878 } 5879 5880 /// DiagnoseClassNameShadow - Implement C++ [class.mem]p13: 5881 /// If T is the name of a class, then each of the following shall have a 5882 /// name different from T: 5883 /// - every static data member of class T; 5884 /// - every member function of class T 5885 /// - every member of class T that is itself a type; 5886 /// \returns true if the declaration name violates these rules. 5887 bool Sema::DiagnoseClassNameShadow(DeclContext *DC, 5888 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo) { 5889 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName(); 5890 5891 CXXRecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC); 5892 while (Record && Record->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) 5893 Record = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getParent()); 5894 if (Record && Record->getIdentifier() && Record->getDeclName() == Name) { 5895 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_member_name_of_class) << Name; 5896 return true; 5897 } 5898 5899 return false; 5900 } 5901 5902 /// Diagnose a declaration whose declarator-id has the given 5903 /// nested-name-specifier. 5904 /// 5905 /// \param SS The nested-name-specifier of the declarator-id. 5906 /// 5907 /// \param DC The declaration context to which the nested-name-specifier 5908 /// resolves. 5909 /// 5910 /// \param Name The name of the entity being declared. 5911 /// 5912 /// \param Loc The location of the name of the entity being declared. 5913 /// 5914 /// \param IsTemplateId Whether the name is a (simple-)template-id, and thus 5915 /// we're declaring an explicit / partial specialization / instantiation. 5916 /// 5917 /// \returns true if we cannot safely recover from this error, false otherwise. 5918 bool Sema::diagnoseQualifiedDeclaration(CXXScopeSpec &SS, DeclContext *DC, 5919 DeclarationName Name, 5920 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsTemplateId) { 5921 DeclContext *Cur = CurContext; 5922 while (isa<LinkageSpecDecl>(Cur) || isa<CapturedDecl>(Cur)) 5923 Cur = Cur->getParent(); 5924 5925 // If the user provided a superfluous scope specifier that refers back to the 5926 // class in which the entity is already declared, diagnose and ignore it. 5927 // 5928 // class X { 5929 // void X::f(); 5930 // }; 5931 // 5932 // Note, it was once ill-formed to give redundant qualification in all 5933 // contexts, but that rule was removed by DR482. 5934 if (Cur->Equals(DC)) { 5935 if (Cur->isRecord()) { 5936 Diag(Loc, LangOpts.MicrosoftExt ? diag::warn_member_extra_qualification 5937 : diag::err_member_extra_qualification) 5938 << Name << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(SS.getRange()); 5939 SS.clear(); 5940 } else { 5941 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_namespace_member_extra_qualification) << Name; 5942 } 5943 return false; 5944 } 5945 5946 // Check whether the qualifying scope encloses the scope of the original 5947 // declaration. For a template-id, we perform the checks in 5948 // CheckTemplateSpecializationScope. 5949 if (!Cur->Encloses(DC) && !IsTemplateId) { 5950 if (Cur->isRecord()) 5951 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_qualification) 5952 << Name << SS.getRange(); 5953 else if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(DC)) 5954 Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_global_scope) 5955 << Name << SS.getRange(); 5956 else if (isa<FunctionDecl>(Cur)) 5957 Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_in_function) 5958 << Name << SS.getRange(); 5959 else if (isa<BlockDecl>(Cur)) 5960 Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_in_block) 5961 << Name << SS.getRange(); 5962 else if (isa<ExportDecl>(Cur)) { 5963 if (!isa<NamespaceDecl>(DC)) 5964 Diag(Loc, diag::err_export_non_namespace_scope_name) 5965 << Name << SS.getRange(); 5966 else 5967 // The cases that DC is not NamespaceDecl should be handled in 5968 // CheckRedeclarationExported. 5969 return false; 5970 } else 5971 Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_scope) 5972 << Name << cast<NamedDecl>(Cur) << cast<NamedDecl>(DC) << SS.getRange(); 5973 5974 return true; 5975 } 5976 5977 if (Cur->isRecord()) { 5978 // Cannot qualify members within a class. 5979 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_qualification) 5980 << Name << SS.getRange(); 5981 SS.clear(); 5982 5983 // C++ constructors and destructors with incorrect scopes can break 5984 // our AST invariants by having the wrong underlying types. If 5985 // that's the case, then drop this declaration entirely. 5986 if ((Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConstructorName || 5987 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) && 5988 !Context.hasSameType(Name.getCXXNameType(), 5989 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Cur)))) 5990 return true; 5991 5992 return false; 5993 } 5994 5995 // C++11 [dcl.meaning]p1: 5996 // [...] "The nested-name-specifier of the qualified declarator-id shall 5997 // not begin with a decltype-specifer" 5998 NestedNameSpecifierLoc SpecLoc(SS.getScopeRep(), SS.location_data()); 5999 while (SpecLoc.getPrefix()) 6000 SpecLoc = SpecLoc.getPrefix(); 6001 if (isa_and_nonnull<DecltypeType>( 6002 SpecLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier()->getAsType())) 6003 Diag(Loc, diag::err_decltype_in_declarator) 6004 << SpecLoc.getTypeLoc().getSourceRange(); 6005 6006 return false; 6007 } 6008 6009 NamedDecl *Sema::HandleDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D, 6010 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists) { 6011 // TODO: consider using NameInfo for diagnostic. 6012 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo = GetNameForDeclarator(D); 6013 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName(); 6014 6015 // All of these full declarators require an identifier. If it doesn't have 6016 // one, the ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec action should be used. 6017 if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) { 6018 return ActOnDecompositionDeclarator(S, D, TemplateParamLists); 6019 } else if (!Name) { 6020 if (!D.isInvalidType()) // Reject this if we think it is valid. 6021 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getBeginLoc(), diag::err_declarator_need_ident) 6022 << D.getDeclSpec().getSourceRange() << D.getSourceRange(); 6023 return nullptr; 6024 } else if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(NameInfo, UPPC_DeclarationType)) 6025 return nullptr; 6026 6027 // The scope passed in may not be a decl scope. Zip up the scope tree until 6028 // we find one that is. 6029 while ((S->getFlags() & Scope::DeclScope) == 0 || 6030 (S->getFlags() & Scope::TemplateParamScope) != 0) 6031 S = S->getParent(); 6032 6033 DeclContext *DC = CurContext; 6034 if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isInvalid()) 6035 D.setInvalidType(); 6036 else if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 6037 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), 6038 UPPC_DeclarationQualifier)) 6039 return nullptr; 6040 6041 bool EnteringContext = !D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified(); 6042 DC = computeDeclContext(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), EnteringContext); 6043 if (!DC || isa<EnumDecl>(DC)) { 6044 // If we could not compute the declaration context, it's because the 6045 // declaration context is dependent but does not refer to a class, 6046 // class template, or class template partial specialization. Complain 6047 // and return early, to avoid the coming semantic disaster. 6048 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 6049 diag::err_template_qualified_declarator_no_match) 6050 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getScopeRep() 6051 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 6052 return nullptr; 6053 } 6054 bool IsDependentContext = DC->isDependentContext(); 6055 6056 if (!IsDependentContext && 6057 RequireCompleteDeclContext(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), DC)) 6058 return nullptr; 6059 6060 // If a class is incomplete, do not parse entities inside it. 6061 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC) && !cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->hasDefinition()) { 6062 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 6063 diag::err_member_def_undefined_record) 6064 << Name << DC << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 6065 return nullptr; 6066 } 6067 if (!D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified()) { 6068 if (diagnoseQualifiedDeclaration( 6069 D.getCXXScopeSpec(), DC, Name, D.getIdentifierLoc(), 6070 D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId)) { 6071 if (DC->isRecord()) 6072 return nullptr; 6073 6074 D.setInvalidType(); 6075 } 6076 } 6077 6078 // Check whether we need to rebuild the type of the given 6079 // declaration in the current instantiation. 6080 if (EnteringContext && IsDependentContext && 6081 TemplateParamLists.size() != 0) { 6082 ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, DC); 6083 if (RebuildDeclaratorInCurrentInstantiation(*this, D, Name)) 6084 D.setInvalidType(); 6085 } 6086 } 6087 6088 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S); 6089 QualType R = TInfo->getType(); 6090 6091 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(D.getIdentifierLoc(), TInfo, 6092 UPPC_DeclarationType)) 6093 D.setInvalidType(); 6094 6095 LookupResult Previous(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName, 6096 forRedeclarationInCurContext()); 6097 6098 // See if this is a redefinition of a variable in the same scope. 6099 if (!D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 6100 bool IsLinkageLookup = false; 6101 bool CreateBuiltins = false; 6102 6103 // If the declaration we're planning to build will be a function 6104 // or object with linkage, then look for another declaration with 6105 // linkage (C99 6.2.2p4-5 and C++ [basic.link]p6). 6106 // 6107 // If the declaration we're planning to build will be declared with 6108 // external linkage in the translation unit, create any builtin with 6109 // the same name. 6110 if (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) 6111 /* Do nothing*/; 6112 else if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod() && 6113 (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_extern || 6114 R->isFunctionType())) { 6115 IsLinkageLookup = true; 6116 CreateBuiltins = 6117 CurContext->getEnclosingNamespaceContext()->isTranslationUnit(); 6118 } else if (CurContext->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit() && 6119 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_static) 6120 CreateBuiltins = true; 6121 6122 if (IsLinkageLookup) { 6123 Previous.clear(LookupRedeclarationWithLinkage); 6124 Previous.setRedeclarationKind(ForExternalRedeclaration); 6125 } 6126 6127 LookupName(Previous, S, CreateBuiltins); 6128 } else { // Something like "int foo::x;" 6129 LookupQualifiedName(Previous, DC); 6130 6131 // C++ [dcl.meaning]p1: 6132 // When the declarator-id is qualified, the declaration shall refer to a 6133 // previously declared member of the class or namespace to which the 6134 // qualifier refers (or, in the case of a namespace, of an element of the 6135 // inline namespace set of that namespace (7.3.1)) or to a specialization 6136 // thereof; [...] 6137 // 6138 // Note that we already checked the context above, and that we do not have 6139 // enough information to make sure that Previous contains the declaration 6140 // we want to match. For example, given: 6141 // 6142 // class X { 6143 // void f(); 6144 // void f(float); 6145 // }; 6146 // 6147 // void X::f(int) { } // ill-formed 6148 // 6149 // In this case, Previous will point to the overload set 6150 // containing the two f's declared in X, but neither of them 6151 // matches. 6152 6153 // C++ [dcl.meaning]p1: 6154 // [...] the member shall not merely have been introduced by a 6155 // using-declaration in the scope of the class or namespace nominated by 6156 // the nested-name-specifier of the declarator-id. 6157 RemoveUsingDecls(Previous); 6158 } 6159 6160 if (Previous.isSingleResult() && 6161 Previous.getFoundDecl()->isTemplateParameter()) { 6162 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 6163 if (!D.isInvalidType()) 6164 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 6165 Previous.getFoundDecl()); 6166 6167 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 6168 Previous.clear(); 6169 } 6170 6171 if (!R->isFunctionType() && DiagnoseClassNameShadow(DC, NameInfo)) 6172 // Forget that the previous declaration is the injected-class-name. 6173 Previous.clear(); 6174 6175 // In C++, the previous declaration we find might be a tag type 6176 // (class or enum). In this case, the new declaration will hide the 6177 // tag type. Note that this applies to functions, function templates, and 6178 // variables, but not to typedefs (C++ [dcl.typedef]p4) or variable templates. 6179 if (Previous.isSingleTagDecl() && 6180 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef && 6181 (TemplateParamLists.size() == 0 || R->isFunctionType())) 6182 Previous.clear(); 6183 6184 // Check that there are no default arguments other than in the parameters 6185 // of a function declaration (C++ only). 6186 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 6187 CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D); 6188 6189 NamedDecl *New; 6190 6191 bool AddToScope = true; 6192 if (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) { 6193 if (TemplateParamLists.size()) { 6194 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_template_typedef); 6195 return nullptr; 6196 } 6197 6198 New = ActOnTypedefDeclarator(S, D, DC, TInfo, Previous); 6199 } else if (R->isFunctionType()) { 6200 New = ActOnFunctionDeclarator(S, D, DC, TInfo, Previous, 6201 TemplateParamLists, 6202 AddToScope); 6203 } else { 6204 New = ActOnVariableDeclarator(S, D, DC, TInfo, Previous, TemplateParamLists, 6205 AddToScope); 6206 } 6207 6208 if (!New) 6209 return nullptr; 6210 6211 // If this has an identifier and is not a function template specialization, 6212 // add it to the scope stack. 6213 if (New->getDeclName() && AddToScope) 6214 PushOnScopeChains(New, S); 6215 6216 if (isInOpenMPDeclareTargetContext()) 6217 checkDeclIsAllowedInOpenMPTarget(nullptr, New); 6218 6219 return New; 6220 } 6221 6222 /// Helper method to turn variable array types into constant array 6223 /// types in certain situations which would otherwise be errors (for 6224 /// GCC compatibility). 6225 static QualType TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(QualType T, 6226 ASTContext &Context, 6227 bool &SizeIsNegative, 6228 llvm::APSInt &Oversized) { 6229 // This method tries to turn a variable array into a constant 6230 // array even when the size isn't an ICE. This is necessary 6231 // for compatibility with code that depends on gcc's buggy 6232 // constant expression folding, like struct {char x[(int)(char*)2];} 6233 SizeIsNegative = false; 6234 Oversized = 0; 6235 6236 if (T->isDependentType()) 6237 return QualType(); 6238 6239 QualifierCollector Qs; 6240 const Type *Ty = Qs.strip(T); 6241 6242 if (const PointerType* PTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(Ty)) { 6243 QualType Pointee = PTy->getPointeeType(); 6244 QualType FixedType = 6245 TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(Pointee, Context, SizeIsNegative, 6246 Oversized); 6247 if (FixedType.isNull()) return FixedType; 6248 FixedType = Context.getPointerType(FixedType); 6249 return Qs.apply(Context, FixedType); 6250 } 6251 if (const ParenType* PTy = dyn_cast<ParenType>(Ty)) { 6252 QualType Inner = PTy->getInnerType(); 6253 QualType FixedType = 6254 TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(Inner, Context, SizeIsNegative, 6255 Oversized); 6256 if (FixedType.isNull()) return FixedType; 6257 FixedType = Context.getParenType(FixedType); 6258 return Qs.apply(Context, FixedType); 6259 } 6260 6261 const VariableArrayType* VLATy = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(T); 6262 if (!VLATy) 6263 return QualType(); 6264 6265 QualType ElemTy = VLATy->getElementType(); 6266 if (ElemTy->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 6267 ElemTy = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(ElemTy, Context, 6268 SizeIsNegative, Oversized); 6269 if (ElemTy.isNull()) 6270 return QualType(); 6271 } 6272 6273 Expr::EvalResult Result; 6274 if (!VLATy->getSizeExpr() || 6275 !VLATy->getSizeExpr()->EvaluateAsInt(Result, Context)) 6276 return QualType(); 6277 6278 llvm::APSInt Res = Result.Val.getInt(); 6279 6280 // Check whether the array size is negative. 6281 if (Res.isSigned() && Res.isNegative()) { 6282 SizeIsNegative = true; 6283 return QualType(); 6284 } 6285 6286 // Check whether the array is too large to be addressed. 6287 unsigned ActiveSizeBits = 6288 (!ElemTy->isDependentType() && !ElemTy->isVariablyModifiedType() && 6289 !ElemTy->isIncompleteType() && !ElemTy->isUndeducedType()) 6290 ? ConstantArrayType::getNumAddressingBits(Context, ElemTy, Res) 6291 : Res.getActiveBits(); 6292 if (ActiveSizeBits > ConstantArrayType::getMaxSizeBits(Context)) { 6293 Oversized = Res; 6294 return QualType(); 6295 } 6296 6297 QualType FoldedArrayType = Context.getConstantArrayType( 6298 ElemTy, Res, VLATy->getSizeExpr(), ArrayType::Normal, 0); 6299 return Qs.apply(Context, FoldedArrayType); 6300 } 6301 6302 static void 6303 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(TypeLoc SrcTL, TypeLoc DstTL) { 6304 SrcTL = SrcTL.getUnqualifiedLoc(); 6305 DstTL = DstTL.getUnqualifiedLoc(); 6306 if (PointerTypeLoc SrcPTL = SrcTL.getAs<PointerTypeLoc>()) { 6307 PointerTypeLoc DstPTL = DstTL.castAs<PointerTypeLoc>(); 6308 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(SrcPTL.getPointeeLoc(), 6309 DstPTL.getPointeeLoc()); 6310 DstPTL.setStarLoc(SrcPTL.getStarLoc()); 6311 return; 6312 } 6313 if (ParenTypeLoc SrcPTL = SrcTL.getAs<ParenTypeLoc>()) { 6314 ParenTypeLoc DstPTL = DstTL.castAs<ParenTypeLoc>(); 6315 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(SrcPTL.getInnerLoc(), 6316 DstPTL.getInnerLoc()); 6317 DstPTL.setLParenLoc(SrcPTL.getLParenLoc()); 6318 DstPTL.setRParenLoc(SrcPTL.getRParenLoc()); 6319 return; 6320 } 6321 ArrayTypeLoc SrcATL = SrcTL.castAs<ArrayTypeLoc>(); 6322 ArrayTypeLoc DstATL = DstTL.castAs<ArrayTypeLoc>(); 6323 TypeLoc SrcElemTL = SrcATL.getElementLoc(); 6324 TypeLoc DstElemTL = DstATL.getElementLoc(); 6325 if (VariableArrayTypeLoc SrcElemATL = 6326 SrcElemTL.getAs<VariableArrayTypeLoc>()) { 6327 ConstantArrayTypeLoc DstElemATL = DstElemTL.castAs<ConstantArrayTypeLoc>(); 6328 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(SrcElemATL, DstElemATL); 6329 } else { 6330 DstElemTL.initializeFullCopy(SrcElemTL); 6331 } 6332 DstATL.setLBracketLoc(SrcATL.getLBracketLoc()); 6333 DstATL.setSizeExpr(SrcATL.getSizeExpr()); 6334 DstATL.setRBracketLoc(SrcATL.getRBracketLoc()); 6335 } 6336 6337 /// Helper method to turn variable array types into constant array 6338 /// types in certain situations which would otherwise be errors (for 6339 /// GCC compatibility). 6340 static TypeSourceInfo* 6341 TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 6342 ASTContext &Context, 6343 bool &SizeIsNegative, 6344 llvm::APSInt &Oversized) { 6345 QualType FixedTy 6346 = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(TInfo->getType(), Context, 6347 SizeIsNegative, Oversized); 6348 if (FixedTy.isNull()) 6349 return nullptr; 6350 TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(FixedTy); 6351 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(TInfo->getTypeLoc(), 6352 FixedTInfo->getTypeLoc()); 6353 return FixedTInfo; 6354 } 6355 6356 /// Attempt to fold a variable-sized type to a constant-sized type, returning 6357 /// true if we were successful. 6358 bool Sema::tryToFixVariablyModifiedVarType(TypeSourceInfo *&TInfo, 6359 QualType &T, SourceLocation Loc, 6360 unsigned FailedFoldDiagID) { 6361 bool SizeIsNegative; 6362 llvm::APSInt Oversized; 6363 TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo( 6364 TInfo, Context, SizeIsNegative, Oversized); 6365 if (FixedTInfo) { 6366 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_vla_folded_to_constant); 6367 TInfo = FixedTInfo; 6368 T = FixedTInfo->getType(); 6369 return true; 6370 } 6371 6372 if (SizeIsNegative) 6373 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_negative_array_size); 6374 else if (Oversized.getBoolValue()) 6375 Diag(Loc, diag::err_array_too_large) << toString(Oversized, 10); 6376 else if (FailedFoldDiagID) 6377 Diag(Loc, FailedFoldDiagID); 6378 return false; 6379 } 6380 6381 /// Register the given locally-scoped extern "C" declaration so 6382 /// that it can be found later for redeclarations. We include any extern "C" 6383 /// declaration that is not visible in the translation unit here, not just 6384 /// function-scope declarations. 6385 void 6386 Sema::RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(NamedDecl *ND, Scope *S) { 6387 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 6388 ND->getLexicalDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) 6389 // Don't need to track declarations in the TU in C. 6390 return; 6391 6392 // Note that we have a locally-scoped external with this name. 6393 Context.getExternCContextDecl()->makeDeclVisibleInContext(ND); 6394 } 6395 6396 NamedDecl *Sema::findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(DeclarationName Name) { 6397 // FIXME: We can have multiple results via __attribute__((overloadable)). 6398 auto Result = Context.getExternCContextDecl()->lookup(Name); 6399 return Result.empty() ? nullptr : *Result.begin(); 6400 } 6401 6402 /// Diagnose function specifiers on a declaration of an identifier that 6403 /// does not identify a function. 6404 void Sema::DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(const DeclSpec &DS) { 6405 // FIXME: We should probably indicate the identifier in question to avoid 6406 // confusion for constructs like "virtual int a(), b;" 6407 if (DS.isVirtualSpecified()) 6408 Diag(DS.getVirtualSpecLoc(), 6409 diag::err_virtual_non_function); 6410 6411 if (DS.hasExplicitSpecifier()) 6412 Diag(DS.getExplicitSpecLoc(), 6413 diag::err_explicit_non_function); 6414 6415 if (DS.isNoreturnSpecified()) 6416 Diag(DS.getNoreturnSpecLoc(), 6417 diag::err_noreturn_non_function); 6418 } 6419 6420 NamedDecl* 6421 Sema::ActOnTypedefDeclarator(Scope* S, Declarator& D, DeclContext* DC, 6422 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, LookupResult &Previous) { 6423 // Typedef declarators cannot be qualified (C++ [dcl.meaning]p1). 6424 if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 6425 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_qualified_typedef_declarator) 6426 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 6427 D.setInvalidType(); 6428 // Pretend we didn't see the scope specifier. 6429 DC = CurContext; 6430 Previous.clear(); 6431 } 6432 6433 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(D.getDeclSpec()); 6434 6435 if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified()) 6436 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function) 6437 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17; 6438 if (D.getDeclSpec().hasConstexprSpecifier()) 6439 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_invalid_constexpr) 6440 << 1 << static_cast<int>(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier()); 6441 6442 if (D.getName().Kind != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_Identifier) { 6443 if (D.getName().Kind == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DeductionGuideName) 6444 Diag(D.getName().StartLocation, 6445 diag::err_deduction_guide_invalid_specifier) 6446 << "typedef"; 6447 else 6448 Diag(D.getName().StartLocation, diag::err_typedef_not_identifier) 6449 << D.getName().getSourceRange(); 6450 return nullptr; 6451 } 6452 6453 TypedefDecl *NewTD = ParseTypedefDecl(S, D, TInfo->getType(), TInfo); 6454 if (!NewTD) return nullptr; 6455 6456 // Handle attributes prior to checking for duplicates in MergeVarDecl 6457 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewTD, D); 6458 6459 CheckTypedefForVariablyModifiedType(S, NewTD); 6460 6461 bool Redeclaration = D.isRedeclaration(); 6462 NamedDecl *ND = ActOnTypedefNameDecl(S, DC, NewTD, Previous, Redeclaration); 6463 D.setRedeclaration(Redeclaration); 6464 return ND; 6465 } 6466 6467 void 6468 Sema::CheckTypedefForVariablyModifiedType(Scope *S, TypedefNameDecl *NewTD) { 6469 // C99 6.7.7p2: If a typedef name specifies a variably modified type 6470 // then it shall have block scope. 6471 // Note that variably modified types must be fixed before merging the decl so 6472 // that redeclarations will match. 6473 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = NewTD->getTypeSourceInfo(); 6474 QualType T = TInfo->getType(); 6475 if (T->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 6476 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 6477 6478 if (S->getFnParent() == nullptr) { 6479 bool SizeIsNegative; 6480 llvm::APSInt Oversized; 6481 TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = 6482 TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo(TInfo, Context, 6483 SizeIsNegative, 6484 Oversized); 6485 if (FixedTInfo) { 6486 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::ext_vla_folded_to_constant); 6487 NewTD->setTypeSourceInfo(FixedTInfo); 6488 } else { 6489 if (SizeIsNegative) 6490 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_typecheck_negative_array_size); 6491 else if (T->isVariableArrayType()) 6492 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_in_file_scope); 6493 else if (Oversized.getBoolValue()) 6494 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_array_too_large) 6495 << toString(Oversized, 10); 6496 else 6497 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_decl_in_file_scope); 6498 NewTD->setInvalidDecl(); 6499 } 6500 } 6501 } 6502 } 6503 6504 /// ActOnTypedefNameDecl - Perform semantic checking for a declaration which 6505 /// declares a typedef-name, either using the 'typedef' type specifier or via 6506 /// a C++0x [dcl.typedef]p2 alias-declaration: 'using T = A;'. 6507 NamedDecl* 6508 Sema::ActOnTypedefNameDecl(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC, TypedefNameDecl *NewTD, 6509 LookupResult &Previous, bool &Redeclaration) { 6510 6511 // Find the shadowed declaration before filtering for scope. 6512 NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = getShadowedDeclaration(NewTD, Previous); 6513 6514 // Merge the decl with the existing one if appropriate. If the decl is 6515 // in an outer scope, it isn't the same thing. 6516 FilterLookupForScope(Previous, DC, S, /*ConsiderLinkage*/false, 6517 /*AllowInlineNamespace*/false); 6518 filterNonConflictingPreviousTypedefDecls(*this, NewTD, Previous); 6519 if (!Previous.empty()) { 6520 Redeclaration = true; 6521 MergeTypedefNameDecl(S, NewTD, Previous); 6522 } else { 6523 inferGslPointerAttribute(NewTD); 6524 } 6525 6526 if (ShadowedDecl && !Redeclaration) 6527 CheckShadow(NewTD, ShadowedDecl, Previous); 6528 6529 // If this is the C FILE type, notify the AST context. 6530 if (IdentifierInfo *II = NewTD->getIdentifier()) 6531 if (!NewTD->isInvalidDecl() && 6532 NewTD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) { 6533 if (II->isStr("FILE")) 6534 Context.setFILEDecl(NewTD); 6535 else if (II->isStr("jmp_buf")) 6536 Context.setjmp_bufDecl(NewTD); 6537 else if (II->isStr("sigjmp_buf")) 6538 Context.setsigjmp_bufDecl(NewTD); 6539 else if (II->isStr("ucontext_t")) 6540 Context.setucontext_tDecl(NewTD); 6541 } 6542 6543 return NewTD; 6544 } 6545 6546 /// Determines whether the given declaration is an out-of-scope 6547 /// previous declaration. 6548 /// 6549 /// This routine should be invoked when name lookup has found a 6550 /// previous declaration (PrevDecl) that is not in the scope where a 6551 /// new declaration by the same name is being introduced. If the new 6552 /// declaration occurs in a local scope, previous declarations with 6553 /// linkage may still be considered previous declarations (C99 6554 /// 6.2.2p4-5, C++ [basic.link]p6). 6555 /// 6556 /// \param PrevDecl the previous declaration found by name 6557 /// lookup 6558 /// 6559 /// \param DC the context in which the new declaration is being 6560 /// declared. 6561 /// 6562 /// \returns true if PrevDecl is an out-of-scope previous declaration 6563 /// for a new delcaration with the same name. 6564 static bool 6565 isOutOfScopePreviousDeclaration(NamedDecl *PrevDecl, DeclContext *DC, 6566 ASTContext &Context) { 6567 if (!PrevDecl) 6568 return false; 6569 6570 if (!PrevDecl->hasLinkage()) 6571 return false; 6572 6573 if (Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 6574 // C++ [basic.link]p6: 6575 // If there is a visible declaration of an entity with linkage 6576 // having the same name and type, ignoring entities declared 6577 // outside the innermost enclosing namespace scope, the block 6578 // scope declaration declares that same entity and receives the 6579 // linkage of the previous declaration. 6580 DeclContext *OuterContext = DC->getRedeclContext(); 6581 if (!OuterContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) 6582 // This rule only applies to block-scope declarations. 6583 return false; 6584 6585 DeclContext *PrevOuterContext = PrevDecl->getDeclContext(); 6586 if (PrevOuterContext->isRecord()) 6587 // We found a member function: ignore it. 6588 return false; 6589 6590 // Find the innermost enclosing namespace for the new and 6591 // previous declarations. 6592 OuterContext = OuterContext->getEnclosingNamespaceContext(); 6593 PrevOuterContext = PrevOuterContext->getEnclosingNamespaceContext(); 6594 6595 // The previous declaration is in a different namespace, so it 6596 // isn't the same function. 6597 if (!OuterContext->Equals(PrevOuterContext)) 6598 return false; 6599 } 6600 6601 return true; 6602 } 6603 6604 static void SetNestedNameSpecifier(Sema &S, DeclaratorDecl *DD, Declarator &D) { 6605 CXXScopeSpec &SS = D.getCXXScopeSpec(); 6606 if (!SS.isSet()) return; 6607 DD->setQualifierInfo(SS.getWithLocInContext(S.Context)); 6608 } 6609 6610 bool Sema::inferObjCARCLifetime(ValueDecl *decl) { 6611 QualType type = decl->getType(); 6612 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = type.getObjCLifetime(); 6613 if (lifetime == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing) { 6614 // Various kinds of declaration aren't allowed to be __autoreleasing. 6615 unsigned kind = -1U; 6616 if (VarDecl *var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(decl)) { 6617 if (var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) 6618 kind = 0; // __block 6619 else if (!var->hasLocalStorage()) 6620 kind = 1; // global 6621 } else if (isa<ObjCIvarDecl>(decl)) { 6622 kind = 3; // ivar 6623 } else if (isa<FieldDecl>(decl)) { 6624 kind = 2; // field 6625 } 6626 6627 if (kind != -1U) { 6628 Diag(decl->getLocation(), diag::err_arc_autoreleasing_var) 6629 << kind; 6630 } 6631 } else if (lifetime == Qualifiers::OCL_None) { 6632 // Try to infer lifetime. 6633 if (!type->isObjCLifetimeType()) 6634 return false; 6635 6636 lifetime = type->getObjCARCImplicitLifetime(); 6637 type = Context.getLifetimeQualifiedType(type, lifetime); 6638 decl->setType(type); 6639 } 6640 6641 if (VarDecl *var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(decl)) { 6642 // Thread-local variables cannot have lifetime. 6643 if (lifetime && lifetime != Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone && 6644 var->getTLSKind()) { 6645 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_arc_thread_ownership) 6646 << var->getType(); 6647 return true; 6648 } 6649 } 6650 6651 return false; 6652 } 6653 6654 void Sema::deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(ValueDecl *Decl) { 6655 if (Decl->getType().hasAddressSpace()) 6656 return; 6657 if (Decl->getType()->isDependentType()) 6658 return; 6659 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Decl)) { 6660 QualType Type = Var->getType(); 6661 if (Type->isSamplerT() || Type->isVoidType()) 6662 return; 6663 LangAS ImplAS = LangAS::opencl_private; 6664 // OpenCL C v3.0 s6.7.8 - For OpenCL C 2.0 or with the 6665 // __opencl_c_program_scope_global_variables feature, the address space 6666 // for a variable at program scope or a static or extern variable inside 6667 // a function are inferred to be __global. 6668 if (getOpenCLOptions().areProgramScopeVariablesSupported(getLangOpts()) && 6669 Var->hasGlobalStorage()) 6670 ImplAS = LangAS::opencl_global; 6671 // If the original type from a decayed type is an array type and that array 6672 // type has no address space yet, deduce it now. 6673 if (auto DT = dyn_cast<DecayedType>(Type)) { 6674 auto OrigTy = DT->getOriginalType(); 6675 if (!OrigTy.hasAddressSpace() && OrigTy->isArrayType()) { 6676 // Add the address space to the original array type and then propagate 6677 // that to the element type through `getAsArrayType`. 6678 OrigTy = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(OrigTy, ImplAS); 6679 OrigTy = QualType(Context.getAsArrayType(OrigTy), 0); 6680 // Re-generate the decayed type. 6681 Type = Context.getDecayedType(OrigTy); 6682 } 6683 } 6684 Type = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(Type, ImplAS); 6685 // Apply any qualifiers (including address space) from the array type to 6686 // the element type. This implements C99 6.7.3p8: "If the specification of 6687 // an array type includes any type qualifiers, the element type is so 6688 // qualified, not the array type." 6689 if (Type->isArrayType()) 6690 Type = QualType(Context.getAsArrayType(Type), 0); 6691 Decl->setType(Type); 6692 } 6693 } 6694 6695 static void checkAttributesAfterMerging(Sema &S, NamedDecl &ND) { 6696 // Ensure that an auto decl is deduced otherwise the checks below might cache 6697 // the wrong linkage. 6698 assert(S.ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(&ND) == 0); 6699 6700 // 'weak' only applies to declarations with external linkage. 6701 if (WeakAttr *Attr = ND.getAttr<WeakAttr>()) { 6702 if (!ND.isExternallyVisible()) { 6703 S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_weak_static); 6704 ND.dropAttr<WeakAttr>(); 6705 } 6706 } 6707 if (WeakRefAttr *Attr = ND.getAttr<WeakRefAttr>()) { 6708 if (ND.isExternallyVisible()) { 6709 S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_weakref_not_static); 6710 ND.dropAttr<WeakRefAttr>(); 6711 ND.dropAttr<AliasAttr>(); 6712 } 6713 } 6714 6715 if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(&ND)) { 6716 if (VD->hasInit()) { 6717 if (const auto *Attr = VD->getAttr<AliasAttr>()) { 6718 assert(VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && 6719 !VD->isExternallyVisible() && "Broken AliasAttr handled late!"); 6720 S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_alias_is_definition) << VD << 0; 6721 VD->dropAttr<AliasAttr>(); 6722 } 6723 } 6724 } 6725 6726 // 'selectany' only applies to externally visible variable declarations. 6727 // It does not apply to functions. 6728 if (SelectAnyAttr *Attr = ND.getAttr<SelectAnyAttr>()) { 6729 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(ND) || !ND.isExternallyVisible()) { 6730 S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), 6731 diag::err_attribute_selectany_non_extern_data); 6732 ND.dropAttr<SelectAnyAttr>(); 6733 } 6734 } 6735 6736 if (const InheritableAttr *Attr = getDLLAttr(&ND)) { 6737 auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(&ND); 6738 bool IsAnonymousNS = false; 6739 bool IsMicrosoft = S.Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft(); 6740 if (VD) { 6741 const NamespaceDecl *NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(VD->getDeclContext()); 6742 while (NS && !IsAnonymousNS) { 6743 IsAnonymousNS = NS->isAnonymousNamespace(); 6744 NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(NS->getParent()); 6745 } 6746 } 6747 // dll attributes require external linkage. Static locals may have external 6748 // linkage but still cannot be explicitly imported or exported. 6749 // In Microsoft mode, a variable defined in anonymous namespace must have 6750 // external linkage in order to be exported. 6751 bool AnonNSInMicrosoftMode = IsAnonymousNS && IsMicrosoft; 6752 if ((ND.isExternallyVisible() && AnonNSInMicrosoftMode) || 6753 (!AnonNSInMicrosoftMode && 6754 (!ND.isExternallyVisible() || (VD && VD->isStaticLocal())))) { 6755 S.Diag(ND.getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dll_not_extern) 6756 << &ND << Attr; 6757 ND.setInvalidDecl(); 6758 } 6759 } 6760 6761 // Check the attributes on the function type, if any. 6762 if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(&ND)) { 6763 // Don't declare this variable in the second operand of the for-statement; 6764 // GCC miscompiles that by ending its lifetime before evaluating the 6765 // third operand. See gcc.gnu.org/PR86769. 6766 AttributedTypeLoc ATL; 6767 for (TypeLoc TL = FD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc(); 6768 (ATL = TL.getAsAdjusted<AttributedTypeLoc>()); 6769 TL = ATL.getModifiedLoc()) { 6770 // The [[lifetimebound]] attribute can be applied to the implicit object 6771 // parameter of a non-static member function (other than a ctor or dtor) 6772 // by applying it to the function type. 6773 if (const auto *A = ATL.getAttrAs<LifetimeBoundAttr>()) { 6774 const auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD); 6775 if (!MD || MD->isStatic()) { 6776 S.Diag(A->getLocation(), diag::err_lifetimebound_no_object_param) 6777 << !MD << A->getRange(); 6778 } else if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD) || isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD)) { 6779 S.Diag(A->getLocation(), diag::err_lifetimebound_ctor_dtor) 6780 << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD) << A->getRange(); 6781 } 6782 } 6783 } 6784 } 6785 } 6786 6787 static void checkDLLAttributeRedeclaration(Sema &S, NamedDecl *OldDecl, 6788 NamedDecl *NewDecl, 6789 bool IsSpecialization, 6790 bool IsDefinition) { 6791 if (OldDecl->isInvalidDecl() || NewDecl->isInvalidDecl()) 6792 return; 6793 6794 bool IsTemplate = false; 6795 if (TemplateDecl *OldTD = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(OldDecl)) { 6796 OldDecl = OldTD->getTemplatedDecl(); 6797 IsTemplate = true; 6798 if (!IsSpecialization) 6799 IsDefinition = false; 6800 } 6801 if (TemplateDecl *NewTD = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(NewDecl)) { 6802 NewDecl = NewTD->getTemplatedDecl(); 6803 IsTemplate = true; 6804 } 6805 6806 if (!OldDecl || !NewDecl) 6807 return; 6808 6809 const DLLImportAttr *OldImportAttr = OldDecl->getAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6810 const DLLExportAttr *OldExportAttr = OldDecl->getAttr<DLLExportAttr>(); 6811 const DLLImportAttr *NewImportAttr = NewDecl->getAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6812 const DLLExportAttr *NewExportAttr = NewDecl->getAttr<DLLExportAttr>(); 6813 6814 // dllimport and dllexport are inheritable attributes so we have to exclude 6815 // inherited attribute instances. 6816 bool HasNewAttr = (NewImportAttr && !NewImportAttr->isInherited()) || 6817 (NewExportAttr && !NewExportAttr->isInherited()); 6818 6819 // A redeclaration is not allowed to add a dllimport or dllexport attribute, 6820 // the only exception being explicit specializations. 6821 // Implicitly generated declarations are also excluded for now because there 6822 // is no other way to switch these to use dllimport or dllexport. 6823 bool AddsAttr = !(OldImportAttr || OldExportAttr) && HasNewAttr; 6824 6825 if (AddsAttr && !IsSpecialization && !OldDecl->isImplicit()) { 6826 // Allow with a warning for free functions and global variables. 6827 bool JustWarn = false; 6828 if (!OldDecl->isCXXClassMember()) { 6829 auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(OldDecl); 6830 if (VD && !VD->getDescribedVarTemplate()) 6831 JustWarn = true; 6832 auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl); 6833 if (FD && FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_NonTemplate) 6834 JustWarn = true; 6835 } 6836 6837 // We cannot change a declaration that's been used because IR has already 6838 // been emitted. Dllimported functions will still work though (modulo 6839 // address equality) as they can use the thunk. 6840 if (OldDecl->isUsed()) 6841 if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl) || !NewImportAttr) 6842 JustWarn = false; 6843 6844 unsigned DiagID = JustWarn ? diag::warn_attribute_dll_redeclaration 6845 : diag::err_attribute_dll_redeclaration; 6846 S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(), DiagID) 6847 << NewDecl 6848 << (NewImportAttr ? (const Attr *)NewImportAttr : NewExportAttr); 6849 S.Diag(OldDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 6850 if (!JustWarn) { 6851 NewDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 6852 return; 6853 } 6854 } 6855 6856 // A redeclaration is not allowed to drop a dllimport attribute, the only 6857 // exceptions being inline function definitions (except for function 6858 // templates), local extern declarations, qualified friend declarations or 6859 // special MSVC extension: in the last case, the declaration is treated as if 6860 // it were marked dllexport. 6861 bool IsInline = false, IsStaticDataMember = false, IsQualifiedFriend = false; 6862 bool IsMicrosoftABI = S.Context.getTargetInfo().shouldDLLImportComdatSymbols(); 6863 if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(NewDecl)) { 6864 // Ignore static data because out-of-line definitions are diagnosed 6865 // separately. 6866 IsStaticDataMember = VD->isStaticDataMember(); 6867 IsDefinition = VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition(S.Context) != 6868 VarDecl::DeclarationOnly; 6869 } else if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(NewDecl)) { 6870 IsInline = FD->isInlined(); 6871 IsQualifiedFriend = FD->getQualifier() && 6872 FD->getFriendObjectKind() == Decl::FOK_Declared; 6873 } 6874 6875 if (OldImportAttr && !HasNewAttr && 6876 (!IsInline || (IsMicrosoftABI && IsTemplate)) && !IsStaticDataMember && 6877 !NewDecl->isLocalExternDecl() && !IsQualifiedFriend) { 6878 if (IsMicrosoftABI && IsDefinition) { 6879 S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(), 6880 diag::warn_redeclaration_without_import_attribute) 6881 << NewDecl; 6882 S.Diag(OldDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 6883 NewDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6884 NewDecl->addAttr( 6885 DLLExportAttr::CreateImplicit(S.Context, NewImportAttr->getRange())); 6886 } else { 6887 S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(), 6888 diag::warn_redeclaration_without_attribute_prev_attribute_ignored) 6889 << NewDecl << OldImportAttr; 6890 S.Diag(OldDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 6891 S.Diag(OldImportAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_attribute); 6892 OldDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6893 NewDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6894 } 6895 } else if (IsInline && OldImportAttr && !IsMicrosoftABI) { 6896 // In MinGW, seeing a function declared inline drops the dllimport 6897 // attribute. 6898 OldDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6899 NewDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6900 S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(), 6901 diag::warn_dllimport_dropped_from_inline_function) 6902 << NewDecl << OldImportAttr; 6903 } 6904 6905 // A specialization of a class template member function is processed here 6906 // since it's a redeclaration. If the parent class is dllexport, the 6907 // specialization inherits that attribute. This doesn't happen automatically 6908 // since the parent class isn't instantiated until later. 6909 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewDecl)) { 6910 if (MD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_MemberSpecialization && 6911 !NewImportAttr && !NewExportAttr) { 6912 if (const DLLExportAttr *ParentExportAttr = 6913 MD->getParent()->getAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) { 6914 DLLExportAttr *NewAttr = ParentExportAttr->clone(S.Context); 6915 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 6916 NewDecl->addAttr(NewAttr); 6917 } 6918 } 6919 } 6920 } 6921 6922 /// Given that we are within the definition of the given function, 6923 /// will that definition behave like C99's 'inline', where the 6924 /// definition is discarded except for optimization purposes? 6925 static bool isFunctionDefinitionDiscarded(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD) { 6926 // Try to avoid calling GetGVALinkageForFunction. 6927 6928 // All cases of this require the 'inline' keyword. 6929 if (!FD->isInlined()) return false; 6930 6931 // This is only possible in C++ with the gnu_inline attribute. 6932 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) 6933 return false; 6934 6935 // Okay, go ahead and call the relatively-more-expensive function. 6936 return S.Context.GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD) == GVA_AvailableExternally; 6937 } 6938 6939 /// Determine whether a variable is extern "C" prior to attaching 6940 /// an initializer. We can't just call isExternC() here, because that 6941 /// will also compute and cache whether the declaration is externally 6942 /// visible, which might change when we attach the initializer. 6943 /// 6944 /// This can only be used if the declaration is known to not be a 6945 /// redeclaration of an internal linkage declaration. 6946 /// 6947 /// For instance: 6948 /// 6949 /// auto x = []{}; 6950 /// 6951 /// Attaching the initializer here makes this declaration not externally 6952 /// visible, because its type has internal linkage. 6953 /// 6954 /// FIXME: This is a hack. 6955 template<typename T> 6956 static bool isIncompleteDeclExternC(Sema &S, const T *D) { 6957 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 6958 // In C++, the overloadable attribute negates the effects of extern "C". 6959 if (!D->isInExternCContext() || D->template hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>()) 6960 return false; 6961 6962 // So do CUDA's host/device attributes. 6963 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && (D->template hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>() || 6964 D->template hasAttr<CUDAHostAttr>())) 6965 return false; 6966 } 6967 return D->isExternC(); 6968 } 6969 6970 static bool shouldConsiderLinkage(const VarDecl *VD) { 6971 const DeclContext *DC = VD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 6972 if (DC->isFunctionOrMethod() || isa<OMPDeclareReductionDecl>(DC) || 6973 isa<OMPDeclareMapperDecl>(DC)) 6974 return VD->hasExternalStorage(); 6975 if (DC->isFileContext()) 6976 return true; 6977 if (DC->isRecord()) 6978 return false; 6979 if (isa<RequiresExprBodyDecl>(DC)) 6980 return false; 6981 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected context"); 6982 } 6983 6984 static bool shouldConsiderLinkage(const FunctionDecl *FD) { 6985 const DeclContext *DC = FD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 6986 if (DC->isFileContext() || DC->isFunctionOrMethod() || 6987 isa<OMPDeclareReductionDecl>(DC) || isa<OMPDeclareMapperDecl>(DC)) 6988 return true; 6989 if (DC->isRecord()) 6990 return false; 6991 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected context"); 6992 } 6993 6994 static bool hasParsedAttr(Scope *S, const Declarator &PD, 6995 ParsedAttr::Kind Kind) { 6996 // Check decl attributes on the DeclSpec. 6997 if (PD.getDeclSpec().getAttributes().hasAttribute(Kind)) 6998 return true; 6999 7000 // Walk the declarator structure, checking decl attributes that were in a type 7001 // position to the decl itself. 7002 for (unsigned I = 0, E = PD.getNumTypeObjects(); I != E; ++I) { 7003 if (PD.getTypeObject(I).getAttrs().hasAttribute(Kind)) 7004 return true; 7005 } 7006 7007 // Finally, check attributes on the decl itself. 7008 return PD.getAttributes().hasAttribute(Kind) || 7009 PD.getDeclarationAttributes().hasAttribute(Kind); 7010 } 7011 7012 /// Adjust the \c DeclContext for a function or variable that might be a 7013 /// function-local external declaration. 7014 bool Sema::adjustContextForLocalExternDecl(DeclContext *&DC) { 7015 if (!DC->isFunctionOrMethod()) 7016 return false; 7017 7018 // If this is a local extern function or variable declared within a function 7019 // template, don't add it into the enclosing namespace scope until it is 7020 // instantiated; it might have a dependent type right now. 7021 if (DC->isDependentContext()) 7022 return true; 7023 7024 // C++11 [basic.link]p7: 7025 // When a block scope declaration of an entity with linkage is not found to 7026 // refer to some other declaration, then that entity is a member of the 7027 // innermost enclosing namespace. 7028 // 7029 // Per C++11 [namespace.def]p6, the innermost enclosing namespace is a 7030 // semantically-enclosing namespace, not a lexically-enclosing one. 7031 while (!DC->isFileContext() && !isa<LinkageSpecDecl>(DC)) 7032 DC = DC->getParent(); 7033 return true; 7034 } 7035 7036 /// Returns true if given declaration has external C language linkage. 7037 static bool isDeclExternC(const Decl *D) { 7038 if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) 7039 return FD->isExternC(); 7040 if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) 7041 return VD->isExternC(); 7042 7043 llvm_unreachable("Unknown type of decl!"); 7044 } 7045 7046 /// Returns true if there hasn't been any invalid type diagnosed. 7047 static bool diagnoseOpenCLTypes(Sema &Se, VarDecl *NewVD) { 7048 DeclContext *DC = NewVD->getDeclContext(); 7049 QualType R = NewVD->getType(); 7050 7051 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.9.b - Image type can only be used as a function argument. 7052 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.13.16.1 - Pipe type can only be used as a function 7053 // argument. 7054 if (R->isImageType() || R->isPipeType()) { 7055 Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), 7056 diag::err_opencl_type_can_only_be_used_as_function_parameter) 7057 << R; 7058 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7059 return false; 7060 } 7061 7062 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.r: 7063 // The event type cannot be used to declare a program scope variable. 7064 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.9.q: 7065 // The clk_event_t and reserve_id_t types cannot be declared in program 7066 // scope. 7067 if (NewVD->hasGlobalStorage() && !NewVD->isStaticLocal()) { 7068 if (R->isReserveIDT() || R->isClkEventT() || R->isEventT()) { 7069 Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), 7070 diag::err_invalid_type_for_program_scope_var) 7071 << R; 7072 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7073 return false; 7074 } 7075 } 7076 7077 // OpenCL v1.0 s6.8.a.3: Pointers to functions are not allowed. 7078 if (!Se.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("__cl_clang_function_pointers", 7079 Se.getLangOpts())) { 7080 QualType NR = R.getCanonicalType(); 7081 while (NR->isPointerType() || NR->isMemberFunctionPointerType() || 7082 NR->isReferenceType()) { 7083 if (NR->isFunctionPointerType() || NR->isMemberFunctionPointerType() || 7084 NR->isFunctionReferenceType()) { 7085 Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_pointer) 7086 << NR->isReferenceType(); 7087 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7088 return false; 7089 } 7090 NR = NR->getPointeeType(); 7091 } 7092 } 7093 7094 if (!Se.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("cl_khr_fp16", 7095 Se.getLangOpts())) { 7096 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.1.1.1: reject declaring variables of the half and 7097 // half array type (unless the cl_khr_fp16 extension is enabled). 7098 if (Se.Context.getBaseElementType(R)->isHalfType()) { 7099 Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_half_declaration) << R; 7100 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7101 return false; 7102 } 7103 } 7104 7105 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.r: 7106 // The event type cannot be used with the __local, __constant and __global 7107 // address space qualifiers. 7108 if (R->isEventT()) { 7109 if (R.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::opencl_private) { 7110 Se.Diag(NewVD->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_event_t_addr_space_qual); 7111 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7112 return false; 7113 } 7114 } 7115 7116 if (R->isSamplerT()) { 7117 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.b p4: 7118 // The sampler type cannot be used with the __local and __global address 7119 // space qualifiers. 7120 if (R.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local || 7121 R.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_global) { 7122 Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_wrong_sampler_addressspace); 7123 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7124 } 7125 7126 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.12.14.1: 7127 // A global sampler must be declared with either the constant address 7128 // space qualifier or with the const qualifier. 7129 if (DC->isTranslationUnit() && 7130 !(R.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant || 7131 R.isConstQualified())) { 7132 Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_nonconst_global_sampler); 7133 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7134 } 7135 if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl()) 7136 return false; 7137 } 7138 7139 return true; 7140 } 7141 7142 template <typename AttrTy> 7143 static void copyAttrFromTypedefToDecl(Sema &S, Decl *D, const TypedefType *TT) { 7144 const TypedefNameDecl *TND = TT->getDecl(); 7145 if (const auto *Attribute = TND->getAttr<AttrTy>()) { 7146 AttrTy *Clone = Attribute->clone(S.Context); 7147 Clone->setInherited(true); 7148 D->addAttr(Clone); 7149 } 7150 } 7151 7152 NamedDecl *Sema::ActOnVariableDeclarator( 7153 Scope *S, Declarator &D, DeclContext *DC, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 7154 LookupResult &Previous, MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists, 7155 bool &AddToScope, ArrayRef<BindingDecl *> Bindings) { 7156 QualType R = TInfo->getType(); 7157 DeclarationName Name = GetNameForDeclarator(D).getName(); 7158 7159 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo(); 7160 7161 if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) { 7162 // Take the name of the first declarator as our name for diagnostic 7163 // purposes. 7164 auto &Decomp = D.getDecompositionDeclarator(); 7165 if (!Decomp.bindings().empty()) { 7166 II = Decomp.bindings()[0].Name; 7167 Name = II; 7168 } 7169 } else if (!II) { 7170 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_bad_variable_name) << Name; 7171 return nullptr; 7172 } 7173 7174 7175 DeclSpec::SCS SCSpec = D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec(); 7176 StorageClass SC = StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass(D.getDeclSpec()); 7177 7178 // dllimport globals without explicit storage class are treated as extern. We 7179 // have to change the storage class this early to get the right DeclContext. 7180 if (SC == SC_None && !DC->isRecord() && 7181 hasParsedAttr(S, D, ParsedAttr::AT_DLLImport) && 7182 !hasParsedAttr(S, D, ParsedAttr::AT_DLLExport)) 7183 SC = SC_Extern; 7184 7185 DeclContext *OriginalDC = DC; 7186 bool IsLocalExternDecl = SC == SC_Extern && 7187 adjustContextForLocalExternDecl(DC); 7188 7189 if (SCSpec == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable) { 7190 // mutable can only appear on non-static class members, so it's always 7191 // an error here 7192 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_mutable_nonmember); 7193 D.setInvalidType(); 7194 SC = SC_None; 7195 } 7196 7197 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && SCSpec == DeclSpec::SCS_register && 7198 !D.getAsmLabel() && !getSourceManager().isInSystemMacro( 7199 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc())) { 7200 // In C++11, the 'register' storage class specifier is deprecated. 7201 // Suppress the warning in system macros, it's used in macros in some 7202 // popular C system headers, such as in glibc's htonl() macro. 7203 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7204 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ? diag::ext_register_storage_class 7205 : diag::warn_deprecated_register) 7206 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 7207 } 7208 7209 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(D.getDeclSpec()); 7210 7211 if (!DC->isRecord() && S->getFnParent() == nullptr) { 7212 // C99 6.9p2: The storage-class specifiers auto and register shall not 7213 // appear in the declaration specifiers in an external declaration. 7214 // Global Register+Asm is a GNU extension we support. 7215 if (SC == SC_Auto || (SC == SC_Register && !D.getAsmLabel())) { 7216 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_sclass_fscope); 7217 D.setInvalidType(); 7218 } 7219 } 7220 7221 // If this variable has a VLA type and an initializer, try to 7222 // fold to a constant-sized type. This is otherwise invalid. 7223 if (D.hasInitializer() && R->isVariableArrayType()) 7224 tryToFixVariablyModifiedVarType(TInfo, R, D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7225 /*DiagID=*/0); 7226 7227 bool IsMemberSpecialization = false; 7228 bool IsVariableTemplateSpecialization = false; 7229 bool IsPartialSpecialization = false; 7230 bool IsVariableTemplate = false; 7231 VarDecl *NewVD = nullptr; 7232 VarTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = nullptr; 7233 TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams = nullptr; 7234 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 7235 NewVD = VarDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7236 II, R, TInfo, SC); 7237 7238 if (R->getContainedDeducedType()) 7239 ParsingInitForAutoVars.insert(NewVD); 7240 7241 if (D.isInvalidType()) 7242 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7243 7244 if (NewVD->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() && 7245 NewVD->hasLocalStorage()) 7246 checkNonTrivialCUnion(NewVD->getType(), NewVD->getLocation(), 7247 NTCUC_AutoVar, NTCUK_Destruct); 7248 } else { 7249 bool Invalid = false; 7250 7251 if (DC->isRecord() && !CurContext->isRecord()) { 7252 // This is an out-of-line definition of a static data member. 7253 switch (SC) { 7254 case SC_None: 7255 break; 7256 case SC_Static: 7257 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7258 diag::err_static_out_of_line) 7259 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 7260 break; 7261 case SC_Auto: 7262 case SC_Register: 7263 case SC_Extern: 7264 // [dcl.stc] p2: The auto or register specifiers shall be applied only 7265 // to names of variables declared in a block or to function parameters. 7266 // [dcl.stc] p6: The extern specifier cannot be used in the declaration 7267 // of class members 7268 7269 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7270 diag::err_storage_class_for_static_member) 7271 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 7272 break; 7273 case SC_PrivateExtern: 7274 llvm_unreachable("C storage class in c++!"); 7275 } 7276 } 7277 7278 if (SC == SC_Static && CurContext->isRecord()) { 7279 if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) { 7280 // Walk up the enclosing DeclContexts to check for any that are 7281 // incompatible with static data members. 7282 const DeclContext *FunctionOrMethod = nullptr; 7283 const CXXRecordDecl *AnonStruct = nullptr; 7284 for (DeclContext *Ctxt = DC; Ctxt; Ctxt = Ctxt->getParent()) { 7285 if (Ctxt->isFunctionOrMethod()) { 7286 FunctionOrMethod = Ctxt; 7287 break; 7288 } 7289 const CXXRecordDecl *ParentDecl = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Ctxt); 7290 if (ParentDecl && !ParentDecl->getDeclName()) { 7291 AnonStruct = ParentDecl; 7292 break; 7293 } 7294 } 7295 if (FunctionOrMethod) { 7296 // C++ [class.static.data]p5: A local class shall not have static data 7297 // members. 7298 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7299 diag::err_static_data_member_not_allowed_in_local_class) 7300 << Name << RD->getDeclName() << RD->getTagKind(); 7301 } else if (AnonStruct) { 7302 // C++ [class.static.data]p4: Unnamed classes and classes contained 7303 // directly or indirectly within unnamed classes shall not contain 7304 // static data members. 7305 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7306 diag::err_static_data_member_not_allowed_in_anon_struct) 7307 << Name << AnonStruct->getTagKind(); 7308 Invalid = true; 7309 } else if (RD->isUnion()) { 7310 // C++98 [class.union]p1: If a union contains a static data member, 7311 // the program is ill-formed. C++11 drops this restriction. 7312 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7313 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 7314 ? diag::warn_cxx98_compat_static_data_member_in_union 7315 : diag::ext_static_data_member_in_union) << Name; 7316 } 7317 } 7318 } 7319 7320 // Match up the template parameter lists with the scope specifier, then 7321 // determine whether we have a template or a template specialization. 7322 bool InvalidScope = false; 7323 TemplateParams = MatchTemplateParametersToScopeSpecifier( 7324 D.getDeclSpec().getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7325 D.getCXXScopeSpec(), 7326 D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId 7327 ? D.getName().TemplateId 7328 : nullptr, 7329 TemplateParamLists, 7330 /*never a friend*/ false, IsMemberSpecialization, InvalidScope); 7331 Invalid |= InvalidScope; 7332 7333 if (TemplateParams) { 7334 if (!TemplateParams->size() && 7335 D.getName().getKind() != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) { 7336 // There is an extraneous 'template<>' for this variable. Complain 7337 // about it, but allow the declaration of the variable. 7338 Diag(TemplateParams->getTemplateLoc(), 7339 diag::err_template_variable_noparams) 7340 << II 7341 << SourceRange(TemplateParams->getTemplateLoc(), 7342 TemplateParams->getRAngleLoc()); 7343 TemplateParams = nullptr; 7344 } else { 7345 // Check that we can declare a template here. 7346 if (CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParams)) 7347 return nullptr; 7348 7349 if (D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) { 7350 // This is an explicit specialization or a partial specialization. 7351 IsVariableTemplateSpecialization = true; 7352 IsPartialSpecialization = TemplateParams->size() > 0; 7353 } else { // if (TemplateParams->size() > 0) 7354 // This is a template declaration. 7355 IsVariableTemplate = true; 7356 7357 // Only C++1y supports variable templates (N3651). 7358 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7359 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 7360 ? diag::warn_cxx11_compat_variable_template 7361 : diag::ext_variable_template); 7362 } 7363 } 7364 } else { 7365 // Check that we can declare a member specialization here. 7366 if (!TemplateParamLists.empty() && IsMemberSpecialization && 7367 CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParamLists.back())) 7368 return nullptr; 7369 assert((Invalid || 7370 D.getName().getKind() != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) && 7371 "should have a 'template<>' for this decl"); 7372 } 7373 7374 if (IsVariableTemplateSpecialization) { 7375 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = 7376 TemplateParamLists.size() > 0 7377 ? TemplateParamLists[0]->getTemplateLoc() 7378 : SourceLocation(); 7379 DeclResult Res = ActOnVarTemplateSpecialization( 7380 S, D, TInfo, TemplateKWLoc, TemplateParams, SC, 7381 IsPartialSpecialization); 7382 if (Res.isInvalid()) 7383 return nullptr; 7384 NewVD = cast<VarDecl>(Res.get()); 7385 AddToScope = false; 7386 } else if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) { 7387 NewVD = DecompositionDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), 7388 D.getIdentifierLoc(), R, TInfo, SC, 7389 Bindings); 7390 } else 7391 NewVD = VarDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), 7392 D.getIdentifierLoc(), II, R, TInfo, SC); 7393 7394 // If this is supposed to be a variable template, create it as such. 7395 if (IsVariableTemplate) { 7396 NewTemplate = 7397 VarTemplateDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getIdentifierLoc(), Name, 7398 TemplateParams, NewVD); 7399 NewVD->setDescribedVarTemplate(NewTemplate); 7400 } 7401 7402 // If this decl has an auto type in need of deduction, make a note of the 7403 // Decl so we can diagnose uses of it in its own initializer. 7404 if (R->getContainedDeducedType()) 7405 ParsingInitForAutoVars.insert(NewVD); 7406 7407 if (D.isInvalidType() || Invalid) { 7408 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7409 if (NewTemplate) 7410 NewTemplate->setInvalidDecl(); 7411 } 7412 7413 SetNestedNameSpecifier(*this, NewVD, D); 7414 7415 // If we have any template parameter lists that don't directly belong to 7416 // the variable (matching the scope specifier), store them. 7417 unsigned VDTemplateParamLists = TemplateParams ? 1 : 0; 7418 if (TemplateParamLists.size() > VDTemplateParamLists) 7419 NewVD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo( 7420 Context, TemplateParamLists.drop_back(VDTemplateParamLists)); 7421 } 7422 7423 if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified()) { 7424 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 7425 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function) 7426 << 0; 7427 } else if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) { 7428 // 'inline' is not allowed on block scope variable declaration. 7429 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), 7430 diag::err_inline_declaration_block_scope) << Name 7431 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc()); 7432 } else { 7433 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), 7434 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ? diag::warn_cxx14_compat_inline_variable 7435 : diag::ext_inline_variable); 7436 NewVD->setInlineSpecified(); 7437 } 7438 } 7439 7440 // Set the lexical context. If the declarator has a C++ scope specifier, the 7441 // lexical context will be different from the semantic context. 7442 NewVD->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 7443 if (NewTemplate) 7444 NewTemplate->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 7445 7446 if (IsLocalExternDecl) { 7447 if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) 7448 for (auto *B : Bindings) 7449 B->setLocalExternDecl(); 7450 else 7451 NewVD->setLocalExternDecl(); 7452 } 7453 7454 bool EmitTLSUnsupportedError = false; 7455 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec()) { 7456 // C++11 [dcl.stc]p4: 7457 // When thread_local is applied to a variable of block scope the 7458 // storage-class-specifier static is implied if it does not appear 7459 // explicitly. 7460 // Core issue: 'static' is not implied if the variable is declared 7461 // 'extern'. 7462 if (NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && 7463 (SCSpec != DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified || 7464 TSCS != DeclSpec::TSCS_thread_local || 7465 !DC->isFunctionOrMethod())) 7466 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7467 diag::err_thread_non_global) 7468 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 7469 else if (!Context.getTargetInfo().isTLSSupported()) { 7470 if (getLangOpts().CUDA || getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice || 7471 getLangOpts().SYCLIsDevice) { 7472 // Postpone error emission until we've collected attributes required to 7473 // figure out whether it's a host or device variable and whether the 7474 // error should be ignored. 7475 EmitTLSUnsupportedError = true; 7476 // We still need to mark the variable as TLS so it shows up in AST with 7477 // proper storage class for other tools to use even if we're not going 7478 // to emit any code for it. 7479 NewVD->setTSCSpec(TSCS); 7480 } else 7481 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7482 diag::err_thread_unsupported); 7483 } else 7484 NewVD->setTSCSpec(TSCS); 7485 } 7486 7487 switch (D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier()) { 7488 case ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified: 7489 break; 7490 7491 case ConstexprSpecKind::Consteval: 7492 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), 7493 diag::err_constexpr_wrong_decl_kind) 7494 << static_cast<int>(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier()); 7495 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 7496 7497 case ConstexprSpecKind::Constexpr: 7498 NewVD->setConstexpr(true); 7499 // C++1z [dcl.spec.constexpr]p1: 7500 // A static data member declared with the constexpr specifier is 7501 // implicitly an inline variable. 7502 if (NewVD->isStaticDataMember() && 7503 (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 || 7504 Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())) 7505 NewVD->setImplicitlyInline(); 7506 break; 7507 7508 case ConstexprSpecKind::Constinit: 7509 if (!NewVD->hasGlobalStorage()) 7510 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), 7511 diag::err_constinit_local_variable); 7512 else 7513 NewVD->addAttr(ConstInitAttr::Create( 7514 Context, D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), 7515 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Keyword, ConstInitAttr::Keyword_constinit)); 7516 break; 7517 } 7518 7519 // C99 6.7.4p3 7520 // An inline definition of a function with external linkage shall 7521 // not contain a definition of a modifiable object with static or 7522 // thread storage duration... 7523 // We only apply this when the function is required to be defined 7524 // elsewhere, i.e. when the function is not 'extern inline'. Note 7525 // that a local variable with thread storage duration still has to 7526 // be marked 'static'. Also note that it's possible to get these 7527 // semantics in C++ using __attribute__((gnu_inline)). 7528 if (SC == SC_Static && S->getFnParent() != nullptr && 7529 !NewVD->getType().isConstQualified()) { 7530 FunctionDecl *CurFD = getCurFunctionDecl(); 7531 if (CurFD && isFunctionDefinitionDiscarded(*this, CurFD)) { 7532 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7533 diag::warn_static_local_in_extern_inline); 7534 MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(CurFD); 7535 } 7536 } 7537 7538 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) { 7539 if (IsVariableTemplateSpecialization) 7540 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_specialization) 7541 << (IsPartialSpecialization ? 1 : 0) 7542 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 7543 D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 7544 else if (IsMemberSpecialization) 7545 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_specialization) 7546 << 2 7547 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 7548 else if (NewVD->hasLocalStorage()) 7549 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_local) 7550 << 0 << NewVD 7551 << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()) 7552 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 7553 D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 7554 else { 7555 NewVD->setModulePrivate(); 7556 if (NewTemplate) 7557 NewTemplate->setModulePrivate(); 7558 for (auto *B : Bindings) 7559 B->setModulePrivate(); 7560 } 7561 } 7562 7563 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 7564 deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(NewVD); 7565 7566 DeclSpec::TSCS TSC = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec(); 7567 if (TSC != TSCS_unspecified) { 7568 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7569 diag::err_opencl_unknown_type_specifier) 7570 << getLangOpts().getOpenCLVersionString() 7571 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSC) << 1; 7572 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7573 } 7574 } 7575 7576 // Handle attributes prior to checking for duplicates in MergeVarDecl 7577 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewVD, D); 7578 7579 // FIXME: This is probably the wrong location to be doing this and we should 7580 // probably be doing this for more attributes (especially for function 7581 // pointer attributes such as format, warn_unused_result, etc.). Ideally 7582 // the code to copy attributes would be generated by TableGen. 7583 if (R->isFunctionPointerType()) 7584 if (const auto *TT = R->getAs<TypedefType>()) 7585 copyAttrFromTypedefToDecl<AllocSizeAttr>(*this, NewVD, TT); 7586 7587 if (getLangOpts().CUDA || getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice || 7588 getLangOpts().SYCLIsDevice) { 7589 if (EmitTLSUnsupportedError && 7590 ((getLangOpts().CUDA && DeclAttrsMatchCUDAMode(getLangOpts(), NewVD)) || 7591 (getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice && 7592 OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::isDeclareTargetDeclaration(NewVD)))) 7593 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7594 diag::err_thread_unsupported); 7595 7596 if (EmitTLSUnsupportedError && 7597 (LangOpts.SYCLIsDevice || (LangOpts.OpenMP && LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice))) 7598 targetDiag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_thread_unsupported); 7599 // CUDA B.2.5: "__shared__ and __constant__ variables have implied static 7600 // storage [duration]." 7601 if (SC == SC_None && S->getFnParent() != nullptr && 7602 (NewVD->hasAttr<CUDASharedAttr>() || 7603 NewVD->hasAttr<CUDAConstantAttr>())) { 7604 NewVD->setStorageClass(SC_Static); 7605 } 7606 } 7607 7608 // Ensure that dllimport globals without explicit storage class are treated as 7609 // extern. The storage class is set above using parsed attributes. Now we can 7610 // check the VarDecl itself. 7611 assert(!NewVD->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>() || 7612 NewVD->getAttr<DLLImportAttr>()->isInherited() || 7613 NewVD->isStaticDataMember() || NewVD->getStorageClass() != SC_None); 7614 7615 // In auto-retain/release, infer strong retension for variables of 7616 // retainable type. 7617 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(NewVD)) 7618 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7619 7620 // Handle GNU asm-label extension (encoded as an attribute). 7621 if (Expr *E = (Expr*)D.getAsmLabel()) { 7622 // The parser guarantees this is a string. 7623 StringLiteral *SE = cast<StringLiteral>(E); 7624 StringRef Label = SE->getString(); 7625 if (S->getFnParent() != nullptr) { 7626 switch (SC) { 7627 case SC_None: 7628 case SC_Auto: 7629 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_asm_label_on_auto_decl) << Label; 7630 break; 7631 case SC_Register: 7632 // Local Named register 7633 if (!Context.getTargetInfo().isValidGCCRegisterName(Label) && 7634 DeclAttrsMatchCUDAMode(getLangOpts(), getCurFunctionDecl())) 7635 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_unknown_register_name) << Label; 7636 break; 7637 case SC_Static: 7638 case SC_Extern: 7639 case SC_PrivateExtern: 7640 break; 7641 } 7642 } else if (SC == SC_Register) { 7643 // Global Named register 7644 if (DeclAttrsMatchCUDAMode(getLangOpts(), NewVD)) { 7645 const auto &TI = Context.getTargetInfo(); 7646 bool HasSizeMismatch; 7647 7648 if (!TI.isValidGCCRegisterName(Label)) 7649 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_unknown_register_name) << Label; 7650 else if (!TI.validateGlobalRegisterVariable(Label, 7651 Context.getTypeSize(R), 7652 HasSizeMismatch)) 7653 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_invalid_global_var_reg) << Label; 7654 else if (HasSizeMismatch) 7655 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_register_size_mismatch) << Label; 7656 } 7657 7658 if (!R->isIntegralType(Context) && !R->isPointerType()) { 7659 Diag(D.getBeginLoc(), diag::err_asm_bad_register_type); 7660 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(true); 7661 } 7662 } 7663 7664 NewVD->addAttr(AsmLabelAttr::Create(Context, Label, 7665 /*IsLiteralLabel=*/true, 7666 SE->getStrTokenLoc(0))); 7667 } else if (!ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.empty()) { 7668 llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*,AsmLabelAttr*>::iterator I = 7669 ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.find(NewVD->getIdentifier()); 7670 if (I != ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.end()) { 7671 if (isDeclExternC(NewVD)) { 7672 NewVD->addAttr(I->second); 7673 ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.erase(I); 7674 } else 7675 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::warn_redefine_extname_not_applied) 7676 << /*Variable*/1 << NewVD; 7677 } 7678 } 7679 7680 // Find the shadowed declaration before filtering for scope. 7681 NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = D.getCXXScopeSpec().isEmpty() 7682 ? getShadowedDeclaration(NewVD, Previous) 7683 : nullptr; 7684 7685 // Don't consider existing declarations that are in a different 7686 // scope and are out-of-semantic-context declarations (if the new 7687 // declaration has linkage). 7688 FilterLookupForScope(Previous, OriginalDC, S, shouldConsiderLinkage(NewVD), 7689 D.getCXXScopeSpec().isNotEmpty() || 7690 IsMemberSpecialization || 7691 IsVariableTemplateSpecialization); 7692 7693 // Check whether the previous declaration is in the same block scope. This 7694 // affects whether we merge types with it, per C++11 [dcl.array]p3. 7695 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 7696 NewVD->isLocalVarDecl() && NewVD->hasExternalStorage()) 7697 NewVD->setPreviousDeclInSameBlockScope( 7698 Previous.isSingleResult() && !Previous.isShadowed() && 7699 isDeclInScope(Previous.getFoundDecl(), OriginalDC, S, false)); 7700 7701 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 7702 D.setRedeclaration(CheckVariableDeclaration(NewVD, Previous)); 7703 } else { 7704 // If this is an explicit specialization of a static data member, check it. 7705 if (IsMemberSpecialization && !NewVD->isInvalidDecl() && 7706 CheckMemberSpecialization(NewVD, Previous)) 7707 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7708 7709 // Merge the decl with the existing one if appropriate. 7710 if (!Previous.empty()) { 7711 if (Previous.isSingleResult() && 7712 isa<FieldDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl()) && 7713 D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 7714 // The user tried to define a non-static data member 7715 // out-of-line (C++ [dcl.meaning]p1). 7716 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_nonstatic_member_out_of_line) 7717 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 7718 Previous.clear(); 7719 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7720 } 7721 } else if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 7722 // No previous declaration in the qualifying scope. 7723 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_no_member) 7724 << Name << computeDeclContext(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), true) 7725 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 7726 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7727 } 7728 7729 if (!IsVariableTemplateSpecialization) 7730 D.setRedeclaration(CheckVariableDeclaration(NewVD, Previous)); 7731 7732 if (NewTemplate) { 7733 VarTemplateDecl *PrevVarTemplate = 7734 NewVD->getPreviousDecl() 7735 ? NewVD->getPreviousDecl()->getDescribedVarTemplate() 7736 : nullptr; 7737 7738 // Check the template parameter list of this declaration, possibly 7739 // merging in the template parameter list from the previous variable 7740 // template declaration. 7741 if (CheckTemplateParameterList( 7742 TemplateParams, 7743 PrevVarTemplate ? PrevVarTemplate->getTemplateParameters() 7744 : nullptr, 7745 (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet() && DC && DC->isRecord() && 7746 DC->isDependentContext()) 7747 ? TPC_ClassTemplateMember 7748 : TPC_VarTemplate)) 7749 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7750 7751 // If we are providing an explicit specialization of a static variable 7752 // template, make a note of that. 7753 if (PrevVarTemplate && 7754 PrevVarTemplate->getInstantiatedFromMemberTemplate()) 7755 PrevVarTemplate->setMemberSpecialization(); 7756 } 7757 } 7758 7759 // Diagnose shadowed variables iff this isn't a redeclaration. 7760 if (ShadowedDecl && !D.isRedeclaration()) 7761 CheckShadow(NewVD, ShadowedDecl, Previous); 7762 7763 ProcessPragmaWeak(S, NewVD); 7764 7765 // If this is the first declaration of an extern C variable, update 7766 // the map of such variables. 7767 if (NewVD->isFirstDecl() && !NewVD->isInvalidDecl() && 7768 isIncompleteDeclExternC(*this, NewVD)) 7769 RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(NewVD, S); 7770 7771 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NewVD->isStaticLocal()) { 7772 MangleNumberingContext *MCtx; 7773 Decl *ManglingContextDecl; 7774 std::tie(MCtx, ManglingContextDecl) = 7775 getCurrentMangleNumberContext(NewVD->getDeclContext()); 7776 if (MCtx) { 7777 Context.setManglingNumber( 7778 NewVD, MCtx->getManglingNumber( 7779 NewVD, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), S))); 7780 Context.setStaticLocalNumber(NewVD, MCtx->getStaticLocalNumber(NewVD)); 7781 } 7782 } 7783 7784 // Special handling of variable named 'main'. 7785 if (Name.getAsIdentifierInfo() && Name.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("main") && 7786 NewVD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit() && 7787 !getLangOpts().Freestanding && !NewVD->getDescribedVarTemplate()) { 7788 7789 // C++ [basic.start.main]p3 7790 // A program that declares a variable main at global scope is ill-formed. 7791 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 7792 Diag(D.getBeginLoc(), diag::err_main_global_variable); 7793 7794 // In C, and external-linkage variable named main results in undefined 7795 // behavior. 7796 else if (NewVD->hasExternalFormalLinkage()) 7797 Diag(D.getBeginLoc(), diag::warn_main_redefined); 7798 } 7799 7800 if (D.isRedeclaration() && !Previous.empty()) { 7801 NamedDecl *Prev = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(); 7802 checkDLLAttributeRedeclaration(*this, Prev, NewVD, IsMemberSpecialization, 7803 D.isFunctionDefinition()); 7804 } 7805 7806 if (NewTemplate) { 7807 if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl()) 7808 NewTemplate->setInvalidDecl(); 7809 ActOnDocumentableDecl(NewTemplate); 7810 return NewTemplate; 7811 } 7812 7813 if (IsMemberSpecialization && !NewVD->isInvalidDecl()) 7814 CompleteMemberSpecialization(NewVD, Previous); 7815 7816 return NewVD; 7817 } 7818 7819 /// Enum describing the %select options in diag::warn_decl_shadow. 7820 enum ShadowedDeclKind { 7821 SDK_Local, 7822 SDK_Global, 7823 SDK_StaticMember, 7824 SDK_Field, 7825 SDK_Typedef, 7826 SDK_Using, 7827 SDK_StructuredBinding 7828 }; 7829 7830 /// Determine what kind of declaration we're shadowing. 7831 static ShadowedDeclKind computeShadowedDeclKind(const NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl, 7832 const DeclContext *OldDC) { 7833 if (isa<TypeAliasDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) 7834 return SDK_Using; 7835 else if (isa<TypedefDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) 7836 return SDK_Typedef; 7837 else if (isa<BindingDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) 7838 return SDK_StructuredBinding; 7839 else if (isa<RecordDecl>(OldDC)) 7840 return isa<FieldDecl>(ShadowedDecl) ? SDK_Field : SDK_StaticMember; 7841 7842 return OldDC->isFileContext() ? SDK_Global : SDK_Local; 7843 } 7844 7845 /// Return the location of the capture if the given lambda captures the given 7846 /// variable \p VD, or an invalid source location otherwise. 7847 static SourceLocation getCaptureLocation(const LambdaScopeInfo *LSI, 7848 const VarDecl *VD) { 7849 for (const Capture &Capture : LSI->Captures) { 7850 if (Capture.isVariableCapture() && Capture.getVariable() == VD) 7851 return Capture.getLocation(); 7852 } 7853 return SourceLocation(); 7854 } 7855 7856 static bool shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(const DiagnosticsEngine &Diags, 7857 const LookupResult &R) { 7858 // Only diagnose if we're shadowing an unambiguous field or variable. 7859 if (R.getResultKind() != LookupResult::Found) 7860 return false; 7861 7862 // Return false if warning is ignored. 7863 return !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_decl_shadow, R.getNameLoc()); 7864 } 7865 7866 /// Return the declaration shadowed by the given variable \p D, or null 7867 /// if it doesn't shadow any declaration or shadowing warnings are disabled. 7868 NamedDecl *Sema::getShadowedDeclaration(const VarDecl *D, 7869 const LookupResult &R) { 7870 if (!shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(Diags, R)) 7871 return nullptr; 7872 7873 // Don't diagnose declarations at file scope. 7874 if (D->hasGlobalStorage()) 7875 return nullptr; 7876 7877 NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = R.getFoundDecl(); 7878 return isa<VarDecl, FieldDecl, BindingDecl>(ShadowedDecl) ? ShadowedDecl 7879 : nullptr; 7880 } 7881 7882 /// Return the declaration shadowed by the given typedef \p D, or null 7883 /// if it doesn't shadow any declaration or shadowing warnings are disabled. 7884 NamedDecl *Sema::getShadowedDeclaration(const TypedefNameDecl *D, 7885 const LookupResult &R) { 7886 // Don't warn if typedef declaration is part of a class 7887 if (D->getDeclContext()->isRecord()) 7888 return nullptr; 7889 7890 if (!shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(Diags, R)) 7891 return nullptr; 7892 7893 NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = R.getFoundDecl(); 7894 return isa<TypedefNameDecl>(ShadowedDecl) ? ShadowedDecl : nullptr; 7895 } 7896 7897 /// Return the declaration shadowed by the given variable \p D, or null 7898 /// if it doesn't shadow any declaration or shadowing warnings are disabled. 7899 NamedDecl *Sema::getShadowedDeclaration(const BindingDecl *D, 7900 const LookupResult &R) { 7901 if (!shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(Diags, R)) 7902 return nullptr; 7903 7904 NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = R.getFoundDecl(); 7905 return isa<VarDecl, FieldDecl, BindingDecl>(ShadowedDecl) ? ShadowedDecl 7906 : nullptr; 7907 } 7908 7909 /// Diagnose variable or built-in function shadowing. Implements 7910 /// -Wshadow. 7911 /// 7912 /// This method is called whenever a VarDecl is added to a "useful" 7913 /// scope. 7914 /// 7915 /// \param ShadowedDecl the declaration that is shadowed by the given variable 7916 /// \param R the lookup of the name 7917 /// 7918 void Sema::CheckShadow(NamedDecl *D, NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl, 7919 const LookupResult &R) { 7920 DeclContext *NewDC = D->getDeclContext(); 7921 7922 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) { 7923 // Fields are not shadowed by variables in C++ static methods. 7924 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewDC)) 7925 if (MD->isStatic()) 7926 return; 7927 7928 // Fields shadowed by constructor parameters are a special case. Usually 7929 // the constructor initializes the field with the parameter. 7930 if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewDC)) 7931 if (const auto PVD = dyn_cast<ParmVarDecl>(D)) { 7932 // Remember that this was shadowed so we can either warn about its 7933 // modification or its existence depending on warning settings. 7934 ShadowingDecls.insert({PVD->getCanonicalDecl(), FD}); 7935 return; 7936 } 7937 } 7938 7939 if (VarDecl *shadowedVar = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) 7940 if (shadowedVar->isExternC()) { 7941 // For shadowing external vars, make sure that we point to the global 7942 // declaration, not a locally scoped extern declaration. 7943 for (auto I : shadowedVar->redecls()) 7944 if (I->isFileVarDecl()) { 7945 ShadowedDecl = I; 7946 break; 7947 } 7948 } 7949 7950 DeclContext *OldDC = ShadowedDecl->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 7951 7952 unsigned WarningDiag = diag::warn_decl_shadow; 7953 SourceLocation CaptureLoc; 7954 if (isa<VarDecl>(D) && isa<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl) && NewDC && 7955 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewDC)) { 7956 if (const auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(NewDC->getParent())) { 7957 if (RD->isLambda() && OldDC->Encloses(NewDC->getLexicalParent())) { 7958 if (RD->getLambdaCaptureDefault() == LCD_None) { 7959 // Try to avoid warnings for lambdas with an explicit capture list. 7960 const auto *LSI = cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(getCurFunction()); 7961 // Warn only when the lambda captures the shadowed decl explicitly. 7962 CaptureLoc = getCaptureLocation(LSI, cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl)); 7963 if (CaptureLoc.isInvalid()) 7964 WarningDiag = diag::warn_decl_shadow_uncaptured_local; 7965 } else { 7966 // Remember that this was shadowed so we can avoid the warning if the 7967 // shadowed decl isn't captured and the warning settings allow it. 7968 cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(getCurFunction()) 7969 ->ShadowingDecls.push_back( 7970 {cast<VarDecl>(D), cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl)}); 7971 return; 7972 } 7973 } 7974 7975 if (cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl)->hasLocalStorage()) { 7976 // A variable can't shadow a local variable in an enclosing scope, if 7977 // they are separated by a non-capturing declaration context. 7978 for (DeclContext *ParentDC = NewDC; 7979 ParentDC && !ParentDC->Equals(OldDC); 7980 ParentDC = getLambdaAwareParentOfDeclContext(ParentDC)) { 7981 // Only block literals, captured statements, and lambda expressions 7982 // can capture; other scopes don't. 7983 if (!isa<BlockDecl>(ParentDC) && !isa<CapturedDecl>(ParentDC) && 7984 !isLambdaCallOperator(ParentDC)) { 7985 return; 7986 } 7987 } 7988 } 7989 } 7990 } 7991 7992 // Only warn about certain kinds of shadowing for class members. 7993 if (NewDC && NewDC->isRecord()) { 7994 // In particular, don't warn about shadowing non-class members. 7995 if (!OldDC->isRecord()) 7996 return; 7997 7998 // TODO: should we warn about static data members shadowing 7999 // static data members from base classes? 8000 8001 // TODO: don't diagnose for inaccessible shadowed members. 8002 // This is hard to do perfectly because we might friend the 8003 // shadowing context, but that's just a false negative. 8004 } 8005 8006 8007 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName(); 8008 8009 // Emit warning and note. 8010 ShadowedDeclKind Kind = computeShadowedDeclKind(ShadowedDecl, OldDC); 8011 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), WarningDiag) << Name << Kind << OldDC; 8012 if (!CaptureLoc.isInvalid()) 8013 Diag(CaptureLoc, diag::note_var_explicitly_captured_here) 8014 << Name << /*explicitly*/ 1; 8015 Diag(ShadowedDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 8016 } 8017 8018 /// Diagnose shadowing for variables shadowed in the lambda record \p LambdaRD 8019 /// when these variables are captured by the lambda. 8020 void Sema::DiagnoseShadowingLambdaDecls(const LambdaScopeInfo *LSI) { 8021 for (const auto &Shadow : LSI->ShadowingDecls) { 8022 const VarDecl *ShadowedDecl = Shadow.ShadowedDecl; 8023 // Try to avoid the warning when the shadowed decl isn't captured. 8024 SourceLocation CaptureLoc = getCaptureLocation(LSI, ShadowedDecl); 8025 const DeclContext *OldDC = ShadowedDecl->getDeclContext(); 8026 Diag(Shadow.VD->getLocation(), CaptureLoc.isInvalid() 8027 ? diag::warn_decl_shadow_uncaptured_local 8028 : diag::warn_decl_shadow) 8029 << Shadow.VD->getDeclName() 8030 << computeShadowedDeclKind(ShadowedDecl, OldDC) << OldDC; 8031 if (!CaptureLoc.isInvalid()) 8032 Diag(CaptureLoc, diag::note_var_explicitly_captured_here) 8033 << Shadow.VD->getDeclName() << /*explicitly*/ 0; 8034 Diag(ShadowedDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 8035 } 8036 } 8037 8038 /// Check -Wshadow without the advantage of a previous lookup. 8039 void Sema::CheckShadow(Scope *S, VarDecl *D) { 8040 if (Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_decl_shadow, D->getLocation())) 8041 return; 8042 8043 LookupResult R(*this, D->getDeclName(), D->getLocation(), 8044 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName, Sema::ForVisibleRedeclaration); 8045 LookupName(R, S); 8046 if (NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = getShadowedDeclaration(D, R)) 8047 CheckShadow(D, ShadowedDecl, R); 8048 } 8049 8050 /// Check if 'E', which is an expression that is about to be modified, refers 8051 /// to a constructor parameter that shadows a field. 8052 void Sema::CheckShadowingDeclModification(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) { 8053 // Quickly ignore expressions that can't be shadowing ctor parameters. 8054 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || ShadowingDecls.empty()) 8055 return; 8056 E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 8057 auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E); 8058 if (!DRE) 8059 return; 8060 const NamedDecl *D = cast<NamedDecl>(DRE->getDecl()->getCanonicalDecl()); 8061 auto I = ShadowingDecls.find(D); 8062 if (I == ShadowingDecls.end()) 8063 return; 8064 const NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = I->second; 8065 const DeclContext *OldDC = ShadowedDecl->getDeclContext(); 8066 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_modifying_shadowing_decl) << D << OldDC; 8067 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_var_declared_here) << D; 8068 Diag(ShadowedDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 8069 8070 // Avoid issuing multiple warnings about the same decl. 8071 ShadowingDecls.erase(I); 8072 } 8073 8074 /// Check for conflict between this global or extern "C" declaration and 8075 /// previous global or extern "C" declarations. This is only used in C++. 8076 template<typename T> 8077 static bool checkGlobalOrExternCConflict( 8078 Sema &S, const T *ND, bool IsGlobal, LookupResult &Previous) { 8079 assert(S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "only C++ has extern \"C\""); 8080 NamedDecl *Prev = S.findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(ND->getDeclName()); 8081 8082 if (!Prev && IsGlobal && !isIncompleteDeclExternC(S, ND)) { 8083 // The common case: this global doesn't conflict with any extern "C" 8084 // declaration. 8085 return false; 8086 } 8087 8088 if (Prev) { 8089 if (!IsGlobal || isIncompleteDeclExternC(S, ND)) { 8090 // Both the old and new declarations have C language linkage. This is a 8091 // redeclaration. 8092 Previous.clear(); 8093 Previous.addDecl(Prev); 8094 return true; 8095 } 8096 8097 // This is a global, non-extern "C" declaration, and there is a previous 8098 // non-global extern "C" declaration. Diagnose if this is a variable 8099 // declaration. 8100 if (!isa<VarDecl>(ND)) 8101 return false; 8102 } else { 8103 // The declaration is extern "C". Check for any declaration in the 8104 // translation unit which might conflict. 8105 if (IsGlobal) { 8106 // We have already performed the lookup into the translation unit. 8107 IsGlobal = false; 8108 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Previous.begin(), E = Previous.end(); 8109 I != E; ++I) { 8110 if (isa<VarDecl>(*I)) { 8111 Prev = *I; 8112 break; 8113 } 8114 } 8115 } else { 8116 DeclContext::lookup_result R = 8117 S.Context.getTranslationUnitDecl()->lookup(ND->getDeclName()); 8118 for (DeclContext::lookup_result::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); 8119 I != E; ++I) { 8120 if (isa<VarDecl>(*I)) { 8121 Prev = *I; 8122 break; 8123 } 8124 // FIXME: If we have any other entity with this name in global scope, 8125 // the declaration is ill-formed, but that is a defect: it breaks the 8126 // 'stat' hack, for instance. Only variables can have mangled name 8127 // clashes with extern "C" declarations, so only they deserve a 8128 // diagnostic. 8129 } 8130 } 8131 8132 if (!Prev) 8133 return false; 8134 } 8135 8136 // Use the first declaration's location to ensure we point at something which 8137 // is lexically inside an extern "C" linkage-spec. 8138 assert(Prev && "should have found a previous declaration to diagnose"); 8139 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Prev)) 8140 Prev = FD->getFirstDecl(); 8141 else 8142 Prev = cast<VarDecl>(Prev)->getFirstDecl(); 8143 8144 S.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::err_extern_c_global_conflict) 8145 << IsGlobal << ND; 8146 S.Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_extern_c_global_conflict) 8147 << IsGlobal; 8148 return false; 8149 } 8150 8151 /// Apply special rules for handling extern "C" declarations. Returns \c true 8152 /// if we have found that this is a redeclaration of some prior entity. 8153 /// 8154 /// Per C++ [dcl.link]p6: 8155 /// Two declarations [for a function or variable] with C language linkage 8156 /// with the same name that appear in different scopes refer to the same 8157 /// [entity]. An entity with C language linkage shall not be declared with 8158 /// the same name as an entity in global scope. 8159 template<typename T> 8160 static bool checkForConflictWithNonVisibleExternC(Sema &S, const T *ND, 8161 LookupResult &Previous) { 8162 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8163 // In C, when declaring a global variable, look for a corresponding 'extern' 8164 // variable declared in function scope. We don't need this in C++, because 8165 // we find local extern decls in the surrounding file-scope DeclContext. 8166 if (ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) { 8167 if (NamedDecl *Prev = S.findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(ND->getDeclName())) { 8168 Previous.clear(); 8169 Previous.addDecl(Prev); 8170 return true; 8171 } 8172 } 8173 return false; 8174 } 8175 8176 // A declaration in the translation unit can conflict with an extern "C" 8177 // declaration. 8178 if (ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) 8179 return checkGlobalOrExternCConflict(S, ND, /*IsGlobal*/true, Previous); 8180 8181 // An extern "C" declaration can conflict with a declaration in the 8182 // translation unit or can be a redeclaration of an extern "C" declaration 8183 // in another scope. 8184 if (isIncompleteDeclExternC(S,ND)) 8185 return checkGlobalOrExternCConflict(S, ND, /*IsGlobal*/false, Previous); 8186 8187 // Neither global nor extern "C": nothing to do. 8188 return false; 8189 } 8190 8191 void Sema::CheckVariableDeclarationType(VarDecl *NewVD) { 8192 // If the decl is already known invalid, don't check it. 8193 if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl()) 8194 return; 8195 8196 QualType T = NewVD->getType(); 8197 8198 // Defer checking an 'auto' type until its initializer is attached. 8199 if (T->isUndeducedType()) 8200 return; 8201 8202 if (NewVD->hasAttrs()) 8203 CheckAlignasUnderalignment(NewVD); 8204 8205 if (T->isObjCObjectType()) { 8206 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_statically_allocated_object) 8207 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(NewVD->getLocation(), "*"); 8208 T = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(T); 8209 NewVD->setType(T); 8210 } 8211 8212 // Emit an error if an address space was applied to decl with local storage. 8213 // This includes arrays of objects with address space qualifiers, but not 8214 // automatic variables that point to other address spaces. 8215 // ISO/IEC TR 18037 S5.1.2 8216 if (!getLangOpts().OpenCL && NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && 8217 T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::Default) { 8218 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_as_qualified_auto_decl) << 0; 8219 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8220 return; 8221 } 8222 8223 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.8 - The static qualifier is valid only in program 8224 // scope. 8225 if (getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion == 120 && 8226 !getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("cl_clang_storage_class_specifiers", 8227 getLangOpts()) && 8228 NewVD->isStaticLocal()) { 8229 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_static_function_scope); 8230 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8231 return; 8232 } 8233 8234 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 8235 if (!diagnoseOpenCLTypes(*this, NewVD)) 8236 return; 8237 8238 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - The __block storage type is not supported. 8239 if (NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 8240 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_block_storage_type); 8241 return; 8242 } 8243 8244 if (T->isBlockPointerType()) { 8245 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - Any block declaration must be const qualified and 8246 // can't use 'extern' storage class. 8247 if (!T.isConstQualified()) { 8248 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_invalid_block_declaration) 8249 << 0 /*const*/; 8250 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8251 return; 8252 } 8253 if (NewVD->hasExternalStorage()) { 8254 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_extern_block_declaration); 8255 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8256 return; 8257 } 8258 } 8259 8260 // FIXME: Adding local AS in C++ for OpenCL might make sense. 8261 if (NewVD->isFileVarDecl() || NewVD->isStaticLocal() || 8262 NewVD->hasExternalStorage()) { 8263 if (!T->isSamplerT() && !T->isDependentType() && 8264 !(T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant || 8265 (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_global && 8266 getOpenCLOptions().areProgramScopeVariablesSupported( 8267 getLangOpts())))) { 8268 int Scope = NewVD->isStaticLocal() | NewVD->hasExternalStorage() << 1; 8269 if (getOpenCLOptions().areProgramScopeVariablesSupported(getLangOpts())) 8270 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_global_invalid_addr_space) 8271 << Scope << "global or constant"; 8272 else 8273 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_global_invalid_addr_space) 8274 << Scope << "constant"; 8275 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8276 return; 8277 } 8278 } else { 8279 if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_global) { 8280 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_variable) 8281 << 1 /*is any function*/ << "global"; 8282 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8283 return; 8284 } 8285 if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant || 8286 T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local) { 8287 FunctionDecl *FD = getCurFunctionDecl(); 8288 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5.2 and s6.5.3: no local or constant variables 8289 // in functions. 8290 if (FD && !FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) { 8291 if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant) 8292 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_variable) 8293 << 0 /*non-kernel only*/ << "constant"; 8294 else 8295 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_variable) 8296 << 0 /*non-kernel only*/ << "local"; 8297 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8298 return; 8299 } 8300 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.5.2 and s6.5.3: local and constant variables must be 8301 // in the outermost scope of a kernel function. 8302 if (FD && FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) { 8303 if (!getCurScope()->isFunctionScope()) { 8304 if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant) 8305 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_addrspace_scope) 8306 << "constant"; 8307 else 8308 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_addrspace_scope) 8309 << "local"; 8310 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8311 return; 8312 } 8313 } 8314 } else if (T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::opencl_private && 8315 // If we are parsing a template we didn't deduce an addr 8316 // space yet. 8317 T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::Default) { 8318 // Do not allow other address spaces on automatic variable. 8319 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_as_qualified_auto_decl) << 1; 8320 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8321 return; 8322 } 8323 } 8324 } 8325 8326 if (NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && T.isObjCGCWeak() 8327 && !NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 8328 if (getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC) 8329 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::warn_gc_attribute_weak_on_local); 8330 else { 8331 assert(!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 8332 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_weak_on_local); 8333 } 8334 } 8335 8336 bool isVM = T->isVariablyModifiedType(); 8337 if (isVM || NewVD->hasAttr<CleanupAttr>() || 8338 NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) 8339 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 8340 8341 if ((isVM && NewVD->hasLinkage()) || 8342 (T->isVariableArrayType() && NewVD->hasGlobalStorage())) { 8343 bool SizeIsNegative; 8344 llvm::APSInt Oversized; 8345 TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo( 8346 NewVD->getTypeSourceInfo(), Context, SizeIsNegative, Oversized); 8347 QualType FixedT; 8348 if (FixedTInfo && T == NewVD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getType()) 8349 FixedT = FixedTInfo->getType(); 8350 else if (FixedTInfo) { 8351 // Type and type-as-written are canonically different. We need to fix up 8352 // both types separately. 8353 FixedT = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(T, Context, SizeIsNegative, 8354 Oversized); 8355 } 8356 if ((!FixedTInfo || FixedT.isNull()) && T->isVariableArrayType()) { 8357 const VariableArrayType *VAT = Context.getAsVariableArrayType(T); 8358 // FIXME: This won't give the correct result for 8359 // int a[10][n]; 8360 SourceRange SizeRange = VAT->getSizeExpr()->getSourceRange(); 8361 8362 if (NewVD->isFileVarDecl()) 8363 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_in_file_scope) 8364 << SizeRange; 8365 else if (NewVD->isStaticLocal()) 8366 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_has_static_storage) 8367 << SizeRange; 8368 else 8369 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_has_extern_linkage) 8370 << SizeRange; 8371 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8372 return; 8373 } 8374 8375 if (!FixedTInfo) { 8376 if (NewVD->isFileVarDecl()) 8377 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_decl_in_file_scope); 8378 else 8379 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_decl_has_extern_linkage); 8380 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8381 return; 8382 } 8383 8384 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::ext_vla_folded_to_constant); 8385 NewVD->setType(FixedT); 8386 NewVD->setTypeSourceInfo(FixedTInfo); 8387 } 8388 8389 if (T->isVoidType()) { 8390 // C++98 [dcl.stc]p5: The extern specifier can be applied only to the names 8391 // of objects and functions. 8392 if (NewVD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8393 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type) 8394 << T; 8395 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8396 return; 8397 } 8398 } 8399 8400 if (!NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 8401 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_block_on_nonlocal); 8402 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8403 return; 8404 } 8405 8406 if (!NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && T->isSizelessType()) { 8407 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_sizeless_nonlocal) << T; 8408 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8409 return; 8410 } 8411 8412 if (isVM && NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 8413 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_block_on_vm); 8414 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8415 return; 8416 } 8417 8418 if (NewVD->isConstexpr() && !T->isDependentType() && 8419 RequireLiteralType(NewVD->getLocation(), T, 8420 diag::err_constexpr_var_non_literal)) { 8421 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8422 return; 8423 } 8424 8425 // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as non-local variable types. 8426 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() && 8427 !NewVD->isLocalVarDecl() && 8428 CheckPPCMMAType(T, NewVD->getLocation())) { 8429 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8430 return; 8431 } 8432 } 8433 8434 /// Perform semantic checking on a newly-created variable 8435 /// declaration. 8436 /// 8437 /// This routine performs all of the type-checking required for a 8438 /// variable declaration once it has been built. It is used both to 8439 /// check variables after they have been parsed and their declarators 8440 /// have been translated into a declaration, and to check variables 8441 /// that have been instantiated from a template. 8442 /// 8443 /// Sets NewVD->isInvalidDecl() if an error was encountered. 8444 /// 8445 /// Returns true if the variable declaration is a redeclaration. 8446 bool Sema::CheckVariableDeclaration(VarDecl *NewVD, LookupResult &Previous) { 8447 CheckVariableDeclarationType(NewVD); 8448 8449 // If the decl is already known invalid, don't check it. 8450 if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl()) 8451 return false; 8452 8453 // If we did not find anything by this name, look for a non-visible 8454 // extern "C" declaration with the same name. 8455 if (Previous.empty() && 8456 checkForConflictWithNonVisibleExternC(*this, NewVD, Previous)) 8457 Previous.setShadowed(); 8458 8459 if (!Previous.empty()) { 8460 MergeVarDecl(NewVD, Previous); 8461 return true; 8462 } 8463 return false; 8464 } 8465 8466 /// AddOverriddenMethods - See if a method overrides any in the base classes, 8467 /// and if so, check that it's a valid override and remember it. 8468 bool Sema::AddOverriddenMethods(CXXRecordDecl *DC, CXXMethodDecl *MD) { 8469 llvm::SmallPtrSet<const CXXMethodDecl*, 4> Overridden; 8470 8471 // Look for methods in base classes that this method might override. 8472 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/false, 8473 /*DetectVirtual=*/false); 8474 auto VisitBase = [&] (const CXXBaseSpecifier *Specifier, CXXBasePath &Path) { 8475 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = Specifier->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 8476 DeclarationName Name = MD->getDeclName(); 8477 8478 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) { 8479 // We really want to find the base class destructor here. 8480 QualType T = Context.getTypeDeclType(BaseRecord); 8481 CanQualType CT = Context.getCanonicalType(T); 8482 Name = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDestructorName(CT); 8483 } 8484 8485 for (NamedDecl *BaseND : BaseRecord->lookup(Name)) { 8486 CXXMethodDecl *BaseMD = 8487 dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(BaseND->getCanonicalDecl()); 8488 if (!BaseMD || !BaseMD->isVirtual() || 8489 IsOverload(MD, BaseMD, /*UseMemberUsingDeclRules=*/false, 8490 /*ConsiderCudaAttrs=*/true, 8491 // C++2a [class.virtual]p2 does not consider requires 8492 // clauses when overriding. 8493 /*ConsiderRequiresClauses=*/false)) 8494 continue; 8495 8496 if (Overridden.insert(BaseMD).second) { 8497 MD->addOverriddenMethod(BaseMD); 8498 CheckOverridingFunctionReturnType(MD, BaseMD); 8499 CheckOverridingFunctionAttributes(MD, BaseMD); 8500 CheckOverridingFunctionExceptionSpec(MD, BaseMD); 8501 CheckIfOverriddenFunctionIsMarkedFinal(MD, BaseMD); 8502 } 8503 8504 // A method can only override one function from each base class. We 8505 // don't track indirectly overridden methods from bases of bases. 8506 return true; 8507 } 8508 8509 return false; 8510 }; 8511 8512 DC->lookupInBases(VisitBase, Paths); 8513 return !Overridden.empty(); 8514 } 8515 8516 namespace { 8517 // Struct for holding all of the extra arguments needed by 8518 // DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration to call Sema::ActOnFunctionDeclarator. 8519 struct ActOnFDArgs { 8520 Scope *S; 8521 Declarator &D; 8522 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists; 8523 bool AddToScope; 8524 }; 8525 } // end anonymous namespace 8526 8527 namespace { 8528 8529 // Callback to only accept typo corrections that have a non-zero edit distance. 8530 // Also only accept corrections that have the same parent decl. 8531 class DifferentNameValidatorCCC final : public CorrectionCandidateCallback { 8532 public: 8533 DifferentNameValidatorCCC(ASTContext &Context, FunctionDecl *TypoFD, 8534 CXXRecordDecl *Parent) 8535 : Context(Context), OriginalFD(TypoFD), 8536 ExpectedParent(Parent ? Parent->getCanonicalDecl() : nullptr) {} 8537 8538 bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) override { 8539 if (candidate.getEditDistance() == 0) 8540 return false; 8541 8542 SmallVector<unsigned, 1> MismatchedParams; 8543 for (TypoCorrection::const_decl_iterator CDecl = candidate.begin(), 8544 CDeclEnd = candidate.end(); 8545 CDecl != CDeclEnd; ++CDecl) { 8546 FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*CDecl); 8547 8548 if (FD && !FD->hasBody() && 8549 hasSimilarParameters(Context, FD, OriginalFD, MismatchedParams)) { 8550 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) { 8551 CXXRecordDecl *Parent = MD->getParent(); 8552 if (Parent && Parent->getCanonicalDecl() == ExpectedParent) 8553 return true; 8554 } else if (!ExpectedParent) { 8555 return true; 8556 } 8557 } 8558 } 8559 8560 return false; 8561 } 8562 8563 std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> clone() override { 8564 return std::make_unique<DifferentNameValidatorCCC>(*this); 8565 } 8566 8567 private: 8568 ASTContext &Context; 8569 FunctionDecl *OriginalFD; 8570 CXXRecordDecl *ExpectedParent; 8571 }; 8572 8573 } // end anonymous namespace 8574 8575 void Sema::MarkTypoCorrectedFunctionDefinition(const NamedDecl *F) { 8576 TypoCorrectedFunctionDefinitions.insert(F); 8577 } 8578 8579 /// Generate diagnostics for an invalid function redeclaration. 8580 /// 8581 /// This routine handles generating the diagnostic messages for an invalid 8582 /// function redeclaration, including finding possible similar declarations 8583 /// or performing typo correction if there are no previous declarations with 8584 /// the same name. 8585 /// 8586 /// Returns a NamedDecl iff typo correction was performed and substituting in 8587 /// the new declaration name does not cause new errors. 8588 static NamedDecl *DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration( 8589 Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &Previous, FunctionDecl *NewFD, 8590 ActOnFDArgs &ExtraArgs, bool IsLocalFriend, Scope *S) { 8591 DeclarationName Name = NewFD->getDeclName(); 8592 DeclContext *NewDC = NewFD->getDeclContext(); 8593 SmallVector<unsigned, 1> MismatchedParams; 8594 SmallVector<std::pair<FunctionDecl *, unsigned>, 1> NearMatches; 8595 TypoCorrection Correction; 8596 bool IsDefinition = ExtraArgs.D.isFunctionDefinition(); 8597 unsigned DiagMsg = 8598 IsLocalFriend ? diag::err_no_matching_local_friend : 8599 NewFD->getFriendObjectKind() ? diag::err_qualified_friend_no_match : 8600 diag::err_member_decl_does_not_match; 8601 LookupResult Prev(SemaRef, Name, NewFD->getLocation(), 8602 IsLocalFriend ? Sema::LookupLocalFriendName 8603 : Sema::LookupOrdinaryName, 8604 Sema::ForVisibleRedeclaration); 8605 8606 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 8607 if (IsLocalFriend) 8608 SemaRef.LookupName(Prev, S); 8609 else 8610 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(Prev, NewDC); 8611 assert(!Prev.isAmbiguous() && 8612 "Cannot have an ambiguity in previous-declaration lookup"); 8613 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD); 8614 DifferentNameValidatorCCC CCC(SemaRef.Context, NewFD, 8615 MD ? MD->getParent() : nullptr); 8616 if (!Prev.empty()) { 8617 for (LookupResult::iterator Func = Prev.begin(), FuncEnd = Prev.end(); 8618 Func != FuncEnd; ++Func) { 8619 FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*Func); 8620 if (FD && 8621 hasSimilarParameters(SemaRef.Context, FD, NewFD, MismatchedParams)) { 8622 // Add 1 to the index so that 0 can mean the mismatch didn't 8623 // involve a parameter 8624 unsigned ParamNum = 8625 MismatchedParams.empty() ? 0 : MismatchedParams.front() + 1; 8626 NearMatches.push_back(std::make_pair(FD, ParamNum)); 8627 } 8628 } 8629 // If the qualified name lookup yielded nothing, try typo correction 8630 } else if ((Correction = SemaRef.CorrectTypo( 8631 Prev.getLookupNameInfo(), Prev.getLookupKind(), S, 8632 &ExtraArgs.D.getCXXScopeSpec(), CCC, Sema::CTK_ErrorRecovery, 8633 IsLocalFriend ? nullptr : NewDC))) { 8634 // Set up everything for the call to ActOnFunctionDeclarator 8635 ExtraArgs.D.SetIdentifier(Correction.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(), 8636 ExtraArgs.D.getIdentifierLoc()); 8637 Previous.clear(); 8638 Previous.setLookupName(Correction.getCorrection()); 8639 for (TypoCorrection::decl_iterator CDecl = Correction.begin(), 8640 CDeclEnd = Correction.end(); 8641 CDecl != CDeclEnd; ++CDecl) { 8642 FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*CDecl); 8643 if (FD && !FD->hasBody() && 8644 hasSimilarParameters(SemaRef.Context, FD, NewFD, MismatchedParams)) { 8645 Previous.addDecl(FD); 8646 } 8647 } 8648 bool wasRedeclaration = ExtraArgs.D.isRedeclaration(); 8649 8650 NamedDecl *Result; 8651 // Retry building the function declaration with the new previous 8652 // declarations, and with errors suppressed. 8653 { 8654 // Trap errors. 8655 Sema::SFINAETrap Trap(SemaRef); 8656 8657 // TODO: Refactor ActOnFunctionDeclarator so that we can call only the 8658 // pieces need to verify the typo-corrected C++ declaration and hopefully 8659 // eliminate the need for the parameter pack ExtraArgs. 8660 Result = SemaRef.ActOnFunctionDeclarator( 8661 ExtraArgs.S, ExtraArgs.D, 8662 Correction.getCorrectionDecl()->getDeclContext(), 8663 NewFD->getTypeSourceInfo(), Previous, ExtraArgs.TemplateParamLists, 8664 ExtraArgs.AddToScope); 8665 8666 if (Trap.hasErrorOccurred()) 8667 Result = nullptr; 8668 } 8669 8670 if (Result) { 8671 // Determine which correction we picked. 8672 Decl *Canonical = Result->getCanonicalDecl(); 8673 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Previous.begin(), E = Previous.end(); 8674 I != E; ++I) 8675 if ((*I)->getCanonicalDecl() == Canonical) 8676 Correction.setCorrectionDecl(*I); 8677 8678 // Let Sema know about the correction. 8679 SemaRef.MarkTypoCorrectedFunctionDefinition(Result); 8680 SemaRef.diagnoseTypo( 8681 Correction, 8682 SemaRef.PDiag(IsLocalFriend 8683 ? diag::err_no_matching_local_friend_suggest 8684 : diag::err_member_decl_does_not_match_suggest) 8685 << Name << NewDC << IsDefinition); 8686 return Result; 8687 } 8688 8689 // Pretend the typo correction never occurred 8690 ExtraArgs.D.SetIdentifier(Name.getAsIdentifierInfo(), 8691 ExtraArgs.D.getIdentifierLoc()); 8692 ExtraArgs.D.setRedeclaration(wasRedeclaration); 8693 Previous.clear(); 8694 Previous.setLookupName(Name); 8695 } 8696 8697 SemaRef.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), DiagMsg) 8698 << Name << NewDC << IsDefinition << NewFD->getLocation(); 8699 8700 bool NewFDisConst = false; 8701 if (CXXMethodDecl *NewMD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) 8702 NewFDisConst = NewMD->isConst(); 8703 8704 for (SmallVectorImpl<std::pair<FunctionDecl *, unsigned> >::iterator 8705 NearMatch = NearMatches.begin(), NearMatchEnd = NearMatches.end(); 8706 NearMatch != NearMatchEnd; ++NearMatch) { 8707 FunctionDecl *FD = NearMatch->first; 8708 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD); 8709 bool FDisConst = MD && MD->isConst(); 8710 bool IsMember = MD || !IsLocalFriend; 8711 8712 // FIXME: These notes are poorly worded for the local friend case. 8713 if (unsigned Idx = NearMatch->second) { 8714 ParmVarDecl *FDParam = FD->getParamDecl(Idx-1); 8715 SourceLocation Loc = FDParam->getTypeSpecStartLoc(); 8716 if (Loc.isInvalid()) Loc = FD->getLocation(); 8717 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, IsMember ? diag::note_member_def_close_param_match 8718 : diag::note_local_decl_close_param_match) 8719 << Idx << FDParam->getType() 8720 << NewFD->getParamDecl(Idx - 1)->getType(); 8721 } else if (FDisConst != NewFDisConst) { 8722 SemaRef.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_member_def_close_const_match) 8723 << NewFDisConst << FD->getSourceRange().getEnd() 8724 << (NewFDisConst 8725 ? FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ExtraArgs.D.getFunctionTypeInfo() 8726 .getConstQualifierLoc()) 8727 : FixItHint::CreateInsertion(ExtraArgs.D.getFunctionTypeInfo() 8728 .getRParenLoc() 8729 .getLocWithOffset(1), 8730 " const")); 8731 } else 8732 SemaRef.Diag(FD->getLocation(), 8733 IsMember ? diag::note_member_def_close_match 8734 : diag::note_local_decl_close_match); 8735 } 8736 return nullptr; 8737 } 8738 8739 static StorageClass getFunctionStorageClass(Sema &SemaRef, Declarator &D) { 8740 switch (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec()) { 8741 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown storage class!"); 8742 case DeclSpec::SCS_auto: 8743 case DeclSpec::SCS_register: 8744 case DeclSpec::SCS_mutable: 8745 SemaRef.Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 8746 diag::err_typecheck_sclass_func); 8747 D.getMutableDeclSpec().ClearStorageClassSpecs(); 8748 D.setInvalidType(); 8749 break; 8750 case DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified: break; 8751 case DeclSpec::SCS_extern: 8752 if (D.getDeclSpec().isExternInLinkageSpec()) 8753 return SC_None; 8754 return SC_Extern; 8755 case DeclSpec::SCS_static: { 8756 if (SemaRef.CurContext->getRedeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()) { 8757 // C99 6.7.1p5: 8758 // The declaration of an identifier for a function that has 8759 // block scope shall have no explicit storage-class specifier 8760 // other than extern 8761 // See also (C++ [dcl.stc]p4). 8762 SemaRef.Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 8763 diag::err_static_block_func); 8764 break; 8765 } else 8766 return SC_Static; 8767 } 8768 case DeclSpec::SCS_private_extern: return SC_PrivateExtern; 8769 } 8770 8771 // No explicit storage class has already been returned 8772 return SC_None; 8773 } 8774 8775 static FunctionDecl *CreateNewFunctionDecl(Sema &SemaRef, Declarator &D, 8776 DeclContext *DC, QualType &R, 8777 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 8778 StorageClass SC, 8779 bool &IsVirtualOkay) { 8780 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameForDeclarator(D); 8781 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName(); 8782 8783 FunctionDecl *NewFD = nullptr; 8784 bool isInline = D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified(); 8785 8786 if (!SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8787 // Determine whether the function was written with a prototype. This is 8788 // true when: 8789 // - there is a prototype in the declarator, or 8790 // - the type R of the function is some kind of typedef or other non- 8791 // attributed reference to a type name (which eventually refers to a 8792 // function type). Note, we can't always look at the adjusted type to 8793 // check this case because attributes may cause a non-function 8794 // declarator to still have a function type. e.g., 8795 // typedef void func(int a); 8796 // __attribute__((noreturn)) func other_func; // This has a prototype 8797 bool HasPrototype = 8798 (D.isFunctionDeclarator() && D.getFunctionTypeInfo().hasPrototype) || 8799 (D.getDeclSpec().isTypeRep() && 8800 D.getDeclSpec().getRepAsType().get()->isFunctionProtoType()) || 8801 (!R->getAsAdjusted<FunctionType>() && R->isFunctionProtoType()); 8802 assert( 8803 (HasPrototype || !SemaRef.getLangOpts().requiresStrictPrototypes()) && 8804 "Strict prototypes are required"); 8805 8806 NewFD = FunctionDecl::Create( 8807 SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, TInfo, SC, 8808 SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline, HasPrototype, 8809 ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified, 8810 /*TrailingRequiresClause=*/nullptr); 8811 if (D.isInvalidType()) 8812 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 8813 8814 return NewFD; 8815 } 8816 8817 ExplicitSpecifier ExplicitSpecifier = D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecifier(); 8818 8819 ConstexprSpecKind ConstexprKind = D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier(); 8820 if (ConstexprKind == ConstexprSpecKind::Constinit) { 8821 SemaRef.Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), 8822 diag::err_constexpr_wrong_decl_kind) 8823 << static_cast<int>(ConstexprKind); 8824 ConstexprKind = ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified; 8825 D.getMutableDeclSpec().ClearConstexprSpec(); 8826 } 8827 Expr *TrailingRequiresClause = D.getTrailingRequiresClause(); 8828 8829 // Check that the return type is not an abstract class type. 8830 // For record types, this is done by the AbstractClassUsageDiagnoser once 8831 // the class has been completely parsed. 8832 if (!DC->isRecord() && 8833 SemaRef.RequireNonAbstractType( 8834 D.getIdentifierLoc(), R->castAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), 8835 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, SemaRef.AbstractReturnType)) 8836 D.setInvalidType(); 8837 8838 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConstructorName) { 8839 // This is a C++ constructor declaration. 8840 assert(DC->isRecord() && 8841 "Constructors can only be declared in a member context"); 8842 8843 R = SemaRef.CheckConstructorDeclarator(D, R, SC); 8844 return CXXConstructorDecl::Create( 8845 SemaRef.Context, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC), D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, 8846 TInfo, ExplicitSpecifier, SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), 8847 isInline, /*isImplicitlyDeclared=*/false, ConstexprKind, 8848 InheritedConstructor(), TrailingRequiresClause); 8849 8850 } else if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) { 8851 // This is a C++ destructor declaration. 8852 if (DC->isRecord()) { 8853 R = SemaRef.CheckDestructorDeclarator(D, R, SC); 8854 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC); 8855 CXXDestructorDecl *NewDD = CXXDestructorDecl::Create( 8856 SemaRef.Context, Record, D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, TInfo, 8857 SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline, 8858 /*isImplicitlyDeclared=*/false, ConstexprKind, 8859 TrailingRequiresClause); 8860 // User defined destructors start as not selected if the class definition is still 8861 // not done. 8862 if (Record->isBeingDefined()) 8863 NewDD->setIneligibleOrNotSelected(true); 8864 8865 // If the destructor needs an implicit exception specification, set it 8866 // now. FIXME: It'd be nice to be able to create the right type to start 8867 // with, but the type needs to reference the destructor declaration. 8868 if (SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 8869 SemaRef.AdjustDestructorExceptionSpec(NewDD); 8870 8871 IsVirtualOkay = true; 8872 return NewDD; 8873 8874 } else { 8875 SemaRef.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_destructor_not_member); 8876 D.setInvalidType(); 8877 8878 // Create a FunctionDecl to satisfy the function definition parsing 8879 // code path. 8880 return FunctionDecl::Create( 8881 SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(), Name, R, 8882 TInfo, SC, SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline, 8883 /*hasPrototype=*/true, ConstexprKind, TrailingRequiresClause); 8884 } 8885 8886 } else if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) { 8887 if (!DC->isRecord()) { 8888 SemaRef.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 8889 diag::err_conv_function_not_member); 8890 return nullptr; 8891 } 8892 8893 SemaRef.CheckConversionDeclarator(D, R, SC); 8894 if (D.isInvalidType()) 8895 return nullptr; 8896 8897 IsVirtualOkay = true; 8898 return CXXConversionDecl::Create( 8899 SemaRef.Context, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC), D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, 8900 TInfo, SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline, 8901 ExplicitSpecifier, ConstexprKind, SourceLocation(), 8902 TrailingRequiresClause); 8903 8904 } else if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDeductionGuideName) { 8905 if (TrailingRequiresClause) 8906 SemaRef.Diag(TrailingRequiresClause->getBeginLoc(), 8907 diag::err_trailing_requires_clause_on_deduction_guide) 8908 << TrailingRequiresClause->getSourceRange(); 8909 SemaRef.CheckDeductionGuideDeclarator(D, R, SC); 8910 8911 return CXXDeductionGuideDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), 8912 ExplicitSpecifier, NameInfo, R, TInfo, 8913 D.getEndLoc()); 8914 } else if (DC->isRecord()) { 8915 // If the name of the function is the same as the name of the record, 8916 // then this must be an invalid constructor that has a return type. 8917 // (The parser checks for a return type and makes the declarator a 8918 // constructor if it has no return type). 8919 if (Name.getAsIdentifierInfo() && 8920 Name.getAsIdentifierInfo() == cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getIdentifier()){ 8921 SemaRef.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_constructor_return_type) 8922 << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getTypeSpecTypeLoc()) 8923 << SourceRange(D.getIdentifierLoc()); 8924 return nullptr; 8925 } 8926 8927 // This is a C++ method declaration. 8928 CXXMethodDecl *Ret = CXXMethodDecl::Create( 8929 SemaRef.Context, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC), D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, 8930 TInfo, SC, SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline, 8931 ConstexprKind, SourceLocation(), TrailingRequiresClause); 8932 IsVirtualOkay = !Ret->isStatic(); 8933 return Ret; 8934 } else { 8935 bool isFriend = 8936 SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified(); 8937 if (!isFriend && SemaRef.CurContext->isRecord()) 8938 return nullptr; 8939 8940 // Determine whether the function was written with a 8941 // prototype. This true when: 8942 // - we're in C++ (where every function has a prototype), 8943 return FunctionDecl::Create( 8944 SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, TInfo, SC, 8945 SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline, 8946 true /*HasPrototype*/, ConstexprKind, TrailingRequiresClause); 8947 } 8948 } 8949 8950 enum OpenCLParamType { 8951 ValidKernelParam, 8952 PtrPtrKernelParam, 8953 PtrKernelParam, 8954 InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam, 8955 InvalidKernelParam, 8956 RecordKernelParam 8957 }; 8958 8959 static bool isOpenCLSizeDependentType(ASTContext &C, QualType Ty) { 8960 // Size dependent types are just typedefs to normal integer types 8961 // (e.g. unsigned long), so we cannot distinguish them from other typedefs to 8962 // integers other than by their names. 8963 StringRef SizeTypeNames[] = {"size_t", "intptr_t", "uintptr_t", "ptrdiff_t"}; 8964 8965 // Remove typedefs one by one until we reach a typedef 8966 // for a size dependent type. 8967 QualType DesugaredTy = Ty; 8968 do { 8969 ArrayRef<StringRef> Names(SizeTypeNames); 8970 auto Match = llvm::find(Names, DesugaredTy.getUnqualifiedType().getAsString()); 8971 if (Names.end() != Match) 8972 return true; 8973 8974 Ty = DesugaredTy; 8975 DesugaredTy = Ty.getSingleStepDesugaredType(C); 8976 } while (DesugaredTy != Ty); 8977 8978 return false; 8979 } 8980 8981 static OpenCLParamType getOpenCLKernelParameterType(Sema &S, QualType PT) { 8982 if (PT->isDependentType()) 8983 return InvalidKernelParam; 8984 8985 if (PT->isPointerType() || PT->isReferenceType()) { 8986 QualType PointeeType = PT->getPointeeType(); 8987 if (PointeeType.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_generic || 8988 PointeeType.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_private || 8989 PointeeType.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::Default) 8990 return InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam; 8991 8992 if (PointeeType->isPointerType()) { 8993 // This is a pointer to pointer parameter. 8994 // Recursively check inner type. 8995 OpenCLParamType ParamKind = getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, PointeeType); 8996 if (ParamKind == InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam || 8997 ParamKind == InvalidKernelParam) 8998 return ParamKind; 8999 9000 return PtrPtrKernelParam; 9001 } 9002 9003 // C++ for OpenCL v1.0 s2.4: 9004 // Moreover the types used in parameters of the kernel functions must be: 9005 // Standard layout types for pointer parameters. The same applies to 9006 // reference if an implementation supports them in kernel parameters. 9007 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus && 9008 !S.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption( 9009 "__cl_clang_non_portable_kernel_param_types", S.getLangOpts()) && 9010 !PointeeType->isAtomicType() && !PointeeType->isVoidType() && 9011 !PointeeType->isStandardLayoutType()) 9012 return InvalidKernelParam; 9013 9014 return PtrKernelParam; 9015 } 9016 9017 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.k: 9018 // Arguments to kernel functions in a program cannot be declared with the 9019 // built-in scalar types bool, half, size_t, ptrdiff_t, intptr_t, and 9020 // uintptr_t or a struct and/or union that contain fields declared to be one 9021 // of these built-in scalar types. 9022 if (isOpenCLSizeDependentType(S.getASTContext(), PT)) 9023 return InvalidKernelParam; 9024 9025 if (PT->isImageType()) 9026 return PtrKernelParam; 9027 9028 if (PT->isBooleanType() || PT->isEventT() || PT->isReserveIDT()) 9029 return InvalidKernelParam; 9030 9031 // OpenCL extension spec v1.2 s9.5: 9032 // This extension adds support for half scalar and vector types as built-in 9033 // types that can be used for arithmetic operations, conversions etc. 9034 if (!S.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("cl_khr_fp16", S.getLangOpts()) && 9035 PT->isHalfType()) 9036 return InvalidKernelParam; 9037 9038 // Look into an array argument to check if it has a forbidden type. 9039 if (PT->isArrayType()) { 9040 const Type *UnderlyingTy = PT->getPointeeOrArrayElementType(); 9041 // Call ourself to check an underlying type of an array. Since the 9042 // getPointeeOrArrayElementType returns an innermost type which is not an 9043 // array, this recursive call only happens once. 9044 return getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, QualType(UnderlyingTy, 0)); 9045 } 9046 9047 // C++ for OpenCL v1.0 s2.4: 9048 // Moreover the types used in parameters of the kernel functions must be: 9049 // Trivial and standard-layout types C++17 [basic.types] (plain old data 9050 // types) for parameters passed by value; 9051 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus && 9052 !S.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption( 9053 "__cl_clang_non_portable_kernel_param_types", S.getLangOpts()) && 9054 !PT->isOpenCLSpecificType() && !PT.isPODType(S.Context)) 9055 return InvalidKernelParam; 9056 9057 if (PT->isRecordType()) 9058 return RecordKernelParam; 9059 9060 return ValidKernelParam; 9061 } 9062 9063 static void checkIsValidOpenCLKernelParameter( 9064 Sema &S, 9065 Declarator &D, 9066 ParmVarDecl *Param, 9067 llvm::SmallPtrSetImpl<const Type *> &ValidTypes) { 9068 QualType PT = Param->getType(); 9069 9070 // Cache the valid types we encounter to avoid rechecking structs that are 9071 // used again 9072 if (ValidTypes.count(PT.getTypePtr())) 9073 return; 9074 9075 switch (getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, PT)) { 9076 case PtrPtrKernelParam: 9077 // OpenCL v3.0 s6.11.a: 9078 // A kernel function argument cannot be declared as a pointer to a pointer 9079 // type. [...] This restriction only applies to OpenCL C 1.2 or below. 9080 if (S.getLangOpts().getOpenCLCompatibleVersion() <= 120) { 9081 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_ptrptr_kernel_param); 9082 D.setInvalidType(); 9083 return; 9084 } 9085 9086 ValidTypes.insert(PT.getTypePtr()); 9087 return; 9088 9089 case InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam: 9090 // OpenCL v1.0 s6.5: 9091 // __kernel function arguments declared to be a pointer of a type can point 9092 // to one of the following address spaces only : __global, __local or 9093 // __constant. 9094 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_kernel_arg_address_space); 9095 D.setInvalidType(); 9096 return; 9097 9098 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.k: 9099 // Arguments to kernel functions in a program cannot be declared with the 9100 // built-in scalar types bool, half, size_t, ptrdiff_t, intptr_t, and 9101 // uintptr_t or a struct and/or union that contain fields declared to be 9102 // one of these built-in scalar types. 9103 9104 case InvalidKernelParam: 9105 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.8 n: 9106 // A kernel function argument cannot be declared 9107 // of event_t type. 9108 // Do not diagnose half type since it is diagnosed as invalid argument 9109 // type for any function elsewhere. 9110 if (!PT->isHalfType()) { 9111 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_kernel_param_type) << PT; 9112 9113 // Explain what typedefs are involved. 9114 const TypedefType *Typedef = nullptr; 9115 while ((Typedef = PT->getAs<TypedefType>())) { 9116 SourceLocation Loc = Typedef->getDecl()->getLocation(); 9117 // SourceLocation may be invalid for a built-in type. 9118 if (Loc.isValid()) 9119 S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_entity_declared_at) << PT; 9120 PT = Typedef->desugar(); 9121 } 9122 } 9123 9124 D.setInvalidType(); 9125 return; 9126 9127 case PtrKernelParam: 9128 case ValidKernelParam: 9129 ValidTypes.insert(PT.getTypePtr()); 9130 return; 9131 9132 case RecordKernelParam: 9133 break; 9134 } 9135 9136 // Track nested structs we will inspect 9137 SmallVector<const Decl *, 4> VisitStack; 9138 9139 // Track where we are in the nested structs. Items will migrate from 9140 // VisitStack to HistoryStack as we do the DFS for bad field. 9141 SmallVector<const FieldDecl *, 4> HistoryStack; 9142 HistoryStack.push_back(nullptr); 9143 9144 // At this point we already handled everything except of a RecordType or 9145 // an ArrayType of a RecordType. 9146 assert((PT->isArrayType() || PT->isRecordType()) && "Unexpected type."); 9147 const RecordType *RecTy = 9148 PT->getPointeeOrArrayElementType()->getAs<RecordType>(); 9149 const RecordDecl *OrigRecDecl = RecTy->getDecl(); 9150 9151 VisitStack.push_back(RecTy->getDecl()); 9152 assert(VisitStack.back() && "First decl null?"); 9153 9154 do { 9155 const Decl *Next = VisitStack.pop_back_val(); 9156 if (!Next) { 9157 assert(!HistoryStack.empty()); 9158 // Found a marker, we have gone up a level 9159 if (const FieldDecl *Hist = HistoryStack.pop_back_val()) 9160 ValidTypes.insert(Hist->getType().getTypePtr()); 9161 9162 continue; 9163 } 9164 9165 // Adds everything except the original parameter declaration (which is not a 9166 // field itself) to the history stack. 9167 const RecordDecl *RD; 9168 if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(Next)) { 9169 HistoryStack.push_back(Field); 9170 9171 QualType FieldTy = Field->getType(); 9172 // Other field types (known to be valid or invalid) are handled while we 9173 // walk around RecordDecl::fields(). 9174 assert((FieldTy->isArrayType() || FieldTy->isRecordType()) && 9175 "Unexpected type."); 9176 const Type *FieldRecTy = FieldTy->getPointeeOrArrayElementType(); 9177 9178 RD = FieldRecTy->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl(); 9179 } else { 9180 RD = cast<RecordDecl>(Next); 9181 } 9182 9183 // Add a null marker so we know when we've gone back up a level 9184 VisitStack.push_back(nullptr); 9185 9186 for (const auto *FD : RD->fields()) { 9187 QualType QT = FD->getType(); 9188 9189 if (ValidTypes.count(QT.getTypePtr())) 9190 continue; 9191 9192 OpenCLParamType ParamType = getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, QT); 9193 if (ParamType == ValidKernelParam) 9194 continue; 9195 9196 if (ParamType == RecordKernelParam) { 9197 VisitStack.push_back(FD); 9198 continue; 9199 } 9200 9201 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.p: 9202 // Arguments to kernel functions that are declared to be a struct or union 9203 // do not allow OpenCL objects to be passed as elements of the struct or 9204 // union. 9205 if (ParamType == PtrKernelParam || ParamType == PtrPtrKernelParam || 9206 ParamType == InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam) { 9207 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), 9208 diag::err_record_with_pointers_kernel_param) 9209 << PT->isUnionType() 9210 << PT; 9211 } else { 9212 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_kernel_param_type) << PT; 9213 } 9214 9215 S.Diag(OrigRecDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_within_field_of_type) 9216 << OrigRecDecl->getDeclName(); 9217 9218 // We have an error, now let's go back up through history and show where 9219 // the offending field came from 9220 for (ArrayRef<const FieldDecl *>::const_iterator 9221 I = HistoryStack.begin() + 1, 9222 E = HistoryStack.end(); 9223 I != E; ++I) { 9224 const FieldDecl *OuterField = *I; 9225 S.Diag(OuterField->getLocation(), diag::note_within_field_of_type) 9226 << OuterField->getType(); 9227 } 9228 9229 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_illegal_field_declared_here) 9230 << QT->isPointerType() 9231 << QT; 9232 D.setInvalidType(); 9233 return; 9234 } 9235 } while (!VisitStack.empty()); 9236 } 9237 9238 /// Find the DeclContext in which a tag is implicitly declared if we see an 9239 /// elaborated type specifier in the specified context, and lookup finds 9240 /// nothing. 9241 static DeclContext *getTagInjectionContext(DeclContext *DC) { 9242 while (!DC->isFileContext() && !DC->isFunctionOrMethod()) 9243 DC = DC->getParent(); 9244 return DC; 9245 } 9246 9247 /// Find the Scope in which a tag is implicitly declared if we see an 9248 /// elaborated type specifier in the specified context, and lookup finds 9249 /// nothing. 9250 static Scope *getTagInjectionScope(Scope *S, const LangOptions &LangOpts) { 9251 while (S->isClassScope() || 9252 (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && 9253 S->isFunctionPrototypeScope()) || 9254 ((S->getFlags() & Scope::DeclScope) == 0) || 9255 (S->getEntity() && S->getEntity()->isTransparentContext())) 9256 S = S->getParent(); 9257 return S; 9258 } 9259 9260 /// Determine whether a declaration matches a known function in namespace std. 9261 static bool isStdBuiltin(ASTContext &Ctx, FunctionDecl *FD, 9262 unsigned BuiltinID) { 9263 switch (BuiltinID) { 9264 case Builtin::BI__GetExceptionInfo: 9265 // No type checking whatsoever. 9266 return Ctx.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft(); 9267 9268 case Builtin::BIaddressof: 9269 case Builtin::BI__addressof: 9270 case Builtin::BIforward: 9271 case Builtin::BImove: 9272 case Builtin::BImove_if_noexcept: 9273 case Builtin::BIas_const: { 9274 // Ensure that we don't treat the algorithm 9275 // OutputIt std::move(InputIt, InputIt, OutputIt) 9276 // as the builtin std::move. 9277 const auto *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 9278 return FPT->getNumParams() == 1 && !FPT->isVariadic(); 9279 } 9280 9281 default: 9282 return false; 9283 } 9284 } 9285 9286 NamedDecl* 9287 Sema::ActOnFunctionDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D, DeclContext *DC, 9288 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, LookupResult &Previous, 9289 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamListsRef, 9290 bool &AddToScope) { 9291 QualType R = TInfo->getType(); 9292 9293 assert(R->isFunctionType()); 9294 if (R.getCanonicalType()->castAs<FunctionType>()->getCmseNSCallAttr()) 9295 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_function_decl_cmse_ns_call); 9296 9297 SmallVector<TemplateParameterList *, 4> TemplateParamLists; 9298 llvm::append_range(TemplateParamLists, TemplateParamListsRef); 9299 if (TemplateParameterList *Invented = D.getInventedTemplateParameterList()) { 9300 if (!TemplateParamLists.empty() && 9301 Invented->getDepth() == TemplateParamLists.back()->getDepth()) 9302 TemplateParamLists.back() = Invented; 9303 else 9304 TemplateParamLists.push_back(Invented); 9305 } 9306 9307 // TODO: consider using NameInfo for diagnostic. 9308 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo = GetNameForDeclarator(D); 9309 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName(); 9310 StorageClass SC = getFunctionStorageClass(*this, D); 9311 9312 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec()) 9313 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 9314 diag::err_invalid_thread) 9315 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 9316 9317 if (D.isFirstDeclarationOfMember()) 9318 adjustMemberFunctionCC(R, D.isStaticMember(), D.isCtorOrDtor(), 9319 D.getIdentifierLoc()); 9320 9321 bool isFriend = false; 9322 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate = nullptr; 9323 bool isMemberSpecialization = false; 9324 bool isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = false; 9325 9326 bool isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization = false; 9327 bool HasExplicitTemplateArgs = false; 9328 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgs; 9329 9330 bool isVirtualOkay = false; 9331 9332 DeclContext *OriginalDC = DC; 9333 bool IsLocalExternDecl = adjustContextForLocalExternDecl(DC); 9334 9335 FunctionDecl *NewFD = CreateNewFunctionDecl(*this, D, DC, R, TInfo, SC, 9336 isVirtualOkay); 9337 if (!NewFD) return nullptr; 9338 9339 if (OriginalLexicalContext && OriginalLexicalContext->isObjCContainer()) 9340 NewFD->setTopLevelDeclInObjCContainer(); 9341 9342 // Set the lexical context. If this is a function-scope declaration, or has a 9343 // C++ scope specifier, or is the object of a friend declaration, the lexical 9344 // context will be different from the semantic context. 9345 NewFD->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 9346 9347 if (IsLocalExternDecl) 9348 NewFD->setLocalExternDecl(); 9349 9350 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 9351 bool isInline = D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified(); 9352 bool isVirtual = D.getDeclSpec().isVirtualSpecified(); 9353 bool hasExplicit = D.getDeclSpec().hasExplicitSpecifier(); 9354 isFriend = D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified(); 9355 if (isFriend && !isInline && D.isFunctionDefinition()) { 9356 // C++ [class.friend]p5 9357 // A function can be defined in a friend declaration of a 9358 // class . . . . Such a function is implicitly inline. 9359 NewFD->setImplicitlyInline(); 9360 } 9361 9362 // If this is a method defined in an __interface, and is not a constructor 9363 // or an overloaded operator, then set the pure flag (isVirtual will already 9364 // return true). 9365 if (const CXXRecordDecl *Parent = 9366 dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(NewFD->getDeclContext())) { 9367 if (Parent->isInterface() && cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)->isUserProvided()) 9368 NewFD->setPure(true); 9369 9370 // C++ [class.union]p2 9371 // A union can have member functions, but not virtual functions. 9372 if (isVirtual && Parent->isUnion()) { 9373 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), diag::err_virtual_in_union); 9374 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9375 } 9376 if ((Parent->isClass() || Parent->isStruct()) && 9377 Parent->hasAttr<SYCLSpecialClassAttr>() && 9378 NewFD->getKind() == Decl::Kind::CXXMethod && NewFD->getIdentifier() && 9379 NewFD->getName() == "__init" && D.isFunctionDefinition()) { 9380 if (auto *Def = Parent->getDefinition()) 9381 Def->setInitMethod(true); 9382 } 9383 } 9384 9385 SetNestedNameSpecifier(*this, NewFD, D); 9386 isMemberSpecialization = false; 9387 isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = false; 9388 if (D.isInvalidType()) 9389 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9390 9391 // Match up the template parameter lists with the scope specifier, then 9392 // determine whether we have a template or a template specialization. 9393 bool Invalid = false; 9394 TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams = 9395 MatchTemplateParametersToScopeSpecifier( 9396 D.getDeclSpec().getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(), 9397 D.getCXXScopeSpec(), 9398 D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId 9399 ? D.getName().TemplateId 9400 : nullptr, 9401 TemplateParamLists, isFriend, isMemberSpecialization, 9402 Invalid); 9403 if (TemplateParams) { 9404 // Check that we can declare a template here. 9405 if (CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParams)) 9406 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9407 9408 if (TemplateParams->size() > 0) { 9409 // This is a function template 9410 9411 // A destructor cannot be a template. 9412 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) { 9413 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_destructor_template); 9414 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9415 } 9416 9417 // If we're adding a template to a dependent context, we may need to 9418 // rebuilding some of the types used within the template parameter list, 9419 // now that we know what the current instantiation is. 9420 if (DC->isDependentContext()) { 9421 ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, DC); 9422 if (RebuildTemplateParamsInCurrentInstantiation(TemplateParams)) 9423 Invalid = true; 9424 } 9425 9426 FunctionTemplate = FunctionTemplateDecl::Create(Context, DC, 9427 NewFD->getLocation(), 9428 Name, TemplateParams, 9429 NewFD); 9430 FunctionTemplate->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 9431 NewFD->setDescribedFunctionTemplate(FunctionTemplate); 9432 9433 // For source fidelity, store the other template param lists. 9434 if (TemplateParamLists.size() > 1) { 9435 NewFD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, 9436 ArrayRef<TemplateParameterList *>(TemplateParamLists) 9437 .drop_back(1)); 9438 } 9439 } else { 9440 // This is a function template specialization. 9441 isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = true; 9442 // For source fidelity, store all the template param lists. 9443 if (TemplateParamLists.size() > 0) 9444 NewFD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, TemplateParamLists); 9445 9446 // C++0x [temp.expl.spec]p20 forbids "template<> friend void foo(int);". 9447 if (isFriend) { 9448 // We want to remove the "template<>", found here. 9449 SourceRange RemoveRange = TemplateParams->getSourceRange(); 9450 9451 // If we remove the template<> and the name is not a 9452 // template-id, we're actually silently creating a problem: 9453 // the friend declaration will refer to an untemplated decl, 9454 // and clearly the user wants a template specialization. So 9455 // we need to insert '<>' after the name. 9456 SourceLocation InsertLoc; 9457 if (D.getName().getKind() != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) { 9458 InsertLoc = D.getName().getSourceRange().getEnd(); 9459 InsertLoc = getLocForEndOfToken(InsertLoc); 9460 } 9461 9462 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_template_spec_decl_friend) 9463 << Name << RemoveRange 9464 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(RemoveRange) 9465 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(InsertLoc, "<>"); 9466 Invalid = true; 9467 } 9468 } 9469 } else { 9470 // Check that we can declare a template here. 9471 if (!TemplateParamLists.empty() && isMemberSpecialization && 9472 CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParamLists.back())) 9473 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9474 9475 // All template param lists were matched against the scope specifier: 9476 // this is NOT (an explicit specialization of) a template. 9477 if (TemplateParamLists.size() > 0) 9478 // For source fidelity, store all the template param lists. 9479 NewFD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, TemplateParamLists); 9480 } 9481 9482 if (Invalid) { 9483 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9484 if (FunctionTemplate) 9485 FunctionTemplate->setInvalidDecl(); 9486 } 9487 9488 // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p5: 9489 // The virtual specifier shall only be used in declarations of 9490 // nonstatic class member functions that appear within a 9491 // member-specification of a class declaration; see 10.3. 9492 // 9493 if (isVirtual && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) { 9494 if (!isVirtualOkay) { 9495 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), 9496 diag::err_virtual_non_function); 9497 } else if (!CurContext->isRecord()) { 9498 // 'virtual' was specified outside of the class. 9499 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), 9500 diag::err_virtual_out_of_class) 9501 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc()); 9502 } else if (NewFD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) { 9503 // C++ [temp.mem]p3: 9504 // A member function template shall not be virtual. 9505 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), 9506 diag::err_virtual_member_function_template) 9507 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc()); 9508 } else { 9509 // Okay: Add virtual to the method. 9510 NewFD->setVirtualAsWritten(true); 9511 } 9512 9513 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && 9514 NewFD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType()) 9515 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), diag::err_auto_fn_virtual); 9516 } 9517 9518 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && 9519 (NewFD->isDependentContext() || 9520 (isFriend && CurContext->isDependentContext())) && 9521 NewFD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType()) { 9522 // If the function template is referenced directly (for instance, as a 9523 // member of the current instantiation), pretend it has a dependent type. 9524 // This is not really justified by the standard, but is the only sane 9525 // thing to do. 9526 // FIXME: For a friend function, we have not marked the function as being 9527 // a friend yet, so 'isDependentContext' on the FD doesn't work. 9528 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = 9529 NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 9530 QualType Result = SubstAutoTypeDependent(FPT->getReturnType()); 9531 NewFD->setType(Context.getFunctionType(Result, FPT->getParamTypes(), 9532 FPT->getExtProtoInfo())); 9533 } 9534 9535 // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p3: 9536 // The inline specifier shall not appear on a block scope function 9537 // declaration. 9538 if (isInline && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) { 9539 if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) { 9540 // 'inline' is not allowed on block scope function declaration. 9541 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), 9542 diag::err_inline_declaration_block_scope) << Name 9543 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc()); 9544 } 9545 } 9546 9547 // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p6: 9548 // The explicit specifier shall be used only in the declaration of a 9549 // constructor or conversion function within its class definition; 9550 // see 12.3.1 and 12.3.2. 9551 if (hasExplicit && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && 9552 !isa<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(NewFD)) { 9553 if (!CurContext->isRecord()) { 9554 // 'explicit' was specified outside of the class. 9555 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecLoc(), 9556 diag::err_explicit_out_of_class) 9557 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecRange()); 9558 } else if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewFD) && 9559 !isa<CXXConversionDecl>(NewFD)) { 9560 // 'explicit' was specified on a function that wasn't a constructor 9561 // or conversion function. 9562 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecLoc(), 9563 diag::err_explicit_non_ctor_or_conv_function) 9564 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecRange()); 9565 } 9566 } 9567 9568 ConstexprSpecKind ConstexprKind = D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier(); 9569 if (ConstexprKind != ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified) { 9570 // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p2: constexpr functions and constexpr constructors 9571 // are implicitly inline. 9572 NewFD->setImplicitlyInline(); 9573 9574 // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p3: functions declared constexpr are required to 9575 // be either constructors or to return a literal type. Therefore, 9576 // destructors cannot be declared constexpr. 9577 if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewFD) && 9578 (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 || 9579 ConstexprKind == ConstexprSpecKind::Consteval)) { 9580 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_dtor) 9581 << static_cast<int>(ConstexprKind); 9582 NewFD->setConstexprKind(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 9583 ? ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified 9584 : ConstexprSpecKind::Constexpr); 9585 } 9586 // C++20 [dcl.constexpr]p2: An allocation function, or a 9587 // deallocation function shall not be declared with the consteval 9588 // specifier. 9589 if (ConstexprKind == ConstexprSpecKind::Consteval && 9590 (NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_New || 9591 NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Array_New || 9592 NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Delete || 9593 NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Array_Delete)) { 9594 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), 9595 diag::err_invalid_consteval_decl_kind) 9596 << NewFD; 9597 NewFD->setConstexprKind(ConstexprSpecKind::Constexpr); 9598 } 9599 } 9600 9601 // If __module_private__ was specified, mark the function accordingly. 9602 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) { 9603 if (isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) { 9604 SourceLocation ModulePrivateLoc 9605 = D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc(); 9606 Diag(ModulePrivateLoc, diag::err_module_private_specialization) 9607 << 0 9608 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ModulePrivateLoc); 9609 } else { 9610 NewFD->setModulePrivate(); 9611 if (FunctionTemplate) 9612 FunctionTemplate->setModulePrivate(); 9613 } 9614 } 9615 9616 if (isFriend) { 9617 if (FunctionTemplate) { 9618 FunctionTemplate->setObjectOfFriendDecl(); 9619 FunctionTemplate->setAccess(AS_public); 9620 } 9621 NewFD->setObjectOfFriendDecl(); 9622 NewFD->setAccess(AS_public); 9623 } 9624 9625 // If a function is defined as defaulted or deleted, mark it as such now. 9626 // We'll do the relevant checks on defaulted / deleted functions later. 9627 switch (D.getFunctionDefinitionKind()) { 9628 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Declaration: 9629 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Definition: 9630 break; 9631 9632 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Defaulted: 9633 NewFD->setDefaulted(); 9634 break; 9635 9636 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Deleted: 9637 NewFD->setDeletedAsWritten(); 9638 break; 9639 } 9640 9641 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD) && DC == CurContext && 9642 D.isFunctionDefinition()) { 9643 // C++ [class.mfct]p2: 9644 // A member function may be defined (8.4) in its class definition, in 9645 // which case it is an inline member function (7.1.2) 9646 NewFD->setImplicitlyInline(); 9647 } 9648 9649 if (SC == SC_Static && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD) && 9650 !CurContext->isRecord()) { 9651 // C++ [class.static]p1: 9652 // A data or function member of a class may be declared static 9653 // in a class definition, in which case it is a static member of 9654 // the class. 9655 9656 // Complain about the 'static' specifier if it's on an out-of-line 9657 // member function definition. 9658 9659 // MSVC permits the use of a 'static' storage specifier on an out-of-line 9660 // member function template declaration and class member template 9661 // declaration (MSVC versions before 2015), warn about this. 9662 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 9663 ((!getLangOpts().isCompatibleWithMSVC(LangOptions::MSVC2015) && 9664 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getDescribedClassTemplate()) || 9665 (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && NewFD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())) 9666 ? diag::ext_static_out_of_line : diag::err_static_out_of_line) 9667 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 9668 } 9669 9670 // C++11 [except.spec]p15: 9671 // A deallocation function with no exception-specification is treated 9672 // as if it were specified with noexcept(true). 9673 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = R->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 9674 if ((Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator() == OO_Delete || 9675 Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator() == OO_Array_Delete) && 9676 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && FPT && !FPT->hasExceptionSpec()) 9677 NewFD->setType(Context.getFunctionType( 9678 FPT->getReturnType(), FPT->getParamTypes(), 9679 FPT->getExtProtoInfo().withExceptionSpec(EST_BasicNoexcept))); 9680 } 9681 9682 // Filter out previous declarations that don't match the scope. 9683 FilterLookupForScope(Previous, OriginalDC, S, shouldConsiderLinkage(NewFD), 9684 D.getCXXScopeSpec().isNotEmpty() || 9685 isMemberSpecialization || 9686 isFunctionTemplateSpecialization); 9687 9688 // Handle GNU asm-label extension (encoded as an attribute). 9689 if (Expr *E = (Expr*) D.getAsmLabel()) { 9690 // The parser guarantees this is a string. 9691 StringLiteral *SE = cast<StringLiteral>(E); 9692 NewFD->addAttr(AsmLabelAttr::Create(Context, SE->getString(), 9693 /*IsLiteralLabel=*/true, 9694 SE->getStrTokenLoc(0))); 9695 } else if (!ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.empty()) { 9696 llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*,AsmLabelAttr*>::iterator I = 9697 ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.find(NewFD->getIdentifier()); 9698 if (I != ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.end()) { 9699 if (isDeclExternC(NewFD)) { 9700 NewFD->addAttr(I->second); 9701 ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.erase(I); 9702 } else 9703 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::warn_redefine_extname_not_applied) 9704 << /*Variable*/0 << NewFD; 9705 } 9706 } 9707 9708 // Copy the parameter declarations from the declarator D to the function 9709 // declaration NewFD, if they are available. First scavenge them into Params. 9710 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 16> Params; 9711 unsigned FTIIdx; 9712 if (D.isFunctionDeclarator(FTIIdx)) { 9713 DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = D.getTypeObject(FTIIdx).Fun; 9714 9715 // Check for C99 6.7.5.3p10 - foo(void) is a non-varargs 9716 // function that takes no arguments, not a function that takes a 9717 // single void argument. 9718 // We let through "const void" here because Sema::GetTypeForDeclarator 9719 // already checks for that case. 9720 if (FTIHasNonVoidParameters(FTI) && FTI.Params[0].Param) { 9721 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FTI.NumParams; i != e; ++i) { 9722 ParmVarDecl *Param = cast<ParmVarDecl>(FTI.Params[i].Param); 9723 assert(Param->getDeclContext() != NewFD && "Was set before ?"); 9724 Param->setDeclContext(NewFD); 9725 Params.push_back(Param); 9726 9727 if (Param->isInvalidDecl()) 9728 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9729 } 9730 } 9731 9732 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 9733 // In C, find all the tag declarations from the prototype and move them 9734 // into the function DeclContext. Remove them from the surrounding tag 9735 // injection context of the function, which is typically but not always 9736 // the TU. 9737 DeclContext *PrototypeTagContext = 9738 getTagInjectionContext(NewFD->getLexicalDeclContext()); 9739 for (NamedDecl *NonParmDecl : FTI.getDeclsInPrototype()) { 9740 auto *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(NonParmDecl); 9741 9742 // We don't want to reparent enumerators. Look at their parent enum 9743 // instead. 9744 if (!TD) { 9745 if (auto *ECD = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(NonParmDecl)) 9746 TD = cast<EnumDecl>(ECD->getDeclContext()); 9747 } 9748 if (!TD) 9749 continue; 9750 DeclContext *TagDC = TD->getLexicalDeclContext(); 9751 if (!TagDC->containsDecl(TD)) 9752 continue; 9753 TagDC->removeDecl(TD); 9754 TD->setDeclContext(NewFD); 9755 NewFD->addDecl(TD); 9756 9757 // Preserve the lexical DeclContext if it is not the surrounding tag 9758 // injection context of the FD. In this example, the semantic context of 9759 // E will be f and the lexical context will be S, while both the 9760 // semantic and lexical contexts of S will be f: 9761 // void f(struct S { enum E { a } f; } s); 9762 if (TagDC != PrototypeTagContext) 9763 TD->setLexicalDeclContext(TagDC); 9764 } 9765 } 9766 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *FT = R->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 9767 // When we're declaring a function with a typedef, typeof, etc as in the 9768 // following example, we'll need to synthesize (unnamed) 9769 // parameters for use in the declaration. 9770 // 9771 // @code 9772 // typedef void fn(int); 9773 // fn f; 9774 // @endcode 9775 9776 // Synthesize a parameter for each argument type. 9777 for (const auto &AI : FT->param_types()) { 9778 ParmVarDecl *Param = 9779 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(NewFD, D.getIdentifierLoc(), AI); 9780 Param->setScopeInfo(0, Params.size()); 9781 Params.push_back(Param); 9782 } 9783 } else { 9784 assert(R->isFunctionNoProtoType() && NewFD->getNumParams() == 0 && 9785 "Should not need args for typedef of non-prototype fn"); 9786 } 9787 9788 // Finally, we know we have the right number of parameters, install them. 9789 NewFD->setParams(Params); 9790 9791 if (D.getDeclSpec().isNoreturnSpecified()) 9792 NewFD->addAttr(C11NoReturnAttr::Create(Context, 9793 D.getDeclSpec().getNoreturnSpecLoc(), 9794 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Keyword)); 9795 9796 // Functions returning a variably modified type violate C99 6.7.5.2p2 9797 // because all functions have linkage. 9798 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && 9799 NewFD->getReturnType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 9800 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_func_decl); 9801 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9802 } 9803 9804 // Apply an implicit SectionAttr if '#pragma clang section text' is active 9805 if (PragmaClangTextSection.Valid && D.isFunctionDefinition() && 9806 !NewFD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) 9807 NewFD->addAttr(PragmaClangTextSectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 9808 Context, PragmaClangTextSection.SectionName, 9809 PragmaClangTextSection.PragmaLocation, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 9810 9811 // Apply an implicit SectionAttr if #pragma code_seg is active. 9812 if (CodeSegStack.CurrentValue && D.isFunctionDefinition() && 9813 !NewFD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) { 9814 NewFD->addAttr(SectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 9815 Context, CodeSegStack.CurrentValue->getString(), 9816 CodeSegStack.CurrentPragmaLocation, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma, 9817 SectionAttr::Declspec_allocate)); 9818 if (UnifySection(CodeSegStack.CurrentValue->getString(), 9819 ASTContext::PSF_Implicit | ASTContext::PSF_Execute | 9820 ASTContext::PSF_Read, 9821 NewFD)) 9822 NewFD->dropAttr<SectionAttr>(); 9823 } 9824 9825 // Apply an implicit CodeSegAttr from class declspec or 9826 // apply an implicit SectionAttr from #pragma code_seg if active. 9827 if (!NewFD->hasAttr<CodeSegAttr>()) { 9828 if (Attr *SAttr = getImplicitCodeSegOrSectionAttrForFunction(NewFD, 9829 D.isFunctionDefinition())) { 9830 NewFD->addAttr(SAttr); 9831 } 9832 } 9833 9834 // Handle attributes. 9835 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewFD, D); 9836 9837 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 9838 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5: Using an address space qualifier in a function return 9839 // type declaration will generate a compilation error. 9840 LangAS AddressSpace = NewFD->getReturnType().getAddressSpace(); 9841 if (AddressSpace != LangAS::Default) { 9842 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 9843 diag::err_opencl_return_value_with_address_space); 9844 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9845 } 9846 } 9847 9848 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 9849 // Perform semantic checking on the function declaration. 9850 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMain()) 9851 CheckMain(NewFD, D.getDeclSpec()); 9852 9853 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMSVCRTEntryPoint()) 9854 CheckMSVCRTEntryPoint(NewFD); 9855 9856 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 9857 D.setRedeclaration(CheckFunctionDeclaration(S, NewFD, Previous, 9858 isMemberSpecialization, 9859 D.isFunctionDefinition())); 9860 else if (!Previous.empty()) 9861 // Recover gracefully from an invalid redeclaration. 9862 D.setRedeclaration(true); 9863 assert((NewFD->isInvalidDecl() || !D.isRedeclaration() || 9864 Previous.getResultKind() != LookupResult::FoundOverloaded) && 9865 "previous declaration set still overloaded"); 9866 9867 // Diagnose no-prototype function declarations with calling conventions that 9868 // don't support variadic calls. Only do this in C and do it after merging 9869 // possibly prototyped redeclarations. 9870 const FunctionType *FT = NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 9871 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FT) && !D.isFunctionDefinition()) { 9872 CallingConv CC = FT->getExtInfo().getCC(); 9873 if (!supportsVariadicCall(CC)) { 9874 // Windows system headers sometimes accidentally use stdcall without 9875 // (void) parameters, so we relax this to a warning. 9876 int DiagID = 9877 CC == CC_X86StdCall ? diag::warn_cconv_knr : diag::err_cconv_knr; 9878 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), DiagID) 9879 << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(CC); 9880 } 9881 } 9882 9883 if (NewFD->getReturnType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() || 9884 NewFD->getReturnType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) 9885 checkNonTrivialCUnion(NewFD->getReturnType(), 9886 NewFD->getReturnTypeSourceRange().getBegin(), 9887 NTCUC_FunctionReturn, NTCUK_Destruct|NTCUK_Copy); 9888 } else { 9889 // C++11 [replacement.functions]p3: 9890 // The program's definitions shall not be specified as inline. 9891 // 9892 // N.B. We diagnose declarations instead of definitions per LWG issue 2340. 9893 // 9894 // Suppress the diagnostic if the function is __attribute__((used)), since 9895 // that forces an external definition to be emitted. 9896 if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified() && 9897 NewFD->isReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction() && 9898 !NewFD->hasAttr<UsedAttr>()) 9899 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), 9900 diag::ext_operator_new_delete_declared_inline) 9901 << NewFD->getDeclName(); 9902 9903 // If the declarator is a template-id, translate the parser's template 9904 // argument list into our AST format. 9905 if (D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) { 9906 TemplateIdAnnotation *TemplateId = D.getName().TemplateId; 9907 TemplateArgs.setLAngleLoc(TemplateId->LAngleLoc); 9908 TemplateArgs.setRAngleLoc(TemplateId->RAngleLoc); 9909 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(), 9910 TemplateId->NumArgs); 9911 translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, 9912 TemplateArgs); 9913 9914 HasExplicitTemplateArgs = true; 9915 9916 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) { 9917 HasExplicitTemplateArgs = false; 9918 } else if (FunctionTemplate) { 9919 // Function template with explicit template arguments. 9920 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_function_template_partial_spec) 9921 << SourceRange(TemplateId->LAngleLoc, TemplateId->RAngleLoc); 9922 9923 HasExplicitTemplateArgs = false; 9924 } else { 9925 assert((isFunctionTemplateSpecialization || 9926 D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified()) && 9927 "should have a 'template<>' for this decl"); 9928 // "friend void foo<>(int);" is an implicit specialization decl. 9929 isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = true; 9930 } 9931 } else if (isFriend && isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) { 9932 // This combination is only possible in a recovery case; the user 9933 // wrote something like: 9934 // template <> friend void foo(int); 9935 // which we're recovering from as if the user had written: 9936 // friend void foo<>(int); 9937 // Go ahead and fake up a template id. 9938 HasExplicitTemplateArgs = true; 9939 TemplateArgs.setLAngleLoc(D.getIdentifierLoc()); 9940 TemplateArgs.setRAngleLoc(D.getIdentifierLoc()); 9941 } 9942 9943 // We do not add HD attributes to specializations here because 9944 // they may have different constexpr-ness compared to their 9945 // templates and, after maybeAddCUDAHostDeviceAttrs() is applied, 9946 // may end up with different effective targets. Instead, a 9947 // specialization inherits its target attributes from its template 9948 // in the CheckFunctionTemplateSpecialization() call below. 9949 if (getLangOpts().CUDA && !isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) 9950 maybeAddCUDAHostDeviceAttrs(NewFD, Previous); 9951 9952 // If it's a friend (and only if it's a friend), it's possible 9953 // that either the specialized function type or the specialized 9954 // template is dependent, and therefore matching will fail. In 9955 // this case, don't check the specialization yet. 9956 if (isFunctionTemplateSpecialization && isFriend && 9957 (NewFD->getType()->isDependentType() || DC->isDependentContext() || 9958 TemplateSpecializationType::anyInstantiationDependentTemplateArguments( 9959 TemplateArgs.arguments()))) { 9960 assert(HasExplicitTemplateArgs && 9961 "friend function specialization without template args"); 9962 if (CheckDependentFunctionTemplateSpecialization(NewFD, TemplateArgs, 9963 Previous)) 9964 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9965 } else if (isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) { 9966 if (CurContext->isDependentContext() && CurContext->isRecord() 9967 && !isFriend) { 9968 isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization = true; 9969 } else if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && 9970 CheckFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 9971 NewFD, (HasExplicitTemplateArgs ? &TemplateArgs : nullptr), 9972 Previous)) 9973 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9974 9975 // C++ [dcl.stc]p1: 9976 // A storage-class-specifier shall not be specified in an explicit 9977 // specialization (14.7.3) 9978 FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *Info = 9979 NewFD->getTemplateSpecializationInfo(); 9980 if (Info && SC != SC_None) { 9981 if (SC != Info->getTemplate()->getTemplatedDecl()->getStorageClass()) 9982 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 9983 diag::err_explicit_specialization_inconsistent_storage_class) 9984 << SC 9985 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 9986 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 9987 9988 else 9989 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 9990 diag::ext_explicit_specialization_storage_class) 9991 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 9992 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 9993 } 9994 } else if (isMemberSpecialization && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) { 9995 if (CheckMemberSpecialization(NewFD, Previous)) 9996 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9997 } 9998 9999 // Perform semantic checking on the function declaration. 10000 if (!isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization) { 10001 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMain()) 10002 CheckMain(NewFD, D.getDeclSpec()); 10003 10004 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMSVCRTEntryPoint()) 10005 CheckMSVCRTEntryPoint(NewFD); 10006 10007 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 10008 D.setRedeclaration(CheckFunctionDeclaration(S, NewFD, Previous, 10009 isMemberSpecialization, 10010 D.isFunctionDefinition())); 10011 else if (!Previous.empty()) 10012 // Recover gracefully from an invalid redeclaration. 10013 D.setRedeclaration(true); 10014 } 10015 10016 assert((NewFD->isInvalidDecl() || !D.isRedeclaration() || 10017 Previous.getResultKind() != LookupResult::FoundOverloaded) && 10018 "previous declaration set still overloaded"); 10019 10020 NamedDecl *PrincipalDecl = (FunctionTemplate 10021 ? cast<NamedDecl>(FunctionTemplate) 10022 : NewFD); 10023 10024 if (isFriend && NewFD->getPreviousDecl()) { 10025 AccessSpecifier Access = AS_public; 10026 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 10027 Access = NewFD->getPreviousDecl()->getAccess(); 10028 10029 NewFD->setAccess(Access); 10030 if (FunctionTemplate) FunctionTemplate->setAccess(Access); 10031 } 10032 10033 if (NewFD->isOverloadedOperator() && !DC->isRecord() && 10034 PrincipalDecl->isInIdentifierNamespace(Decl::IDNS_Ordinary)) 10035 PrincipalDecl->setNonMemberOperator(); 10036 10037 // If we have a function template, check the template parameter 10038 // list. This will check and merge default template arguments. 10039 if (FunctionTemplate) { 10040 FunctionTemplateDecl *PrevTemplate = 10041 FunctionTemplate->getPreviousDecl(); 10042 CheckTemplateParameterList(FunctionTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 10043 PrevTemplate ? PrevTemplate->getTemplateParameters() 10044 : nullptr, 10045 D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified() 10046 ? (D.isFunctionDefinition() 10047 ? TPC_FriendFunctionTemplateDefinition 10048 : TPC_FriendFunctionTemplate) 10049 : (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet() && 10050 DC && DC->isRecord() && 10051 DC->isDependentContext()) 10052 ? TPC_ClassTemplateMember 10053 : TPC_FunctionTemplate); 10054 } 10055 10056 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) { 10057 // Ignore all the rest of this. 10058 } else if (!D.isRedeclaration()) { 10059 struct ActOnFDArgs ExtraArgs = { S, D, TemplateParamLists, 10060 AddToScope }; 10061 // Fake up an access specifier if it's supposed to be a class member. 10062 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(NewFD->getDeclContext())) 10063 NewFD->setAccess(AS_public); 10064 10065 // Qualified decls generally require a previous declaration. 10066 if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 10067 // ...with the major exception of templated-scope or 10068 // dependent-scope friend declarations. 10069 10070 // TODO: we currently also suppress this check in dependent 10071 // contexts because (1) the parameter depth will be off when 10072 // matching friend templates and (2) we might actually be 10073 // selecting a friend based on a dependent factor. But there 10074 // are situations where these conditions don't apply and we 10075 // can actually do this check immediately. 10076 // 10077 // Unless the scope is dependent, it's always an error if qualified 10078 // redeclaration lookup found nothing at all. Diagnose that now; 10079 // nothing will diagnose that error later. 10080 if (isFriend && 10081 (D.getCXXScopeSpec().getScopeRep()->isDependent() || 10082 (!Previous.empty() && CurContext->isDependentContext()))) { 10083 // ignore these 10084 } else if (NewFD->isCPUDispatchMultiVersion() || 10085 NewFD->isCPUSpecificMultiVersion()) { 10086 // ignore this, we allow the redeclaration behavior here to create new 10087 // versions of the function. 10088 } else { 10089 // The user tried to provide an out-of-line definition for a 10090 // function that is a member of a class or namespace, but there 10091 // was no such member function declared (C++ [class.mfct]p2, 10092 // C++ [namespace.memdef]p2). For example: 10093 // 10094 // class X { 10095 // void f() const; 10096 // }; 10097 // 10098 // void X::f() { } // ill-formed 10099 // 10100 // Complain about this problem, and attempt to suggest close 10101 // matches (e.g., those that differ only in cv-qualifiers and 10102 // whether the parameter types are references). 10103 10104 if (NamedDecl *Result = DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration( 10105 *this, Previous, NewFD, ExtraArgs, false, nullptr)) { 10106 AddToScope = ExtraArgs.AddToScope; 10107 return Result; 10108 } 10109 } 10110 10111 // Unqualified local friend declarations are required to resolve 10112 // to something. 10113 } else if (isFriend && cast<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext)->isLocalClass()) { 10114 if (NamedDecl *Result = DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration( 10115 *this, Previous, NewFD, ExtraArgs, true, S)) { 10116 AddToScope = ExtraArgs.AddToScope; 10117 return Result; 10118 } 10119 } 10120 } else if (!D.isFunctionDefinition() && 10121 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD) && NewFD->isOutOfLine() && 10122 !isFriend && !isFunctionTemplateSpecialization && 10123 !isMemberSpecialization) { 10124 // An out-of-line member function declaration must also be a 10125 // definition (C++ [class.mfct]p2). 10126 // Note that this is not the case for explicit specializations of 10127 // function templates or member functions of class templates, per 10128 // C++ [temp.expl.spec]p2. We also allow these declarations as an 10129 // extension for compatibility with old SWIG code which likes to 10130 // generate them. 10131 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::ext_out_of_line_declaration) 10132 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 10133 } 10134 } 10135 10136 // If this is the first declaration of a library builtin function, add 10137 // attributes as appropriate. 10138 if (!D.isRedeclaration()) { 10139 if (IdentifierInfo *II = Previous.getLookupName().getAsIdentifierInfo()) { 10140 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) { 10141 bool InStdNamespace = Context.BuiltinInfo.isInStdNamespace(BuiltinID); 10142 if (!InStdNamespace && 10143 NewFD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isFileContext()) { 10144 if (NewFD->getLanguageLinkage() == CLanguageLinkage) { 10145 // Validate the type matches unless this builtin is specified as 10146 // matching regardless of its declared type. 10147 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.allowTypeMismatch(BuiltinID)) { 10148 NewFD->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, BuiltinID)); 10149 } else { 10150 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError Error; 10151 LookupNecessaryTypesForBuiltin(S, BuiltinID); 10152 QualType BuiltinType = Context.GetBuiltinType(BuiltinID, Error); 10153 10154 if (!Error && !BuiltinType.isNull() && 10155 Context.hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringExceptionSpec( 10156 NewFD->getType(), BuiltinType)) 10157 NewFD->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, BuiltinID)); 10158 } 10159 } 10160 } else if (InStdNamespace && NewFD->isInStdNamespace() && 10161 isStdBuiltin(Context, NewFD, BuiltinID)) { 10162 NewFD->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, BuiltinID)); 10163 } 10164 } 10165 } 10166 } 10167 10168 ProcessPragmaWeak(S, NewFD); 10169 checkAttributesAfterMerging(*this, *NewFD); 10170 10171 AddKnownFunctionAttributes(NewFD); 10172 10173 if (NewFD->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>() && 10174 !NewFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 10175 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 10176 diag::err_attribute_overloadable_no_prototype) 10177 << NewFD; 10178 10179 // Turn this into a variadic function with no parameters. 10180 const auto *FT = NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 10181 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI( 10182 Context.getDefaultCallingConvention(true, false)); 10183 EPI.Variadic = true; 10184 EPI.ExtInfo = FT->getExtInfo(); 10185 10186 QualType R = Context.getFunctionType(FT->getReturnType(), None, EPI); 10187 NewFD->setType(R); 10188 } 10189 10190 // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, and this isn't a class 10191 // member, set the visibility of this function. 10192 if (!DC->isRecord() && NewFD->isExternallyVisible()) 10193 AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(NewFD); 10194 10195 // If there's a #pragma clang arc_cf_code_audited in scope, consider 10196 // marking the function. 10197 AddCFAuditedAttribute(NewFD); 10198 10199 // If this is a function definition, check if we have to apply any 10200 // attributes (i.e. optnone and no_builtin) due to a pragma. 10201 if (D.isFunctionDefinition()) { 10202 AddRangeBasedOptnone(NewFD); 10203 AddImplicitMSFunctionNoBuiltinAttr(NewFD); 10204 AddSectionMSAllocText(NewFD); 10205 ModifyFnAttributesMSPragmaOptimize(NewFD); 10206 } 10207 10208 // If this is the first declaration of an extern C variable, update 10209 // the map of such variables. 10210 if (NewFD->isFirstDecl() && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && 10211 isIncompleteDeclExternC(*this, NewFD)) 10212 RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(NewFD, S); 10213 10214 // Set this FunctionDecl's range up to the right paren. 10215 NewFD->setRangeEnd(D.getSourceRange().getEnd()); 10216 10217 if (D.isRedeclaration() && !Previous.empty()) { 10218 NamedDecl *Prev = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(); 10219 checkDLLAttributeRedeclaration(*this, Prev, NewFD, 10220 isMemberSpecialization || 10221 isFunctionTemplateSpecialization, 10222 D.isFunctionDefinition()); 10223 } 10224 10225 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) { 10226 IdentifierInfo *II = NewFD->getIdentifier(); 10227 if (II && II->isStr(getCudaConfigureFuncName()) && 10228 !NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && 10229 NewFD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) { 10230 if (!R->castAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType()->isScalarType()) 10231 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_config_scalar_return) 10232 << getCudaConfigureFuncName(); 10233 Context.setcudaConfigureCallDecl(NewFD); 10234 } 10235 10236 // Variadic functions, other than a *declaration* of printf, are not allowed 10237 // in device-side CUDA code, unless someone passed 10238 // -fcuda-allow-variadic-functions. 10239 if (!getLangOpts().CUDAAllowVariadicFunctions && NewFD->isVariadic() && 10240 (NewFD->hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>() || 10241 NewFD->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) && 10242 !(II && II->isStr("printf") && NewFD->isExternC() && 10243 !D.isFunctionDefinition())) { 10244 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_variadic_device_fn); 10245 } 10246 } 10247 10248 MarkUnusedFileScopedDecl(NewFD); 10249 10250 10251 10252 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && NewFD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) { 10253 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.8 static is invalid for kernel functions. 10254 if (SC == SC_Static) { 10255 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_static_kernel); 10256 D.setInvalidType(); 10257 } 10258 10259 // OpenCL v1.2, s6.9 -- Kernels can only have return type void. 10260 if (!NewFD->getReturnType()->isVoidType()) { 10261 SourceRange RTRange = NewFD->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 10262 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_expected_kernel_void_return_type) 10263 << (RTRange.isValid() ? FixItHint::CreateReplacement(RTRange, "void") 10264 : FixItHint()); 10265 D.setInvalidType(); 10266 } 10267 10268 llvm::SmallPtrSet<const Type *, 16> ValidTypes; 10269 for (auto Param : NewFD->parameters()) 10270 checkIsValidOpenCLKernelParameter(*this, D, Param, ValidTypes); 10271 10272 if (getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus) { 10273 if (DC->isRecord()) { 10274 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_method_kernel); 10275 D.setInvalidType(); 10276 } 10277 if (FunctionTemplate) { 10278 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_template_kernel); 10279 D.setInvalidType(); 10280 } 10281 } 10282 } 10283 10284 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 10285 if (FunctionTemplate) { 10286 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 10287 FunctionTemplate->setInvalidDecl(); 10288 return FunctionTemplate; 10289 } 10290 10291 if (isMemberSpecialization && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 10292 CompleteMemberSpecialization(NewFD, Previous); 10293 } 10294 10295 for (const ParmVarDecl *Param : NewFD->parameters()) { 10296 QualType PT = Param->getType(); 10297 10298 // OpenCL 2.0 pipe restrictions forbids pipe packet types to be non-value 10299 // types. 10300 if (getLangOpts().getOpenCLCompatibleVersion() >= 200) { 10301 if(const PipeType *PipeTy = PT->getAs<PipeType>()) { 10302 QualType ElemTy = PipeTy->getElementType(); 10303 if (ElemTy->isReferenceType() || ElemTy->isPointerType()) { 10304 Diag(Param->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::err_reference_pipe_type ); 10305 D.setInvalidType(); 10306 } 10307 } 10308 } 10309 } 10310 10311 // Here we have an function template explicit specialization at class scope. 10312 // The actual specialization will be postponed to template instatiation 10313 // time via the ClassScopeFunctionSpecializationDecl node. 10314 if (isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization) { 10315 ClassScopeFunctionSpecializationDecl *NewSpec = 10316 ClassScopeFunctionSpecializationDecl::Create( 10317 Context, CurContext, NewFD->getLocation(), 10318 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD), 10319 HasExplicitTemplateArgs, TemplateArgs); 10320 CurContext->addDecl(NewSpec); 10321 AddToScope = false; 10322 } 10323 10324 // Diagnose availability attributes. Availability cannot be used on functions 10325 // that are run during load/unload. 10326 if (const auto *attr = NewFD->getAttr<AvailabilityAttr>()) { 10327 if (NewFD->hasAttr<ConstructorAttr>()) { 10328 Diag(attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_availability_on_static_initializer) 10329 << 1; 10330 NewFD->dropAttr<AvailabilityAttr>(); 10331 } 10332 if (NewFD->hasAttr<DestructorAttr>()) { 10333 Diag(attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_availability_on_static_initializer) 10334 << 2; 10335 NewFD->dropAttr<AvailabilityAttr>(); 10336 } 10337 } 10338 10339 // Diagnose no_builtin attribute on function declaration that are not a 10340 // definition. 10341 // FIXME: We should really be doing this in 10342 // SemaDeclAttr.cpp::handleNoBuiltinAttr, unfortunately we only have access to 10343 // the FunctionDecl and at this point of the code 10344 // FunctionDecl::isThisDeclarationADefinition() which always returns `false` 10345 // because Sema::ActOnStartOfFunctionDef has not been called yet. 10346 if (const auto *NBA = NewFD->getAttr<NoBuiltinAttr>()) 10347 switch (D.getFunctionDefinitionKind()) { 10348 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Defaulted: 10349 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Deleted: 10350 Diag(NBA->getLocation(), 10351 diag::err_attribute_no_builtin_on_defaulted_deleted_function) 10352 << NBA->getSpelling(); 10353 break; 10354 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Declaration: 10355 Diag(NBA->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_no_builtin_on_non_definition) 10356 << NBA->getSpelling(); 10357 break; 10358 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Definition: 10359 break; 10360 } 10361 10362 return NewFD; 10363 } 10364 10365 /// Return a CodeSegAttr from a containing class. The Microsoft docs say 10366 /// when __declspec(code_seg) "is applied to a class, all member functions of 10367 /// the class and nested classes -- this includes compiler-generated special 10368 /// member functions -- are put in the specified segment." 10369 /// The actual behavior is a little more complicated. The Microsoft compiler 10370 /// won't check outer classes if there is an active value from #pragma code_seg. 10371 /// The CodeSeg is always applied from the direct parent but only from outer 10372 /// classes when the #pragma code_seg stack is empty. See: 10373 /// https://reviews.llvm.org/D22931, the Microsoft feedback page is no longer 10374 /// available since MS has removed the page. 10375 static Attr *getImplicitCodeSegAttrFromClass(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *FD) { 10376 const auto *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD); 10377 if (!Method) 10378 return nullptr; 10379 const CXXRecordDecl *Parent = Method->getParent(); 10380 if (const auto *SAttr = Parent->getAttr<CodeSegAttr>()) { 10381 Attr *NewAttr = SAttr->clone(S.getASTContext()); 10382 NewAttr->setImplicit(true); 10383 return NewAttr; 10384 } 10385 10386 // The Microsoft compiler won't check outer classes for the CodeSeg 10387 // when the #pragma code_seg stack is active. 10388 if (S.CodeSegStack.CurrentValue) 10389 return nullptr; 10390 10391 while ((Parent = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Parent->getParent()))) { 10392 if (const auto *SAttr = Parent->getAttr<CodeSegAttr>()) { 10393 Attr *NewAttr = SAttr->clone(S.getASTContext()); 10394 NewAttr->setImplicit(true); 10395 return NewAttr; 10396 } 10397 } 10398 return nullptr; 10399 } 10400 10401 /// Returns an implicit CodeSegAttr if a __declspec(code_seg) is found on a 10402 /// containing class. Otherwise it will return implicit SectionAttr if the 10403 /// function is a definition and there is an active value on CodeSegStack 10404 /// (from the current #pragma code-seg value). 10405 /// 10406 /// \param FD Function being declared. 10407 /// \param IsDefinition Whether it is a definition or just a declarartion. 10408 /// \returns A CodeSegAttr or SectionAttr to apply to the function or 10409 /// nullptr if no attribute should be added. 10410 Attr *Sema::getImplicitCodeSegOrSectionAttrForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD, 10411 bool IsDefinition) { 10412 if (Attr *A = getImplicitCodeSegAttrFromClass(*this, FD)) 10413 return A; 10414 if (!FD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>() && IsDefinition && 10415 CodeSegStack.CurrentValue) 10416 return SectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 10417 getASTContext(), CodeSegStack.CurrentValue->getString(), 10418 CodeSegStack.CurrentPragmaLocation, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma, 10419 SectionAttr::Declspec_allocate); 10420 return nullptr; 10421 } 10422 10423 /// Determines if we can perform a correct type check for \p D as a 10424 /// redeclaration of \p PrevDecl. If not, we can generally still perform a 10425 /// best-effort check. 10426 /// 10427 /// \param NewD The new declaration. 10428 /// \param OldD The old declaration. 10429 /// \param NewT The portion of the type of the new declaration to check. 10430 /// \param OldT The portion of the type of the old declaration to check. 10431 bool Sema::canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(ValueDecl *NewD, ValueDecl *OldD, 10432 QualType NewT, QualType OldT) { 10433 if (!NewD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isDependentContext()) 10434 return true; 10435 10436 // For dependently-typed local extern declarations and friends, we can't 10437 // perform a correct type check in general until instantiation: 10438 // 10439 // int f(); 10440 // template<typename T> void g() { T f(); } 10441 // 10442 // (valid if g() is only instantiated with T = int). 10443 if (NewT->isDependentType() && 10444 (NewD->isLocalExternDecl() || NewD->getFriendObjectKind())) 10445 return false; 10446 10447 // Similarly, if the previous declaration was a dependent local extern 10448 // declaration, we don't really know its type yet. 10449 if (OldT->isDependentType() && OldD->isLocalExternDecl()) 10450 return false; 10451 10452 return true; 10453 } 10454 10455 /// Checks if the new declaration declared in dependent context must be 10456 /// put in the same redeclaration chain as the specified declaration. 10457 /// 10458 /// \param D Declaration that is checked. 10459 /// \param PrevDecl Previous declaration found with proper lookup method for the 10460 /// same declaration name. 10461 /// \returns True if D must be added to the redeclaration chain which PrevDecl 10462 /// belongs to. 10463 /// 10464 bool Sema::shouldLinkDependentDeclWithPrevious(Decl *D, Decl *PrevDecl) { 10465 if (!D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isDependentContext()) 10466 return true; 10467 10468 // Don't chain dependent friend function definitions until instantiation, to 10469 // permit cases like 10470 // 10471 // void func(); 10472 // template<typename T> class C1 { friend void func() {} }; 10473 // template<typename T> class C2 { friend void func() {} }; 10474 // 10475 // ... which is valid if only one of C1 and C2 is ever instantiated. 10476 // 10477 // FIXME: This need only apply to function definitions. For now, we proxy 10478 // this by checking for a file-scope function. We do not want this to apply 10479 // to friend declarations nominating member functions, because that gets in 10480 // the way of access checks. 10481 if (D->getFriendObjectKind() && D->getDeclContext()->isFileContext()) 10482 return false; 10483 10484 auto *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D); 10485 auto *PrevVD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(PrevDecl); 10486 return !VD || !PrevVD || 10487 canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(VD, PrevVD, VD->getType(), 10488 PrevVD->getType()); 10489 } 10490 10491 /// Check the target attribute of the function for MultiVersion 10492 /// validity. 10493 /// 10494 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise. 10495 static bool CheckMultiVersionValue(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *FD) { 10496 const auto *TA = FD->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 10497 assert(TA && "MultiVersion Candidate requires a target attribute"); 10498 ParsedTargetAttr ParseInfo = TA->parse(); 10499 const TargetInfo &TargetInfo = S.Context.getTargetInfo(); 10500 enum ErrType { Feature = 0, Architecture = 1 }; 10501 10502 if (!ParseInfo.Architecture.empty() && 10503 !TargetInfo.validateCpuIs(ParseInfo.Architecture)) { 10504 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_multiversion_option) 10505 << Architecture << ParseInfo.Architecture; 10506 return true; 10507 } 10508 10509 for (const auto &Feat : ParseInfo.Features) { 10510 auto BareFeat = StringRef{Feat}.substr(1); 10511 if (Feat[0] == '-') { 10512 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_multiversion_option) 10513 << Feature << ("no-" + BareFeat).str(); 10514 return true; 10515 } 10516 10517 if (!TargetInfo.validateCpuSupports(BareFeat) || 10518 !TargetInfo.isValidFeatureName(BareFeat)) { 10519 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_multiversion_option) 10520 << Feature << BareFeat; 10521 return true; 10522 } 10523 } 10524 return false; 10525 } 10526 10527 // Provide a white-list of attributes that are allowed to be combined with 10528 // multiversion functions. 10529 static bool AttrCompatibleWithMultiVersion(attr::Kind Kind, 10530 MultiVersionKind MVKind) { 10531 // Note: this list/diagnosis must match the list in 10532 // checkMultiversionAttributesAllSame. 10533 switch (Kind) { 10534 default: 10535 return false; 10536 case attr::Used: 10537 return MVKind == MultiVersionKind::Target; 10538 case attr::NonNull: 10539 case attr::NoThrow: 10540 return true; 10541 } 10542 } 10543 10544 static bool checkNonMultiVersionCompatAttributes(Sema &S, 10545 const FunctionDecl *FD, 10546 const FunctionDecl *CausedFD, 10547 MultiVersionKind MVKind) { 10548 const auto Diagnose = [FD, CausedFD, MVKind](Sema &S, const Attr *A) { 10549 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_disallowed_other_attr) 10550 << static_cast<unsigned>(MVKind) << A; 10551 if (CausedFD) 10552 S.Diag(CausedFD->getLocation(), diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here); 10553 return true; 10554 }; 10555 10556 for (const Attr *A : FD->attrs()) { 10557 switch (A->getKind()) { 10558 case attr::CPUDispatch: 10559 case attr::CPUSpecific: 10560 if (MVKind != MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch && 10561 MVKind != MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific) 10562 return Diagnose(S, A); 10563 break; 10564 case attr::Target: 10565 if (MVKind != MultiVersionKind::Target) 10566 return Diagnose(S, A); 10567 break; 10568 case attr::TargetClones: 10569 if (MVKind != MultiVersionKind::TargetClones) 10570 return Diagnose(S, A); 10571 break; 10572 default: 10573 if (!AttrCompatibleWithMultiVersion(A->getKind(), MVKind)) 10574 return Diagnose(S, A); 10575 break; 10576 } 10577 } 10578 return false; 10579 } 10580 10581 bool Sema::areMultiversionVariantFunctionsCompatible( 10582 const FunctionDecl *OldFD, const FunctionDecl *NewFD, 10583 const PartialDiagnostic &NoProtoDiagID, 10584 const PartialDiagnosticAt &NoteCausedDiagIDAt, 10585 const PartialDiagnosticAt &NoSupportDiagIDAt, 10586 const PartialDiagnosticAt &DiffDiagIDAt, bool TemplatesSupported, 10587 bool ConstexprSupported, bool CLinkageMayDiffer) { 10588 enum DoesntSupport { 10589 FuncTemplates = 0, 10590 VirtFuncs = 1, 10591 DeducedReturn = 2, 10592 Constructors = 3, 10593 Destructors = 4, 10594 DeletedFuncs = 5, 10595 DefaultedFuncs = 6, 10596 ConstexprFuncs = 7, 10597 ConstevalFuncs = 8, 10598 Lambda = 9, 10599 }; 10600 enum Different { 10601 CallingConv = 0, 10602 ReturnType = 1, 10603 ConstexprSpec = 2, 10604 InlineSpec = 3, 10605 Linkage = 4, 10606 LanguageLinkage = 5, 10607 }; 10608 10609 if (NoProtoDiagID.getDiagID() != 0 && OldFD && 10610 !OldFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 10611 Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), NoProtoDiagID); 10612 Diag(NoteCausedDiagIDAt.first, NoteCausedDiagIDAt.second); 10613 return true; 10614 } 10615 10616 if (NoProtoDiagID.getDiagID() != 0 && 10617 !NewFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 10618 return Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), NoProtoDiagID); 10619 10620 if (!TemplatesSupported && 10621 NewFD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplate) 10622 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10623 << FuncTemplates; 10624 10625 if (const auto *NewCXXFD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) { 10626 if (NewCXXFD->isVirtual()) 10627 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10628 << VirtFuncs; 10629 10630 if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewCXXFD)) 10631 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10632 << Constructors; 10633 10634 if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewCXXFD)) 10635 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10636 << Destructors; 10637 } 10638 10639 if (NewFD->isDeleted()) 10640 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10641 << DeletedFuncs; 10642 10643 if (NewFD->isDefaulted()) 10644 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10645 << DefaultedFuncs; 10646 10647 if (!ConstexprSupported && NewFD->isConstexpr()) 10648 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10649 << (NewFD->isConsteval() ? ConstevalFuncs : ConstexprFuncs); 10650 10651 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(NewFD->getType()); 10652 const auto *NewType = cast<FunctionType>(NewQType); 10653 QualType NewReturnType = NewType->getReturnType(); 10654 10655 if (NewReturnType->isUndeducedType()) 10656 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10657 << DeducedReturn; 10658 10659 // Ensure the return type is identical. 10660 if (OldFD) { 10661 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(OldFD->getType()); 10662 const auto *OldType = cast<FunctionType>(OldQType); 10663 FunctionType::ExtInfo OldTypeInfo = OldType->getExtInfo(); 10664 FunctionType::ExtInfo NewTypeInfo = NewType->getExtInfo(); 10665 10666 if (OldTypeInfo.getCC() != NewTypeInfo.getCC()) 10667 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << CallingConv; 10668 10669 QualType OldReturnType = OldType->getReturnType(); 10670 10671 if (OldReturnType != NewReturnType) 10672 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << ReturnType; 10673 10674 if (OldFD->getConstexprKind() != NewFD->getConstexprKind()) 10675 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << ConstexprSpec; 10676 10677 if (OldFD->isInlineSpecified() != NewFD->isInlineSpecified()) 10678 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << InlineSpec; 10679 10680 if (OldFD->getFormalLinkage() != NewFD->getFormalLinkage()) 10681 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << Linkage; 10682 10683 if (!CLinkageMayDiffer && OldFD->isExternC() != NewFD->isExternC()) 10684 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << LanguageLinkage; 10685 10686 if (CheckEquivalentExceptionSpec( 10687 OldFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(), OldFD->getLocation(), 10688 NewFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(), NewFD->getLocation())) 10689 return true; 10690 } 10691 return false; 10692 } 10693 10694 static bool CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *OldFD, 10695 const FunctionDecl *NewFD, 10696 bool CausesMV, 10697 MultiVersionKind MVKind) { 10698 if (!S.getASTContext().getTargetInfo().supportsMultiVersioning()) { 10699 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_not_supported); 10700 if (OldFD) 10701 S.Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10702 return true; 10703 } 10704 10705 bool IsCPUSpecificCPUDispatchMVKind = 10706 MVKind == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch || 10707 MVKind == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific; 10708 10709 if (CausesMV && OldFD && 10710 checkNonMultiVersionCompatAttributes(S, OldFD, NewFD, MVKind)) 10711 return true; 10712 10713 if (checkNonMultiVersionCompatAttributes(S, NewFD, nullptr, MVKind)) 10714 return true; 10715 10716 // Only allow transition to MultiVersion if it hasn't been used. 10717 if (OldFD && CausesMV && OldFD->isUsed(false)) 10718 return S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_after_used); 10719 10720 return S.areMultiversionVariantFunctionsCompatible( 10721 OldFD, NewFD, S.PDiag(diag::err_multiversion_noproto), 10722 PartialDiagnosticAt(NewFD->getLocation(), 10723 S.PDiag(diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here)), 10724 PartialDiagnosticAt(NewFD->getLocation(), 10725 S.PDiag(diag::err_multiversion_doesnt_support) 10726 << static_cast<unsigned>(MVKind)), 10727 PartialDiagnosticAt(NewFD->getLocation(), 10728 S.PDiag(diag::err_multiversion_diff)), 10729 /*TemplatesSupported=*/false, 10730 /*ConstexprSupported=*/!IsCPUSpecificCPUDispatchMVKind, 10731 /*CLinkageMayDiffer=*/false); 10732 } 10733 10734 /// Check the validity of a multiversion function declaration that is the 10735 /// first of its kind. Also sets the multiversion'ness' of the function itself. 10736 /// 10737 /// This sets NewFD->isInvalidDecl() to true if there was an error. 10738 /// 10739 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise. 10740 static bool CheckMultiVersionFirstFunction(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD, 10741 MultiVersionKind MVKind, 10742 const TargetAttr *TA) { 10743 assert(MVKind != MultiVersionKind::None && 10744 "Function lacks multiversion attribute"); 10745 10746 // Target only causes MV if it is default, otherwise this is a normal 10747 // function. 10748 if (MVKind == MultiVersionKind::Target && !TA->isDefaultVersion()) 10749 return false; 10750 10751 if (MVKind == MultiVersionKind::Target && CheckMultiVersionValue(S, FD)) { 10752 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 10753 return true; 10754 } 10755 10756 if (CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(S, nullptr, FD, true, MVKind)) { 10757 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 10758 return true; 10759 } 10760 10761 FD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10762 return false; 10763 } 10764 10765 static bool PreviousDeclsHaveMultiVersionAttribute(const FunctionDecl *FD) { 10766 for (const Decl *D = FD->getPreviousDecl(); D; D = D->getPreviousDecl()) { 10767 if (D->getAsFunction()->getMultiVersionKind() != MultiVersionKind::None) 10768 return true; 10769 } 10770 10771 return false; 10772 } 10773 10774 static bool CheckTargetCausesMultiVersioning( 10775 Sema &S, FunctionDecl *OldFD, FunctionDecl *NewFD, const TargetAttr *NewTA, 10776 bool &Redeclaration, NamedDecl *&OldDecl, LookupResult &Previous) { 10777 const auto *OldTA = OldFD->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 10778 ParsedTargetAttr NewParsed = NewTA->parse(); 10779 // Sort order doesn't matter, it just needs to be consistent. 10780 llvm::sort(NewParsed.Features); 10781 10782 // If the old decl is NOT MultiVersioned yet, and we don't cause that 10783 // to change, this is a simple redeclaration. 10784 if (!NewTA->isDefaultVersion() && 10785 (!OldTA || OldTA->getFeaturesStr() == NewTA->getFeaturesStr())) 10786 return false; 10787 10788 // Otherwise, this decl causes MultiVersioning. 10789 if (CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(S, OldFD, NewFD, true, 10790 MultiVersionKind::Target)) { 10791 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10792 return true; 10793 } 10794 10795 if (CheckMultiVersionValue(S, NewFD)) { 10796 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10797 return true; 10798 } 10799 10800 // If this is 'default', permit the forward declaration. 10801 if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion() && !OldTA && NewTA->isDefaultVersion()) { 10802 Redeclaration = true; 10803 OldDecl = OldFD; 10804 OldFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10805 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10806 return false; 10807 } 10808 10809 if (CheckMultiVersionValue(S, OldFD)) { 10810 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here); 10811 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10812 return true; 10813 } 10814 10815 ParsedTargetAttr OldParsed = OldTA->parse(std::less<std::string>()); 10816 10817 if (OldParsed == NewParsed) { 10818 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_duplicate); 10819 S.Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10820 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10821 return true; 10822 } 10823 10824 for (const auto *FD : OldFD->redecls()) { 10825 const auto *CurTA = FD->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 10826 // We allow forward declarations before ANY multiversioning attributes, but 10827 // nothing after the fact. 10828 if (PreviousDeclsHaveMultiVersionAttribute(FD) && 10829 (!CurTA || CurTA->isInherited())) { 10830 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_required_in_redecl) 10831 << 0; 10832 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here); 10833 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10834 return true; 10835 } 10836 } 10837 10838 OldFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10839 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10840 Redeclaration = false; 10841 OldDecl = nullptr; 10842 Previous.clear(); 10843 return false; 10844 } 10845 10846 static bool MultiVersionTypesCompatible(MultiVersionKind Old, 10847 MultiVersionKind New) { 10848 if (Old == New || Old == MultiVersionKind::None || 10849 New == MultiVersionKind::None) 10850 return true; 10851 10852 return (Old == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch && 10853 New == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific) || 10854 (Old == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific && 10855 New == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch); 10856 } 10857 10858 /// Check the validity of a new function declaration being added to an existing 10859 /// multiversioned declaration collection. 10860 static bool CheckMultiVersionAdditionalDecl( 10861 Sema &S, FunctionDecl *OldFD, FunctionDecl *NewFD, 10862 MultiVersionKind NewMVKind, const TargetAttr *NewTA, 10863 const CPUDispatchAttr *NewCPUDisp, const CPUSpecificAttr *NewCPUSpec, 10864 const TargetClonesAttr *NewClones, bool &Redeclaration, NamedDecl *&OldDecl, 10865 LookupResult &Previous) { 10866 10867 MultiVersionKind OldMVKind = OldFD->getMultiVersionKind(); 10868 // Disallow mixing of multiversioning types. 10869 if (!MultiVersionTypesCompatible(OldMVKind, NewMVKind)) { 10870 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_types_mixed); 10871 S.Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10872 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10873 return true; 10874 } 10875 10876 ParsedTargetAttr NewParsed; 10877 if (NewTA) { 10878 NewParsed = NewTA->parse(); 10879 llvm::sort(NewParsed.Features); 10880 } 10881 10882 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules = 10883 S.CurContext->isRecord() && !NewFD->getFriendObjectKind(); 10884 10885 bool MayNeedOverloadableChecks = 10886 AllowOverloadingOfFunction(Previous, S.Context, NewFD); 10887 10888 // Next, check ALL non-overloads to see if this is a redeclaration of a 10889 // previous member of the MultiVersion set. 10890 for (NamedDecl *ND : Previous) { 10891 FunctionDecl *CurFD = ND->getAsFunction(); 10892 if (!CurFD) 10893 continue; 10894 if (MayNeedOverloadableChecks && 10895 S.IsOverload(NewFD, CurFD, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) 10896 continue; 10897 10898 switch (NewMVKind) { 10899 case MultiVersionKind::None: 10900 assert(OldMVKind == MultiVersionKind::TargetClones && 10901 "Only target_clones can be omitted in subsequent declarations"); 10902 break; 10903 case MultiVersionKind::Target: { 10904 const auto *CurTA = CurFD->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 10905 if (CurTA->getFeaturesStr() == NewTA->getFeaturesStr()) { 10906 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10907 Redeclaration = true; 10908 OldDecl = ND; 10909 return false; 10910 } 10911 10912 ParsedTargetAttr CurParsed = CurTA->parse(std::less<std::string>()); 10913 if (CurParsed == NewParsed) { 10914 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_duplicate); 10915 S.Diag(CurFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10916 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10917 return true; 10918 } 10919 break; 10920 } 10921 case MultiVersionKind::TargetClones: { 10922 const auto *CurClones = CurFD->getAttr<TargetClonesAttr>(); 10923 Redeclaration = true; 10924 OldDecl = CurFD; 10925 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10926 10927 if (CurClones && NewClones && 10928 (CurClones->featuresStrs_size() != NewClones->featuresStrs_size() || 10929 !std::equal(CurClones->featuresStrs_begin(), 10930 CurClones->featuresStrs_end(), 10931 NewClones->featuresStrs_begin()))) { 10932 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_target_clone_doesnt_match); 10933 S.Diag(CurFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10934 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10935 return true; 10936 } 10937 10938 return false; 10939 } 10940 case MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific: 10941 case MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch: { 10942 const auto *CurCPUSpec = CurFD->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>(); 10943 const auto *CurCPUDisp = CurFD->getAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>(); 10944 // Handle CPUDispatch/CPUSpecific versions. 10945 // Only 1 CPUDispatch function is allowed, this will make it go through 10946 // the redeclaration errors. 10947 if (NewMVKind == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch && 10948 CurFD->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>()) { 10949 if (CurCPUDisp->cpus_size() == NewCPUDisp->cpus_size() && 10950 std::equal( 10951 CurCPUDisp->cpus_begin(), CurCPUDisp->cpus_end(), 10952 NewCPUDisp->cpus_begin(), 10953 [](const IdentifierInfo *Cur, const IdentifierInfo *New) { 10954 return Cur->getName() == New->getName(); 10955 })) { 10956 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10957 Redeclaration = true; 10958 OldDecl = ND; 10959 return false; 10960 } 10961 10962 // If the declarations don't match, this is an error condition. 10963 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_cpu_dispatch_mismatch); 10964 S.Diag(CurFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10965 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10966 return true; 10967 } 10968 if (NewMVKind == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific && CurCPUSpec) { 10969 if (CurCPUSpec->cpus_size() == NewCPUSpec->cpus_size() && 10970 std::equal( 10971 CurCPUSpec->cpus_begin(), CurCPUSpec->cpus_end(), 10972 NewCPUSpec->cpus_begin(), 10973 [](const IdentifierInfo *Cur, const IdentifierInfo *New) { 10974 return Cur->getName() == New->getName(); 10975 })) { 10976 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10977 Redeclaration = true; 10978 OldDecl = ND; 10979 return false; 10980 } 10981 10982 // Only 1 version of CPUSpecific is allowed for each CPU. 10983 for (const IdentifierInfo *CurII : CurCPUSpec->cpus()) { 10984 for (const IdentifierInfo *NewII : NewCPUSpec->cpus()) { 10985 if (CurII == NewII) { 10986 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_cpu_specific_multiple_defs) 10987 << NewII; 10988 S.Diag(CurFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10989 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10990 return true; 10991 } 10992 } 10993 } 10994 } 10995 break; 10996 } 10997 } 10998 } 10999 11000 // Else, this is simply a non-redecl case. Checking the 'value' is only 11001 // necessary in the Target case, since The CPUSpecific/Dispatch cases are 11002 // handled in the attribute adding step. 11003 if (NewMVKind == MultiVersionKind::Target && 11004 CheckMultiVersionValue(S, NewFD)) { 11005 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11006 return true; 11007 } 11008 11009 if (CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(S, OldFD, NewFD, 11010 !OldFD->isMultiVersion(), NewMVKind)) { 11011 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11012 return true; 11013 } 11014 11015 // Permit forward declarations in the case where these two are compatible. 11016 if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion()) { 11017 OldFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 11018 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 11019 Redeclaration = true; 11020 OldDecl = OldFD; 11021 return false; 11022 } 11023 11024 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 11025 Redeclaration = false; 11026 OldDecl = nullptr; 11027 Previous.clear(); 11028 return false; 11029 } 11030 11031 /// Check the validity of a mulitversion function declaration. 11032 /// Also sets the multiversion'ness' of the function itself. 11033 /// 11034 /// This sets NewFD->isInvalidDecl() to true if there was an error. 11035 /// 11036 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise. 11037 static bool CheckMultiVersionFunction(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *NewFD, 11038 bool &Redeclaration, NamedDecl *&OldDecl, 11039 LookupResult &Previous) { 11040 const auto *NewTA = NewFD->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 11041 const auto *NewCPUDisp = NewFD->getAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>(); 11042 const auto *NewCPUSpec = NewFD->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>(); 11043 const auto *NewClones = NewFD->getAttr<TargetClonesAttr>(); 11044 MultiVersionKind MVKind = NewFD->getMultiVersionKind(); 11045 11046 // Main isn't allowed to become a multiversion function, however it IS 11047 // permitted to have 'main' be marked with the 'target' optimization hint. 11048 if (NewFD->isMain()) { 11049 if (MVKind != MultiVersionKind::None && 11050 !(MVKind == MultiVersionKind::Target && !NewTA->isDefaultVersion())) { 11051 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_not_allowed_on_main); 11052 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11053 return true; 11054 } 11055 return false; 11056 } 11057 11058 if (!OldDecl || !OldDecl->getAsFunction() || 11059 OldDecl->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext() != 11060 NewFD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()) { 11061 // If there's no previous declaration, AND this isn't attempting to cause 11062 // multiversioning, this isn't an error condition. 11063 if (MVKind == MultiVersionKind::None) 11064 return false; 11065 return CheckMultiVersionFirstFunction(S, NewFD, MVKind, NewTA); 11066 } 11067 11068 FunctionDecl *OldFD = OldDecl->getAsFunction(); 11069 11070 if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion() && MVKind == MultiVersionKind::None) 11071 return false; 11072 11073 // Multiversioned redeclarations aren't allowed to omit the attribute, except 11074 // for target_clones. 11075 if (OldFD->isMultiVersion() && MVKind == MultiVersionKind::None && 11076 OldFD->getMultiVersionKind() != MultiVersionKind::TargetClones) { 11077 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_required_in_redecl) 11078 << (OldFD->getMultiVersionKind() != MultiVersionKind::Target); 11079 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11080 return true; 11081 } 11082 11083 if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion()) { 11084 switch (MVKind) { 11085 case MultiVersionKind::Target: 11086 return CheckTargetCausesMultiVersioning(S, OldFD, NewFD, NewTA, 11087 Redeclaration, OldDecl, Previous); 11088 case MultiVersionKind::TargetClones: 11089 if (OldFD->isUsed(false)) { 11090 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11091 return S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_after_used); 11092 } 11093 OldFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 11094 break; 11095 case MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch: 11096 case MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific: 11097 case MultiVersionKind::None: 11098 break; 11099 } 11100 } 11101 11102 // At this point, we have a multiversion function decl (in OldFD) AND an 11103 // appropriate attribute in the current function decl. Resolve that these are 11104 // still compatible with previous declarations. 11105 return CheckMultiVersionAdditionalDecl(S, OldFD, NewFD, MVKind, NewTA, 11106 NewCPUDisp, NewCPUSpec, NewClones, 11107 Redeclaration, OldDecl, Previous); 11108 } 11109 11110 /// Perform semantic checking of a new function declaration. 11111 /// 11112 /// Performs semantic analysis of the new function declaration 11113 /// NewFD. This routine performs all semantic checking that does not 11114 /// require the actual declarator involved in the declaration, and is 11115 /// used both for the declaration of functions as they are parsed 11116 /// (called via ActOnDeclarator) and for the declaration of functions 11117 /// that have been instantiated via C++ template instantiation (called 11118 /// via InstantiateDecl). 11119 /// 11120 /// \param IsMemberSpecialization whether this new function declaration is 11121 /// a member specialization (that replaces any definition provided by the 11122 /// previous declaration). 11123 /// 11124 /// This sets NewFD->isInvalidDecl() to true if there was an error. 11125 /// 11126 /// \returns true if the function declaration is a redeclaration. 11127 bool Sema::CheckFunctionDeclaration(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *NewFD, 11128 LookupResult &Previous, 11129 bool IsMemberSpecialization, 11130 bool DeclIsDefn) { 11131 assert(!NewFD->getReturnType()->isVariablyModifiedType() && 11132 "Variably modified return types are not handled here"); 11133 11134 // Determine whether the type of this function should be merged with 11135 // a previous visible declaration. This never happens for functions in C++, 11136 // and always happens in C if the previous declaration was visible. 11137 bool MergeTypeWithPrevious = !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 11138 !Previous.isShadowed(); 11139 11140 bool Redeclaration = false; 11141 NamedDecl *OldDecl = nullptr; 11142 bool MayNeedOverloadableChecks = false; 11143 11144 // Merge or overload the declaration with an existing declaration of 11145 // the same name, if appropriate. 11146 if (!Previous.empty()) { 11147 // Determine whether NewFD is an overload of PrevDecl or 11148 // a declaration that requires merging. If it's an overload, 11149 // there's no more work to do here; we'll just add the new 11150 // function to the scope. 11151 if (!AllowOverloadingOfFunction(Previous, Context, NewFD)) { 11152 NamedDecl *Candidate = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(); 11153 if (shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(Candidate, NewFD)) { 11154 Redeclaration = true; 11155 OldDecl = Candidate; 11156 } 11157 } else { 11158 MayNeedOverloadableChecks = true; 11159 switch (CheckOverload(S, NewFD, Previous, OldDecl, 11160 /*NewIsUsingDecl*/ false)) { 11161 case Ovl_Match: 11162 Redeclaration = true; 11163 break; 11164 11165 case Ovl_NonFunction: 11166 Redeclaration = true; 11167 break; 11168 11169 case Ovl_Overload: 11170 Redeclaration = false; 11171 break; 11172 } 11173 } 11174 } 11175 11176 // Check for a previous extern "C" declaration with this name. 11177 if (!Redeclaration && 11178 checkForConflictWithNonVisibleExternC(*this, NewFD, Previous)) { 11179 if (!Previous.empty()) { 11180 // This is an extern "C" declaration with the same name as a previous 11181 // declaration, and thus redeclares that entity... 11182 Redeclaration = true; 11183 OldDecl = Previous.getFoundDecl(); 11184 MergeTypeWithPrevious = false; 11185 11186 // ... except in the presence of __attribute__((overloadable)). 11187 if (OldDecl->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>() || 11188 NewFD->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>()) { 11189 if (IsOverload(NewFD, cast<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl), false)) { 11190 MayNeedOverloadableChecks = true; 11191 Redeclaration = false; 11192 OldDecl = nullptr; 11193 } 11194 } 11195 } 11196 } 11197 11198 if (CheckMultiVersionFunction(*this, NewFD, Redeclaration, OldDecl, Previous)) 11199 return Redeclaration; 11200 11201 // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as function return types. 11202 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() && 11203 CheckPPCMMAType(NewFD->getReturnType(), NewFD->getLocation())) { 11204 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11205 } 11206 11207 // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p8: 11208 // A constexpr specifier for a non-static member function that is not 11209 // a constructor declares that member function to be const. 11210 // 11211 // This needs to be delayed until we know whether this is an out-of-line 11212 // definition of a static member function. 11213 // 11214 // This rule is not present in C++1y, so we produce a backwards 11215 // compatibility warning whenever it happens in C++11. 11216 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD); 11217 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && MD && MD->isConstexpr() && 11218 !MD->isStatic() && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD) && 11219 !isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD) && !MD->getMethodQualifiers().hasConst()) { 11220 CXXMethodDecl *OldMD = nullptr; 11221 if (OldDecl) 11222 OldMD = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(OldDecl->getAsFunction()); 11223 if (!OldMD || !OldMD->isStatic()) { 11224 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = 11225 MD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 11226 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo(); 11227 EPI.TypeQuals.addConst(); 11228 MD->setType(Context.getFunctionType(FPT->getReturnType(), 11229 FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI)); 11230 11231 // Warn that we did this, if we're not performing template instantiation. 11232 // In that case, we'll have warned already when the template was defined. 11233 if (!inTemplateInstantiation()) { 11234 SourceLocation AddConstLoc; 11235 if (FunctionTypeLoc FTL = MD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc() 11236 .IgnoreParens().getAs<FunctionTypeLoc>()) 11237 AddConstLoc = getLocForEndOfToken(FTL.getRParenLoc()); 11238 11239 Diag(MD->getLocation(), diag::warn_cxx14_compat_constexpr_not_const) 11240 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(AddConstLoc, " const"); 11241 } 11242 } 11243 } 11244 11245 if (Redeclaration) { 11246 // NewFD and OldDecl represent declarations that need to be 11247 // merged. 11248 if (MergeFunctionDecl(NewFD, OldDecl, S, MergeTypeWithPrevious, 11249 DeclIsDefn)) { 11250 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11251 return Redeclaration; 11252 } 11253 11254 Previous.clear(); 11255 Previous.addDecl(OldDecl); 11256 11257 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplateDecl = 11258 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldDecl)) { 11259 auto *OldFD = OldTemplateDecl->getTemplatedDecl(); 11260 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplateDecl 11261 = NewFD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate(); 11262 assert(NewTemplateDecl && "Template/non-template mismatch"); 11263 11264 // The call to MergeFunctionDecl above may have created some state in 11265 // NewTemplateDecl that needs to be merged with OldTemplateDecl before we 11266 // can add it as a redeclaration. 11267 NewTemplateDecl->mergePrevDecl(OldTemplateDecl); 11268 11269 NewFD->setPreviousDeclaration(OldFD); 11270 if (NewFD->isCXXClassMember()) { 11271 NewFD->setAccess(OldTemplateDecl->getAccess()); 11272 NewTemplateDecl->setAccess(OldTemplateDecl->getAccess()); 11273 } 11274 11275 // If this is an explicit specialization of a member that is a function 11276 // template, mark it as a member specialization. 11277 if (IsMemberSpecialization && 11278 NewTemplateDecl->getInstantiatedFromMemberTemplate()) { 11279 NewTemplateDecl->setMemberSpecialization(); 11280 assert(OldTemplateDecl->isMemberSpecialization()); 11281 // Explicit specializations of a member template do not inherit deleted 11282 // status from the parent member template that they are specializing. 11283 if (OldFD->isDeleted()) { 11284 // FIXME: This assert will not hold in the presence of modules. 11285 assert(OldFD->getCanonicalDecl() == OldFD); 11286 // FIXME: We need an update record for this AST mutation. 11287 OldFD->setDeletedAsWritten(false); 11288 } 11289 } 11290 11291 } else { 11292 if (shouldLinkDependentDeclWithPrevious(NewFD, OldDecl)) { 11293 auto *OldFD = cast<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl); 11294 // This needs to happen first so that 'inline' propagates. 11295 NewFD->setPreviousDeclaration(OldFD); 11296 if (NewFD->isCXXClassMember()) 11297 NewFD->setAccess(OldFD->getAccess()); 11298 } 11299 } 11300 } else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && MayNeedOverloadableChecks && 11301 !NewFD->getAttr<OverloadableAttr>()) { 11302 assert((Previous.empty() || 11303 llvm::any_of(Previous, 11304 [](const NamedDecl *ND) { 11305 return ND->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 11306 })) && 11307 "Non-redecls shouldn't happen without overloadable present"); 11308 11309 auto OtherUnmarkedIter = llvm::find_if(Previous, [](const NamedDecl *ND) { 11310 const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(ND); 11311 return FD && !FD->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 11312 }); 11313 11314 if (OtherUnmarkedIter != Previous.end()) { 11315 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 11316 diag::err_attribute_overloadable_multiple_unmarked_overloads); 11317 Diag((*OtherUnmarkedIter)->getLocation(), 11318 diag::note_attribute_overloadable_prev_overload) 11319 << false; 11320 11321 NewFD->addAttr(OverloadableAttr::CreateImplicit(Context)); 11322 } 11323 } 11324 11325 if (LangOpts.OpenMP) 11326 ActOnFinishedFunctionDefinitionInOpenMPAssumeScope(NewFD); 11327 11328 // Semantic checking for this function declaration (in isolation). 11329 11330 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 11331 // C++-specific checks. 11332 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewFD)) { 11333 CheckConstructor(Constructor); 11334 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = 11335 dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewFD)) { 11336 CXXRecordDecl *Record = Destructor->getParent(); 11337 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Record); 11338 11339 // FIXME: Shouldn't we be able to perform this check even when the class 11340 // type is dependent? Both gcc and edg can handle that. 11341 if (!ClassType->isDependentType()) { 11342 DeclarationName Name 11343 = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDestructorName( 11344 Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType)); 11345 if (NewFD->getDeclName() != Name) { 11346 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_destructor_name); 11347 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11348 return Redeclaration; 11349 } 11350 } 11351 } else if (auto *Guide = dyn_cast<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(NewFD)) { 11352 if (auto *TD = Guide->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) 11353 CheckDeductionGuideTemplate(TD); 11354 11355 // A deduction guide is not on the list of entities that can be 11356 // explicitly specialized. 11357 if (Guide->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization) 11358 Diag(Guide->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_deduction_guide_specialized) 11359 << /*explicit specialization*/ 1; 11360 } 11361 11362 // Find any virtual functions that this function overrides. 11363 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) { 11364 if (!Method->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization() && 11365 !Method->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() && 11366 Method->isCanonicalDecl()) { 11367 AddOverriddenMethods(Method->getParent(), Method); 11368 } 11369 if (Method->isVirtual() && NewFD->getTrailingRequiresClause()) 11370 // C++2a [class.virtual]p6 11371 // A virtual method shall not have a requires-clause. 11372 Diag(NewFD->getTrailingRequiresClause()->getBeginLoc(), 11373 diag::err_constrained_virtual_method); 11374 11375 if (Method->isStatic()) 11376 checkThisInStaticMemberFunctionType(Method); 11377 } 11378 11379 // C++20: dcl.decl.general p4: 11380 // The optional requires-clause ([temp.pre]) in an init-declarator or 11381 // member-declarator shall be present only if the declarator declares a 11382 // templated function ([dcl.fct]). 11383 if (Expr *TRC = NewFD->getTrailingRequiresClause()) { 11384 if (!NewFD->isTemplated() && !NewFD->isTemplateInstantiation()) 11385 Diag(TRC->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_constrained_non_templated_function); 11386 } 11387 11388 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(NewFD)) 11389 ActOnConversionDeclarator(Conversion); 11390 11391 // Extra checking for C++ overloaded operators (C++ [over.oper]). 11392 if (NewFD->isOverloadedOperator() && 11393 CheckOverloadedOperatorDeclaration(NewFD)) { 11394 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11395 return Redeclaration; 11396 } 11397 11398 // Extra checking for C++0x literal operators (C++0x [over.literal]). 11399 if (NewFD->getLiteralIdentifier() && 11400 CheckLiteralOperatorDeclaration(NewFD)) { 11401 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11402 return Redeclaration; 11403 } 11404 11405 // In C++, check default arguments now that we have merged decls. Unless 11406 // the lexical context is the class, because in this case this is done 11407 // during delayed parsing anyway. 11408 if (!CurContext->isRecord()) 11409 CheckCXXDefaultArguments(NewFD); 11410 11411 // If this function is declared as being extern "C", then check to see if 11412 // the function returns a UDT (class, struct, or union type) that is not C 11413 // compatible, and if it does, warn the user. 11414 // But, issue any diagnostic on the first declaration only. 11415 if (Previous.empty() && NewFD->isExternC()) { 11416 QualType R = NewFD->getReturnType(); 11417 if (R->isIncompleteType() && !R->isVoidType()) 11418 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::warn_return_value_udt_incomplete) 11419 << NewFD << R; 11420 else if (!R.isPODType(Context) && !R->isVoidType() && 11421 !R->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 11422 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::warn_return_value_udt) << NewFD << R; 11423 } 11424 11425 // C++1z [dcl.fct]p6: 11426 // [...] whether the function has a non-throwing exception-specification 11427 // [is] part of the function type 11428 // 11429 // This results in an ABI break between C++14 and C++17 for functions whose 11430 // declared type includes an exception-specification in a parameter or 11431 // return type. (Exception specifications on the function itself are OK in 11432 // most cases, and exception specifications are not permitted in most other 11433 // contexts where they could make it into a mangling.) 11434 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 && !NewFD->getPrimaryTemplate()) { 11435 auto HasNoexcept = [&](QualType T) -> bool { 11436 // Strip off declarator chunks that could be between us and a function 11437 // type. We don't need to look far, exception specifications are very 11438 // restricted prior to C++17. 11439 if (auto *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 11440 T = RT->getPointeeType(); 11441 else if (T->isAnyPointerType()) 11442 T = T->getPointeeType(); 11443 else if (auto *MPT = T->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 11444 T = MPT->getPointeeType(); 11445 if (auto *FPT = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 11446 if (FPT->isNothrow()) 11447 return true; 11448 return false; 11449 }; 11450 11451 auto *FPT = NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 11452 bool AnyNoexcept = HasNoexcept(FPT->getReturnType()); 11453 for (QualType T : FPT->param_types()) 11454 AnyNoexcept |= HasNoexcept(T); 11455 if (AnyNoexcept) 11456 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 11457 diag::warn_cxx17_compat_exception_spec_in_signature) 11458 << NewFD; 11459 } 11460 11461 if (!Redeclaration && LangOpts.CUDA) 11462 checkCUDATargetOverload(NewFD, Previous); 11463 } 11464 return Redeclaration; 11465 } 11466 11467 void Sema::CheckMain(FunctionDecl* FD, const DeclSpec& DS) { 11468 // C++11 [basic.start.main]p3: 11469 // A program that [...] declares main to be inline, static or 11470 // constexpr is ill-formed. 11471 // C11 6.7.4p4: In a hosted environment, no function specifier(s) shall 11472 // appear in a declaration of main. 11473 // static main is not an error under C99, but we should warn about it. 11474 // We accept _Noreturn main as an extension. 11475 if (FD->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) 11476 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 11477 ? diag::err_static_main : diag::warn_static_main) 11478 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 11479 if (FD->isInlineSpecified()) 11480 Diag(DS.getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_main) 11481 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getInlineSpecLoc()); 11482 if (DS.isNoreturnSpecified()) { 11483 SourceLocation NoreturnLoc = DS.getNoreturnSpecLoc(); 11484 SourceRange NoreturnRange(NoreturnLoc, getLocForEndOfToken(NoreturnLoc)); 11485 Diag(NoreturnLoc, diag::ext_noreturn_main); 11486 Diag(NoreturnLoc, diag::note_main_remove_noreturn) 11487 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(NoreturnRange); 11488 } 11489 if (FD->isConstexpr()) { 11490 Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_main) 11491 << FD->isConsteval() 11492 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc()); 11493 FD->setConstexprKind(ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified); 11494 } 11495 11496 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 11497 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_no_main) 11498 << FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>(); 11499 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 11500 return; 11501 } 11502 11503 // Functions named main in hlsl are default entries, but don't have specific 11504 // signatures they are required to conform to. 11505 if (getLangOpts().HLSL) 11506 return; 11507 11508 QualType T = FD->getType(); 11509 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "function decl is not of function type"); 11510 const FunctionType* FT = T->castAs<FunctionType>(); 11511 11512 // Set default calling convention for main() 11513 if (FT->getCallConv() != CC_C) { 11514 FT = Context.adjustFunctionType(FT, FT->getExtInfo().withCallingConv(CC_C)); 11515 FD->setType(QualType(FT, 0)); 11516 T = Context.getCanonicalType(FD->getType()); 11517 } 11518 11519 if (getLangOpts().GNUMode && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 11520 // In C with GNU extensions we allow main() to have non-integer return 11521 // type, but we should warn about the extension, and we disable the 11522 // implicit-return-zero rule. 11523 11524 // GCC in C mode accepts qualified 'int'. 11525 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FT->getReturnType(), Context.IntTy)) 11526 FD->setHasImplicitReturnZero(true); 11527 else { 11528 Diag(FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::ext_main_returns_nonint); 11529 SourceRange RTRange = FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 11530 if (RTRange.isValid()) 11531 Diag(RTRange.getBegin(), diag::note_main_change_return_type) 11532 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(RTRange, "int"); 11533 } 11534 } else { 11535 // In C and C++, main magically returns 0 if you fall off the end; 11536 // set the flag which tells us that. 11537 // This is C++ [basic.start.main]p5 and C99 5.1.2.2.3. 11538 11539 // All the standards say that main() should return 'int'. 11540 if (Context.hasSameType(FT->getReturnType(), Context.IntTy)) 11541 FD->setHasImplicitReturnZero(true); 11542 else { 11543 // Otherwise, this is just a flat-out error. 11544 SourceRange RTRange = FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 11545 Diag(FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::err_main_returns_nonint) 11546 << (RTRange.isValid() ? FixItHint::CreateReplacement(RTRange, "int") 11547 : FixItHint()); 11548 FD->setInvalidDecl(true); 11549 } 11550 } 11551 11552 // Treat protoless main() as nullary. 11553 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FT)) return; 11554 11555 const FunctionProtoType* FTP = cast<const FunctionProtoType>(FT); 11556 unsigned nparams = FTP->getNumParams(); 11557 assert(FD->getNumParams() == nparams); 11558 11559 bool HasExtraParameters = (nparams > 3); 11560 11561 if (FTP->isVariadic()) { 11562 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_variadic_main); 11563 // FIXME: if we had information about the location of the ellipsis, we 11564 // could add a FixIt hint to remove it as a parameter. 11565 } 11566 11567 // Darwin passes an undocumented fourth argument of type char**. If 11568 // other platforms start sprouting these, the logic below will start 11569 // getting shifty. 11570 if (nparams == 4 && Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isOSDarwin()) 11571 HasExtraParameters = false; 11572 11573 if (HasExtraParameters) { 11574 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_main_surplus_args) << nparams; 11575 FD->setInvalidDecl(true); 11576 nparams = 3; 11577 } 11578 11579 // FIXME: a lot of the following diagnostics would be improved 11580 // if we had some location information about types. 11581 11582 QualType CharPP = 11583 Context.getPointerType(Context.getPointerType(Context.CharTy)); 11584 QualType Expected[] = { Context.IntTy, CharPP, CharPP, CharPP }; 11585 11586 for (unsigned i = 0; i < nparams; ++i) { 11587 QualType AT = FTP->getParamType(i); 11588 11589 bool mismatch = true; 11590 11591 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(AT, Expected[i])) 11592 mismatch = false; 11593 else if (Expected[i] == CharPP) { 11594 // As an extension, the following forms are okay: 11595 // char const ** 11596 // char const * const * 11597 // char * const * 11598 11599 QualifierCollector qs; 11600 const PointerType* PT; 11601 if ((PT = qs.strip(AT)->getAs<PointerType>()) && 11602 (PT = qs.strip(PT->getPointeeType())->getAs<PointerType>()) && 11603 Context.hasSameType(QualType(qs.strip(PT->getPointeeType()), 0), 11604 Context.CharTy)) { 11605 qs.removeConst(); 11606 mismatch = !qs.empty(); 11607 } 11608 } 11609 11610 if (mismatch) { 11611 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_main_arg_wrong) << i << Expected[i]; 11612 // TODO: suggest replacing given type with expected type 11613 FD->setInvalidDecl(true); 11614 } 11615 } 11616 11617 if (nparams == 1 && !FD->isInvalidDecl()) { 11618 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_main_one_arg); 11619 } 11620 11621 if (!FD->isInvalidDecl() && FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) { 11622 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_mainlike_template_decl) << FD; 11623 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 11624 } 11625 } 11626 11627 static bool isDefaultStdCall(FunctionDecl *FD, Sema &S) { 11628 11629 // Default calling convention for main and wmain is __cdecl 11630 if (FD->getName() == "main" || FD->getName() == "wmain") 11631 return false; 11632 11633 // Default calling convention for MinGW is __cdecl 11634 const llvm::Triple &T = S.Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple(); 11635 if (T.isWindowsGNUEnvironment()) 11636 return false; 11637 11638 // Default calling convention for WinMain, wWinMain and DllMain 11639 // is __stdcall on 32 bit Windows 11640 if (T.isOSWindows() && T.getArch() == llvm::Triple::x86) 11641 return true; 11642 11643 return false; 11644 } 11645 11646 void Sema::CheckMSVCRTEntryPoint(FunctionDecl *FD) { 11647 QualType T = FD->getType(); 11648 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "function decl is not of function type"); 11649 const FunctionType *FT = T->castAs<FunctionType>(); 11650 11651 // Set an implicit return of 'zero' if the function can return some integral, 11652 // enumeration, pointer or nullptr type. 11653 if (FT->getReturnType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() || 11654 FT->getReturnType()->isAnyPointerType() || 11655 FT->getReturnType()->isNullPtrType()) 11656 // DllMain is exempt because a return value of zero means it failed. 11657 if (FD->getName() != "DllMain") 11658 FD->setHasImplicitReturnZero(true); 11659 11660 // Explicity specified calling conventions are applied to MSVC entry points 11661 if (!hasExplicitCallingConv(T)) { 11662 if (isDefaultStdCall(FD, *this)) { 11663 if (FT->getCallConv() != CC_X86StdCall) { 11664 FT = Context.adjustFunctionType( 11665 FT, FT->getExtInfo().withCallingConv(CC_X86StdCall)); 11666 FD->setType(QualType(FT, 0)); 11667 } 11668 } else if (FT->getCallConv() != CC_C) { 11669 FT = Context.adjustFunctionType(FT, 11670 FT->getExtInfo().withCallingConv(CC_C)); 11671 FD->setType(QualType(FT, 0)); 11672 } 11673 } 11674 11675 if (!FD->isInvalidDecl() && FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) { 11676 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_mainlike_template_decl) << FD; 11677 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 11678 } 11679 } 11680 11681 bool Sema::CheckForConstantInitializer(Expr *Init, QualType DclT) { 11682 // FIXME: Need strict checking. In C89, we need to check for 11683 // any assignment, increment, decrement, function-calls, or 11684 // commas outside of a sizeof. In C99, it's the same list, 11685 // except that the aforementioned are allowed in unevaluated 11686 // expressions. Everything else falls under the 11687 // "may accept other forms of constant expressions" exception. 11688 // 11689 // Regular C++ code will not end up here (exceptions: language extensions, 11690 // OpenCL C++ etc), so the constant expression rules there don't matter. 11691 if (Init->isValueDependent()) { 11692 assert(Init->containsErrors() && 11693 "Dependent code should only occur in error-recovery path."); 11694 return true; 11695 } 11696 const Expr *Culprit; 11697 if (Init->isConstantInitializer(Context, false, &Culprit)) 11698 return false; 11699 Diag(Culprit->getExprLoc(), diag::err_init_element_not_constant) 11700 << Culprit->getSourceRange(); 11701 return true; 11702 } 11703 11704 namespace { 11705 // Visits an initialization expression to see if OrigDecl is evaluated in 11706 // its own initialization and throws a warning if it does. 11707 class SelfReferenceChecker 11708 : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<SelfReferenceChecker> { 11709 Sema &S; 11710 Decl *OrigDecl; 11711 bool isRecordType; 11712 bool isPODType; 11713 bool isReferenceType; 11714 11715 bool isInitList; 11716 llvm::SmallVector<unsigned, 4> InitFieldIndex; 11717 11718 public: 11719 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<SelfReferenceChecker> Inherited; 11720 11721 SelfReferenceChecker(Sema &S, Decl *OrigDecl) : Inherited(S.Context), 11722 S(S), OrigDecl(OrigDecl) { 11723 isPODType = false; 11724 isRecordType = false; 11725 isReferenceType = false; 11726 isInitList = false; 11727 if (ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(OrigDecl)) { 11728 isPODType = VD->getType().isPODType(S.Context); 11729 isRecordType = VD->getType()->isRecordType(); 11730 isReferenceType = VD->getType()->isReferenceType(); 11731 } 11732 } 11733 11734 // For most expressions, just call the visitor. For initializer lists, 11735 // track the index of the field being initialized since fields are 11736 // initialized in order allowing use of previously initialized fields. 11737 void CheckExpr(Expr *E) { 11738 InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(E); 11739 if (!InitList) { 11740 Visit(E); 11741 return; 11742 } 11743 11744 // Track and increment the index here. 11745 isInitList = true; 11746 InitFieldIndex.push_back(0); 11747 for (auto Child : InitList->children()) { 11748 CheckExpr(cast<Expr>(Child)); 11749 ++InitFieldIndex.back(); 11750 } 11751 InitFieldIndex.pop_back(); 11752 } 11753 11754 // Returns true if MemberExpr is checked and no further checking is needed. 11755 // Returns false if additional checking is required. 11756 bool CheckInitListMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E, bool CheckReference) { 11757 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Fields; 11758 Expr *Base = E; 11759 bool ReferenceField = false; 11760 11761 // Get the field members used. 11762 while (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Base)) { 11763 FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()); 11764 if (!FD) 11765 return false; 11766 Fields.push_back(FD); 11767 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) 11768 ReferenceField = true; 11769 Base = ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11770 } 11771 11772 // Keep checking only if the base Decl is the same. 11773 DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Base); 11774 if (!DRE || DRE->getDecl() != OrigDecl) 11775 return false; 11776 11777 // A reference field can be bound to an unininitialized field. 11778 if (CheckReference && !ReferenceField) 11779 return true; 11780 11781 // Convert FieldDecls to their index number. 11782 llvm::SmallVector<unsigned, 4> UsedFieldIndex; 11783 for (const FieldDecl *I : llvm::reverse(Fields)) 11784 UsedFieldIndex.push_back(I->getFieldIndex()); 11785 11786 // See if a warning is needed by checking the first difference in index 11787 // numbers. If field being used has index less than the field being 11788 // initialized, then the use is safe. 11789 for (auto UsedIter = UsedFieldIndex.begin(), 11790 UsedEnd = UsedFieldIndex.end(), 11791 OrigIter = InitFieldIndex.begin(), 11792 OrigEnd = InitFieldIndex.end(); 11793 UsedIter != UsedEnd && OrigIter != OrigEnd; ++UsedIter, ++OrigIter) { 11794 if (*UsedIter < *OrigIter) 11795 return true; 11796 if (*UsedIter > *OrigIter) 11797 break; 11798 } 11799 11800 // TODO: Add a different warning which will print the field names. 11801 HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE); 11802 return true; 11803 } 11804 11805 // For most expressions, the cast is directly above the DeclRefExpr. 11806 // For conditional operators, the cast can be outside the conditional 11807 // operator if both expressions are DeclRefExpr's. 11808 void HandleValue(Expr *E) { 11809 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 11810 if (DeclRefExpr* DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) { 11811 HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE); 11812 return; 11813 } 11814 11815 if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(E)) { 11816 Visit(CO->getCond()); 11817 HandleValue(CO->getTrueExpr()); 11818 HandleValue(CO->getFalseExpr()); 11819 return; 11820 } 11821 11822 if (BinaryConditionalOperator *BCO = 11823 dyn_cast<BinaryConditionalOperator>(E)) { 11824 Visit(BCO->getCond()); 11825 HandleValue(BCO->getFalseExpr()); 11826 return; 11827 } 11828 11829 if (OpaqueValueExpr *OVE = dyn_cast<OpaqueValueExpr>(E)) { 11830 HandleValue(OVE->getSourceExpr()); 11831 return; 11832 } 11833 11834 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) { 11835 if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_Comma) { 11836 Visit(BO->getLHS()); 11837 HandleValue(BO->getRHS()); 11838 return; 11839 } 11840 } 11841 11842 if (isa<MemberExpr>(E)) { 11843 if (isInitList) { 11844 if (CheckInitListMemberExpr(cast<MemberExpr>(E), 11845 false /*CheckReference*/)) 11846 return; 11847 } 11848 11849 Expr *Base = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11850 while (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Base)) { 11851 // Check for static member variables and don't warn on them. 11852 if (!isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) 11853 return; 11854 Base = ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11855 } 11856 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Base)) 11857 HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE); 11858 return; 11859 } 11860 11861 Visit(E); 11862 } 11863 11864 // Reference types not handled in HandleValue are handled here since all 11865 // uses of references are bad, not just r-value uses. 11866 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) { 11867 if (isReferenceType) 11868 HandleDeclRefExpr(E); 11869 } 11870 11871 void VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E) { 11872 if (E->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue) { 11873 HandleValue(E->getSubExpr()); 11874 return; 11875 } 11876 11877 Inherited::VisitImplicitCastExpr(E); 11878 } 11879 11880 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) { 11881 if (isInitList) { 11882 if (CheckInitListMemberExpr(E, true /*CheckReference*/)) 11883 return; 11884 } 11885 11886 // Don't warn on arrays since they can be treated as pointers. 11887 if (E->getType()->canDecayToPointerType()) return; 11888 11889 // Warn when a non-static method call is followed by non-static member 11890 // field accesses, which is followed by a DeclRefExpr. 11891 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(E->getMemberDecl()); 11892 bool Warn = (MD && !MD->isStatic()); 11893 Expr *Base = E->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11894 while (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Base)) { 11895 if (!isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) 11896 Warn = false; 11897 Base = ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11898 } 11899 11900 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Base)) { 11901 if (Warn) 11902 HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE); 11903 return; 11904 } 11905 11906 // The base of a MemberExpr is not a MemberExpr or a DeclRefExpr. 11907 // Visit that expression. 11908 Visit(Base); 11909 } 11910 11911 void VisitCXXOperatorCallExpr(CXXOperatorCallExpr *E) { 11912 Expr *Callee = E->getCallee(); 11913 11914 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(Callee)) 11915 return Inherited::VisitCXXOperatorCallExpr(E); 11916 11917 Visit(Callee); 11918 for (auto Arg: E->arguments()) 11919 HandleValue(Arg->IgnoreParenImpCasts()); 11920 } 11921 11922 void VisitUnaryOperator(UnaryOperator *E) { 11923 // For POD record types, addresses of its own members are well-defined. 11924 if (E->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf && isRecordType && 11925 isa<MemberExpr>(E->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens())) { 11926 if (!isPODType) 11927 HandleValue(E->getSubExpr()); 11928 return; 11929 } 11930 11931 if (E->isIncrementDecrementOp()) { 11932 HandleValue(E->getSubExpr()); 11933 return; 11934 } 11935 11936 Inherited::VisitUnaryOperator(E); 11937 } 11938 11939 void VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr *E) {} 11940 11941 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) { 11942 if (E->getConstructor()->isCopyConstructor()) { 11943 Expr *ArgExpr = E->getArg(0); 11944 if (InitListExpr *ILE = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(ArgExpr)) 11945 if (ILE->getNumInits() == 1) 11946 ArgExpr = ILE->getInit(0); 11947 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(ArgExpr)) 11948 if (ICE->getCastKind() == CK_NoOp) 11949 ArgExpr = ICE->getSubExpr(); 11950 HandleValue(ArgExpr); 11951 return; 11952 } 11953 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E); 11954 } 11955 11956 void VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E) { 11957 // Treat std::move as a use. 11958 if (E->isCallToStdMove()) { 11959 HandleValue(E->getArg(0)); 11960 return; 11961 } 11962 11963 Inherited::VisitCallExpr(E); 11964 } 11965 11966 void VisitBinaryOperator(BinaryOperator *E) { 11967 if (E->isCompoundAssignmentOp()) { 11968 HandleValue(E->getLHS()); 11969 Visit(E->getRHS()); 11970 return; 11971 } 11972 11973 Inherited::VisitBinaryOperator(E); 11974 } 11975 11976 // A custom visitor for BinaryConditionalOperator is needed because the 11977 // regular visitor would check the condition and true expression separately 11978 // but both point to the same place giving duplicate diagnostics. 11979 void VisitBinaryConditionalOperator(BinaryConditionalOperator *E) { 11980 Visit(E->getCond()); 11981 Visit(E->getFalseExpr()); 11982 } 11983 11984 void HandleDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *DRE) { 11985 Decl* ReferenceDecl = DRE->getDecl(); 11986 if (OrigDecl != ReferenceDecl) return; 11987 unsigned diag; 11988 if (isReferenceType) { 11989 diag = diag::warn_uninit_self_reference_in_reference_init; 11990 } else if (cast<VarDecl>(OrigDecl)->isStaticLocal()) { 11991 diag = diag::warn_static_self_reference_in_init; 11992 } else if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(OrigDecl->getDeclContext()) || 11993 isa<NamespaceDecl>(OrigDecl->getDeclContext()) || 11994 DRE->getDecl()->getType()->isRecordType()) { 11995 diag = diag::warn_uninit_self_reference_in_init; 11996 } else { 11997 // Local variables will be handled by the CFG analysis. 11998 return; 11999 } 12000 12001 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(DRE->getBeginLoc(), DRE, 12002 S.PDiag(diag) 12003 << DRE->getDecl() << OrigDecl->getLocation() 12004 << DRE->getSourceRange()); 12005 } 12006 }; 12007 12008 /// CheckSelfReference - Warns if OrigDecl is used in expression E. 12009 static void CheckSelfReference(Sema &S, Decl* OrigDecl, Expr *E, 12010 bool DirectInit) { 12011 // Parameters arguments are occassionially constructed with itself, 12012 // for instance, in recursive functions. Skip them. 12013 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(OrigDecl)) 12014 return; 12015 12016 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 12017 12018 // Skip checking T a = a where T is not a record or reference type. 12019 // Doing so is a way to silence uninitialized warnings. 12020 if (!DirectInit && !cast<VarDecl>(OrigDecl)->getType()->isRecordType()) 12021 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) 12022 if (ICE->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue) 12023 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(ICE->getSubExpr())) 12024 if (DRE->getDecl() == OrigDecl) 12025 return; 12026 12027 SelfReferenceChecker(S, OrigDecl).CheckExpr(E); 12028 } 12029 } // end anonymous namespace 12030 12031 namespace { 12032 // Simple wrapper to add the name of a variable or (if no variable is 12033 // available) a DeclarationName into a diagnostic. 12034 struct VarDeclOrName { 12035 VarDecl *VDecl; 12036 DeclarationName Name; 12037 12038 friend const Sema::SemaDiagnosticBuilder & 12039 operator<<(const Sema::SemaDiagnosticBuilder &Diag, VarDeclOrName VN) { 12040 return VN.VDecl ? Diag << VN.VDecl : Diag << VN.Name; 12041 } 12042 }; 12043 } // end anonymous namespace 12044 12045 QualType Sema::deduceVarTypeFromInitializer(VarDecl *VDecl, 12046 DeclarationName Name, QualType Type, 12047 TypeSourceInfo *TSI, 12048 SourceRange Range, bool DirectInit, 12049 Expr *Init) { 12050 bool IsInitCapture = !VDecl; 12051 assert((!VDecl || !VDecl->isInitCapture()) && 12052 "init captures are expected to be deduced prior to initialization"); 12053 12054 VarDeclOrName VN{VDecl, Name}; 12055 12056 DeducedType *Deduced = Type->getContainedDeducedType(); 12057 assert(Deduced && "deduceVarTypeFromInitializer for non-deduced type"); 12058 12059 // C++11 [dcl.spec.auto]p3 12060 if (!Init) { 12061 assert(VDecl && "no init for init capture deduction?"); 12062 12063 // Except for class argument deduction, and then for an initializing 12064 // declaration only, i.e. no static at class scope or extern. 12065 if (!isa<DeducedTemplateSpecializationType>(Deduced) || 12066 VDecl->hasExternalStorage() || 12067 VDecl->isStaticDataMember()) { 12068 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_auto_var_requires_init) 12069 << VDecl->getDeclName() << Type; 12070 return QualType(); 12071 } 12072 } 12073 12074 ArrayRef<Expr*> DeduceInits; 12075 if (Init) 12076 DeduceInits = Init; 12077 12078 if (DirectInit) { 12079 if (auto *PL = dyn_cast_or_null<ParenListExpr>(Init)) 12080 DeduceInits = PL->exprs(); 12081 } 12082 12083 if (isa<DeducedTemplateSpecializationType>(Deduced)) { 12084 assert(VDecl && "non-auto type for init capture deduction?"); 12085 InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeVariable(VDecl); 12086 InitializationKind Kind = InitializationKind::CreateForInit( 12087 VDecl->getLocation(), DirectInit, Init); 12088 // FIXME: Initialization should not be taking a mutable list of inits. 12089 SmallVector<Expr*, 8> InitsCopy(DeduceInits.begin(), DeduceInits.end()); 12090 return DeduceTemplateSpecializationFromInitializer(TSI, Entity, Kind, 12091 InitsCopy); 12092 } 12093 12094 if (DirectInit) { 12095 if (auto *IL = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(Init)) 12096 DeduceInits = IL->inits(); 12097 } 12098 12099 // Deduction only works if we have exactly one source expression. 12100 if (DeduceInits.empty()) { 12101 // It isn't possible to write this directly, but it is possible to 12102 // end up in this situation with "auto x(some_pack...);" 12103 Diag(Init->getBeginLoc(), IsInitCapture 12104 ? diag::err_init_capture_no_expression 12105 : diag::err_auto_var_init_no_expression) 12106 << VN << Type << Range; 12107 return QualType(); 12108 } 12109 12110 if (DeduceInits.size() > 1) { 12111 Diag(DeduceInits[1]->getBeginLoc(), 12112 IsInitCapture ? diag::err_init_capture_multiple_expressions 12113 : diag::err_auto_var_init_multiple_expressions) 12114 << VN << Type << Range; 12115 return QualType(); 12116 } 12117 12118 Expr *DeduceInit = DeduceInits[0]; 12119 if (DirectInit && isa<InitListExpr>(DeduceInit)) { 12120 Diag(Init->getBeginLoc(), IsInitCapture 12121 ? diag::err_init_capture_paren_braces 12122 : diag::err_auto_var_init_paren_braces) 12123 << isa<InitListExpr>(Init) << VN << Type << Range; 12124 return QualType(); 12125 } 12126 12127 // Expressions default to 'id' when we're in a debugger. 12128 bool DefaultedAnyToId = false; 12129 if (getLangOpts().DebuggerCastResultToId && 12130 Init->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy && !IsInitCapture) { 12131 ExprResult Result = forceUnknownAnyToType(Init, Context.getObjCIdType()); 12132 if (Result.isInvalid()) { 12133 return QualType(); 12134 } 12135 Init = Result.get(); 12136 DefaultedAnyToId = true; 12137 } 12138 12139 // C++ [dcl.decomp]p1: 12140 // If the assignment-expression [...] has array type A and no ref-qualifier 12141 // is present, e has type cv A 12142 if (VDecl && isa<DecompositionDecl>(VDecl) && 12143 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Type, Context.getAutoDeductType()) && 12144 DeduceInit->getType()->isConstantArrayType()) 12145 return Context.getQualifiedType(DeduceInit->getType(), 12146 Type.getQualifiers()); 12147 12148 QualType DeducedType; 12149 if (DeduceAutoType(TSI, DeduceInit, DeducedType) == DAR_Failed) { 12150 if (!IsInitCapture) 12151 DiagnoseAutoDeductionFailure(VDecl, DeduceInit); 12152 else if (isa<InitListExpr>(Init)) 12153 Diag(Range.getBegin(), 12154 diag::err_init_capture_deduction_failure_from_init_list) 12155 << VN 12156 << (DeduceInit->getType().isNull() ? TSI->getType() 12157 : DeduceInit->getType()) 12158 << DeduceInit->getSourceRange(); 12159 else 12160 Diag(Range.getBegin(), diag::err_init_capture_deduction_failure) 12161 << VN << TSI->getType() 12162 << (DeduceInit->getType().isNull() ? TSI->getType() 12163 : DeduceInit->getType()) 12164 << DeduceInit->getSourceRange(); 12165 } 12166 12167 // Warn if we deduced 'id'. 'auto' usually implies type-safety, but using 12168 // 'id' instead of a specific object type prevents most of our usual 12169 // checks. 12170 // We only want to warn outside of template instantiations, though: 12171 // inside a template, the 'id' could have come from a parameter. 12172 if (!inTemplateInstantiation() && !DefaultedAnyToId && !IsInitCapture && 12173 !DeducedType.isNull() && DeducedType->isObjCIdType()) { 12174 SourceLocation Loc = TSI->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(); 12175 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_auto_var_is_id) << VN << Range; 12176 } 12177 12178 return DeducedType; 12179 } 12180 12181 bool Sema::DeduceVariableDeclarationType(VarDecl *VDecl, bool DirectInit, 12182 Expr *Init) { 12183 assert(!Init || !Init->containsErrors()); 12184 QualType DeducedType = deduceVarTypeFromInitializer( 12185 VDecl, VDecl->getDeclName(), VDecl->getType(), VDecl->getTypeSourceInfo(), 12186 VDecl->getSourceRange(), DirectInit, Init); 12187 if (DeducedType.isNull()) { 12188 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12189 return true; 12190 } 12191 12192 VDecl->setType(DeducedType); 12193 assert(VDecl->isLinkageValid()); 12194 12195 // In ARC, infer lifetime. 12196 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(VDecl)) 12197 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12198 12199 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) 12200 deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(VDecl); 12201 12202 // If this is a redeclaration, check that the type we just deduced matches 12203 // the previously declared type. 12204 if (VarDecl *Old = VDecl->getPreviousDecl()) { 12205 // We never need to merge the type, because we cannot form an incomplete 12206 // array of auto, nor deduce such a type. 12207 MergeVarDeclTypes(VDecl, Old, /*MergeTypeWithPrevious*/ false); 12208 } 12209 12210 // Check the deduced type is valid for a variable declaration. 12211 CheckVariableDeclarationType(VDecl); 12212 return VDecl->isInvalidDecl(); 12213 } 12214 12215 void Sema::checkNonTrivialCUnionInInitializer(const Expr *Init, 12216 SourceLocation Loc) { 12217 if (auto *EWC = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Init)) 12218 Init = EWC->getSubExpr(); 12219 12220 if (auto *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Init)) 12221 Init = CE->getSubExpr(); 12222 12223 QualType InitType = Init->getType(); 12224 assert((InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() || 12225 InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) && 12226 "shouldn't be called if type doesn't have a non-trivial C struct"); 12227 if (auto *ILE = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(Init)) { 12228 for (auto I : ILE->inits()) { 12229 if (!I->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() && 12230 !I->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) 12231 continue; 12232 SourceLocation SL = I->getExprLoc(); 12233 checkNonTrivialCUnionInInitializer(I, SL.isValid() ? SL : Loc); 12234 } 12235 return; 12236 } 12237 12238 if (isa<ImplicitValueInitExpr>(Init)) { 12239 if (InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion()) 12240 checkNonTrivialCUnion(InitType, Loc, NTCUC_DefaultInitializedObject, 12241 NTCUK_Init); 12242 } else { 12243 // Assume all other explicit initializers involving copying some existing 12244 // object. 12245 // TODO: ignore any explicit initializers where we can guarantee 12246 // copy-elision. 12247 if (InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) 12248 checkNonTrivialCUnion(InitType, Loc, NTCUC_CopyInit, NTCUK_Copy); 12249 } 12250 } 12251 12252 namespace { 12253 12254 bool shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(const FieldDecl *FD) { 12255 // Ignore unavailable fields. A field can be marked as unavailable explicitly 12256 // in the source code or implicitly by the compiler if it is in a union 12257 // defined in a system header and has non-trivial ObjC ownership 12258 // qualifications. We don't want those fields to participate in determining 12259 // whether the containing union is non-trivial. 12260 return FD->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>(); 12261 } 12262 12263 struct DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor 12264 : DefaultInitializedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor, 12265 void> { 12266 using Super = 12267 DefaultInitializedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor, 12268 void>; 12269 12270 DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor( 12271 QualType OrigTy, SourceLocation OrigLoc, 12272 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext, Sema &S) 12273 : OrigTy(OrigTy), OrigLoc(OrigLoc), UseContext(UseContext), S(S) {} 12274 12275 void visitWithKind(QualType::PrimitiveDefaultInitializeKind PDIK, QualType QT, 12276 const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12277 if (const auto *AT = S.Context.getAsArrayType(QT)) 12278 return this->asDerived().visit(S.Context.getBaseElementType(AT), FD, 12279 InNonTrivialUnion); 12280 return Super::visitWithKind(PDIK, QT, FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 12281 } 12282 12283 void visitARCStrong(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, 12284 bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12285 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12286 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12287 << 1 << 0 << QT << FD->getName(); 12288 } 12289 12290 void visitARCWeak(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12291 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12292 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12293 << 1 << 0 << QT << FD->getName(); 12294 } 12295 12296 void visitStruct(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12297 const RecordDecl *RD = QT->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl(); 12298 if (RD->isUnion()) { 12299 if (OrigLoc.isValid()) { 12300 bool IsUnion = false; 12301 if (auto *OrigRD = OrigTy->getAsRecordDecl()) 12302 IsUnion = OrigRD->isUnion(); 12303 S.Diag(OrigLoc, diag::err_non_trivial_c_union_in_invalid_context) 12304 << 0 << OrigTy << IsUnion << UseContext; 12305 // Reset OrigLoc so that this diagnostic is emitted only once. 12306 OrigLoc = SourceLocation(); 12307 } 12308 InNonTrivialUnion = true; 12309 } 12310 12311 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12312 S.Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12313 << 0 << 0 << QT.getUnqualifiedType() << ""; 12314 12315 for (const FieldDecl *FD : RD->fields()) 12316 if (!shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD)) 12317 asDerived().visit(FD->getType(), FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 12318 } 12319 12320 void visitTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 12321 12322 // The non-trivial C union type or the struct/union type that contains a 12323 // non-trivial C union. 12324 QualType OrigTy; 12325 SourceLocation OrigLoc; 12326 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext; 12327 Sema &S; 12328 }; 12329 12330 struct DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor 12331 : DestructedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor, void> { 12332 using Super = 12333 DestructedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor, void>; 12334 12335 DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor( 12336 QualType OrigTy, SourceLocation OrigLoc, 12337 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext, Sema &S) 12338 : OrigTy(OrigTy), OrigLoc(OrigLoc), UseContext(UseContext), S(S) {} 12339 12340 void visitWithKind(QualType::DestructionKind DK, QualType QT, 12341 const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12342 if (const auto *AT = S.Context.getAsArrayType(QT)) 12343 return this->asDerived().visit(S.Context.getBaseElementType(AT), FD, 12344 InNonTrivialUnion); 12345 return Super::visitWithKind(DK, QT, FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 12346 } 12347 12348 void visitARCStrong(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, 12349 bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12350 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12351 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12352 << 1 << 1 << QT << FD->getName(); 12353 } 12354 12355 void visitARCWeak(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12356 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12357 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12358 << 1 << 1 << QT << FD->getName(); 12359 } 12360 12361 void visitStruct(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12362 const RecordDecl *RD = QT->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl(); 12363 if (RD->isUnion()) { 12364 if (OrigLoc.isValid()) { 12365 bool IsUnion = false; 12366 if (auto *OrigRD = OrigTy->getAsRecordDecl()) 12367 IsUnion = OrigRD->isUnion(); 12368 S.Diag(OrigLoc, diag::err_non_trivial_c_union_in_invalid_context) 12369 << 1 << OrigTy << IsUnion << UseContext; 12370 // Reset OrigLoc so that this diagnostic is emitted only once. 12371 OrigLoc = SourceLocation(); 12372 } 12373 InNonTrivialUnion = true; 12374 } 12375 12376 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12377 S.Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12378 << 0 << 1 << QT.getUnqualifiedType() << ""; 12379 12380 for (const FieldDecl *FD : RD->fields()) 12381 if (!shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD)) 12382 asDerived().visit(FD->getType(), FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 12383 } 12384 12385 void visitTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 12386 void visitCXXDestructor(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, 12387 bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 12388 12389 // The non-trivial C union type or the struct/union type that contains a 12390 // non-trivial C union. 12391 QualType OrigTy; 12392 SourceLocation OrigLoc; 12393 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext; 12394 Sema &S; 12395 }; 12396 12397 struct DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor 12398 : CopiedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor, false, void> { 12399 using Super = CopiedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor, false, void>; 12400 12401 DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor(QualType OrigTy, SourceLocation OrigLoc, 12402 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext, 12403 Sema &S) 12404 : OrigTy(OrigTy), OrigLoc(OrigLoc), UseContext(UseContext), S(S) {} 12405 12406 void visitWithKind(QualType::PrimitiveCopyKind PCK, QualType QT, 12407 const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12408 if (const auto *AT = S.Context.getAsArrayType(QT)) 12409 return this->asDerived().visit(S.Context.getBaseElementType(AT), FD, 12410 InNonTrivialUnion); 12411 return Super::visitWithKind(PCK, QT, FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 12412 } 12413 12414 void visitARCStrong(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, 12415 bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12416 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12417 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12418 << 1 << 2 << QT << FD->getName(); 12419 } 12420 12421 void visitARCWeak(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12422 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12423 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12424 << 1 << 2 << QT << FD->getName(); 12425 } 12426 12427 void visitStruct(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12428 const RecordDecl *RD = QT->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl(); 12429 if (RD->isUnion()) { 12430 if (OrigLoc.isValid()) { 12431 bool IsUnion = false; 12432 if (auto *OrigRD = OrigTy->getAsRecordDecl()) 12433 IsUnion = OrigRD->isUnion(); 12434 S.Diag(OrigLoc, diag::err_non_trivial_c_union_in_invalid_context) 12435 << 2 << OrigTy << IsUnion << UseContext; 12436 // Reset OrigLoc so that this diagnostic is emitted only once. 12437 OrigLoc = SourceLocation(); 12438 } 12439 InNonTrivialUnion = true; 12440 } 12441 12442 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12443 S.Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12444 << 0 << 2 << QT.getUnqualifiedType() << ""; 12445 12446 for (const FieldDecl *FD : RD->fields()) 12447 if (!shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD)) 12448 asDerived().visit(FD->getType(), FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 12449 } 12450 12451 void preVisit(QualType::PrimitiveCopyKind PCK, QualType QT, 12452 const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 12453 void visitTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 12454 void visitVolatileTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, 12455 bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 12456 12457 // The non-trivial C union type or the struct/union type that contains a 12458 // non-trivial C union. 12459 QualType OrigTy; 12460 SourceLocation OrigLoc; 12461 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext; 12462 Sema &S; 12463 }; 12464 12465 } // namespace 12466 12467 void Sema::checkNonTrivialCUnion(QualType QT, SourceLocation Loc, 12468 NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext, 12469 unsigned NonTrivialKind) { 12470 assert((QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() || 12471 QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() || 12472 QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) && 12473 "shouldn't be called if type doesn't have a non-trivial C union"); 12474 12475 if ((NonTrivialKind & NTCUK_Init) && 12476 QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion()) 12477 DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor(QT, Loc, UseContext, *this) 12478 .visit(QT, nullptr, false); 12479 if ((NonTrivialKind & NTCUK_Destruct) && 12480 QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion()) 12481 DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor(QT, Loc, UseContext, *this) 12482 .visit(QT, nullptr, false); 12483 if ((NonTrivialKind & NTCUK_Copy) && QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) 12484 DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor(QT, Loc, UseContext, *this) 12485 .visit(QT, nullptr, false); 12486 } 12487 12488 /// AddInitializerToDecl - Adds the initializer Init to the 12489 /// declaration dcl. If DirectInit is true, this is C++ direct 12490 /// initialization rather than copy initialization. 12491 void Sema::AddInitializerToDecl(Decl *RealDecl, Expr *Init, bool DirectInit) { 12492 // If there is no declaration, there was an error parsing it. Just ignore 12493 // the initializer. 12494 if (!RealDecl || RealDecl->isInvalidDecl()) { 12495 CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(Init, dyn_cast_or_null<VarDecl>(RealDecl)); 12496 return; 12497 } 12498 12499 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(RealDecl)) { 12500 // Pure-specifiers are handled in ActOnPureSpecifier. 12501 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::err_member_function_initialization) 12502 << Method->getDeclName() << Init->getSourceRange(); 12503 Method->setInvalidDecl(); 12504 return; 12505 } 12506 12507 VarDecl *VDecl = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(RealDecl); 12508 if (!VDecl) { 12509 assert(!isa<FieldDecl>(RealDecl) && "field init shouldn't get here"); 12510 Diag(RealDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_illegal_initializer); 12511 RealDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12512 return; 12513 } 12514 12515 // C++11 [decl.spec.auto]p6. Deduce the type which 'auto' stands in for. 12516 if (VDecl->getType()->isUndeducedType()) { 12517 // Attempt typo correction early so that the type of the init expression can 12518 // be deduced based on the chosen correction if the original init contains a 12519 // TypoExpr. 12520 ExprResult Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(Init, VDecl); 12521 if (!Res.isUsable()) { 12522 // There are unresolved typos in Init, just drop them. 12523 // FIXME: improve the recovery strategy to preserve the Init. 12524 RealDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12525 return; 12526 } 12527 if (Res.get()->containsErrors()) { 12528 // Invalidate the decl as we don't know the type for recovery-expr yet. 12529 RealDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12530 VDecl->setInit(Res.get()); 12531 return; 12532 } 12533 Init = Res.get(); 12534 12535 if (DeduceVariableDeclarationType(VDecl, DirectInit, Init)) 12536 return; 12537 } 12538 12539 // dllimport cannot be used on variable definitions. 12540 if (VDecl->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>() && !VDecl->isStaticDataMember()) { 12541 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dllimport_data_definition); 12542 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12543 return; 12544 } 12545 12546 if (VDecl->isLocalVarDecl() && VDecl->hasExternalStorage()) { 12547 // C99 6.7.8p5. C++ has no such restriction, but that is a defect. 12548 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_block_extern_cant_init); 12549 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12550 return; 12551 } 12552 12553 if (!VDecl->getType()->isDependentType()) { 12554 // A definition must end up with a complete type, which means it must be 12555 // complete with the restriction that an array type might be completed by 12556 // the initializer; note that later code assumes this restriction. 12557 QualType BaseDeclType = VDecl->getType(); 12558 if (const ArrayType *Array = Context.getAsIncompleteArrayType(BaseDeclType)) 12559 BaseDeclType = Array->getElementType(); 12560 if (RequireCompleteType(VDecl->getLocation(), BaseDeclType, 12561 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) { 12562 RealDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12563 return; 12564 } 12565 12566 // The variable can not have an abstract class type. 12567 if (RequireNonAbstractType(VDecl->getLocation(), VDecl->getType(), 12568 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 12569 AbstractVariableType)) 12570 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12571 } 12572 12573 // If adding the initializer will turn this declaration into a definition, 12574 // and we already have a definition for this variable, diagnose or otherwise 12575 // handle the situation. 12576 if (VarDecl *Def = VDecl->getDefinition()) 12577 if (Def != VDecl && 12578 (!VDecl->isStaticDataMember() || VDecl->isOutOfLine()) && 12579 !VDecl->isThisDeclarationADemotedDefinition() && 12580 checkVarDeclRedefinition(Def, VDecl)) 12581 return; 12582 12583 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 12584 // C++ [class.static.data]p4 12585 // If a static data member is of const integral or const 12586 // enumeration type, its declaration in the class definition can 12587 // specify a constant-initializer which shall be an integral 12588 // constant expression (5.19). In that case, the member can appear 12589 // in integral constant expressions. The member shall still be 12590 // defined in a namespace scope if it is used in the program and the 12591 // namespace scope definition shall not contain an initializer. 12592 // 12593 // We already performed a redefinition check above, but for static 12594 // data members we also need to check whether there was an in-class 12595 // declaration with an initializer. 12596 if (VDecl->isStaticDataMember() && VDecl->getCanonicalDecl()->hasInit()) { 12597 Diag(Init->getExprLoc(), diag::err_static_data_member_reinitialization) 12598 << VDecl->getDeclName(); 12599 Diag(VDecl->getCanonicalDecl()->getInit()->getExprLoc(), 12600 diag::note_previous_initializer) 12601 << 0; 12602 return; 12603 } 12604 12605 if (VDecl->hasLocalStorage()) 12606 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 12607 12608 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(Init, UPPC_Initializer)) { 12609 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12610 return; 12611 } 12612 } 12613 12614 // OpenCL 1.1 6.5.2: "Variables allocated in the __local address space inside 12615 // a kernel function cannot be initialized." 12616 if (VDecl->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local) { 12617 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_local_cant_init); 12618 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12619 return; 12620 } 12621 12622 // The LoaderUninitialized attribute acts as a definition (of undef). 12623 if (VDecl->hasAttr<LoaderUninitializedAttr>()) { 12624 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_loader_uninitialized_cant_init); 12625 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12626 return; 12627 } 12628 12629 // Get the decls type and save a reference for later, since 12630 // CheckInitializerTypes may change it. 12631 QualType DclT = VDecl->getType(), SavT = DclT; 12632 12633 // Expressions default to 'id' when we're in a debugger 12634 // and we are assigning it to a variable of Objective-C pointer type. 12635 if (getLangOpts().DebuggerCastResultToId && DclT->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 12636 Init->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 12637 ExprResult Result = forceUnknownAnyToType(Init, Context.getObjCIdType()); 12638 if (Result.isInvalid()) { 12639 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12640 return; 12641 } 12642 Init = Result.get(); 12643 } 12644 12645 // Perform the initialization. 12646 ParenListExpr *CXXDirectInit = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(Init); 12647 if (!VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) { 12648 InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeVariable(VDecl); 12649 InitializationKind Kind = InitializationKind::CreateForInit( 12650 VDecl->getLocation(), DirectInit, Init); 12651 12652 MultiExprArg Args = Init; 12653 if (CXXDirectInit) 12654 Args = MultiExprArg(CXXDirectInit->getExprs(), 12655 CXXDirectInit->getNumExprs()); 12656 12657 // Try to correct any TypoExprs in the initialization arguments. 12658 for (size_t Idx = 0; Idx < Args.size(); ++Idx) { 12659 ExprResult Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr( 12660 Args[Idx], VDecl, /*RecoverUncorrectedTypos=*/true, 12661 [this, Entity, Kind](Expr *E) { 12662 InitializationSequence Init(*this, Entity, Kind, MultiExprArg(E)); 12663 return Init.Failed() ? ExprError() : E; 12664 }); 12665 if (Res.isInvalid()) { 12666 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12667 } else if (Res.get() != Args[Idx]) { 12668 Args[Idx] = Res.get(); 12669 } 12670 } 12671 if (VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) 12672 return; 12673 12674 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, Args, 12675 /*TopLevelOfInitList=*/false, 12676 /*TreatUnavailableAsInvalid=*/false); 12677 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, Args, &DclT); 12678 if (Result.isInvalid()) { 12679 // If the provided initializer fails to initialize the var decl, 12680 // we attach a recovery expr for better recovery. 12681 auto RecoveryExpr = 12682 CreateRecoveryExpr(Init->getBeginLoc(), Init->getEndLoc(), Args); 12683 if (RecoveryExpr.get()) 12684 VDecl->setInit(RecoveryExpr.get()); 12685 return; 12686 } 12687 12688 Init = Result.getAs<Expr>(); 12689 } 12690 12691 // Check for self-references within variable initializers. 12692 // Variables declared within a function/method body (except for references) 12693 // are handled by a dataflow analysis. 12694 // This is undefined behavior in C++, but valid in C. 12695 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 12696 if (!VDecl->hasLocalStorage() || VDecl->getType()->isRecordType() || 12697 VDecl->getType()->isReferenceType()) 12698 CheckSelfReference(*this, RealDecl, Init, DirectInit); 12699 12700 // If the type changed, it means we had an incomplete type that was 12701 // completed by the initializer. For example: 12702 // int ary[] = { 1, 3, 5 }; 12703 // "ary" transitions from an IncompleteArrayType to a ConstantArrayType. 12704 if (!VDecl->isInvalidDecl() && (DclT != SavT)) 12705 VDecl->setType(DclT); 12706 12707 if (!VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) { 12708 checkUnsafeAssigns(VDecl->getLocation(), VDecl->getType(), Init); 12709 12710 if (VDecl->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) 12711 checkRetainCycles(VDecl, Init); 12712 12713 // It is safe to assign a weak reference into a strong variable. 12714 // Although this code can still have problems: 12715 // id x = self.weakProp; 12716 // id y = self.weakProp; 12717 // we do not warn to warn spuriously when 'x' and 'y' are on separate 12718 // paths through the function. This should be revisited if 12719 // -Wrepeated-use-of-weak is made flow-sensitive. 12720 if (FunctionScopeInfo *FSI = getCurFunction()) 12721 if ((VDecl->getType().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Strong || 12722 VDecl->getType().isNonWeakInMRRWithObjCWeak(Context)) && 12723 !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak, 12724 Init->getBeginLoc())) 12725 FSI->markSafeWeakUse(Init); 12726 } 12727 12728 // The initialization is usually a full-expression. 12729 // 12730 // FIXME: If this is a braced initialization of an aggregate, it is not 12731 // an expression, and each individual field initializer is a separate 12732 // full-expression. For instance, in: 12733 // 12734 // struct Temp { ~Temp(); }; 12735 // struct S { S(Temp); }; 12736 // struct T { S a, b; } t = { Temp(), Temp() } 12737 // 12738 // we should destroy the first Temp before constructing the second. 12739 ExprResult Result = 12740 ActOnFinishFullExpr(Init, VDecl->getLocation(), 12741 /*DiscardedValue*/ false, VDecl->isConstexpr()); 12742 if (Result.isInvalid()) { 12743 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12744 return; 12745 } 12746 Init = Result.get(); 12747 12748 // Attach the initializer to the decl. 12749 VDecl->setInit(Init); 12750 12751 if (VDecl->isLocalVarDecl()) { 12752 // Don't check the initializer if the declaration is malformed. 12753 if (VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) { 12754 // do nothing 12755 12756 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.5.3: __constant locals must be constant-initialized. 12757 // This is true even in C++ for OpenCL. 12758 } else if (VDecl->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant) { 12759 CheckForConstantInitializer(Init, DclT); 12760 12761 // Otherwise, C++ does not restrict the initializer. 12762 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 12763 // do nothing 12764 12765 // C99 6.7.8p4: All the expressions in an initializer for an object that has 12766 // static storage duration shall be constant expressions or string literals. 12767 } else if (VDecl->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) { 12768 CheckForConstantInitializer(Init, DclT); 12769 12770 // C89 is stricter than C99 for aggregate initializers. 12771 // C89 6.5.7p3: All the expressions [...] in an initializer list 12772 // for an object that has aggregate or union type shall be 12773 // constant expressions. 12774 } else if (!getLangOpts().C99 && VDecl->getType()->isAggregateType() && 12775 isa<InitListExpr>(Init)) { 12776 const Expr *Culprit; 12777 if (!Init->isConstantInitializer(Context, false, &Culprit)) { 12778 Diag(Culprit->getExprLoc(), 12779 diag::ext_aggregate_init_not_constant) 12780 << Culprit->getSourceRange(); 12781 } 12782 } 12783 12784 if (auto *E = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Init)) 12785 if (auto *BE = dyn_cast<BlockExpr>(E->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens())) 12786 if (VDecl->hasLocalStorage()) 12787 BE->getBlockDecl()->setCanAvoidCopyToHeap(); 12788 } else if (VDecl->isStaticDataMember() && !VDecl->isInline() && 12789 VDecl->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord()) { 12790 // This is an in-class initialization for a static data member, e.g., 12791 // 12792 // struct S { 12793 // static const int value = 17; 12794 // }; 12795 12796 // C++ [class.mem]p4: 12797 // A member-declarator can contain a constant-initializer only 12798 // if it declares a static member (9.4) of const integral or 12799 // const enumeration type, see 9.4.2. 12800 // 12801 // C++11 [class.static.data]p3: 12802 // If a non-volatile non-inline const static data member is of integral 12803 // or enumeration type, its declaration in the class definition can 12804 // specify a brace-or-equal-initializer in which every initializer-clause 12805 // that is an assignment-expression is a constant expression. A static 12806 // data member of literal type can be declared in the class definition 12807 // with the constexpr specifier; if so, its declaration shall specify a 12808 // brace-or-equal-initializer in which every initializer-clause that is 12809 // an assignment-expression is a constant expression. 12810 12811 // Do nothing on dependent types. 12812 if (DclT->isDependentType()) { 12813 12814 // Allow any 'static constexpr' members, whether or not they are of literal 12815 // type. We separately check that every constexpr variable is of literal 12816 // type. 12817 } else if (VDecl->isConstexpr()) { 12818 12819 // Require constness. 12820 } else if (!DclT.isConstQualified()) { 12821 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_non_const) 12822 << Init->getSourceRange(); 12823 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12824 12825 // We allow integer constant expressions in all cases. 12826 } else if (DclT->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) { 12827 // Check whether the expression is a constant expression. 12828 SourceLocation Loc; 12829 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && DclT.isVolatileQualified()) 12830 // In C++11, a non-constexpr const static data member with an 12831 // in-class initializer cannot be volatile. 12832 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_volatile); 12833 else if (Init->isValueDependent()) 12834 ; // Nothing to check. 12835 else if (Init->isIntegerConstantExpr(Context, &Loc)) 12836 ; // Ok, it's an ICE! 12837 else if (Init->getType()->isScopedEnumeralType() && 12838 Init->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Context)) 12839 ; // Ok, it is a scoped-enum constant expression. 12840 else if (Init->isEvaluatable(Context)) { 12841 // If we can constant fold the initializer through heroics, accept it, 12842 // but report this as a use of an extension for -pedantic. 12843 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_in_class_initializer_non_constant) 12844 << Init->getSourceRange(); 12845 } else { 12846 // Otherwise, this is some crazy unknown case. Report the issue at the 12847 // location provided by the isIntegerConstantExpr failed check. 12848 Diag(Loc, diag::err_in_class_initializer_non_constant) 12849 << Init->getSourceRange(); 12850 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12851 } 12852 12853 // We allow foldable floating-point constants as an extension. 12854 } else if (DclT->isFloatingType()) { // also permits complex, which is ok 12855 // In C++98, this is a GNU extension. In C++11, it is not, but we support 12856 // it anyway and provide a fixit to add the 'constexpr'. 12857 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 12858 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), 12859 diag::ext_in_class_initializer_float_type_cxx11) 12860 << DclT << Init->getSourceRange(); 12861 Diag(VDecl->getBeginLoc(), 12862 diag::note_in_class_initializer_float_type_cxx11) 12863 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(VDecl->getBeginLoc(), "constexpr "); 12864 } else { 12865 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::ext_in_class_initializer_float_type) 12866 << DclT << Init->getSourceRange(); 12867 12868 if (!Init->isValueDependent() && !Init->isEvaluatable(Context)) { 12869 Diag(Init->getExprLoc(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_non_constant) 12870 << Init->getSourceRange(); 12871 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12872 } 12873 } 12874 12875 // Suggest adding 'constexpr' in C++11 for literal types. 12876 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && DclT->isLiteralType(Context)) { 12877 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_literal_type) 12878 << DclT << Init->getSourceRange() 12879 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(VDecl->getBeginLoc(), "constexpr "); 12880 VDecl->setConstexpr(true); 12881 12882 } else { 12883 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_bad_type) 12884 << DclT << Init->getSourceRange(); 12885 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12886 } 12887 } else if (VDecl->isFileVarDecl()) { 12888 // In C, extern is typically used to avoid tentative definitions when 12889 // declaring variables in headers, but adding an intializer makes it a 12890 // definition. This is somewhat confusing, so GCC and Clang both warn on it. 12891 // In C++, extern is often used to give implictly static const variables 12892 // external linkage, so don't warn in that case. If selectany is present, 12893 // this might be header code intended for C and C++ inclusion, so apply the 12894 // C++ rules. 12895 if (VDecl->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern && 12896 ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !VDecl->hasAttr<SelectAnyAttr>()) || 12897 !Context.getBaseElementType(VDecl->getType()).isConstQualified()) && 12898 !(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && VDecl->isExternC()) && 12899 !isTemplateInstantiation(VDecl->getTemplateSpecializationKind())) 12900 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::warn_extern_init); 12901 12902 // In Microsoft C++ mode, a const variable defined in namespace scope has 12903 // external linkage by default if the variable is declared with 12904 // __declspec(dllexport). 12905 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() && 12906 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && VDecl->getType().isConstQualified() && 12907 VDecl->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>() && VDecl->getDefinition()) 12908 VDecl->setStorageClass(SC_Extern); 12909 12910 // C99 6.7.8p4. All file scoped initializers need to be constant. 12911 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) 12912 CheckForConstantInitializer(Init, DclT); 12913 } 12914 12915 QualType InitType = Init->getType(); 12916 if (!InitType.isNull() && 12917 (InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() || 12918 InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion())) 12919 checkNonTrivialCUnionInInitializer(Init, Init->getExprLoc()); 12920 12921 // We will represent direct-initialization similarly to copy-initialization: 12922 // int x(1); -as-> int x = 1; 12923 // ClassType x(a,b,c); -as-> ClassType x = ClassType(a,b,c); 12924 // 12925 // Clients that want to distinguish between the two forms, can check for 12926 // direct initializer using VarDecl::getInitStyle(). 12927 // A major benefit is that clients that don't particularly care about which 12928 // exactly form was it (like the CodeGen) can handle both cases without 12929 // special case code. 12930 12931 // C++ 8.5p11: 12932 // The form of initialization (using parentheses or '=') is generally 12933 // insignificant, but does matter when the entity being initialized has a 12934 // class type. 12935 if (CXXDirectInit) { 12936 assert(DirectInit && "Call-style initializer must be direct init."); 12937 VDecl->setInitStyle(VarDecl::CallInit); 12938 } else if (DirectInit) { 12939 // This must be list-initialization. No other way is direct-initialization. 12940 VDecl->setInitStyle(VarDecl::ListInit); 12941 } 12942 12943 if (LangOpts.OpenMP && 12944 (LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice || !LangOpts.OMPTargetTriples.empty()) && 12945 VDecl->isFileVarDecl()) 12946 DeclsToCheckForDeferredDiags.insert(VDecl); 12947 CheckCompleteVariableDeclaration(VDecl); 12948 } 12949 12950 /// ActOnInitializerError - Given that there was an error parsing an 12951 /// initializer for the given declaration, try to at least re-establish 12952 /// invariants such as whether a variable's type is either dependent or 12953 /// complete. 12954 void Sema::ActOnInitializerError(Decl *D) { 12955 // Our main concern here is re-establishing invariants like "a 12956 // variable's type is either dependent or complete". 12957 if (!D || D->isInvalidDecl()) return; 12958 12959 VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D); 12960 if (!VD) return; 12961 12962 // Bindings are not usable if we can't make sense of the initializer. 12963 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(D)) 12964 for (auto *BD : DD->bindings()) 12965 BD->setInvalidDecl(); 12966 12967 // Auto types are meaningless if we can't make sense of the initializer. 12968 if (VD->getType()->isUndeducedType()) { 12969 D->setInvalidDecl(); 12970 return; 12971 } 12972 12973 QualType Ty = VD->getType(); 12974 if (Ty->isDependentType()) return; 12975 12976 // Require a complete type. 12977 if (RequireCompleteType(VD->getLocation(), 12978 Context.getBaseElementType(Ty), 12979 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) { 12980 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 12981 return; 12982 } 12983 12984 // Require a non-abstract type. 12985 if (RequireNonAbstractType(VD->getLocation(), Ty, 12986 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 12987 AbstractVariableType)) { 12988 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 12989 return; 12990 } 12991 12992 // Don't bother complaining about constructors or destructors, 12993 // though. 12994 } 12995 12996 void Sema::ActOnUninitializedDecl(Decl *RealDecl) { 12997 // If there is no declaration, there was an error parsing it. Just ignore it. 12998 if (!RealDecl) 12999 return; 13000 13001 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(RealDecl)) { 13002 QualType Type = Var->getType(); 13003 13004 // C++1z [dcl.dcl]p1 grammar implies that an initializer is mandatory. 13005 if (isa<DecompositionDecl>(RealDecl)) { 13006 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_decomp_decl_requires_init) << Var; 13007 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13008 return; 13009 } 13010 13011 if (Type->isUndeducedType() && 13012 DeduceVariableDeclarationType(Var, false, nullptr)) 13013 return; 13014 13015 // C++11 [class.static.data]p3: A static data member can be declared with 13016 // the constexpr specifier; if so, its declaration shall specify 13017 // a brace-or-equal-initializer. 13018 // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p1: The constexpr specifier shall be applied only to 13019 // the definition of a variable [...] or the declaration of a static data 13020 // member. 13021 if (Var->isConstexpr() && !Var->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && 13022 !Var->isThisDeclarationADemotedDefinition()) { 13023 if (Var->isStaticDataMember()) { 13024 // C++1z removes the relevant rule; the in-class declaration is always 13025 // a definition there. 13026 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 && 13027 !Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) { 13028 Diag(Var->getLocation(), 13029 diag::err_constexpr_static_mem_var_requires_init) 13030 << Var; 13031 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13032 return; 13033 } 13034 } else { 13035 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_invalid_constexpr_var_decl); 13036 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13037 return; 13038 } 13039 } 13040 13041 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5.3: variables declared in the constant address space must 13042 // be initialized. 13043 if (!Var->isInvalidDecl() && 13044 Var->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant && 13045 Var->getStorageClass() != SC_Extern && !Var->getInit()) { 13046 bool HasConstExprDefaultConstructor = false; 13047 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = Var->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) { 13048 for (auto *Ctor : RD->ctors()) { 13049 if (Ctor->isConstexpr() && Ctor->getNumParams() == 0 && 13050 Ctor->getMethodQualifiers().getAddressSpace() == 13051 LangAS::opencl_constant) { 13052 HasConstExprDefaultConstructor = true; 13053 } 13054 } 13055 } 13056 if (!HasConstExprDefaultConstructor) { 13057 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_constant_no_init); 13058 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13059 return; 13060 } 13061 } 13062 13063 if (!Var->isInvalidDecl() && RealDecl->hasAttr<LoaderUninitializedAttr>()) { 13064 if (Var->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern) { 13065 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_loader_uninitialized_extern_decl) 13066 << Var; 13067 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13068 return; 13069 } 13070 if (RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), Var->getType(), 13071 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) { 13072 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13073 return; 13074 } 13075 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = Var->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) { 13076 if (!RD->hasTrivialDefaultConstructor()) { 13077 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_loader_uninitialized_trivial_ctor); 13078 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13079 return; 13080 } 13081 } 13082 // The declaration is unitialized, no need for further checks. 13083 return; 13084 } 13085 13086 VarDecl::DefinitionKind DefKind = Var->isThisDeclarationADefinition(); 13087 if (!Var->isInvalidDecl() && DefKind != VarDecl::DeclarationOnly && 13088 Var->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion()) 13089 checkNonTrivialCUnion(Var->getType(), Var->getLocation(), 13090 NTCUC_DefaultInitializedObject, NTCUK_Init); 13091 13092 13093 switch (DefKind) { 13094 case VarDecl::Definition: 13095 if (!Var->isStaticDataMember() || !Var->getAnyInitializer()) 13096 break; 13097 13098 // We have an out-of-line definition of a static data member 13099 // that has an in-class initializer, so we type-check this like 13100 // a declaration. 13101 // 13102 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 13103 13104 case VarDecl::DeclarationOnly: 13105 // It's only a declaration. 13106 13107 // Block scope. C99 6.7p7: If an identifier for an object is 13108 // declared with no linkage (C99 6.2.2p6), the type for the 13109 // object shall be complete. 13110 if (!Type->isDependentType() && Var->isLocalVarDecl() && 13111 !Var->hasLinkage() && !Var->isInvalidDecl() && 13112 RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), Type, 13113 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) 13114 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13115 13116 // Make sure that the type is not abstract. 13117 if (!Type->isDependentType() && !Var->isInvalidDecl() && 13118 RequireNonAbstractType(Var->getLocation(), Type, 13119 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 13120 AbstractVariableType)) 13121 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13122 if (!Type->isDependentType() && !Var->isInvalidDecl() && 13123 Var->getStorageClass() == SC_PrivateExtern) { 13124 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::warn_private_extern); 13125 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_private_extern); 13126 } 13127 13128 if (Context.getTargetInfo().allowDebugInfoForExternalRef() && 13129 !Var->isInvalidDecl() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 13130 ExternalDeclarations.push_back(Var); 13131 13132 return; 13133 13134 case VarDecl::TentativeDefinition: 13135 // File scope. C99 6.9.2p2: A declaration of an identifier for an 13136 // object that has file scope without an initializer, and without a 13137 // storage-class specifier or with the storage-class specifier "static", 13138 // constitutes a tentative definition. Note: A tentative definition with 13139 // external linkage is valid (C99 6.2.2p5). 13140 if (!Var->isInvalidDecl()) { 13141 if (const IncompleteArrayType *ArrayT 13142 = Context.getAsIncompleteArrayType(Type)) { 13143 if (RequireCompleteSizedType( 13144 Var->getLocation(), ArrayT->getElementType(), 13145 diag::err_array_incomplete_or_sizeless_type)) 13146 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13147 } else if (Var->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) { 13148 // C99 6.9.2p3: If the declaration of an identifier for an object is 13149 // a tentative definition and has internal linkage (C99 6.2.2p3), the 13150 // declared type shall not be an incomplete type. 13151 // NOTE: code such as the following 13152 // static struct s; 13153 // struct s { int a; }; 13154 // is accepted by gcc. Hence here we issue a warning instead of 13155 // an error and we do not invalidate the static declaration. 13156 // NOTE: to avoid multiple warnings, only check the first declaration. 13157 if (Var->isFirstDecl()) 13158 RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), Type, 13159 diag::ext_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type); 13160 } 13161 } 13162 13163 // Record the tentative definition; we're done. 13164 if (!Var->isInvalidDecl()) 13165 TentativeDefinitions.push_back(Var); 13166 return; 13167 } 13168 13169 // Provide a specific diagnostic for uninitialized variable 13170 // definitions with incomplete array type. 13171 if (Type->isIncompleteArrayType()) { 13172 Diag(Var->getLocation(), 13173 diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_array_needs_initializer); 13174 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13175 return; 13176 } 13177 13178 // Provide a specific diagnostic for uninitialized variable 13179 // definitions with reference type. 13180 if (Type->isReferenceType()) { 13181 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_reference_var_requires_init) 13182 << Var << SourceRange(Var->getLocation(), Var->getLocation()); 13183 return; 13184 } 13185 13186 // Do not attempt to type-check the default initializer for a 13187 // variable with dependent type. 13188 if (Type->isDependentType()) 13189 return; 13190 13191 if (Var->isInvalidDecl()) 13192 return; 13193 13194 if (!Var->hasAttr<AliasAttr>()) { 13195 if (RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), 13196 Context.getBaseElementType(Type), 13197 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) { 13198 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13199 return; 13200 } 13201 } else { 13202 return; 13203 } 13204 13205 // The variable can not have an abstract class type. 13206 if (RequireNonAbstractType(Var->getLocation(), Type, 13207 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 13208 AbstractVariableType)) { 13209 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13210 return; 13211 } 13212 13213 // Check for jumps past the implicit initializer. C++0x 13214 // clarifies that this applies to a "variable with automatic 13215 // storage duration", not a "local variable". 13216 // C++11 [stmt.dcl]p3 13217 // A program that jumps from a point where a variable with automatic 13218 // storage duration is not in scope to a point where it is in scope is 13219 // ill-formed unless the variable has scalar type, class type with a 13220 // trivial default constructor and a trivial destructor, a cv-qualified 13221 // version of one of these types, or an array of one of the preceding 13222 // types and is declared without an initializer. 13223 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Var->hasLocalStorage()) { 13224 if (const RecordType *Record 13225 = Context.getBaseElementType(Type)->getAs<RecordType>()) { 13226 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl()); 13227 // Mark the function (if we're in one) for further checking even if the 13228 // looser rules of C++11 do not require such checks, so that we can 13229 // diagnose incompatibilities with C++98. 13230 if (!CXXRecord->isPOD()) 13231 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 13232 } 13233 } 13234 // In OpenCL, we can't initialize objects in the __local address space, 13235 // even implicitly, so don't synthesize an implicit initializer. 13236 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && 13237 Var->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local) 13238 return; 13239 // C++03 [dcl.init]p9: 13240 // If no initializer is specified for an object, and the 13241 // object is of (possibly cv-qualified) non-POD class type (or 13242 // array thereof), the object shall be default-initialized; if 13243 // the object is of const-qualified type, the underlying class 13244 // type shall have a user-declared default 13245 // constructor. Otherwise, if no initializer is specified for 13246 // a non- static object, the object and its subobjects, if 13247 // any, have an indeterminate initial value); if the object 13248 // or any of its subobjects are of const-qualified type, the 13249 // program is ill-formed. 13250 // C++0x [dcl.init]p11: 13251 // If no initializer is specified for an object, the object is 13252 // default-initialized; [...]. 13253 InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeVariable(Var); 13254 InitializationKind Kind 13255 = InitializationKind::CreateDefault(Var->getLocation()); 13256 13257 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, None); 13258 ExprResult Init = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, None); 13259 13260 if (Init.get()) { 13261 Var->setInit(MaybeCreateExprWithCleanups(Init.get())); 13262 // This is important for template substitution. 13263 Var->setInitStyle(VarDecl::CallInit); 13264 } else if (Init.isInvalid()) { 13265 // If default-init fails, attach a recovery-expr initializer to track 13266 // that initialization was attempted and failed. 13267 auto RecoveryExpr = 13268 CreateRecoveryExpr(Var->getLocation(), Var->getLocation(), {}); 13269 if (RecoveryExpr.get()) 13270 Var->setInit(RecoveryExpr.get()); 13271 } 13272 13273 CheckCompleteVariableDeclaration(Var); 13274 } 13275 } 13276 13277 void Sema::ActOnCXXForRangeDecl(Decl *D) { 13278 // If there is no declaration, there was an error parsing it. Ignore it. 13279 if (!D) 13280 return; 13281 13282 VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D); 13283 if (!VD) { 13284 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::err_for_range_decl_must_be_var); 13285 D->setInvalidDecl(); 13286 return; 13287 } 13288 13289 VD->setCXXForRangeDecl(true); 13290 13291 // for-range-declaration cannot be given a storage class specifier. 13292 int Error = -1; 13293 switch (VD->getStorageClass()) { 13294 case SC_None: 13295 break; 13296 case SC_Extern: 13297 Error = 0; 13298 break; 13299 case SC_Static: 13300 Error = 1; 13301 break; 13302 case SC_PrivateExtern: 13303 Error = 2; 13304 break; 13305 case SC_Auto: 13306 Error = 3; 13307 break; 13308 case SC_Register: 13309 Error = 4; 13310 break; 13311 } 13312 13313 // for-range-declaration cannot be given a storage class specifier con't. 13314 switch (VD->getTSCSpec()) { 13315 case TSCS_thread_local: 13316 Error = 6; 13317 break; 13318 case TSCS___thread: 13319 case TSCS__Thread_local: 13320 case TSCS_unspecified: 13321 break; 13322 } 13323 13324 if (Error != -1) { 13325 Diag(VD->getOuterLocStart(), diag::err_for_range_storage_class) 13326 << VD << Error; 13327 D->setInvalidDecl(); 13328 } 13329 } 13330 13331 StmtResult Sema::ActOnCXXForRangeIdentifier(Scope *S, SourceLocation IdentLoc, 13332 IdentifierInfo *Ident, 13333 ParsedAttributes &Attrs) { 13334 // C++1y [stmt.iter]p1: 13335 // A range-based for statement of the form 13336 // for ( for-range-identifier : for-range-initializer ) statement 13337 // is equivalent to 13338 // for ( auto&& for-range-identifier : for-range-initializer ) statement 13339 DeclSpec DS(Attrs.getPool().getFactory()); 13340 13341 const char *PrevSpec; 13342 unsigned DiagID; 13343 DS.SetTypeSpecType(DeclSpec::TST_auto, IdentLoc, PrevSpec, DiagID, 13344 getPrintingPolicy()); 13345 13346 Declarator D(DS, ParsedAttributesView::none(), DeclaratorContext::ForInit); 13347 D.SetIdentifier(Ident, IdentLoc); 13348 D.takeAttributes(Attrs); 13349 13350 D.AddTypeInfo(DeclaratorChunk::getReference(0, IdentLoc, /*lvalue*/ false), 13351 IdentLoc); 13352 Decl *Var = ActOnDeclarator(S, D); 13353 cast<VarDecl>(Var)->setCXXForRangeDecl(true); 13354 FinalizeDeclaration(Var); 13355 return ActOnDeclStmt(FinalizeDeclaratorGroup(S, DS, Var), IdentLoc, 13356 Attrs.Range.getEnd().isValid() ? Attrs.Range.getEnd() 13357 : IdentLoc); 13358 } 13359 13360 void Sema::CheckCompleteVariableDeclaration(VarDecl *var) { 13361 if (var->isInvalidDecl()) return; 13362 13363 MaybeAddCUDAConstantAttr(var); 13364 13365 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 13366 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - Every block variable declaration must have an 13367 // initialiser 13368 if (var->getTypeSourceInfo()->getType()->isBlockPointerType() && 13369 !var->hasInit()) { 13370 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_invalid_block_declaration) 13371 << 1 /*Init*/; 13372 var->setInvalidDecl(); 13373 return; 13374 } 13375 } 13376 13377 // In Objective-C, don't allow jumps past the implicit initialization of a 13378 // local retaining variable. 13379 if (getLangOpts().ObjC && 13380 var->hasLocalStorage()) { 13381 switch (var->getType().getObjCLifetime()) { 13382 case Qualifiers::OCL_None: 13383 case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone: 13384 case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing: 13385 break; 13386 13387 case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak: 13388 case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong: 13389 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 13390 break; 13391 } 13392 } 13393 13394 if (var->hasLocalStorage() && 13395 var->getType().isDestructedType() == QualType::DK_nontrivial_c_struct) 13396 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 13397 13398 // Warn about externally-visible variables being defined without a 13399 // prior declaration. We only want to do this for global 13400 // declarations, but we also specifically need to avoid doing it for 13401 // class members because the linkage of an anonymous class can 13402 // change if it's later given a typedef name. 13403 if (var->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && 13404 var->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isFileContext() && 13405 var->isExternallyVisible() && var->hasLinkage() && 13406 !var->isInline() && !var->getDescribedVarTemplate() && 13407 !isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(var) && 13408 !isTemplateInstantiation(var->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) && 13409 !getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_missing_variable_declarations, 13410 var->getLocation())) { 13411 // Find a previous declaration that's not a definition. 13412 VarDecl *prev = var->getPreviousDecl(); 13413 while (prev && prev->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) 13414 prev = prev->getPreviousDecl(); 13415 13416 if (!prev) { 13417 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::warn_missing_variable_declarations) << var; 13418 Diag(var->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::note_static_for_internal_linkage) 13419 << /* variable */ 0; 13420 } 13421 } 13422 13423 // Cache the result of checking for constant initialization. 13424 Optional<bool> CacheHasConstInit; 13425 const Expr *CacheCulprit = nullptr; 13426 auto checkConstInit = [&]() mutable { 13427 if (!CacheHasConstInit) 13428 CacheHasConstInit = var->getInit()->isConstantInitializer( 13429 Context, var->getType()->isReferenceType(), &CacheCulprit); 13430 return *CacheHasConstInit; 13431 }; 13432 13433 if (var->getTLSKind() == VarDecl::TLS_Static) { 13434 if (var->getType().isDestructedType()) { 13435 // GNU C++98 edits for __thread, [basic.start.term]p3: 13436 // The type of an object with thread storage duration shall not 13437 // have a non-trivial destructor. 13438 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_thread_nontrivial_dtor); 13439 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 13440 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::note_use_thread_local); 13441 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && var->hasInit()) { 13442 if (!checkConstInit()) { 13443 // GNU C++98 edits for __thread, [basic.start.init]p4: 13444 // An object of thread storage duration shall not require dynamic 13445 // initialization. 13446 // FIXME: Need strict checking here. 13447 Diag(CacheCulprit->getExprLoc(), diag::err_thread_dynamic_init) 13448 << CacheCulprit->getSourceRange(); 13449 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 13450 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::note_use_thread_local); 13451 } 13452 } 13453 } 13454 13455 13456 if (!var->getType()->isStructureType() && var->hasInit() && 13457 isa<InitListExpr>(var->getInit())) { 13458 const auto *ILE = cast<InitListExpr>(var->getInit()); 13459 unsigned NumInits = ILE->getNumInits(); 13460 if (NumInits > 2) 13461 for (unsigned I = 0; I < NumInits; ++I) { 13462 const auto *Init = ILE->getInit(I); 13463 if (!Init) 13464 break; 13465 const auto *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(Init->IgnoreImpCasts()); 13466 if (!SL) 13467 break; 13468 13469 unsigned NumConcat = SL->getNumConcatenated(); 13470 // Diagnose missing comma in string array initialization. 13471 // Do not warn when all the elements in the initializer are concatenated 13472 // together. Do not warn for macros too. 13473 if (NumConcat == 2 && !SL->getBeginLoc().isMacroID()) { 13474 bool OnlyOneMissingComma = true; 13475 for (unsigned J = I + 1; J < NumInits; ++J) { 13476 const auto *Init = ILE->getInit(J); 13477 if (!Init) 13478 break; 13479 const auto *SLJ = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(Init->IgnoreImpCasts()); 13480 if (!SLJ || SLJ->getNumConcatenated() > 1) { 13481 OnlyOneMissingComma = false; 13482 break; 13483 } 13484 } 13485 13486 if (OnlyOneMissingComma) { 13487 SmallVector<FixItHint, 1> Hints; 13488 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumConcat - 1; ++i) 13489 Hints.push_back(FixItHint::CreateInsertion( 13490 PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SL->getStrTokenLoc(i)), ",")); 13491 13492 Diag(SL->getStrTokenLoc(1), 13493 diag::warn_concatenated_literal_array_init) 13494 << Hints; 13495 Diag(SL->getBeginLoc(), 13496 diag::note_concatenated_string_literal_silence); 13497 } 13498 // In any case, stop now. 13499 break; 13500 } 13501 } 13502 } 13503 13504 13505 QualType type = var->getType(); 13506 13507 if (var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) 13508 getCurFunction()->addByrefBlockVar(var); 13509 13510 Expr *Init = var->getInit(); 13511 bool GlobalStorage = var->hasGlobalStorage(); 13512 bool IsGlobal = GlobalStorage && !var->isStaticLocal(); 13513 QualType baseType = Context.getBaseElementType(type); 13514 bool HasConstInit = true; 13515 13516 // Check whether the initializer is sufficiently constant. 13517 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !type->isDependentType() && Init && 13518 !Init->isValueDependent() && 13519 (GlobalStorage || var->isConstexpr() || 13520 var->mightBeUsableInConstantExpressions(Context))) { 13521 // If this variable might have a constant initializer or might be usable in 13522 // constant expressions, check whether or not it actually is now. We can't 13523 // do this lazily, because the result might depend on things that change 13524 // later, such as which constexpr functions happen to be defined. 13525 SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes; 13526 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 13527 // Prior to C++11, in contexts where a constant initializer is required, 13528 // the set of valid constant initializers is described by syntactic rules 13529 // in [expr.const]p2-6. 13530 // FIXME: Stricter checking for these rules would be useful for constinit / 13531 // -Wglobal-constructors. 13532 HasConstInit = checkConstInit(); 13533 13534 // Compute and cache the constant value, and remember that we have a 13535 // constant initializer. 13536 if (HasConstInit) { 13537 (void)var->checkForConstantInitialization(Notes); 13538 Notes.clear(); 13539 } else if (CacheCulprit) { 13540 Notes.emplace_back(CacheCulprit->getExprLoc(), 13541 PDiag(diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr)); 13542 Notes.back().second << CacheCulprit->getSourceRange(); 13543 } 13544 } else { 13545 // Evaluate the initializer to see if it's a constant initializer. 13546 HasConstInit = var->checkForConstantInitialization(Notes); 13547 } 13548 13549 if (HasConstInit) { 13550 // FIXME: Consider replacing the initializer with a ConstantExpr. 13551 } else if (var->isConstexpr()) { 13552 SourceLocation DiagLoc = var->getLocation(); 13553 // If the note doesn't add any useful information other than a source 13554 // location, fold it into the primary diagnostic. 13555 if (Notes.size() == 1 && Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == 13556 diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) { 13557 DiagLoc = Notes[0].first; 13558 Notes.clear(); 13559 } 13560 Diag(DiagLoc, diag::err_constexpr_var_requires_const_init) 13561 << var << Init->getSourceRange(); 13562 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Notes.size(); I != N; ++I) 13563 Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second); 13564 } else if (GlobalStorage && var->hasAttr<ConstInitAttr>()) { 13565 auto *Attr = var->getAttr<ConstInitAttr>(); 13566 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_require_constant_init_failed) 13567 << Init->getSourceRange(); 13568 Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_required_constant_init_here) 13569 << Attr->getRange() << Attr->isConstinit(); 13570 for (auto &it : Notes) 13571 Diag(it.first, it.second); 13572 } else if (IsGlobal && 13573 !getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_global_constructor, 13574 var->getLocation())) { 13575 // Warn about globals which don't have a constant initializer. Don't 13576 // warn about globals with a non-trivial destructor because we already 13577 // warned about them. 13578 CXXRecordDecl *RD = baseType->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 13579 if (!(RD && !RD->hasTrivialDestructor())) { 13580 // checkConstInit() here permits trivial default initialization even in 13581 // C++11 onwards, where such an initializer is not a constant initializer 13582 // but nonetheless doesn't require a global constructor. 13583 if (!checkConstInit()) 13584 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::warn_global_constructor) 13585 << Init->getSourceRange(); 13586 } 13587 } 13588 } 13589 13590 // Apply section attributes and pragmas to global variables. 13591 if (GlobalStorage && var->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && 13592 !inTemplateInstantiation()) { 13593 PragmaStack<StringLiteral *> *Stack = nullptr; 13594 int SectionFlags = ASTContext::PSF_Read; 13595 if (var->getType().isConstQualified()) { 13596 if (HasConstInit) 13597 Stack = &ConstSegStack; 13598 else { 13599 Stack = &BSSSegStack; 13600 SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Write; 13601 } 13602 } else if (var->hasInit() && HasConstInit) { 13603 Stack = &DataSegStack; 13604 SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Write; 13605 } else { 13606 Stack = &BSSSegStack; 13607 SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Write; 13608 } 13609 if (const SectionAttr *SA = var->getAttr<SectionAttr>()) { 13610 if (SA->getSyntax() == AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Declspec) 13611 SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Implicit; 13612 UnifySection(SA->getName(), SectionFlags, var); 13613 } else if (Stack->CurrentValue) { 13614 SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Implicit; 13615 auto SectionName = Stack->CurrentValue->getString(); 13616 var->addAttr(SectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 13617 Context, SectionName, Stack->CurrentPragmaLocation, 13618 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma, SectionAttr::Declspec_allocate)); 13619 if (UnifySection(SectionName, SectionFlags, var)) 13620 var->dropAttr<SectionAttr>(); 13621 } 13622 13623 // Apply the init_seg attribute if this has an initializer. If the 13624 // initializer turns out to not be dynamic, we'll end up ignoring this 13625 // attribute. 13626 if (CurInitSeg && var->getInit()) 13627 var->addAttr(InitSegAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, CurInitSeg->getString(), 13628 CurInitSegLoc, 13629 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 13630 } 13631 13632 // All the following checks are C++ only. 13633 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 13634 // If this variable must be emitted, add it as an initializer for the 13635 // current module. 13636 if (Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(var) && !ModuleScopes.empty()) 13637 Context.addModuleInitializer(ModuleScopes.back().Module, var); 13638 return; 13639 } 13640 13641 // Require the destructor. 13642 if (!type->isDependentType()) 13643 if (const RecordType *recordType = baseType->getAs<RecordType>()) 13644 FinalizeVarWithDestructor(var, recordType); 13645 13646 // If this variable must be emitted, add it as an initializer for the current 13647 // module. 13648 if (Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(var) && !ModuleScopes.empty()) 13649 Context.addModuleInitializer(ModuleScopes.back().Module, var); 13650 13651 // Build the bindings if this is a structured binding declaration. 13652 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(var)) 13653 CheckCompleteDecompositionDeclaration(DD); 13654 } 13655 13656 /// Check if VD needs to be dllexport/dllimport due to being in a 13657 /// dllexport/import function. 13658 void Sema::CheckStaticLocalForDllExport(VarDecl *VD) { 13659 assert(VD->isStaticLocal()); 13660 13661 auto *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod()); 13662 13663 // Find outermost function when VD is in lambda function. 13664 while (FD && !getDLLAttr(FD) && 13665 !FD->hasAttr<DLLExportStaticLocalAttr>() && 13666 !FD->hasAttr<DLLImportStaticLocalAttr>()) { 13667 FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(FD->getParentFunctionOrMethod()); 13668 } 13669 13670 if (!FD) 13671 return; 13672 13673 // Static locals inherit dll attributes from their function. 13674 if (Attr *A = getDLLAttr(FD)) { 13675 auto *NewAttr = cast<InheritableAttr>(A->clone(getASTContext())); 13676 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 13677 VD->addAttr(NewAttr); 13678 } else if (Attr *A = FD->getAttr<DLLExportStaticLocalAttr>()) { 13679 auto *NewAttr = DLLExportAttr::CreateImplicit(getASTContext(), *A); 13680 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 13681 VD->addAttr(NewAttr); 13682 13683 // Export this function to enforce exporting this static variable even 13684 // if it is not used in this compilation unit. 13685 if (!FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) 13686 FD->addAttr(NewAttr); 13687 13688 } else if (Attr *A = FD->getAttr<DLLImportStaticLocalAttr>()) { 13689 auto *NewAttr = DLLImportAttr::CreateImplicit(getASTContext(), *A); 13690 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 13691 VD->addAttr(NewAttr); 13692 } 13693 } 13694 13695 /// FinalizeDeclaration - called by ParseDeclarationAfterDeclarator to perform 13696 /// any semantic actions necessary after any initializer has been attached. 13697 void Sema::FinalizeDeclaration(Decl *ThisDecl) { 13698 // Note that we are no longer parsing the initializer for this declaration. 13699 ParsingInitForAutoVars.erase(ThisDecl); 13700 13701 VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast_or_null<VarDecl>(ThisDecl); 13702 if (!VD) 13703 return; 13704 13705 // Apply an implicit SectionAttr if '#pragma clang section bss|data|rodata' is active 13706 if (VD->hasGlobalStorage() && VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && 13707 !inTemplateInstantiation() && !VD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) { 13708 if (PragmaClangBSSSection.Valid) 13709 VD->addAttr(PragmaClangBSSSectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 13710 Context, PragmaClangBSSSection.SectionName, 13711 PragmaClangBSSSection.PragmaLocation, 13712 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 13713 if (PragmaClangDataSection.Valid) 13714 VD->addAttr(PragmaClangDataSectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 13715 Context, PragmaClangDataSection.SectionName, 13716 PragmaClangDataSection.PragmaLocation, 13717 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 13718 if (PragmaClangRodataSection.Valid) 13719 VD->addAttr(PragmaClangRodataSectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 13720 Context, PragmaClangRodataSection.SectionName, 13721 PragmaClangRodataSection.PragmaLocation, 13722 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 13723 if (PragmaClangRelroSection.Valid) 13724 VD->addAttr(PragmaClangRelroSectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 13725 Context, PragmaClangRelroSection.SectionName, 13726 PragmaClangRelroSection.PragmaLocation, 13727 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 13728 } 13729 13730 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(ThisDecl)) { 13731 for (auto *BD : DD->bindings()) { 13732 FinalizeDeclaration(BD); 13733 } 13734 } 13735 13736 checkAttributesAfterMerging(*this, *VD); 13737 13738 // Perform TLS alignment check here after attributes attached to the variable 13739 // which may affect the alignment have been processed. Only perform the check 13740 // if the target has a maximum TLS alignment (zero means no constraints). 13741 if (unsigned MaxAlign = Context.getTargetInfo().getMaxTLSAlign()) { 13742 // Protect the check so that it's not performed on dependent types and 13743 // dependent alignments (we can't determine the alignment in that case). 13744 if (VD->getTLSKind() && !VD->hasDependentAlignment()) { 13745 CharUnits MaxAlignChars = Context.toCharUnitsFromBits(MaxAlign); 13746 if (Context.getDeclAlign(VD) > MaxAlignChars) { 13747 Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::err_tls_var_aligned_over_maximum) 13748 << (unsigned)Context.getDeclAlign(VD).getQuantity() << VD 13749 << (unsigned)MaxAlignChars.getQuantity(); 13750 } 13751 } 13752 } 13753 13754 if (VD->isStaticLocal()) 13755 CheckStaticLocalForDllExport(VD); 13756 13757 // Perform check for initializers of device-side global variables. 13758 // CUDA allows empty constructors as initializers (see E.2.3.1, CUDA 13759 // 7.5). We must also apply the same checks to all __shared__ 13760 // variables whether they are local or not. CUDA also allows 13761 // constant initializers for __constant__ and __device__ variables. 13762 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) 13763 checkAllowedCUDAInitializer(VD); 13764 13765 // Grab the dllimport or dllexport attribute off of the VarDecl. 13766 const InheritableAttr *DLLAttr = getDLLAttr(VD); 13767 13768 // Imported static data members cannot be defined out-of-line. 13769 if (const auto *IA = dyn_cast_or_null<DLLImportAttr>(DLLAttr)) { 13770 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() && VD->isOutOfLine() && 13771 VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) { 13772 // We allow definitions of dllimport class template static data members 13773 // with a warning. 13774 CXXRecordDecl *Context = 13775 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(VD->getFirstDecl()->getDeclContext()); 13776 bool IsClassTemplateMember = 13777 isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(Context) || 13778 Context->getDescribedClassTemplate(); 13779 13780 Diag(VD->getLocation(), 13781 IsClassTemplateMember 13782 ? diag::warn_attribute_dllimport_static_field_definition 13783 : diag::err_attribute_dllimport_static_field_definition); 13784 Diag(IA->getLocation(), diag::note_attribute); 13785 if (!IsClassTemplateMember) 13786 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 13787 } 13788 } 13789 13790 // dllimport/dllexport variables cannot be thread local, their TLS index 13791 // isn't exported with the variable. 13792 if (DLLAttr && VD->getTLSKind()) { 13793 auto *F = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod()); 13794 if (F && getDLLAttr(F)) { 13795 assert(VD->isStaticLocal()); 13796 // But if this is a static local in a dlimport/dllexport function, the 13797 // function will never be inlined, which means the var would never be 13798 // imported, so having it marked import/export is safe. 13799 } else { 13800 Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dll_thread_local) << VD 13801 << DLLAttr; 13802 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 13803 } 13804 } 13805 13806 if (UsedAttr *Attr = VD->getAttr<UsedAttr>()) { 13807 if (!Attr->isInherited() && !VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) { 13808 Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_ignored_on_non_definition) 13809 << Attr; 13810 VD->dropAttr<UsedAttr>(); 13811 } 13812 } 13813 if (RetainAttr *Attr = VD->getAttr<RetainAttr>()) { 13814 if (!Attr->isInherited() && !VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) { 13815 Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_ignored_on_non_definition) 13816 << Attr; 13817 VD->dropAttr<RetainAttr>(); 13818 } 13819 } 13820 13821 const DeclContext *DC = VD->getDeclContext(); 13822 // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, and this isn't a class 13823 // member, set the visibility of this variable. 13824 if (DC->getRedeclContext()->isFileContext() && VD->isExternallyVisible()) 13825 AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(VD); 13826 13827 // FIXME: Warn on unused var template partial specializations. 13828 if (VD->isFileVarDecl() && !isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(VD)) 13829 MarkUnusedFileScopedDecl(VD); 13830 13831 // Now we have parsed the initializer and can update the table of magic 13832 // tag values. 13833 if (!VD->hasAttr<TypeTagForDatatypeAttr>() || 13834 !VD->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) 13835 return; 13836 13837 for (const auto *I : ThisDecl->specific_attrs<TypeTagForDatatypeAttr>()) { 13838 const Expr *MagicValueExpr = VD->getInit(); 13839 if (!MagicValueExpr) { 13840 continue; 13841 } 13842 Optional<llvm::APSInt> MagicValueInt; 13843 if (!(MagicValueInt = MagicValueExpr->getIntegerConstantExpr(Context))) { 13844 Diag(I->getRange().getBegin(), 13845 diag::err_type_tag_for_datatype_not_ice) 13846 << LangOpts.CPlusPlus << MagicValueExpr->getSourceRange(); 13847 continue; 13848 } 13849 if (MagicValueInt->getActiveBits() > 64) { 13850 Diag(I->getRange().getBegin(), 13851 diag::err_type_tag_for_datatype_too_large) 13852 << LangOpts.CPlusPlus << MagicValueExpr->getSourceRange(); 13853 continue; 13854 } 13855 uint64_t MagicValue = MagicValueInt->getZExtValue(); 13856 RegisterTypeTagForDatatype(I->getArgumentKind(), 13857 MagicValue, 13858 I->getMatchingCType(), 13859 I->getLayoutCompatible(), 13860 I->getMustBeNull()); 13861 } 13862 } 13863 13864 static bool hasDeducedAuto(DeclaratorDecl *DD) { 13865 auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(DD); 13866 return VD && !VD->getType()->hasAutoForTrailingReturnType(); 13867 } 13868 13869 Sema::DeclGroupPtrTy Sema::FinalizeDeclaratorGroup(Scope *S, const DeclSpec &DS, 13870 ArrayRef<Decl *> Group) { 13871 SmallVector<Decl*, 8> Decls; 13872 13873 if (DS.isTypeSpecOwned()) 13874 Decls.push_back(DS.getRepAsDecl()); 13875 13876 DeclaratorDecl *FirstDeclaratorInGroup = nullptr; 13877 DecompositionDecl *FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup = nullptr; 13878 bool DiagnosedMultipleDecomps = false; 13879 DeclaratorDecl *FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup = nullptr; 13880 bool DiagnosedNonDeducedAuto = false; 13881 13882 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Group.size(); i != e; ++i) { 13883 if (Decl *D = Group[i]) { 13884 // For declarators, there are some additional syntactic-ish checks we need 13885 // to perform. 13886 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DeclaratorDecl>(D)) { 13887 if (!FirstDeclaratorInGroup) 13888 FirstDeclaratorInGroup = DD; 13889 if (!FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup) 13890 FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(D); 13891 if (!FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup && DS.hasAutoTypeSpec() && 13892 !hasDeducedAuto(DD)) 13893 FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup = DD; 13894 13895 if (FirstDeclaratorInGroup != DD) { 13896 // A decomposition declaration cannot be combined with any other 13897 // declaration in the same group. 13898 if (FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup && !DiagnosedMultipleDecomps) { 13899 Diag(FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup->getLocation(), 13900 diag::err_decomp_decl_not_alone) 13901 << FirstDeclaratorInGroup->getSourceRange() 13902 << DD->getSourceRange(); 13903 DiagnosedMultipleDecomps = true; 13904 } 13905 13906 // A declarator that uses 'auto' in any way other than to declare a 13907 // variable with a deduced type cannot be combined with any other 13908 // declarator in the same group. 13909 if (FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup && !DiagnosedNonDeducedAuto) { 13910 Diag(FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup->getLocation(), 13911 diag::err_auto_non_deduced_not_alone) 13912 << FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup->getType() 13913 ->hasAutoForTrailingReturnType() 13914 << FirstDeclaratorInGroup->getSourceRange() 13915 << DD->getSourceRange(); 13916 DiagnosedNonDeducedAuto = true; 13917 } 13918 } 13919 } 13920 13921 Decls.push_back(D); 13922 } 13923 } 13924 13925 if (DeclSpec::isDeclRep(DS.getTypeSpecType())) { 13926 if (TagDecl *Tag = dyn_cast_or_null<TagDecl>(DS.getRepAsDecl())) { 13927 handleTagNumbering(Tag, S); 13928 if (FirstDeclaratorInGroup && !Tag->hasNameForLinkage() && 13929 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 13930 Context.addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(Tag, FirstDeclaratorInGroup); 13931 } 13932 } 13933 13934 return BuildDeclaratorGroup(Decls); 13935 } 13936 13937 /// BuildDeclaratorGroup - convert a list of declarations into a declaration 13938 /// group, performing any necessary semantic checking. 13939 Sema::DeclGroupPtrTy 13940 Sema::BuildDeclaratorGroup(MutableArrayRef<Decl *> Group) { 13941 // C++14 [dcl.spec.auto]p7: (DR1347) 13942 // If the type that replaces the placeholder type is not the same in each 13943 // deduction, the program is ill-formed. 13944 if (Group.size() > 1) { 13945 QualType Deduced; 13946 VarDecl *DeducedDecl = nullptr; 13947 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Group.size(); i != e; ++i) { 13948 VarDecl *D = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Group[i]); 13949 if (!D || D->isInvalidDecl()) 13950 break; 13951 DeducedType *DT = D->getType()->getContainedDeducedType(); 13952 if (!DT || DT->getDeducedType().isNull()) 13953 continue; 13954 if (Deduced.isNull()) { 13955 Deduced = DT->getDeducedType(); 13956 DeducedDecl = D; 13957 } else if (!Context.hasSameType(DT->getDeducedType(), Deduced)) { 13958 auto *AT = dyn_cast<AutoType>(DT); 13959 auto Dia = Diag(D->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 13960 diag::err_auto_different_deductions) 13961 << (AT ? (unsigned)AT->getKeyword() : 3) << Deduced 13962 << DeducedDecl->getDeclName() << DT->getDeducedType() 13963 << D->getDeclName(); 13964 if (DeducedDecl->hasInit()) 13965 Dia << DeducedDecl->getInit()->getSourceRange(); 13966 if (D->getInit()) 13967 Dia << D->getInit()->getSourceRange(); 13968 D->setInvalidDecl(); 13969 break; 13970 } 13971 } 13972 } 13973 13974 ActOnDocumentableDecls(Group); 13975 13976 return DeclGroupPtrTy::make( 13977 DeclGroupRef::Create(Context, Group.data(), Group.size())); 13978 } 13979 13980 void Sema::ActOnDocumentableDecl(Decl *D) { 13981 ActOnDocumentableDecls(D); 13982 } 13983 13984 void Sema::ActOnDocumentableDecls(ArrayRef<Decl *> Group) { 13985 // Don't parse the comment if Doxygen diagnostics are ignored. 13986 if (Group.empty() || !Group[0]) 13987 return; 13988 13989 if (Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_doc_param_not_found, 13990 Group[0]->getLocation()) && 13991 Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_unknown_comment_command_name, 13992 Group[0]->getLocation())) 13993 return; 13994 13995 if (Group.size() >= 2) { 13996 // This is a decl group. Normally it will contain only declarations 13997 // produced from declarator list. But in case we have any definitions or 13998 // additional declaration references: 13999 // 'typedef struct S {} S;' 14000 // 'typedef struct S *S;' 14001 // 'struct S *pS;' 14002 // FinalizeDeclaratorGroup adds these as separate declarations. 14003 Decl *MaybeTagDecl = Group[0]; 14004 if (MaybeTagDecl && isa<TagDecl>(MaybeTagDecl)) { 14005 Group = Group.slice(1); 14006 } 14007 } 14008 14009 // FIMXE: We assume every Decl in the group is in the same file. 14010 // This is false when preprocessor constructs the group from decls in 14011 // different files (e. g. macros or #include). 14012 Context.attachCommentsToJustParsedDecls(Group, &getPreprocessor()); 14013 } 14014 14015 /// Common checks for a parameter-declaration that should apply to both function 14016 /// parameters and non-type template parameters. 14017 void Sema::CheckFunctionOrTemplateParamDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D) { 14018 // Check that there are no default arguments inside the type of this 14019 // parameter. 14020 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 14021 CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D); 14022 14023 // Parameter declarators cannot be qualified (C++ [dcl.meaning]p1). 14024 if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 14025 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_qualified_param_declarator) 14026 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 14027 } 14028 14029 // [dcl.meaning]p1: An unqualified-id occurring in a declarator-id shall be a 14030 // simple identifier except [...irrelevant cases...]. 14031 switch (D.getName().getKind()) { 14032 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_Identifier: 14033 break; 14034 14035 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_OperatorFunctionId: 14036 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConversionFunctionId: 14037 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_LiteralOperatorId: 14038 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorName: 14039 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DestructorName: 14040 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ImplicitSelfParam: 14041 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DeductionGuideName: 14042 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_bad_parameter_name) 14043 << GetNameForDeclarator(D).getName(); 14044 break; 14045 14046 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId: 14047 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorTemplateId: 14048 // GetNameForDeclarator would not produce a useful name in this case. 14049 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_bad_parameter_name_template_id); 14050 break; 14051 } 14052 } 14053 14054 /// ActOnParamDeclarator - Called from Parser::ParseFunctionDeclarator() 14055 /// to introduce parameters into function prototype scope. 14056 Decl *Sema::ActOnParamDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D) { 14057 const DeclSpec &DS = D.getDeclSpec(); 14058 14059 // Verify C99 6.7.5.3p2: The only SCS allowed is 'register'. 14060 14061 // C++03 [dcl.stc]p2 also permits 'auto'. 14062 StorageClass SC = SC_None; 14063 if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_register) { 14064 SC = SC_Register; 14065 // In C++11, the 'register' storage class specifier is deprecated. 14066 // In C++17, it is not allowed, but we tolerate it as an extension. 14067 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 14068 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 14069 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ? diag::ext_register_storage_class 14070 : diag::warn_deprecated_register) 14071 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 14072 } 14073 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 14074 DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_auto) { 14075 SC = SC_Auto; 14076 } else if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified) { 14077 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 14078 diag::err_invalid_storage_class_in_func_decl); 14079 D.getMutableDeclSpec().ClearStorageClassSpecs(); 14080 } 14081 14082 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = DS.getThreadStorageClassSpec()) 14083 Diag(DS.getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), diag::err_invalid_thread) 14084 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 14085 if (DS.isInlineSpecified()) 14086 Diag(DS.getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function) 14087 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17; 14088 if (DS.hasConstexprSpecifier()) 14089 Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_invalid_constexpr) 14090 << 0 << static_cast<int>(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier()); 14091 14092 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(DS); 14093 14094 CheckFunctionOrTemplateParamDeclarator(S, D); 14095 14096 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S); 14097 QualType parmDeclType = TInfo->getType(); 14098 14099 // Check for redeclaration of parameters, e.g. int foo(int x, int x); 14100 IdentifierInfo *II = D.getIdentifier(); 14101 if (II) { 14102 LookupResult R(*this, II, D.getIdentifierLoc(), LookupOrdinaryName, 14103 ForVisibleRedeclaration); 14104 LookupName(R, S); 14105 if (R.isSingleResult()) { 14106 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = R.getFoundDecl(); 14107 if (PrevDecl->isTemplateParameter()) { 14108 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 14109 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(D.getIdentifierLoc(), PrevDecl); 14110 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 14111 PrevDecl = nullptr; 14112 } else if (S->isDeclScope(PrevDecl)) { 14113 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_param_redefinition) << II; 14114 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 14115 14116 // Recover by removing the name 14117 II = nullptr; 14118 D.SetIdentifier(nullptr, D.getIdentifierLoc()); 14119 D.setInvalidType(true); 14120 } 14121 } 14122 } 14123 14124 // Temporarily put parameter variables in the translation unit, not 14125 // the enclosing context. This prevents them from accidentally 14126 // looking like class members in C++. 14127 ParmVarDecl *New = 14128 CheckParameter(Context.getTranslationUnitDecl(), D.getBeginLoc(), 14129 D.getIdentifierLoc(), II, parmDeclType, TInfo, SC); 14130 14131 if (D.isInvalidType()) 14132 New->setInvalidDecl(); 14133 14134 assert(S->isFunctionPrototypeScope()); 14135 assert(S->getFunctionPrototypeDepth() >= 1); 14136 New->setScopeInfo(S->getFunctionPrototypeDepth() - 1, 14137 S->getNextFunctionPrototypeIndex()); 14138 14139 // Add the parameter declaration into this scope. 14140 S->AddDecl(New); 14141 if (II) 14142 IdResolver.AddDecl(New); 14143 14144 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, New, D); 14145 14146 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) 14147 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_local) 14148 << 1 << New << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()) 14149 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 14150 14151 if (New->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 14152 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_block_on_nonlocal); 14153 } 14154 14155 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) 14156 deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(New); 14157 14158 return New; 14159 } 14160 14161 /// Synthesizes a variable for a parameter arising from a 14162 /// typedef. 14163 ParmVarDecl *Sema::BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(DeclContext *DC, 14164 SourceLocation Loc, 14165 QualType T) { 14166 /* FIXME: setting StartLoc == Loc. 14167 Would it be worth to modify callers so as to provide proper source 14168 location for the unnamed parameters, embedding the parameter's type? */ 14169 ParmVarDecl *Param = ParmVarDecl::Create(Context, DC, Loc, Loc, nullptr, 14170 T, Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T, Loc), 14171 SC_None, nullptr); 14172 Param->setImplicit(); 14173 return Param; 14174 } 14175 14176 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedParameters(ArrayRef<ParmVarDecl *> Parameters) { 14177 // Don't diagnose unused-parameter errors in template instantiations; we 14178 // will already have done so in the template itself. 14179 if (inTemplateInstantiation()) 14180 return; 14181 14182 for (const ParmVarDecl *Parameter : Parameters) { 14183 if (!Parameter->isReferenced() && Parameter->getDeclName() && 14184 !Parameter->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) { 14185 Diag(Parameter->getLocation(), diag::warn_unused_parameter) 14186 << Parameter->getDeclName(); 14187 } 14188 } 14189 } 14190 14191 void Sema::DiagnoseSizeOfParametersAndReturnValue( 14192 ArrayRef<ParmVarDecl *> Parameters, QualType ReturnTy, NamedDecl *D) { 14193 if (LangOpts.NumLargeByValueCopy == 0) // No check. 14194 return; 14195 14196 // Warn if the return value is pass-by-value and larger than the specified 14197 // threshold. 14198 if (!ReturnTy->isDependentType() && ReturnTy.isPODType(Context)) { 14199 unsigned Size = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(ReturnTy).getQuantity(); 14200 if (Size > LangOpts.NumLargeByValueCopy) 14201 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::warn_return_value_size) << D << Size; 14202 } 14203 14204 // Warn if any parameter is pass-by-value and larger than the specified 14205 // threshold. 14206 for (const ParmVarDecl *Parameter : Parameters) { 14207 QualType T = Parameter->getType(); 14208 if (T->isDependentType() || !T.isPODType(Context)) 14209 continue; 14210 unsigned Size = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(T).getQuantity(); 14211 if (Size > LangOpts.NumLargeByValueCopy) 14212 Diag(Parameter->getLocation(), diag::warn_parameter_size) 14213 << Parameter << Size; 14214 } 14215 } 14216 14217 ParmVarDecl *Sema::CheckParameter(DeclContext *DC, SourceLocation StartLoc, 14218 SourceLocation NameLoc, IdentifierInfo *Name, 14219 QualType T, TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo, 14220 StorageClass SC) { 14221 // In ARC, infer a lifetime qualifier for appropriate parameter types. 14222 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && 14223 T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None && 14224 T->isObjCLifetimeType()) { 14225 14226 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime; 14227 14228 // Special cases for arrays: 14229 // - if it's const, use __unsafe_unretained 14230 // - otherwise, it's an error 14231 if (T->isArrayType()) { 14232 if (!T.isConstQualified()) { 14233 if (DelayedDiagnostics.shouldDelayDiagnostics()) 14234 DelayedDiagnostics.add( 14235 sema::DelayedDiagnostic::makeForbiddenType( 14236 NameLoc, diag::err_arc_array_param_no_ownership, T, false)); 14237 else 14238 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_arc_array_param_no_ownership) 14239 << TSInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange(); 14240 } 14241 lifetime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone; 14242 } else { 14243 lifetime = T->getObjCARCImplicitLifetime(); 14244 } 14245 T = Context.getLifetimeQualifiedType(T, lifetime); 14246 } 14247 14248 ParmVarDecl *New = ParmVarDecl::Create(Context, DC, StartLoc, NameLoc, Name, 14249 Context.getAdjustedParameterType(T), 14250 TSInfo, SC, nullptr); 14251 14252 // Make a note if we created a new pack in the scope of a lambda, so that 14253 // we know that references to that pack must also be expanded within the 14254 // lambda scope. 14255 if (New->isParameterPack()) 14256 if (auto *LSI = getEnclosingLambda()) 14257 LSI->LocalPacks.push_back(New); 14258 14259 if (New->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() || 14260 New->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) 14261 checkNonTrivialCUnion(New->getType(), New->getLocation(), 14262 NTCUC_FunctionParam, NTCUK_Destruct|NTCUK_Copy); 14263 14264 // Parameters can not be abstract class types. 14265 // For record types, this is done by the AbstractClassUsageDiagnoser once 14266 // the class has been completely parsed. 14267 if (!CurContext->isRecord() && 14268 RequireNonAbstractType(NameLoc, T, diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 14269 AbstractParamType)) 14270 New->setInvalidDecl(); 14271 14272 // Parameter declarators cannot be interface types. All ObjC objects are 14273 // passed by reference. 14274 if (T->isObjCObjectType()) { 14275 SourceLocation TypeEndLoc = 14276 getLocForEndOfToken(TSInfo->getTypeLoc().getEndLoc()); 14277 Diag(NameLoc, 14278 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 1 << T 14279 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(TypeEndLoc, "*"); 14280 T = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(T); 14281 New->setType(T); 14282 } 14283 14284 // ISO/IEC TR 18037 S6.7.3: "The type of an object with automatic storage 14285 // duration shall not be qualified by an address-space qualifier." 14286 // Since all parameters have automatic store duration, they can not have 14287 // an address space. 14288 if (T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::Default && 14289 // OpenCL allows function arguments declared to be an array of a type 14290 // to be qualified with an address space. 14291 !(getLangOpts().OpenCL && 14292 (T->isArrayType() || T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_private))) { 14293 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_arg_with_address_space); 14294 New->setInvalidDecl(); 14295 } 14296 14297 // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as function argument types. 14298 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() && 14299 CheckPPCMMAType(New->getOriginalType(), New->getLocation())) { 14300 New->setInvalidDecl(); 14301 } 14302 14303 return New; 14304 } 14305 14306 void Sema::ActOnFinishKNRParamDeclarations(Scope *S, Declarator &D, 14307 SourceLocation LocAfterDecls) { 14308 DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = D.getFunctionTypeInfo(); 14309 14310 // C99 6.9.1p6 "If a declarator includes an identifier list, each declaration 14311 // in the declaration list shall have at least one declarator, those 14312 // declarators shall only declare identifiers from the identifier list, and 14313 // every identifier in the identifier list shall be declared. 14314 // 14315 // C89 3.7.1p5 "If a declarator includes an identifier list, only the 14316 // identifiers it names shall be declared in the declaration list." 14317 // 14318 // This is why we only diagnose in C99 and later. Note, the other conditions 14319 // listed are checked elsewhere. 14320 if (!FTI.hasPrototype) { 14321 for (int i = FTI.NumParams; i != 0; /* decrement in loop */) { 14322 --i; 14323 if (FTI.Params[i].Param == nullptr) { 14324 if (getLangOpts().C99) { 14325 SmallString<256> Code; 14326 llvm::raw_svector_ostream(Code) 14327 << " int " << FTI.Params[i].Ident->getName() << ";\n"; 14328 Diag(FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc, diag::ext_param_not_declared) 14329 << FTI.Params[i].Ident 14330 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LocAfterDecls, Code); 14331 } 14332 14333 // Implicitly declare the argument as type 'int' for lack of a better 14334 // type. 14335 AttributeFactory attrs; 14336 DeclSpec DS(attrs); 14337 const char* PrevSpec; // unused 14338 unsigned DiagID; // unused 14339 DS.SetTypeSpecType(DeclSpec::TST_int, FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc, PrevSpec, 14340 DiagID, Context.getPrintingPolicy()); 14341 // Use the identifier location for the type source range. 14342 DS.SetRangeStart(FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc); 14343 DS.SetRangeEnd(FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc); 14344 Declarator ParamD(DS, ParsedAttributesView::none(), 14345 DeclaratorContext::KNRTypeList); 14346 ParamD.SetIdentifier(FTI.Params[i].Ident, FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc); 14347 FTI.Params[i].Param = ActOnParamDeclarator(S, ParamD); 14348 } 14349 } 14350 } 14351 } 14352 14353 Decl * 14354 Sema::ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(Scope *FnBodyScope, Declarator &D, 14355 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParameterLists, 14356 SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody, FnBodyKind BodyKind) { 14357 assert(getCurFunctionDecl() == nullptr && "Function parsing confused"); 14358 assert(D.isFunctionDeclarator() && "Not a function declarator!"); 14359 Scope *ParentScope = FnBodyScope->getParent(); 14360 14361 // Check if we are in an `omp begin/end declare variant` scope. If we are, and 14362 // we define a non-templated function definition, we will create a declaration 14363 // instead (=BaseFD), and emit the definition with a mangled name afterwards. 14364 // The base function declaration will have the equivalent of an `omp declare 14365 // variant` annotation which specifies the mangled definition as a 14366 // specialization function under the OpenMP context defined as part of the 14367 // `omp begin declare variant`. 14368 SmallVector<FunctionDecl *, 4> Bases; 14369 if (LangOpts.OpenMP && isInOpenMPDeclareVariantScope()) 14370 ActOnStartOfFunctionDefinitionInOpenMPDeclareVariantScope( 14371 ParentScope, D, TemplateParameterLists, Bases); 14372 14373 D.setFunctionDefinitionKind(FunctionDefinitionKind::Definition); 14374 Decl *DP = HandleDeclarator(ParentScope, D, TemplateParameterLists); 14375 Decl *Dcl = ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(FnBodyScope, DP, SkipBody, BodyKind); 14376 14377 if (!Bases.empty()) 14378 ActOnFinishedFunctionDefinitionInOpenMPDeclareVariantScope(Dcl, Bases); 14379 14380 return Dcl; 14381 } 14382 14383 void Sema::ActOnFinishInlineFunctionDef(FunctionDecl *D) { 14384 Consumer.HandleInlineFunctionDefinition(D); 14385 } 14386 14387 static bool 14388 ShouldWarnAboutMissingPrototype(const FunctionDecl *FD, 14389 const FunctionDecl *&PossiblePrototype) { 14390 // Don't warn about invalid declarations. 14391 if (FD->isInvalidDecl()) 14392 return false; 14393 14394 // Or declarations that aren't global. 14395 if (!FD->isGlobal()) 14396 return false; 14397 14398 // Don't warn about C++ member functions. 14399 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) 14400 return false; 14401 14402 // Don't warn about 'main'. 14403 if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(FD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext())) 14404 if (IdentifierInfo *II = FD->getIdentifier()) 14405 if (II->isStr("main") || II->isStr("efi_main")) 14406 return false; 14407 14408 // Don't warn about inline functions. 14409 if (FD->isInlined()) 14410 return false; 14411 14412 // Don't warn about function templates. 14413 if (FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) 14414 return false; 14415 14416 // Don't warn about function template specializations. 14417 if (FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization()) 14418 return false; 14419 14420 // Don't warn for OpenCL kernels. 14421 if (FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) 14422 return false; 14423 14424 // Don't warn on explicitly deleted functions. 14425 if (FD->isDeleted()) 14426 return false; 14427 14428 // Don't warn on implicitly local functions (such as having local-typed 14429 // parameters). 14430 if (!FD->isExternallyVisible()) 14431 return false; 14432 14433 for (const FunctionDecl *Prev = FD->getPreviousDecl(); 14434 Prev; Prev = Prev->getPreviousDecl()) { 14435 // Ignore any declarations that occur in function or method 14436 // scope, because they aren't visible from the header. 14437 if (Prev->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()) 14438 continue; 14439 14440 PossiblePrototype = Prev; 14441 return Prev->getType()->isFunctionNoProtoType(); 14442 } 14443 14444 return true; 14445 } 14446 14447 void 14448 Sema::CheckForFunctionRedefinition(FunctionDecl *FD, 14449 const FunctionDecl *EffectiveDefinition, 14450 SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody) { 14451 const FunctionDecl *Definition = EffectiveDefinition; 14452 if (!Definition && 14453 !FD->isDefined(Definition, /*CheckForPendingFriendDefinition*/ true)) 14454 return; 14455 14456 if (Definition->getFriendObjectKind() != Decl::FOK_None) { 14457 if (FunctionDecl *OrigDef = Definition->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction()) { 14458 if (FunctionDecl *OrigFD = FD->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction()) { 14459 // A merged copy of the same function, instantiated as a member of 14460 // the same class, is OK. 14461 if (declaresSameEntity(OrigFD, OrigDef) && 14462 declaresSameEntity(cast<Decl>(Definition->getLexicalDeclContext()), 14463 cast<Decl>(FD->getLexicalDeclContext()))) 14464 return; 14465 } 14466 } 14467 } 14468 14469 if (canRedefineFunction(Definition, getLangOpts())) 14470 return; 14471 14472 // Don't emit an error when this is redefinition of a typo-corrected 14473 // definition. 14474 if (TypoCorrectedFunctionDefinitions.count(Definition)) 14475 return; 14476 14477 // If we don't have a visible definition of the function, and it's inline or 14478 // a template, skip the new definition. 14479 if (SkipBody && !hasVisibleDefinition(Definition) && 14480 (Definition->getFormalLinkage() == InternalLinkage || 14481 Definition->isInlined() || 14482 Definition->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() || 14483 Definition->getNumTemplateParameterLists())) { 14484 SkipBody->ShouldSkip = true; 14485 SkipBody->Previous = const_cast<FunctionDecl*>(Definition); 14486 if (auto *TD = Definition->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) 14487 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(TD); 14488 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(const_cast<FunctionDecl*>(Definition)); 14489 return; 14490 } 14491 14492 if (getLangOpts().GNUMode && Definition->isInlineSpecified() && 14493 Definition->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern) 14494 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_extern_inline) 14495 << FD << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 14496 else 14497 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) << FD; 14498 14499 Diag(Definition->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 14500 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14501 } 14502 14503 static void RebuildLambdaScopeInfo(CXXMethodDecl *CallOperator, 14504 Sema &S) { 14505 CXXRecordDecl *const LambdaClass = CallOperator->getParent(); 14506 14507 LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = S.PushLambdaScope(); 14508 LSI->CallOperator = CallOperator; 14509 LSI->Lambda = LambdaClass; 14510 LSI->ReturnType = CallOperator->getReturnType(); 14511 const LambdaCaptureDefault LCD = LambdaClass->getLambdaCaptureDefault(); 14512 14513 if (LCD == LCD_None) 14514 LSI->ImpCaptureStyle = CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_None; 14515 else if (LCD == LCD_ByCopy) 14516 LSI->ImpCaptureStyle = CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_LambdaByval; 14517 else if (LCD == LCD_ByRef) 14518 LSI->ImpCaptureStyle = CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_LambdaByref; 14519 DeclarationNameInfo DNI = CallOperator->getNameInfo(); 14520 14521 LSI->IntroducerRange = DNI.getCXXOperatorNameRange(); 14522 LSI->Mutable = !CallOperator->isConst(); 14523 14524 // Add the captures to the LSI so they can be noted as already 14525 // captured within tryCaptureVar. 14526 auto I = LambdaClass->field_begin(); 14527 for (const auto &C : LambdaClass->captures()) { 14528 if (C.capturesVariable()) { 14529 VarDecl *VD = C.getCapturedVar(); 14530 if (VD->isInitCapture()) 14531 S.CurrentInstantiationScope->InstantiatedLocal(VD, VD); 14532 const bool ByRef = C.getCaptureKind() == LCK_ByRef; 14533 LSI->addCapture(VD, /*IsBlock*/false, ByRef, 14534 /*RefersToEnclosingVariableOrCapture*/true, C.getLocation(), 14535 /*EllipsisLoc*/C.isPackExpansion() 14536 ? C.getEllipsisLoc() : SourceLocation(), 14537 I->getType(), /*Invalid*/false); 14538 14539 } else if (C.capturesThis()) { 14540 LSI->addThisCapture(/*Nested*/ false, C.getLocation(), I->getType(), 14541 C.getCaptureKind() == LCK_StarThis); 14542 } else { 14543 LSI->addVLATypeCapture(C.getLocation(), I->getCapturedVLAType(), 14544 I->getType()); 14545 } 14546 ++I; 14547 } 14548 } 14549 14550 Decl *Sema::ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(Scope *FnBodyScope, Decl *D, 14551 SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody, 14552 FnBodyKind BodyKind) { 14553 if (!D) { 14554 // Parsing the function declaration failed in some way. Push on a fake scope 14555 // anyway so we can try to parse the function body. 14556 PushFunctionScope(); 14557 PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExprEvalContexts.back().Context); 14558 return D; 14559 } 14560 14561 FunctionDecl *FD = nullptr; 14562 14563 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 14564 FD = FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(); 14565 else 14566 FD = cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 14567 14568 // Do not push if it is a lambda because one is already pushed when building 14569 // the lambda in ActOnStartOfLambdaDefinition(). 14570 if (!isLambdaCallOperator(FD)) 14571 PushExpressionEvaluationContext( 14572 FD->isConsteval() ? ExpressionEvaluationContext::ConstantEvaluated 14573 : ExprEvalContexts.back().Context); 14574 14575 // Check for defining attributes before the check for redefinition. 14576 if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<AliasAttr>()) { 14577 Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_alias_is_definition) << FD << 0; 14578 FD->dropAttr<AliasAttr>(); 14579 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14580 } 14581 if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<IFuncAttr>()) { 14582 Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_alias_is_definition) << FD << 1; 14583 FD->dropAttr<IFuncAttr>(); 14584 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14585 } 14586 14587 if (auto *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD)) { 14588 if (Ctor->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization && 14589 Ctor->isDefaultConstructor() && 14590 Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) { 14591 // If this is an MS ABI dllexport default constructor, instantiate any 14592 // default arguments. 14593 InstantiateDefaultCtorDefaultArgs(Ctor); 14594 } 14595 } 14596 14597 // See if this is a redefinition. If 'will have body' (or similar) is already 14598 // set, then these checks were already performed when it was set. 14599 if (!FD->willHaveBody() && !FD->isLateTemplateParsed() && 14600 !FD->isThisDeclarationInstantiatedFromAFriendDefinition()) { 14601 CheckForFunctionRedefinition(FD, nullptr, SkipBody); 14602 14603 // If we're skipping the body, we're done. Don't enter the scope. 14604 if (SkipBody && SkipBody->ShouldSkip) 14605 return D; 14606 } 14607 14608 // Mark this function as "will have a body eventually". This lets users to 14609 // call e.g. isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible while we're still parsing 14610 // this function. 14611 FD->setWillHaveBody(); 14612 14613 // If we are instantiating a generic lambda call operator, push 14614 // a LambdaScopeInfo onto the function stack. But use the information 14615 // that's already been calculated (ActOnLambdaExpr) to prime the current 14616 // LambdaScopeInfo. 14617 // When the template operator is being specialized, the LambdaScopeInfo, 14618 // has to be properly restored so that tryCaptureVariable doesn't try 14619 // and capture any new variables. In addition when calculating potential 14620 // captures during transformation of nested lambdas, it is necessary to 14621 // have the LSI properly restored. 14622 if (isGenericLambdaCallOperatorSpecialization(FD)) { 14623 assert(inTemplateInstantiation() && 14624 "There should be an active template instantiation on the stack " 14625 "when instantiating a generic lambda!"); 14626 RebuildLambdaScopeInfo(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D), *this); 14627 } else { 14628 // Enter a new function scope 14629 PushFunctionScope(); 14630 } 14631 14632 // Builtin functions cannot be defined. 14633 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FD->getBuiltinID()) { 14634 if (!Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID) && 14635 !Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedRuntimeFunction(BuiltinID)) { 14636 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_builtin_definition) << FD; 14637 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14638 } 14639 } 14640 14641 // The return type of a function definition must be complete (C99 6.9.1p3), 14642 // unless the function is deleted (C++ specifc, C++ [dcl.fct.def.general]p2) 14643 QualType ResultType = FD->getReturnType(); 14644 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() && !ResultType->isVoidType() && 14645 !FD->isInvalidDecl() && BodyKind != FnBodyKind::Delete && 14646 RequireCompleteType(FD->getLocation(), ResultType, 14647 diag::err_func_def_incomplete_result)) 14648 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14649 14650 if (FnBodyScope) 14651 PushDeclContext(FnBodyScope, FD); 14652 14653 // Check the validity of our function parameters 14654 if (BodyKind != FnBodyKind::Delete) 14655 CheckParmsForFunctionDef(FD->parameters(), 14656 /*CheckParameterNames=*/true); 14657 14658 // Add non-parameter declarations already in the function to the current 14659 // scope. 14660 if (FnBodyScope) { 14661 for (Decl *NPD : FD->decls()) { 14662 auto *NonParmDecl = dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(NPD); 14663 if (!NonParmDecl) 14664 continue; 14665 assert(!isa<ParmVarDecl>(NonParmDecl) && 14666 "parameters should not be in newly created FD yet"); 14667 14668 // If the decl has a name, make it accessible in the current scope. 14669 if (NonParmDecl->getDeclName()) 14670 PushOnScopeChains(NonParmDecl, FnBodyScope, /*AddToContext=*/false); 14671 14672 // Similarly, dive into enums and fish their constants out, making them 14673 // accessible in this scope. 14674 if (auto *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(NonParmDecl)) { 14675 for (auto *EI : ED->enumerators()) 14676 PushOnScopeChains(EI, FnBodyScope, /*AddToContext=*/false); 14677 } 14678 } 14679 } 14680 14681 // Introduce our parameters into the function scope 14682 for (auto Param : FD->parameters()) { 14683 Param->setOwningFunction(FD); 14684 14685 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack. 14686 if (Param->getIdentifier() && FnBodyScope) { 14687 CheckShadow(FnBodyScope, Param); 14688 14689 PushOnScopeChains(Param, FnBodyScope); 14690 } 14691 } 14692 14693 // Ensure that the function's exception specification is instantiated. 14694 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 14695 ResolveExceptionSpec(D->getLocation(), FPT); 14696 14697 // dllimport cannot be applied to non-inline function definitions. 14698 if (FD->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>() && !FD->isInlined() && 14699 !FD->isTemplateInstantiation()) { 14700 assert(!FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()); 14701 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dllimport_function_definition); 14702 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14703 return D; 14704 } 14705 // We want to attach documentation to original Decl (which might be 14706 // a function template). 14707 ActOnDocumentableDecl(D); 14708 if (getCurLexicalContext()->isObjCContainer() && 14709 getCurLexicalContext()->getDeclKind() != Decl::ObjCCategoryImpl && 14710 getCurLexicalContext()->getDeclKind() != Decl::ObjCImplementation) 14711 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_function_def_in_objc_container); 14712 14713 return D; 14714 } 14715 14716 /// Given the set of return statements within a function body, 14717 /// compute the variables that are subject to the named return value 14718 /// optimization. 14719 /// 14720 /// Each of the variables that is subject to the named return value 14721 /// optimization will be marked as NRVO variables in the AST, and any 14722 /// return statement that has a marked NRVO variable as its NRVO candidate can 14723 /// use the named return value optimization. 14724 /// 14725 /// This function applies a very simplistic algorithm for NRVO: if every return 14726 /// statement in the scope of a variable has the same NRVO candidate, that 14727 /// candidate is an NRVO variable. 14728 void Sema::computeNRVO(Stmt *Body, FunctionScopeInfo *Scope) { 14729 ReturnStmt **Returns = Scope->Returns.data(); 14730 14731 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Scope->Returns.size(); I != E; ++I) { 14732 if (const VarDecl *NRVOCandidate = Returns[I]->getNRVOCandidate()) { 14733 if (!NRVOCandidate->isNRVOVariable()) 14734 Returns[I]->setNRVOCandidate(nullptr); 14735 } 14736 } 14737 } 14738 14739 bool Sema::canDelayFunctionBody(const Declarator &D) { 14740 // We can't delay parsing the body of a constexpr function template (yet). 14741 if (D.getDeclSpec().hasConstexprSpecifier()) 14742 return false; 14743 14744 // We can't delay parsing the body of a function template with a deduced 14745 // return type (yet). 14746 if (D.getDeclSpec().hasAutoTypeSpec()) { 14747 // If the placeholder introduces a non-deduced trailing return type, 14748 // we can still delay parsing it. 14749 if (D.getNumTypeObjects()) { 14750 const auto &Outer = D.getTypeObject(D.getNumTypeObjects() - 1); 14751 if (Outer.Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Function && 14752 Outer.Fun.hasTrailingReturnType()) { 14753 QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Outer.Fun.getTrailingReturnType()); 14754 return Ty.isNull() || !Ty->isUndeducedType(); 14755 } 14756 } 14757 return false; 14758 } 14759 14760 return true; 14761 } 14762 14763 bool Sema::canSkipFunctionBody(Decl *D) { 14764 // We cannot skip the body of a function (or function template) which is 14765 // constexpr, since we may need to evaluate its body in order to parse the 14766 // rest of the file. 14767 // We cannot skip the body of a function with an undeduced return type, 14768 // because any callers of that function need to know the type. 14769 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = D->getAsFunction()) { 14770 if (FD->isConstexpr()) 14771 return false; 14772 // We can't simply call Type::isUndeducedType here, because inside template 14773 // auto can be deduced to a dependent type, which is not considered 14774 // "undeduced". 14775 if (FD->getReturnType()->getContainedDeducedType()) 14776 return false; 14777 } 14778 return Consumer.shouldSkipFunctionBody(D); 14779 } 14780 14781 Decl *Sema::ActOnSkippedFunctionBody(Decl *Decl) { 14782 if (!Decl) 14783 return nullptr; 14784 if (FunctionDecl *FD = Decl->getAsFunction()) 14785 FD->setHasSkippedBody(); 14786 else if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(Decl)) 14787 MD->setHasSkippedBody(); 14788 return Decl; 14789 } 14790 14791 Decl *Sema::ActOnFinishFunctionBody(Decl *D, Stmt *BodyArg) { 14792 return ActOnFinishFunctionBody(D, BodyArg, false); 14793 } 14794 14795 /// RAII object that pops an ExpressionEvaluationContext when exiting a function 14796 /// body. 14797 class ExitFunctionBodyRAII { 14798 public: 14799 ExitFunctionBodyRAII(Sema &S, bool IsLambda) : S(S), IsLambda(IsLambda) {} 14800 ~ExitFunctionBodyRAII() { 14801 if (!IsLambda) 14802 S.PopExpressionEvaluationContext(); 14803 } 14804 14805 private: 14806 Sema &S; 14807 bool IsLambda = false; 14808 }; 14809 14810 static void diagnoseImplicitlyRetainedSelf(Sema &S) { 14811 llvm::DenseMap<const BlockDecl *, bool> EscapeInfo; 14812 14813 auto IsOrNestedInEscapingBlock = [&](const BlockDecl *BD) { 14814 if (EscapeInfo.count(BD)) 14815 return EscapeInfo[BD]; 14816 14817 bool R = false; 14818 const BlockDecl *CurBD = BD; 14819 14820 do { 14821 R = !CurBD->doesNotEscape(); 14822 if (R) 14823 break; 14824 CurBD = CurBD->getParent()->getInnermostBlockDecl(); 14825 } while (CurBD); 14826 14827 return EscapeInfo[BD] = R; 14828 }; 14829 14830 // If the location where 'self' is implicitly retained is inside a escaping 14831 // block, emit a diagnostic. 14832 for (const std::pair<SourceLocation, const BlockDecl *> &P : 14833 S.ImplicitlyRetainedSelfLocs) 14834 if (IsOrNestedInEscapingBlock(P.second)) 14835 S.Diag(P.first, diag::warn_implicitly_retains_self) 14836 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(P.first, "self->"); 14837 } 14838 14839 Decl *Sema::ActOnFinishFunctionBody(Decl *dcl, Stmt *Body, 14840 bool IsInstantiation) { 14841 FunctionScopeInfo *FSI = getCurFunction(); 14842 FunctionDecl *FD = dcl ? dcl->getAsFunction() : nullptr; 14843 14844 if (FSI->UsesFPIntrin && FD && !FD->hasAttr<StrictFPAttr>()) 14845 FD->addAttr(StrictFPAttr::CreateImplicit(Context)); 14846 14847 sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy WP = AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy(); 14848 sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy *ActivePolicy = nullptr; 14849 14850 if (getLangOpts().Coroutines && FSI->isCoroutine()) 14851 CheckCompletedCoroutineBody(FD, Body); 14852 14853 { 14854 // Do not call PopExpressionEvaluationContext() if it is a lambda because 14855 // one is already popped when finishing the lambda in BuildLambdaExpr(). 14856 // This is meant to pop the context added in ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(). 14857 ExitFunctionBodyRAII ExitRAII(*this, isLambdaCallOperator(FD)); 14858 14859 if (FD) { 14860 FD->setBody(Body); 14861 FD->setWillHaveBody(false); 14862 14863 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) { 14864 if (!FD->isInvalidDecl() && Body && !FD->isDependentContext() && 14865 FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType()) { 14866 // For a function with a deduced result type to return void, 14867 // the result type as written must be 'auto' or 'decltype(auto)', 14868 // possibly cv-qualified or constrained, but not ref-qualified. 14869 if (!FD->getReturnType()->getAs<AutoType>()) { 14870 Diag(dcl->getLocation(), diag::err_auto_fn_no_return_but_not_auto) 14871 << FD->getReturnType(); 14872 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14873 } else { 14874 // Falling off the end of the function is the same as 'return;'. 14875 Expr *Dummy = nullptr; 14876 if (DeduceFunctionTypeFromReturnExpr( 14877 FD, dcl->getLocation(), Dummy, 14878 FD->getReturnType()->getAs<AutoType>())) 14879 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14880 } 14881 } 14882 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && isLambdaCallOperator(FD)) { 14883 // In C++11, we don't use 'auto' deduction rules for lambda call 14884 // operators because we don't support return type deduction. 14885 auto *LSI = getCurLambda(); 14886 if (LSI->HasImplicitReturnType) { 14887 deduceClosureReturnType(*LSI); 14888 14889 // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p4: 14890 // [...] if there are no return statements in the compound-statement 14891 // [the deduced type is] the type void 14892 QualType RetType = 14893 LSI->ReturnType.isNull() ? Context.VoidTy : LSI->ReturnType; 14894 14895 // Update the return type to the deduced type. 14896 const auto *Proto = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 14897 FD->setType(Context.getFunctionType(RetType, Proto->getParamTypes(), 14898 Proto->getExtProtoInfo())); 14899 } 14900 } 14901 14902 // If the function implicitly returns zero (like 'main') or is naked, 14903 // don't complain about missing return statements. 14904 if (FD->hasImplicitReturnZero() || FD->hasAttr<NakedAttr>()) 14905 WP.disableCheckFallThrough(); 14906 14907 // MSVC permits the use of pure specifier (=0) on function definition, 14908 // defined at class scope, warn about this non-standard construct. 14909 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && FD->isPure() && !FD->isOutOfLine()) 14910 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_pure_function_definition); 14911 14912 if (!FD->isInvalidDecl()) { 14913 // Don't diagnose unused parameters of defaulted, deleted or naked 14914 // functions. 14915 if (!FD->isDeleted() && !FD->isDefaulted() && !FD->hasSkippedBody() && 14916 !FD->hasAttr<NakedAttr>()) 14917 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(FD->parameters()); 14918 DiagnoseSizeOfParametersAndReturnValue(FD->parameters(), 14919 FD->getReturnType(), FD); 14920 14921 // If this is a structor, we need a vtable. 14922 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD)) 14923 MarkVTableUsed(FD->getLocation(), Constructor->getParent()); 14924 else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = 14925 dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(FD)) 14926 MarkVTableUsed(FD->getLocation(), Destructor->getParent()); 14927 14928 // Try to apply the named return value optimization. We have to check 14929 // if we can do this here because lambdas keep return statements around 14930 // to deduce an implicit return type. 14931 if (FD->getReturnType()->isRecordType() && 14932 (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !FD->isDependentContext())) 14933 computeNRVO(Body, FSI); 14934 } 14935 14936 // GNU warning -Wmissing-prototypes: 14937 // Warn if a global function is defined without a previous 14938 // prototype declaration. This warning is issued even if the 14939 // definition itself provides a prototype. The aim is to detect 14940 // global functions that fail to be declared in header files. 14941 const FunctionDecl *PossiblePrototype = nullptr; 14942 if (ShouldWarnAboutMissingPrototype(FD, PossiblePrototype)) { 14943 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_missing_prototype) << FD; 14944 14945 if (PossiblePrototype) { 14946 // We found a declaration that is not a prototype, 14947 // but that could be a zero-parameter prototype 14948 if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = PossiblePrototype->getTypeSourceInfo()) { 14949 TypeLoc TL = TI->getTypeLoc(); 14950 if (FunctionNoProtoTypeLoc FTL = TL.getAs<FunctionNoProtoTypeLoc>()) 14951 Diag(PossiblePrototype->getLocation(), 14952 diag::note_declaration_not_a_prototype) 14953 << (FD->getNumParams() != 0) 14954 << (FD->getNumParams() == 0 ? FixItHint::CreateInsertion( 14955 FTL.getRParenLoc(), "void") 14956 : FixItHint{}); 14957 } 14958 } else { 14959 // Returns true if the token beginning at this Loc is `const`. 14960 auto isLocAtConst = [&](SourceLocation Loc, const SourceManager &SM, 14961 const LangOptions &LangOpts) { 14962 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> LocInfo = SM.getDecomposedLoc(Loc); 14963 if (LocInfo.first.isInvalid()) 14964 return false; 14965 14966 bool Invalid = false; 14967 StringRef Buffer = SM.getBufferData(LocInfo.first, &Invalid); 14968 if (Invalid) 14969 return false; 14970 14971 if (LocInfo.second > Buffer.size()) 14972 return false; 14973 14974 const char *LexStart = Buffer.data() + LocInfo.second; 14975 StringRef StartTok(LexStart, Buffer.size() - LocInfo.second); 14976 14977 return StartTok.consume_front("const") && 14978 (StartTok.empty() || isWhitespace(StartTok[0]) || 14979 StartTok.startswith("/*") || StartTok.startswith("//")); 14980 }; 14981 14982 auto findBeginLoc = [&]() { 14983 // If the return type has `const` qualifier, we want to insert 14984 // `static` before `const` (and not before the typename). 14985 if ((FD->getReturnType()->isAnyPointerType() && 14986 FD->getReturnType()->getPointeeType().isConstQualified()) || 14987 FD->getReturnType().isConstQualified()) { 14988 // But only do this if we can determine where the `const` is. 14989 14990 if (isLocAtConst(FD->getBeginLoc(), getSourceManager(), 14991 getLangOpts())) 14992 14993 return FD->getBeginLoc(); 14994 } 14995 return FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(); 14996 }; 14997 Diag(FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), 14998 diag::note_static_for_internal_linkage) 14999 << /* function */ 1 15000 << (FD->getStorageClass() == SC_None 15001 ? FixItHint::CreateInsertion(findBeginLoc(), "static ") 15002 : FixItHint{}); 15003 } 15004 } 15005 15006 // If the function being defined does not have a prototype, then we may 15007 // need to diagnose it as changing behavior in C2x because we now know 15008 // whether the function accepts arguments or not. This only handles the 15009 // case where the definition has no prototype but does have parameters 15010 // and either there is no previous potential prototype, or the previous 15011 // potential prototype also has no actual prototype. This handles cases 15012 // like: 15013 // void f(); void f(a) int a; {} 15014 // void g(a) int a; {} 15015 // See MergeFunctionDecl() for other cases of the behavior change 15016 // diagnostic. See GetFullTypeForDeclarator() for handling of a function 15017 // type without a prototype. 15018 if (!FD->hasWrittenPrototype() && FD->getNumParams() != 0 && 15019 (!PossiblePrototype || (!PossiblePrototype->hasWrittenPrototype() && 15020 !PossiblePrototype->isImplicit()))) { 15021 // The function definition has parameters, so this will change behavior 15022 // in C2x. If there is a possible prototype, it comes before the 15023 // function definition. 15024 // FIXME: The declaration may have already been diagnosed as being 15025 // deprecated in GetFullTypeForDeclarator() if it had no arguments, but 15026 // there's no way to test for the "changes behavior" condition in 15027 // SemaType.cpp when forming the declaration's function type. So, we do 15028 // this awkward dance instead. 15029 // 15030 // If we have a possible prototype and it declares a function with a 15031 // prototype, we don't want to diagnose it; if we have a possible 15032 // prototype and it has no prototype, it may have already been 15033 // diagnosed in SemaType.cpp as deprecated depending on whether 15034 // -Wstrict-prototypes is enabled. If we already warned about it being 15035 // deprecated, add a note that it also changes behavior. If we didn't 15036 // warn about it being deprecated (because the diagnostic is not 15037 // enabled), warn now that it is deprecated and changes behavior. 15038 15039 // This K&R C function definition definitely changes behavior in C2x, 15040 // so diagnose it. 15041 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_non_prototype_changes_behavior) 15042 << /*definition*/ 1 << /* not supported in C2x */ 0; 15043 15044 // If we have a possible prototype for the function which is a user- 15045 // visible declaration, we already tested that it has no prototype. 15046 // This will change behavior in C2x. This gets a warning rather than a 15047 // note because it's the same behavior-changing problem as with the 15048 // definition. 15049 if (PossiblePrototype) 15050 Diag(PossiblePrototype->getLocation(), 15051 diag::warn_non_prototype_changes_behavior) 15052 << /*declaration*/ 0 << /* conflicting */ 1 << /*subsequent*/ 1 15053 << /*definition*/ 1; 15054 } 15055 15056 // Warn on CPUDispatch with an actual body. 15057 if (FD->isMultiVersion() && FD->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>() && Body) 15058 if (const auto *CmpndBody = dyn_cast<CompoundStmt>(Body)) 15059 if (!CmpndBody->body_empty()) 15060 Diag(CmpndBody->body_front()->getBeginLoc(), 15061 diag::warn_dispatch_body_ignored); 15062 15063 if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) { 15064 const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunction; 15065 if (MD->isOutOfLine() && (MD = MD->getCanonicalDecl()) && 15066 MD->isVirtual() && 15067 (KeyFunction = Context.getCurrentKeyFunction(MD->getParent())) && 15068 MD == KeyFunction->getCanonicalDecl()) { 15069 // Update the key-function state if necessary for this ABI. 15070 if (FD->isInlined() && 15071 !Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) { 15072 Context.setNonKeyFunction(MD); 15073 15074 // If the newly-chosen key function is already defined, then we 15075 // need to mark the vtable as used retroactively. 15076 KeyFunction = Context.getCurrentKeyFunction(MD->getParent()); 15077 const FunctionDecl *Definition; 15078 if (KeyFunction && KeyFunction->isDefined(Definition)) 15079 MarkVTableUsed(Definition->getLocation(), MD->getParent(), true); 15080 } else { 15081 // We just defined they key function; mark the vtable as used. 15082 MarkVTableUsed(FD->getLocation(), MD->getParent(), true); 15083 } 15084 } 15085 } 15086 15087 assert( 15088 (FD == getCurFunctionDecl() || getCurLambda()->CallOperator == FD) && 15089 "Function parsing confused"); 15090 } else if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCMethodDecl>(dcl)) { 15091 assert(MD == getCurMethodDecl() && "Method parsing confused"); 15092 MD->setBody(Body); 15093 if (!MD->isInvalidDecl()) { 15094 DiagnoseSizeOfParametersAndReturnValue(MD->parameters(), 15095 MD->getReturnType(), MD); 15096 15097 if (Body) 15098 computeNRVO(Body, FSI); 15099 } 15100 if (FSI->ObjCShouldCallSuper) { 15101 Diag(MD->getEndLoc(), diag::warn_objc_missing_super_call) 15102 << MD->getSelector().getAsString(); 15103 FSI->ObjCShouldCallSuper = false; 15104 } 15105 if (FSI->ObjCWarnForNoDesignatedInitChain) { 15106 const ObjCMethodDecl *InitMethod = nullptr; 15107 bool isDesignated = 15108 MD->isDesignatedInitializerForTheInterface(&InitMethod); 15109 assert(isDesignated && InitMethod); 15110 (void)isDesignated; 15111 15112 auto superIsNSObject = [&](const ObjCMethodDecl *MD) { 15113 auto IFace = MD->getClassInterface(); 15114 if (!IFace) 15115 return false; 15116 auto SuperD = IFace->getSuperClass(); 15117 if (!SuperD) 15118 return false; 15119 return SuperD->getIdentifier() == 15120 NSAPIObj->getNSClassId(NSAPI::ClassId_NSObject); 15121 }; 15122 // Don't issue this warning for unavailable inits or direct subclasses 15123 // of NSObject. 15124 if (!MD->isUnavailable() && !superIsNSObject(MD)) { 15125 Diag(MD->getLocation(), 15126 diag::warn_objc_designated_init_missing_super_call); 15127 Diag(InitMethod->getLocation(), 15128 diag::note_objc_designated_init_marked_here); 15129 } 15130 FSI->ObjCWarnForNoDesignatedInitChain = false; 15131 } 15132 if (FSI->ObjCWarnForNoInitDelegation) { 15133 // Don't issue this warning for unavaialable inits. 15134 if (!MD->isUnavailable()) 15135 Diag(MD->getLocation(), 15136 diag::warn_objc_secondary_init_missing_init_call); 15137 FSI->ObjCWarnForNoInitDelegation = false; 15138 } 15139 15140 diagnoseImplicitlyRetainedSelf(*this); 15141 } else { 15142 // Parsing the function declaration failed in some way. Pop the fake scope 15143 // we pushed on. 15144 PopFunctionScopeInfo(ActivePolicy, dcl); 15145 return nullptr; 15146 } 15147 15148 if (Body && FSI->HasPotentialAvailabilityViolations) 15149 DiagnoseUnguardedAvailabilityViolations(dcl); 15150 15151 assert(!FSI->ObjCShouldCallSuper && 15152 "This should only be set for ObjC methods, which should have been " 15153 "handled in the block above."); 15154 15155 // Verify and clean out per-function state. 15156 if (Body && (!FD || !FD->isDefaulted())) { 15157 // C++ constructors that have function-try-blocks can't have return 15158 // statements in the handlers of that block. (C++ [except.handle]p14) 15159 // Verify this. 15160 if (FD && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD) && isa<CXXTryStmt>(Body)) 15161 DiagnoseReturnInConstructorExceptionHandler(cast<CXXTryStmt>(Body)); 15162 15163 // Verify that gotos and switch cases don't jump into scopes illegally. 15164 if (FSI->NeedsScopeChecking() && !PP.isCodeCompletionEnabled()) 15165 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(Body); 15166 15167 if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(dcl)) { 15168 if (!Destructor->getParent()->isDependentType()) 15169 CheckDestructor(Destructor); 15170 15171 MarkBaseAndMemberDestructorsReferenced(Destructor->getLocation(), 15172 Destructor->getParent()); 15173 } 15174 15175 // If any errors have occurred, clear out any temporaries that may have 15176 // been leftover. This ensures that these temporaries won't be picked up 15177 // for deletion in some later function. 15178 if (hasUncompilableErrorOccurred() || 15179 getDiagnostics().getSuppressAllDiagnostics()) { 15180 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 15181 } 15182 if (!hasUncompilableErrorOccurred() && !isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) { 15183 // Since the body is valid, issue any analysis-based warnings that are 15184 // enabled. 15185 ActivePolicy = &WP; 15186 } 15187 15188 if (!IsInstantiation && FD && FD->isConstexpr() && !FD->isInvalidDecl() && 15189 !CheckConstexprFunctionDefinition(FD, CheckConstexprKind::Diagnose)) 15190 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 15191 15192 if (FD && FD->hasAttr<NakedAttr>()) { 15193 for (const Stmt *S : Body->children()) { 15194 // Allow local register variables without initializer as they don't 15195 // require prologue. 15196 bool RegisterVariables = false; 15197 if (auto *DS = dyn_cast<DeclStmt>(S)) { 15198 for (const auto *Decl : DS->decls()) { 15199 if (const auto *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Decl)) { 15200 RegisterVariables = 15201 Var->hasAttr<AsmLabelAttr>() && !Var->hasInit(); 15202 if (!RegisterVariables) 15203 break; 15204 } 15205 } 15206 } 15207 if (RegisterVariables) 15208 continue; 15209 if (!isa<AsmStmt>(S) && !isa<NullStmt>(S)) { 15210 Diag(S->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_non_asm_stmt_in_naked_function); 15211 Diag(FD->getAttr<NakedAttr>()->getLocation(), diag::note_attribute); 15212 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 15213 break; 15214 } 15215 } 15216 } 15217 15218 assert(ExprCleanupObjects.size() == 15219 ExprEvalContexts.back().NumCleanupObjects && 15220 "Leftover temporaries in function"); 15221 assert(!Cleanup.exprNeedsCleanups() && 15222 "Unaccounted cleanups in function"); 15223 assert(MaybeODRUseExprs.empty() && 15224 "Leftover expressions for odr-use checking"); 15225 } 15226 } // Pops the ExitFunctionBodyRAII scope, which needs to happen before we pop 15227 // the declaration context below. Otherwise, we're unable to transform 15228 // 'this' expressions when transforming immediate context functions. 15229 15230 if (!IsInstantiation) 15231 PopDeclContext(); 15232 15233 PopFunctionScopeInfo(ActivePolicy, dcl); 15234 // If any errors have occurred, clear out any temporaries that may have 15235 // been leftover. This ensures that these temporaries won't be picked up for 15236 // deletion in some later function. 15237 if (hasUncompilableErrorOccurred()) { 15238 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 15239 } 15240 15241 if (FD && ((LangOpts.OpenMP && (LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice || 15242 !LangOpts.OMPTargetTriples.empty())) || 15243 LangOpts.CUDA || LangOpts.SYCLIsDevice)) { 15244 auto ES = getEmissionStatus(FD); 15245 if (ES == Sema::FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted || 15246 ES == Sema::FunctionEmissionStatus::Unknown) 15247 DeclsToCheckForDeferredDiags.insert(FD); 15248 } 15249 15250 if (FD && !FD->isDeleted()) 15251 checkTypeSupport(FD->getType(), FD->getLocation(), FD); 15252 15253 return dcl; 15254 } 15255 15256 /// When we finish delayed parsing of an attribute, we must attach it to the 15257 /// relevant Decl. 15258 void Sema::ActOnFinishDelayedAttribute(Scope *S, Decl *D, 15259 ParsedAttributes &Attrs) { 15260 // Always attach attributes to the underlying decl. 15261 if (TemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) 15262 D = TD->getTemplatedDecl(); 15263 ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, D, Attrs); 15264 15265 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) 15266 if (Method->isStatic()) 15267 checkThisInStaticMemberFunctionAttributes(Method); 15268 } 15269 15270 /// ImplicitlyDefineFunction - An undeclared identifier was used in a function 15271 /// call, forming a call to an implicitly defined function (per C99 6.5.1p2). 15272 NamedDecl *Sema::ImplicitlyDefineFunction(SourceLocation Loc, 15273 IdentifierInfo &II, Scope *S) { 15274 // It is not valid to implicitly define a function in C2x. 15275 assert(LangOpts.implicitFunctionsAllowed() && 15276 "Implicit function declarations aren't allowed in this language mode"); 15277 15278 // Find the scope in which the identifier is injected and the corresponding 15279 // DeclContext. 15280 // FIXME: C89 does not say what happens if there is no enclosing block scope. 15281 // In that case, we inject the declaration into the translation unit scope 15282 // instead. 15283 Scope *BlockScope = S; 15284 while (!BlockScope->isCompoundStmtScope() && BlockScope->getParent()) 15285 BlockScope = BlockScope->getParent(); 15286 15287 Scope *ContextScope = BlockScope; 15288 while (!ContextScope->getEntity()) 15289 ContextScope = ContextScope->getParent(); 15290 ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, ContextScope->getEntity()); 15291 15292 // Before we produce a declaration for an implicitly defined 15293 // function, see whether there was a locally-scoped declaration of 15294 // this name as a function or variable. If so, use that 15295 // (non-visible) declaration, and complain about it. 15296 NamedDecl *ExternCPrev = findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(&II); 15297 if (ExternCPrev) { 15298 // We still need to inject the function into the enclosing block scope so 15299 // that later (non-call) uses can see it. 15300 PushOnScopeChains(ExternCPrev, BlockScope, /*AddToContext*/false); 15301 15302 // C89 footnote 38: 15303 // If in fact it is not defined as having type "function returning int", 15304 // the behavior is undefined. 15305 if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(ExternCPrev) || 15306 !Context.typesAreCompatible( 15307 cast<FunctionDecl>(ExternCPrev)->getType(), 15308 Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Context.IntTy))) { 15309 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_use_out_of_scope_declaration) 15310 << ExternCPrev << !getLangOpts().C99; 15311 Diag(ExternCPrev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 15312 return ExternCPrev; 15313 } 15314 } 15315 15316 // Extension in C99 (defaults to error). Legal in C89, but warn about it. 15317 unsigned diag_id; 15318 if (II.getName().startswith("__builtin_")) 15319 diag_id = diag::warn_builtin_unknown; 15320 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.9.u - Implicit function declaration is not supported. 15321 else if (getLangOpts().C99) 15322 diag_id = diag::ext_implicit_function_decl_c99; 15323 else 15324 diag_id = diag::warn_implicit_function_decl; 15325 15326 TypoCorrection Corrected; 15327 // Because typo correction is expensive, only do it if the implicit 15328 // function declaration is going to be treated as an error. 15329 // 15330 // Perform the corection before issuing the main diagnostic, as some consumers 15331 // use typo-correction callbacks to enhance the main diagnostic. 15332 if (S && !ExternCPrev && 15333 (Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag_id, Loc) >= DiagnosticsEngine::Error)) { 15334 DeclFilterCCC<FunctionDecl> CCC{}; 15335 Corrected = CorrectTypo(DeclarationNameInfo(&II, Loc), LookupOrdinaryName, 15336 S, nullptr, CCC, CTK_NonError); 15337 } 15338 15339 Diag(Loc, diag_id) << &II; 15340 if (Corrected) { 15341 // If the correction is going to suggest an implicitly defined function, 15342 // skip the correction as not being a particularly good idea. 15343 bool Diagnose = true; 15344 if (const auto *D = Corrected.getCorrectionDecl()) 15345 Diagnose = !D->isImplicit(); 15346 if (Diagnose) 15347 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(diag::note_function_suggestion), 15348 /*ErrorRecovery*/ false); 15349 } 15350 15351 // If we found a prior declaration of this function, don't bother building 15352 // another one. We've already pushed that one into scope, so there's nothing 15353 // more to do. 15354 if (ExternCPrev) 15355 return ExternCPrev; 15356 15357 // Set a Declarator for the implicit definition: int foo(); 15358 const char *Dummy; 15359 AttributeFactory attrFactory; 15360 DeclSpec DS(attrFactory); 15361 unsigned DiagID; 15362 bool Error = DS.SetTypeSpecType(DeclSpec::TST_int, Loc, Dummy, DiagID, 15363 Context.getPrintingPolicy()); 15364 (void)Error; // Silence warning. 15365 assert(!Error && "Error setting up implicit decl!"); 15366 SourceLocation NoLoc; 15367 Declarator D(DS, ParsedAttributesView::none(), DeclaratorContext::Block); 15368 D.AddTypeInfo(DeclaratorChunk::getFunction(/*HasProto=*/false, 15369 /*IsAmbiguous=*/false, 15370 /*LParenLoc=*/NoLoc, 15371 /*Params=*/nullptr, 15372 /*NumParams=*/0, 15373 /*EllipsisLoc=*/NoLoc, 15374 /*RParenLoc=*/NoLoc, 15375 /*RefQualifierIsLvalueRef=*/true, 15376 /*RefQualifierLoc=*/NoLoc, 15377 /*MutableLoc=*/NoLoc, EST_None, 15378 /*ESpecRange=*/SourceRange(), 15379 /*Exceptions=*/nullptr, 15380 /*ExceptionRanges=*/nullptr, 15381 /*NumExceptions=*/0, 15382 /*NoexceptExpr=*/nullptr, 15383 /*ExceptionSpecTokens=*/nullptr, 15384 /*DeclsInPrototype=*/None, Loc, 15385 Loc, D), 15386 std::move(DS.getAttributes()), SourceLocation()); 15387 D.SetIdentifier(&II, Loc); 15388 15389 // Insert this function into the enclosing block scope. 15390 FunctionDecl *FD = cast<FunctionDecl>(ActOnDeclarator(BlockScope, D)); 15391 FD->setImplicit(); 15392 15393 AddKnownFunctionAttributes(FD); 15394 15395 return FD; 15396 } 15397 15398 /// If this function is a C++ replaceable global allocation function 15399 /// (C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation], C++2a [new.delete]), 15400 /// adds any function attributes that we know a priori based on the standard. 15401 /// 15402 /// We need to check for duplicate attributes both here and where user-written 15403 /// attributes are applied to declarations. 15404 void Sema::AddKnownFunctionAttributesForReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction( 15405 FunctionDecl *FD) { 15406 if (FD->isInvalidDecl()) 15407 return; 15408 15409 if (FD->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator() != OO_New && 15410 FD->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator() != OO_Array_New) 15411 return; 15412 15413 Optional<unsigned> AlignmentParam; 15414 bool IsNothrow = false; 15415 if (!FD->isReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction(&AlignmentParam, &IsNothrow)) 15416 return; 15417 15418 // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p4: 15419 // An allocation function that has a non-throwing exception specification 15420 // indicates failure by returning a null pointer value. Any other allocation 15421 // function never returns a null pointer value and indicates failure only by 15422 // throwing an exception [...] 15423 if (!IsNothrow && !FD->hasAttr<ReturnsNonNullAttr>()) 15424 FD->addAttr(ReturnsNonNullAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15425 15426 // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p2: 15427 // An allocation function attempts to allocate the requested amount of 15428 // storage. [...] If the request succeeds, the value returned by a 15429 // replaceable allocation function is a [...] pointer value p0 different 15430 // from any previously returned value p1 [...] 15431 // 15432 // However, this particular information is being added in codegen, 15433 // because there is an opt-out switch for it (-fno-assume-sane-operator-new) 15434 15435 // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p2: 15436 // An allocation function attempts to allocate the requested amount of 15437 // storage. If it is successful, it returns the address of the start of a 15438 // block of storage whose length in bytes is at least as large as the 15439 // requested size. 15440 if (!FD->hasAttr<AllocSizeAttr>()) { 15441 FD->addAttr(AllocSizeAttr::CreateImplicit( 15442 Context, /*ElemSizeParam=*/ParamIdx(1, FD), 15443 /*NumElemsParam=*/ParamIdx(), FD->getLocation())); 15444 } 15445 15446 // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p3: 15447 // For an allocation function [...], the pointer returned on a successful 15448 // call shall represent the address of storage that is aligned as follows: 15449 // (3.1) If the allocation function takes an argument of type 15450 // std::align_val_t, the storage will have the alignment 15451 // specified by the value of this argument. 15452 if (AlignmentParam && !FD->hasAttr<AllocAlignAttr>()) { 15453 FD->addAttr(AllocAlignAttr::CreateImplicit( 15454 Context, ParamIdx(AlignmentParam.getValue(), FD), FD->getLocation())); 15455 } 15456 15457 // FIXME: 15458 // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p3: 15459 // For an allocation function [...], the pointer returned on a successful 15460 // call shall represent the address of storage that is aligned as follows: 15461 // (3.2) Otherwise, if the allocation function is named operator new[], 15462 // the storage is aligned for any object that does not have 15463 // new-extended alignment ([basic.align]) and is no larger than the 15464 // requested size. 15465 // (3.3) Otherwise, the storage is aligned for any object that does not 15466 // have new-extended alignment and is of the requested size. 15467 } 15468 15469 /// Adds any function attributes that we know a priori based on 15470 /// the declaration of this function. 15471 /// 15472 /// These attributes can apply both to implicitly-declared builtins 15473 /// (like __builtin___printf_chk) or to library-declared functions 15474 /// like NSLog or printf. 15475 /// 15476 /// We need to check for duplicate attributes both here and where user-written 15477 /// attributes are applied to declarations. 15478 void Sema::AddKnownFunctionAttributes(FunctionDecl *FD) { 15479 if (FD->isInvalidDecl()) 15480 return; 15481 15482 // If this is a built-in function, map its builtin attributes to 15483 // actual attributes. 15484 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FD->getBuiltinID()) { 15485 // Handle printf-formatting attributes. 15486 unsigned FormatIdx; 15487 bool HasVAListArg; 15488 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPrintfLike(BuiltinID, FormatIdx, HasVAListArg)) { 15489 if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatAttr>()) { 15490 const char *fmt = "printf"; 15491 unsigned int NumParams = FD->getNumParams(); 15492 if (FormatIdx < NumParams && // NumParams may be 0 (e.g. vfprintf) 15493 FD->getParamDecl(FormatIdx)->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 15494 fmt = "NSString"; 15495 FD->addAttr(FormatAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, 15496 &Context.Idents.get(fmt), 15497 FormatIdx+1, 15498 HasVAListArg ? 0 : FormatIdx+2, 15499 FD->getLocation())); 15500 } 15501 } 15502 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isScanfLike(BuiltinID, FormatIdx, 15503 HasVAListArg)) { 15504 if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatAttr>()) 15505 FD->addAttr(FormatAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, 15506 &Context.Idents.get("scanf"), 15507 FormatIdx+1, 15508 HasVAListArg ? 0 : FormatIdx+2, 15509 FD->getLocation())); 15510 } 15511 15512 // Handle automatically recognized callbacks. 15513 SmallVector<int, 4> Encoding; 15514 if (!FD->hasAttr<CallbackAttr>() && 15515 Context.BuiltinInfo.performsCallback(BuiltinID, Encoding)) 15516 FD->addAttr(CallbackAttr::CreateImplicit( 15517 Context, Encoding.data(), Encoding.size(), FD->getLocation())); 15518 15519 // Mark const if we don't care about errno and that is the only thing 15520 // preventing the function from being const. This allows IRgen to use LLVM 15521 // intrinsics for such functions. 15522 if (!getLangOpts().MathErrno && !FD->hasAttr<ConstAttr>() && 15523 Context.BuiltinInfo.isConstWithoutErrno(BuiltinID)) 15524 FD->addAttr(ConstAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15525 15526 // We make "fma" on GNU or Windows const because we know it does not set 15527 // errno in those environments even though it could set errno based on the 15528 // C standard. 15529 const llvm::Triple &Trip = Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple(); 15530 if ((Trip.isGNUEnvironment() || Trip.isOSMSVCRT()) && 15531 !FD->hasAttr<ConstAttr>()) { 15532 switch (BuiltinID) { 15533 case Builtin::BI__builtin_fma: 15534 case Builtin::BI__builtin_fmaf: 15535 case Builtin::BI__builtin_fmal: 15536 case Builtin::BIfma: 15537 case Builtin::BIfmaf: 15538 case Builtin::BIfmal: 15539 FD->addAttr(ConstAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15540 break; 15541 default: 15542 break; 15543 } 15544 } 15545 15546 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isReturnsTwice(BuiltinID) && 15547 !FD->hasAttr<ReturnsTwiceAttr>()) 15548 FD->addAttr(ReturnsTwiceAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, 15549 FD->getLocation())); 15550 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isNoThrow(BuiltinID) && !FD->hasAttr<NoThrowAttr>()) 15551 FD->addAttr(NoThrowAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15552 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPure(BuiltinID) && !FD->hasAttr<PureAttr>()) 15553 FD->addAttr(PureAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15554 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isConst(BuiltinID) && !FD->hasAttr<ConstAttr>()) 15555 FD->addAttr(ConstAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15556 if (getLangOpts().CUDA && Context.BuiltinInfo.isTSBuiltin(BuiltinID) && 15557 !FD->hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>() && !FD->hasAttr<CUDAHostAttr>()) { 15558 // Add the appropriate attribute, depending on the CUDA compilation mode 15559 // and which target the builtin belongs to. For example, during host 15560 // compilation, aux builtins are __device__, while the rest are __host__. 15561 if (getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice != 15562 Context.BuiltinInfo.isAuxBuiltinID(BuiltinID)) 15563 FD->addAttr(CUDADeviceAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15564 else 15565 FD->addAttr(CUDAHostAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15566 } 15567 15568 // Add known guaranteed alignment for allocation functions. 15569 switch (BuiltinID) { 15570 case Builtin::BImemalign: 15571 case Builtin::BIaligned_alloc: 15572 if (!FD->hasAttr<AllocAlignAttr>()) 15573 FD->addAttr(AllocAlignAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ParamIdx(1, FD), 15574 FD->getLocation())); 15575 break; 15576 default: 15577 break; 15578 } 15579 15580 // Add allocsize attribute for allocation functions. 15581 switch (BuiltinID) { 15582 case Builtin::BIcalloc: 15583 FD->addAttr(AllocSizeAttr::CreateImplicit( 15584 Context, ParamIdx(1, FD), ParamIdx(2, FD), FD->getLocation())); 15585 break; 15586 case Builtin::BImemalign: 15587 case Builtin::BIaligned_alloc: 15588 case Builtin::BIrealloc: 15589 FD->addAttr(AllocSizeAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ParamIdx(2, FD), 15590 ParamIdx(), FD->getLocation())); 15591 break; 15592 case Builtin::BImalloc: 15593 FD->addAttr(AllocSizeAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ParamIdx(1, FD), 15594 ParamIdx(), FD->getLocation())); 15595 break; 15596 default: 15597 break; 15598 } 15599 } 15600 15601 AddKnownFunctionAttributesForReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction(FD); 15602 15603 // If C++ exceptions are enabled but we are told extern "C" functions cannot 15604 // throw, add an implicit nothrow attribute to any extern "C" function we come 15605 // across. 15606 if (getLangOpts().CXXExceptions && getLangOpts().ExternCNoUnwind && 15607 FD->isExternC() && !FD->hasAttr<NoThrowAttr>()) { 15608 const auto *FPT = FD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 15609 if (!FPT || FPT->getExceptionSpecType() == EST_None) 15610 FD->addAttr(NoThrowAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15611 } 15612 15613 IdentifierInfo *Name = FD->getIdentifier(); 15614 if (!Name) 15615 return; 15616 if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 15617 FD->getDeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) || 15618 (isa<LinkageSpecDecl>(FD->getDeclContext()) && 15619 cast<LinkageSpecDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getLanguage() == 15620 LinkageSpecDecl::lang_c)) { 15621 // Okay: this could be a libc/libm/Objective-C function we know 15622 // about. 15623 } else 15624 return; 15625 15626 if (Name->isStr("asprintf") || Name->isStr("vasprintf")) { 15627 // FIXME: asprintf and vasprintf aren't C99 functions. Should they be 15628 // target-specific builtins, perhaps? 15629 if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatAttr>()) 15630 FD->addAttr(FormatAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, 15631 &Context.Idents.get("printf"), 2, 15632 Name->isStr("vasprintf") ? 0 : 3, 15633 FD->getLocation())); 15634 } 15635 15636 if (Name->isStr("__CFStringMakeConstantString")) { 15637 // We already have a __builtin___CFStringMakeConstantString, 15638 // but builds that use -fno-constant-cfstrings don't go through that. 15639 if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatArgAttr>()) 15640 FD->addAttr(FormatArgAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ParamIdx(1, FD), 15641 FD->getLocation())); 15642 } 15643 } 15644 15645 TypedefDecl *Sema::ParseTypedefDecl(Scope *S, Declarator &D, QualType T, 15646 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) { 15647 assert(D.getIdentifier() && "Wrong callback for declspec without declarator"); 15648 assert(!T.isNull() && "GetTypeForDeclarator() returned null type"); 15649 15650 if (!TInfo) { 15651 assert(D.isInvalidType() && "no declarator info for valid type"); 15652 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T); 15653 } 15654 15655 // Scope manipulation handled by caller. 15656 TypedefDecl *NewTD = 15657 TypedefDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, D.getBeginLoc(), 15658 D.getIdentifierLoc(), D.getIdentifier(), TInfo); 15659 15660 // Bail out immediately if we have an invalid declaration. 15661 if (D.isInvalidType()) { 15662 NewTD->setInvalidDecl(); 15663 return NewTD; 15664 } 15665 15666 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) { 15667 if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) 15668 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_local) 15669 << 2 << NewTD 15670 << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()) 15671 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 15672 D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 15673 else 15674 NewTD->setModulePrivate(); 15675 } 15676 15677 // C++ [dcl.typedef]p8: 15678 // If the typedef declaration defines an unnamed class (or 15679 // enum), the first typedef-name declared by the declaration 15680 // to be that class type (or enum type) is used to denote the 15681 // class type (or enum type) for linkage purposes only. 15682 // We need to check whether the type was declared in the declaration. 15683 switch (D.getDeclSpec().getTypeSpecType()) { 15684 case TST_enum: 15685 case TST_struct: 15686 case TST_interface: 15687 case TST_union: 15688 case TST_class: { 15689 TagDecl *tagFromDeclSpec = cast<TagDecl>(D.getDeclSpec().getRepAsDecl()); 15690 setTagNameForLinkagePurposes(tagFromDeclSpec, NewTD); 15691 break; 15692 } 15693 15694 default: 15695 break; 15696 } 15697 15698 return NewTD; 15699 } 15700 15701 /// Check that this is a valid underlying type for an enum declaration. 15702 bool Sema::CheckEnumUnderlyingType(TypeSourceInfo *TI) { 15703 SourceLocation UnderlyingLoc = TI->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(); 15704 QualType T = TI->getType(); 15705 15706 if (T->isDependentType()) 15707 return false; 15708 15709 // This doesn't use 'isIntegralType' despite the error message mentioning 15710 // integral type because isIntegralType would also allow enum types in C. 15711 if (const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>()) 15712 if (BT->isInteger()) 15713 return false; 15714 15715 if (T->isBitIntType()) 15716 return false; 15717 15718 return Diag(UnderlyingLoc, diag::err_enum_invalid_underlying) << T; 15719 } 15720 15721 /// Check whether this is a valid redeclaration of a previous enumeration. 15722 /// \return true if the redeclaration was invalid. 15723 bool Sema::CheckEnumRedeclaration(SourceLocation EnumLoc, bool IsScoped, 15724 QualType EnumUnderlyingTy, bool IsFixed, 15725 const EnumDecl *Prev) { 15726 if (IsScoped != Prev->isScoped()) { 15727 Diag(EnumLoc, diag::err_enum_redeclare_scoped_mismatch) 15728 << Prev->isScoped(); 15729 Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 15730 return true; 15731 } 15732 15733 if (IsFixed && Prev->isFixed()) { 15734 if (!EnumUnderlyingTy->isDependentType() && 15735 !Prev->getIntegerType()->isDependentType() && 15736 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(EnumUnderlyingTy, 15737 Prev->getIntegerType())) { 15738 // TODO: Highlight the underlying type of the redeclaration. 15739 Diag(EnumLoc, diag::err_enum_redeclare_type_mismatch) 15740 << EnumUnderlyingTy << Prev->getIntegerType(); 15741 Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration) 15742 << Prev->getIntegerTypeRange(); 15743 return true; 15744 } 15745 } else if (IsFixed != Prev->isFixed()) { 15746 Diag(EnumLoc, diag::err_enum_redeclare_fixed_mismatch) 15747 << Prev->isFixed(); 15748 Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 15749 return true; 15750 } 15751 15752 return false; 15753 } 15754 15755 /// Get diagnostic %select index for tag kind for 15756 /// redeclaration diagnostic message. 15757 /// WARNING: Indexes apply to particular diagnostics only! 15758 /// 15759 /// \returns diagnostic %select index. 15760 static unsigned getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(TagTypeKind Tag) { 15761 switch (Tag) { 15762 case TTK_Struct: return 0; 15763 case TTK_Interface: return 1; 15764 case TTK_Class: return 2; 15765 default: llvm_unreachable("Invalid tag kind for redecl diagnostic!"); 15766 } 15767 } 15768 15769 /// Determine if tag kind is a class-key compatible with 15770 /// class for redeclaration (class, struct, or __interface). 15771 /// 15772 /// \returns true iff the tag kind is compatible. 15773 static bool isClassCompatTagKind(TagTypeKind Tag) 15774 { 15775 return Tag == TTK_Struct || Tag == TTK_Class || Tag == TTK_Interface; 15776 } 15777 15778 Sema::NonTagKind Sema::getNonTagTypeDeclKind(const Decl *PrevDecl, 15779 TagTypeKind TTK) { 15780 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(PrevDecl)) 15781 return NTK_Typedef; 15782 else if (isa<TypeAliasDecl>(PrevDecl)) 15783 return NTK_TypeAlias; 15784 else if (isa<ClassTemplateDecl>(PrevDecl)) 15785 return NTK_Template; 15786 else if (isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(PrevDecl)) 15787 return NTK_TypeAliasTemplate; 15788 else if (isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(PrevDecl)) 15789 return NTK_TemplateTemplateArgument; 15790 switch (TTK) { 15791 case TTK_Struct: 15792 case TTK_Interface: 15793 case TTK_Class: 15794 return getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ? NTK_NonClass : NTK_NonStruct; 15795 case TTK_Union: 15796 return NTK_NonUnion; 15797 case TTK_Enum: 15798 return NTK_NonEnum; 15799 } 15800 llvm_unreachable("invalid TTK"); 15801 } 15802 15803 /// Determine whether a tag with a given kind is acceptable 15804 /// as a redeclaration of the given tag declaration. 15805 /// 15806 /// \returns true if the new tag kind is acceptable, false otherwise. 15807 bool Sema::isAcceptableTagRedeclaration(const TagDecl *Previous, 15808 TagTypeKind NewTag, bool isDefinition, 15809 SourceLocation NewTagLoc, 15810 const IdentifierInfo *Name) { 15811 // C++ [dcl.type.elab]p3: 15812 // The class-key or enum keyword present in the 15813 // elaborated-type-specifier shall agree in kind with the 15814 // declaration to which the name in the elaborated-type-specifier 15815 // refers. This rule also applies to the form of 15816 // elaborated-type-specifier that declares a class-name or 15817 // friend class since it can be construed as referring to the 15818 // definition of the class. Thus, in any 15819 // elaborated-type-specifier, the enum keyword shall be used to 15820 // refer to an enumeration (7.2), the union class-key shall be 15821 // used to refer to a union (clause 9), and either the class or 15822 // struct class-key shall be used to refer to a class (clause 9) 15823 // declared using the class or struct class-key. 15824 TagTypeKind OldTag = Previous->getTagKind(); 15825 if (OldTag != NewTag && 15826 !(isClassCompatTagKind(OldTag) && isClassCompatTagKind(NewTag))) 15827 return false; 15828 15829 // Tags are compatible, but we might still want to warn on mismatched tags. 15830 // Non-class tags can't be mismatched at this point. 15831 if (!isClassCompatTagKind(NewTag)) 15832 return true; 15833 15834 // Declarations for which -Wmismatched-tags is disabled are entirely ignored 15835 // by our warning analysis. We don't want to warn about mismatches with (eg) 15836 // declarations in system headers that are designed to be specialized, but if 15837 // a user asks us to warn, we should warn if their code contains mismatched 15838 // declarations. 15839 auto IsIgnoredLoc = [&](SourceLocation Loc) { 15840 return getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_struct_class_tag_mismatch, 15841 Loc); 15842 }; 15843 if (IsIgnoredLoc(NewTagLoc)) 15844 return true; 15845 15846 auto IsIgnored = [&](const TagDecl *Tag) { 15847 return IsIgnoredLoc(Tag->getLocation()); 15848 }; 15849 while (IsIgnored(Previous)) { 15850 Previous = Previous->getPreviousDecl(); 15851 if (!Previous) 15852 return true; 15853 OldTag = Previous->getTagKind(); 15854 } 15855 15856 bool isTemplate = false; 15857 if (const CXXRecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Previous)) 15858 isTemplate = Record->getDescribedClassTemplate(); 15859 15860 if (inTemplateInstantiation()) { 15861 if (OldTag != NewTag) { 15862 // In a template instantiation, do not offer fix-its for tag mismatches 15863 // since they usually mess up the template instead of fixing the problem. 15864 Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::warn_struct_class_tag_mismatch) 15865 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) << isTemplate << Name 15866 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(OldTag); 15867 // FIXME: Note previous location? 15868 } 15869 return true; 15870 } 15871 15872 if (isDefinition) { 15873 // On definitions, check all previous tags and issue a fix-it for each 15874 // one that doesn't match the current tag. 15875 if (Previous->getDefinition()) { 15876 // Don't suggest fix-its for redefinitions. 15877 return true; 15878 } 15879 15880 bool previousMismatch = false; 15881 for (const TagDecl *I : Previous->redecls()) { 15882 if (I->getTagKind() != NewTag) { 15883 // Ignore previous declarations for which the warning was disabled. 15884 if (IsIgnored(I)) 15885 continue; 15886 15887 if (!previousMismatch) { 15888 previousMismatch = true; 15889 Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::warn_struct_class_previous_tag_mismatch) 15890 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) << isTemplate << Name 15891 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(I->getTagKind()); 15892 } 15893 Diag(I->getInnerLocStart(), diag::note_struct_class_suggestion) 15894 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) 15895 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(I->getInnerLocStart(), 15896 TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindName(NewTag)); 15897 } 15898 } 15899 return true; 15900 } 15901 15902 // Identify the prevailing tag kind: this is the kind of the definition (if 15903 // there is a non-ignored definition), or otherwise the kind of the prior 15904 // (non-ignored) declaration. 15905 const TagDecl *PrevDef = Previous->getDefinition(); 15906 if (PrevDef && IsIgnored(PrevDef)) 15907 PrevDef = nullptr; 15908 const TagDecl *Redecl = PrevDef ? PrevDef : Previous; 15909 if (Redecl->getTagKind() != NewTag) { 15910 Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::warn_struct_class_tag_mismatch) 15911 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) << isTemplate << Name 15912 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(OldTag); 15913 Diag(Redecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_use); 15914 15915 // If there is a previous definition, suggest a fix-it. 15916 if (PrevDef) { 15917 Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::note_struct_class_suggestion) 15918 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(Redecl->getTagKind()) 15919 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(NewTagLoc), 15920 TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindName(Redecl->getTagKind())); 15921 } 15922 } 15923 15924 return true; 15925 } 15926 15927 /// Add a minimal nested name specifier fixit hint to allow lookup of a tag name 15928 /// from an outer enclosing namespace or file scope inside a friend declaration. 15929 /// This should provide the commented out code in the following snippet: 15930 /// namespace N { 15931 /// struct X; 15932 /// namespace M { 15933 /// struct Y { friend struct /*N::*/ X; }; 15934 /// } 15935 /// } 15936 static FixItHint createFriendTagNNSFixIt(Sema &SemaRef, NamedDecl *ND, Scope *S, 15937 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 15938 // While the decl is in a namespace, do repeated lookup of that name and see 15939 // if we get the same namespace back. If we do not, continue until 15940 // translation unit scope, at which point we have a fully qualified NNS. 15941 SmallVector<IdentifierInfo *, 4> Namespaces; 15942 DeclContext *DC = ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 15943 for (; !DC->isTranslationUnit(); DC = DC->getParent()) { 15944 // This tag should be declared in a namespace, which can only be enclosed by 15945 // other namespaces. Bail if there's an anonymous namespace in the chain. 15946 NamespaceDecl *Namespace = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(DC); 15947 if (!Namespace || Namespace->isAnonymousNamespace()) 15948 return FixItHint(); 15949 IdentifierInfo *II = Namespace->getIdentifier(); 15950 Namespaces.push_back(II); 15951 NamedDecl *Lookup = SemaRef.LookupSingleName( 15952 S, II, NameLoc, Sema::LookupNestedNameSpecifierName); 15953 if (Lookup == Namespace) 15954 break; 15955 } 15956 15957 // Once we have all the namespaces, reverse them to go outermost first, and 15958 // build an NNS. 15959 SmallString<64> Insertion; 15960 llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Insertion); 15961 if (DC->isTranslationUnit()) 15962 OS << "::"; 15963 std::reverse(Namespaces.begin(), Namespaces.end()); 15964 for (auto *II : Namespaces) 15965 OS << II->getName() << "::"; 15966 return FixItHint::CreateInsertion(NameLoc, Insertion); 15967 } 15968 15969 /// Determine whether a tag originally declared in context \p OldDC can 15970 /// be redeclared with an unqualified name in \p NewDC (assuming name lookup 15971 /// found a declaration in \p OldDC as a previous decl, perhaps through a 15972 /// using-declaration). 15973 static bool isAcceptableTagRedeclContext(Sema &S, DeclContext *OldDC, 15974 DeclContext *NewDC) { 15975 OldDC = OldDC->getRedeclContext(); 15976 NewDC = NewDC->getRedeclContext(); 15977 15978 if (OldDC->Equals(NewDC)) 15979 return true; 15980 15981 // In MSVC mode, we allow a redeclaration if the contexts are related (either 15982 // encloses the other). 15983 if (S.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && 15984 (OldDC->Encloses(NewDC) || NewDC->Encloses(OldDC))) 15985 return true; 15986 15987 return false; 15988 } 15989 15990 /// This is invoked when we see 'struct foo' or 'struct {'. In the 15991 /// former case, Name will be non-null. In the later case, Name will be null. 15992 /// TagSpec indicates what kind of tag this is. TUK indicates whether this is a 15993 /// reference/declaration/definition of a tag. 15994 /// 15995 /// \param IsTypeSpecifier \c true if this is a type-specifier (or 15996 /// trailing-type-specifier) other than one in an alias-declaration. 15997 /// 15998 /// \param SkipBody If non-null, will be set to indicate if the caller should 15999 /// skip the definition of this tag and treat it as if it were a declaration. 16000 Decl *Sema::ActOnTag(Scope *S, unsigned TagSpec, TagUseKind TUK, 16001 SourceLocation KWLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS, 16002 IdentifierInfo *Name, SourceLocation NameLoc, 16003 const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs, AccessSpecifier AS, 16004 SourceLocation ModulePrivateLoc, 16005 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParameterLists, 16006 bool &OwnedDecl, bool &IsDependent, 16007 SourceLocation ScopedEnumKWLoc, 16008 bool ScopedEnumUsesClassTag, TypeResult UnderlyingType, 16009 bool IsTypeSpecifier, bool IsTemplateParamOrArg, 16010 SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody) { 16011 // If this is not a definition, it must have a name. 16012 IdentifierInfo *OrigName = Name; 16013 assert((Name != nullptr || TUK == TUK_Definition) && 16014 "Nameless record must be a definition!"); 16015 assert(TemplateParameterLists.size() == 0 || TUK != TUK_Reference); 16016 16017 OwnedDecl = false; 16018 TagTypeKind Kind = TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindForTypeSpec(TagSpec); 16019 bool ScopedEnum = ScopedEnumKWLoc.isValid(); 16020 16021 // FIXME: Check member specializations more carefully. 16022 bool isMemberSpecialization = false; 16023 bool Invalid = false; 16024 16025 // We only need to do this matching if we have template parameters 16026 // or a scope specifier, which also conveniently avoids this work 16027 // for non-C++ cases. 16028 if (TemplateParameterLists.size() > 0 || 16029 (SS.isNotEmpty() && TUK != TUK_Reference)) { 16030 if (TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams = 16031 MatchTemplateParametersToScopeSpecifier( 16032 KWLoc, NameLoc, SS, nullptr, TemplateParameterLists, 16033 TUK == TUK_Friend, isMemberSpecialization, Invalid)) { 16034 if (Kind == TTK_Enum) { 16035 Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_enum_template); 16036 return nullptr; 16037 } 16038 16039 if (TemplateParams->size() > 0) { 16040 // This is a declaration or definition of a class template (which may 16041 // be a member of another template). 16042 16043 if (Invalid) 16044 return nullptr; 16045 16046 OwnedDecl = false; 16047 DeclResult Result = CheckClassTemplate( 16048 S, TagSpec, TUK, KWLoc, SS, Name, NameLoc, Attrs, TemplateParams, 16049 AS, ModulePrivateLoc, 16050 /*FriendLoc*/ SourceLocation(), TemplateParameterLists.size() - 1, 16051 TemplateParameterLists.data(), SkipBody); 16052 return Result.get(); 16053 } else { 16054 // The "template<>" header is extraneous. 16055 Diag(TemplateParams->getTemplateLoc(), diag::err_template_tag_noparams) 16056 << TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindName(Kind) << Name; 16057 isMemberSpecialization = true; 16058 } 16059 } 16060 16061 if (!TemplateParameterLists.empty() && isMemberSpecialization && 16062 CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParameterLists.back())) 16063 return nullptr; 16064 } 16065 16066 // Figure out the underlying type if this a enum declaration. We need to do 16067 // this early, because it's needed to detect if this is an incompatible 16068 // redeclaration. 16069 llvm::PointerUnion<const Type*, TypeSourceInfo*> EnumUnderlying; 16070 bool IsFixed = !UnderlyingType.isUnset() || ScopedEnum; 16071 16072 if (Kind == TTK_Enum) { 16073 if (UnderlyingType.isInvalid() || (!UnderlyingType.get() && ScopedEnum)) { 16074 // No underlying type explicitly specified, or we failed to parse the 16075 // type, default to int. 16076 EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr(); 16077 } else if (UnderlyingType.get()) { 16078 // C++0x 7.2p2: The type-specifier-seq of an enum-base shall name an 16079 // integral type; any cv-qualification is ignored. 16080 TypeSourceInfo *TI = nullptr; 16081 GetTypeFromParser(UnderlyingType.get(), &TI); 16082 EnumUnderlying = TI; 16083 16084 if (CheckEnumUnderlyingType(TI)) 16085 // Recover by falling back to int. 16086 EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr(); 16087 16088 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(TI->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), TI, 16089 UPPC_FixedUnderlyingType)) 16090 EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr(); 16091 16092 } else if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isWindowsMSVCEnvironment()) { 16093 // For MSVC ABI compatibility, unfixed enums must use an underlying type 16094 // of 'int'. However, if this is an unfixed forward declaration, don't set 16095 // the underlying type unless the user enables -fms-compatibility. This 16096 // makes unfixed forward declared enums incomplete and is more conforming. 16097 if (TUK == TUK_Definition || getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 16098 EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr(); 16099 } 16100 } 16101 16102 DeclContext *SearchDC = CurContext; 16103 DeclContext *DC = CurContext; 16104 bool isStdBadAlloc = false; 16105 bool isStdAlignValT = false; 16106 16107 RedeclarationKind Redecl = forRedeclarationInCurContext(); 16108 if (TUK == TUK_Friend || TUK == TUK_Reference) 16109 Redecl = NotForRedeclaration; 16110 16111 /// Create a new tag decl in C/ObjC. Since the ODR-like semantics for ObjC/C 16112 /// implemented asks for structural equivalence checking, the returned decl 16113 /// here is passed back to the parser, allowing the tag body to be parsed. 16114 auto createTagFromNewDecl = [&]() -> TagDecl * { 16115 assert(!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "not meant for C++ usage"); 16116 // If there is an identifier, use the location of the identifier as the 16117 // location of the decl, otherwise use the location of the struct/union 16118 // keyword. 16119 SourceLocation Loc = NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc; 16120 TagDecl *New = nullptr; 16121 16122 if (Kind == TTK_Enum) { 16123 New = EnumDecl::Create(Context, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, nullptr, 16124 ScopedEnum, ScopedEnumUsesClassTag, IsFixed); 16125 // If this is an undefined enum, bail. 16126 if (TUK != TUK_Definition && !Invalid) 16127 return nullptr; 16128 if (EnumUnderlying) { 16129 EnumDecl *ED = cast<EnumDecl>(New); 16130 if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<TypeSourceInfo *>()) 16131 ED->setIntegerTypeSourceInfo(TI); 16132 else 16133 ED->setIntegerType(QualType(EnumUnderlying.get<const Type *>(), 0)); 16134 ED->setPromotionType(ED->getIntegerType()); 16135 } 16136 } else { // struct/union 16137 New = RecordDecl::Create(Context, Kind, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, 16138 nullptr); 16139 } 16140 16141 if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(New)) { 16142 // Add alignment attributes if necessary; these attributes are checked 16143 // when the ASTContext lays out the structure. 16144 // 16145 // It is important for implementing the correct semantics that this 16146 // happen here (in ActOnTag). The #pragma pack stack is 16147 // maintained as a result of parser callbacks which can occur at 16148 // many points during the parsing of a struct declaration (because 16149 // the #pragma tokens are effectively skipped over during the 16150 // parsing of the struct). 16151 if (TUK == TUK_Definition && (!SkipBody || !SkipBody->ShouldSkip)) { 16152 AddAlignmentAttributesForRecord(RD); 16153 AddMsStructLayoutForRecord(RD); 16154 } 16155 } 16156 New->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 16157 return New; 16158 }; 16159 16160 LookupResult Previous(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupTagName, Redecl); 16161 if (Name && SS.isNotEmpty()) { 16162 // We have a nested-name tag ('struct foo::bar'). 16163 16164 // Check for invalid 'foo::'. 16165 if (SS.isInvalid()) { 16166 Name = nullptr; 16167 goto CreateNewDecl; 16168 } 16169 16170 // If this is a friend or a reference to a class in a dependent 16171 // context, don't try to make a decl for it. 16172 if (TUK == TUK_Friend || TUK == TUK_Reference) { 16173 DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false); 16174 if (!DC) { 16175 IsDependent = true; 16176 return nullptr; 16177 } 16178 } else { 16179 DC = computeDeclContext(SS, true); 16180 if (!DC) { 16181 Diag(SS.getRange().getBegin(), diag::err_dependent_nested_name_spec) 16182 << SS.getRange(); 16183 return nullptr; 16184 } 16185 } 16186 16187 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) 16188 return nullptr; 16189 16190 SearchDC = DC; 16191 // Look-up name inside 'foo::'. 16192 LookupQualifiedName(Previous, DC); 16193 16194 if (Previous.isAmbiguous()) 16195 return nullptr; 16196 16197 if (Previous.empty()) { 16198 // Name lookup did not find anything. However, if the 16199 // nested-name-specifier refers to the current instantiation, 16200 // and that current instantiation has any dependent base 16201 // classes, we might find something at instantiation time: treat 16202 // this as a dependent elaborated-type-specifier. 16203 // But this only makes any sense for reference-like lookups. 16204 if (Previous.wasNotFoundInCurrentInstantiation() && 16205 (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend)) { 16206 IsDependent = true; 16207 return nullptr; 16208 } 16209 16210 // A tag 'foo::bar' must already exist. 16211 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_not_tag_in_scope) 16212 << Kind << Name << DC << SS.getRange(); 16213 Name = nullptr; 16214 Invalid = true; 16215 goto CreateNewDecl; 16216 } 16217 } else if (Name) { 16218 // C++14 [class.mem]p14: 16219 // If T is the name of a class, then each of the following shall have a 16220 // name different from T: 16221 // -- every member of class T that is itself a type 16222 if (TUK != TUK_Reference && TUK != TUK_Friend && 16223 DiagnoseClassNameShadow(SearchDC, DeclarationNameInfo(Name, NameLoc))) 16224 return nullptr; 16225 16226 // If this is a named struct, check to see if there was a previous forward 16227 // declaration or definition. 16228 // FIXME: We're looking into outer scopes here, even when we 16229 // shouldn't be. Doing so can result in ambiguities that we 16230 // shouldn't be diagnosing. 16231 LookupName(Previous, S); 16232 16233 // When declaring or defining a tag, ignore ambiguities introduced 16234 // by types using'ed into this scope. 16235 if (Previous.isAmbiguous() && 16236 (TUK == TUK_Definition || TUK == TUK_Declaration)) { 16237 LookupResult::Filter F = Previous.makeFilter(); 16238 while (F.hasNext()) { 16239 NamedDecl *ND = F.next(); 16240 if (!ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->Equals( 16241 SearchDC->getRedeclContext())) 16242 F.erase(); 16243 } 16244 F.done(); 16245 } 16246 16247 // C++11 [namespace.memdef]p3: 16248 // If the name in a friend declaration is neither qualified nor 16249 // a template-id and the declaration is a function or an 16250 // elaborated-type-specifier, the lookup to determine whether 16251 // the entity has been previously declared shall not consider 16252 // any scopes outside the innermost enclosing namespace. 16253 // 16254 // MSVC doesn't implement the above rule for types, so a friend tag 16255 // declaration may be a redeclaration of a type declared in an enclosing 16256 // scope. They do implement this rule for friend functions. 16257 // 16258 // Does it matter that this should be by scope instead of by 16259 // semantic context? 16260 if (!Previous.empty() && TUK == TUK_Friend) { 16261 DeclContext *EnclosingNS = SearchDC->getEnclosingNamespaceContext(); 16262 LookupResult::Filter F = Previous.makeFilter(); 16263 bool FriendSawTagOutsideEnclosingNamespace = false; 16264 while (F.hasNext()) { 16265 NamedDecl *ND = F.next(); 16266 DeclContext *DC = ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 16267 if (DC->isFileContext() && 16268 !EnclosingNS->Encloses(ND->getDeclContext())) { 16269 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 16270 FriendSawTagOutsideEnclosingNamespace = true; 16271 else 16272 F.erase(); 16273 } 16274 } 16275 F.done(); 16276 16277 // Diagnose this MSVC extension in the easy case where lookup would have 16278 // unambiguously found something outside the enclosing namespace. 16279 if (Previous.isSingleResult() && FriendSawTagOutsideEnclosingNamespace) { 16280 NamedDecl *ND = Previous.getFoundDecl(); 16281 Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_friend_tag_redecl_outside_namespace) 16282 << createFriendTagNNSFixIt(*this, ND, S, NameLoc); 16283 } 16284 } 16285 16286 // Note: there used to be some attempt at recovery here. 16287 if (Previous.isAmbiguous()) 16288 return nullptr; 16289 16290 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && TUK != TUK_Reference) { 16291 // FIXME: This makes sure that we ignore the contexts associated 16292 // with C structs, unions, and enums when looking for a matching 16293 // tag declaration or definition. See the similar lookup tweak 16294 // in Sema::LookupName; is there a better way to deal with this? 16295 while (isa<RecordDecl, EnumDecl, ObjCContainerDecl>(SearchDC)) 16296 SearchDC = SearchDC->getParent(); 16297 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16298 // Inside ObjCContainer want to keep it as a lexical decl context but go 16299 // past it (most often to TranslationUnit) to find the semantic decl 16300 // context. 16301 while (isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(SearchDC)) 16302 SearchDC = SearchDC->getParent(); 16303 } 16304 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16305 // Don't use ObjCContainerDecl as the semantic decl context for anonymous 16306 // TagDecl the same way as we skip it for named TagDecl. 16307 while (isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(SearchDC)) 16308 SearchDC = SearchDC->getParent(); 16309 } 16310 16311 if (Previous.isSingleResult() && 16312 Previous.getFoundDecl()->isTemplateParameter()) { 16313 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 16314 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(NameLoc, Previous.getFoundDecl()); 16315 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 16316 Previous.clear(); 16317 } 16318 16319 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Name && DC && StdNamespace && 16320 DC->Equals(getStdNamespace())) { 16321 if (Name->isStr("bad_alloc")) { 16322 // This is a declaration of or a reference to "std::bad_alloc". 16323 isStdBadAlloc = true; 16324 16325 // If std::bad_alloc has been implicitly declared (but made invisible to 16326 // name lookup), fill in this implicit declaration as the previous 16327 // declaration, so that the declarations get chained appropriately. 16328 if (Previous.empty() && StdBadAlloc) 16329 Previous.addDecl(getStdBadAlloc()); 16330 } else if (Name->isStr("align_val_t")) { 16331 isStdAlignValT = true; 16332 if (Previous.empty() && StdAlignValT) 16333 Previous.addDecl(getStdAlignValT()); 16334 } 16335 } 16336 16337 // If we didn't find a previous declaration, and this is a reference 16338 // (or friend reference), move to the correct scope. In C++, we 16339 // also need to do a redeclaration lookup there, just in case 16340 // there's a shadow friend decl. 16341 if (Name && Previous.empty() && 16342 (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend || IsTemplateParamOrArg)) { 16343 if (Invalid) goto CreateNewDecl; 16344 assert(SS.isEmpty()); 16345 16346 if (TUK == TUK_Reference || IsTemplateParamOrArg) { 16347 // C++ [basic.scope.pdecl]p5: 16348 // -- for an elaborated-type-specifier of the form 16349 // 16350 // class-key identifier 16351 // 16352 // if the elaborated-type-specifier is used in the 16353 // decl-specifier-seq or parameter-declaration-clause of a 16354 // function defined in namespace scope, the identifier is 16355 // declared as a class-name in the namespace that contains 16356 // the declaration; otherwise, except as a friend 16357 // declaration, the identifier is declared in the smallest 16358 // non-class, non-function-prototype scope that contains the 16359 // declaration. 16360 // 16361 // C99 6.7.2.3p8 has a similar (but not identical!) provision for 16362 // C structs and unions. 16363 // 16364 // It is an error in C++ to declare (rather than define) an enum 16365 // type, including via an elaborated type specifier. We'll 16366 // diagnose that later; for now, declare the enum in the same 16367 // scope as we would have picked for any other tag type. 16368 // 16369 // GNU C also supports this behavior as part of its incomplete 16370 // enum types extension, while GNU C++ does not. 16371 // 16372 // Find the context where we'll be declaring the tag. 16373 // FIXME: We would like to maintain the current DeclContext as the 16374 // lexical context, 16375 SearchDC = getTagInjectionContext(SearchDC); 16376 16377 // Find the scope where we'll be declaring the tag. 16378 S = getTagInjectionScope(S, getLangOpts()); 16379 } else { 16380 assert(TUK == TUK_Friend); 16381 // C++ [namespace.memdef]p3: 16382 // If a friend declaration in a non-local class first declares a 16383 // class or function, the friend class or function is a member of 16384 // the innermost enclosing namespace. 16385 SearchDC = SearchDC->getEnclosingNamespaceContext(); 16386 } 16387 16388 // In C++, we need to do a redeclaration lookup to properly 16389 // diagnose some problems. 16390 // FIXME: redeclaration lookup is also used (with and without C++) to find a 16391 // hidden declaration so that we don't get ambiguity errors when using a 16392 // type declared by an elaborated-type-specifier. In C that is not correct 16393 // and we should instead merge compatible types found by lookup. 16394 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16395 // FIXME: This can perform qualified lookups into function contexts, 16396 // which are meaningless. 16397 Previous.setRedeclarationKind(forRedeclarationInCurContext()); 16398 LookupQualifiedName(Previous, SearchDC); 16399 } else { 16400 Previous.setRedeclarationKind(forRedeclarationInCurContext()); 16401 LookupName(Previous, S); 16402 } 16403 } 16404 16405 // If we have a known previous declaration to use, then use it. 16406 if (Previous.empty() && SkipBody && SkipBody->Previous) 16407 Previous.addDecl(SkipBody->Previous); 16408 16409 if (!Previous.empty()) { 16410 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = Previous.getFoundDecl(); 16411 NamedDecl *DirectPrevDecl = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(); 16412 16413 // It's okay to have a tag decl in the same scope as a typedef 16414 // which hides a tag decl in the same scope. Finding this 16415 // with a redeclaration lookup can only actually happen in C++. 16416 // 16417 // This is also okay for elaborated-type-specifiers, which is 16418 // technically forbidden by the current standard but which is 16419 // okay according to the likely resolution of an open issue; 16420 // see http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#407 16421 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16422 if (TypedefNameDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 16423 if (const TagType *TT = TD->getUnderlyingType()->getAs<TagType>()) { 16424 TagDecl *Tag = TT->getDecl(); 16425 if (Tag->getDeclName() == Name && 16426 Tag->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext() 16427 ->Equals(TD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext())) { 16428 PrevDecl = Tag; 16429 Previous.clear(); 16430 Previous.addDecl(Tag); 16431 Previous.resolveKind(); 16432 } 16433 } 16434 } 16435 } 16436 16437 // If this is a redeclaration of a using shadow declaration, it must 16438 // declare a tag in the same context. In MSVC mode, we allow a 16439 // redefinition if either context is within the other. 16440 if (auto *Shadow = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(DirectPrevDecl)) { 16441 auto *OldTag = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(PrevDecl); 16442 if (SS.isEmpty() && TUK != TUK_Reference && TUK != TUK_Friend && 16443 isDeclInScope(Shadow, SearchDC, S, isMemberSpecialization) && 16444 !(OldTag && isAcceptableTagRedeclContext( 16445 *this, OldTag->getDeclContext(), SearchDC))) { 16446 Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_using_decl_conflict_reverse); 16447 Diag(Shadow->getTargetDecl()->getLocation(), 16448 diag::note_using_decl_target); 16449 Diag(Shadow->getIntroducer()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl) 16450 << 0; 16451 // Recover by ignoring the old declaration. 16452 Previous.clear(); 16453 goto CreateNewDecl; 16454 } 16455 } 16456 16457 if (TagDecl *PrevTagDecl = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 16458 // If this is a use of a previous tag, or if the tag is already declared 16459 // in the same scope (so that the definition/declaration completes or 16460 // rementions the tag), reuse the decl. 16461 if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend || 16462 isDeclInScope(DirectPrevDecl, SearchDC, S, 16463 SS.isNotEmpty() || isMemberSpecialization)) { 16464 // Make sure that this wasn't declared as an enum and now used as a 16465 // struct or something similar. 16466 if (!isAcceptableTagRedeclaration(PrevTagDecl, Kind, 16467 TUK == TUK_Definition, KWLoc, 16468 Name)) { 16469 bool SafeToContinue 16470 = (PrevTagDecl->getTagKind() != TTK_Enum && 16471 Kind != TTK_Enum); 16472 if (SafeToContinue) 16473 Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_use_with_wrong_tag) 16474 << Name 16475 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(KWLoc), 16476 PrevTagDecl->getKindName()); 16477 else 16478 Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_use_with_wrong_tag) << Name; 16479 Diag(PrevTagDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_use); 16480 16481 if (SafeToContinue) 16482 Kind = PrevTagDecl->getTagKind(); 16483 else { 16484 // Recover by making this an anonymous redefinition. 16485 Name = nullptr; 16486 Previous.clear(); 16487 Invalid = true; 16488 } 16489 } 16490 16491 if (Kind == TTK_Enum && PrevTagDecl->getTagKind() == TTK_Enum) { 16492 const EnumDecl *PrevEnum = cast<EnumDecl>(PrevTagDecl); 16493 if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) 16494 return PrevTagDecl; 16495 16496 QualType EnumUnderlyingTy; 16497 if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<TypeSourceInfo*>()) 16498 EnumUnderlyingTy = TI->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 16499 else if (const Type *T = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<const Type*>()) 16500 EnumUnderlyingTy = QualType(T, 0); 16501 16502 // All conflicts with previous declarations are recovered by 16503 // returning the previous declaration, unless this is a definition, 16504 // in which case we want the caller to bail out. 16505 if (CheckEnumRedeclaration(NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc, 16506 ScopedEnum, EnumUnderlyingTy, 16507 IsFixed, PrevEnum)) 16508 return TUK == TUK_Declaration ? PrevTagDecl : nullptr; 16509 } 16510 16511 // C++11 [class.mem]p1: 16512 // A member shall not be declared twice in the member-specification, 16513 // except that a nested class or member class template can be declared 16514 // and then later defined. 16515 if (TUK == TUK_Declaration && PrevDecl->isCXXClassMember() && 16516 S->isDeclScope(PrevDecl)) { 16517 Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_member_redeclared); 16518 Diag(PrevTagDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 16519 } 16520 16521 if (!Invalid) { 16522 // If this is a use, just return the declaration we found, unless 16523 // we have attributes. 16524 if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) { 16525 if (!Attrs.empty()) { 16526 // FIXME: Diagnose these attributes. For now, we create a new 16527 // declaration to hold them. 16528 } else if (TUK == TUK_Reference && 16529 (PrevTagDecl->getFriendObjectKind() == 16530 Decl::FOK_Undeclared || 16531 PrevDecl->getOwningModule() != getCurrentModule()) && 16532 SS.isEmpty()) { 16533 // This declaration is a reference to an existing entity, but 16534 // has different visibility from that entity: it either makes 16535 // a friend visible or it makes a type visible in a new module. 16536 // In either case, create a new declaration. We only do this if 16537 // the declaration would have meant the same thing if no prior 16538 // declaration were found, that is, if it was found in the same 16539 // scope where we would have injected a declaration. 16540 if (!getTagInjectionContext(CurContext)->getRedeclContext() 16541 ->Equals(PrevDecl->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext())) 16542 return PrevTagDecl; 16543 // This is in the injected scope, create a new declaration in 16544 // that scope. 16545 S = getTagInjectionScope(S, getLangOpts()); 16546 } else { 16547 return PrevTagDecl; 16548 } 16549 } 16550 16551 // Diagnose attempts to redefine a tag. 16552 if (TUK == TUK_Definition) { 16553 if (NamedDecl *Def = PrevTagDecl->getDefinition()) { 16554 // If we're defining a specialization and the previous definition 16555 // is from an implicit instantiation, don't emit an error 16556 // here; we'll catch this in the general case below. 16557 bool IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation = false; 16558 if (isMemberSpecialization) { 16559 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Def)) 16560 IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation = 16561 RD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != 16562 TSK_ExplicitSpecialization; 16563 else if (EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Def)) 16564 IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation = 16565 ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != 16566 TSK_ExplicitSpecialization; 16567 } 16568 16569 // Note that clang allows ODR-like semantics for ObjC/C, i.e., do 16570 // not keep more that one definition around (merge them). However, 16571 // ensure the decl passes the structural compatibility check in 16572 // C11 6.2.7/1 (or 6.1.2.6/1 in C89). 16573 NamedDecl *Hidden = nullptr; 16574 if (SkipBody && !hasVisibleDefinition(Def, &Hidden)) { 16575 // There is a definition of this tag, but it is not visible. We 16576 // explicitly make use of C++'s one definition rule here, and 16577 // assume that this definition is identical to the hidden one 16578 // we already have. Make the existing definition visible and 16579 // use it in place of this one. 16580 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16581 // Postpone making the old definition visible until after we 16582 // complete parsing the new one and do the structural 16583 // comparison. 16584 SkipBody->CheckSameAsPrevious = true; 16585 SkipBody->New = createTagFromNewDecl(); 16586 SkipBody->Previous = Def; 16587 return Def; 16588 } else { 16589 SkipBody->ShouldSkip = true; 16590 SkipBody->Previous = Def; 16591 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(Hidden); 16592 // Carry on and handle it like a normal definition. We'll 16593 // skip starting the definitiion later. 16594 } 16595 } else if (!IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation) { 16596 // A redeclaration in function prototype scope in C isn't 16597 // visible elsewhere, so merely issue a warning. 16598 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && S->containedInPrototypeScope()) 16599 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_redefinition_in_param_list) << Name; 16600 else 16601 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_redefinition) << Name; 16602 notePreviousDefinition(Def, 16603 NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc); 16604 // If this is a redefinition, recover by making this 16605 // struct be anonymous, which will make any later 16606 // references get the previous definition. 16607 Name = nullptr; 16608 Previous.clear(); 16609 Invalid = true; 16610 } 16611 } else { 16612 // If the type is currently being defined, complain 16613 // about a nested redefinition. 16614 auto *TD = Context.getTagDeclType(PrevTagDecl)->getAsTagDecl(); 16615 if (TD->isBeingDefined()) { 16616 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_nested_redefinition) << Name; 16617 Diag(PrevTagDecl->getLocation(), 16618 diag::note_previous_definition); 16619 Name = nullptr; 16620 Previous.clear(); 16621 Invalid = true; 16622 } 16623 } 16624 16625 // Okay, this is definition of a previously declared or referenced 16626 // tag. We're going to create a new Decl for it. 16627 } 16628 16629 // Okay, we're going to make a redeclaration. If this is some kind 16630 // of reference, make sure we build the redeclaration in the same DC 16631 // as the original, and ignore the current access specifier. 16632 if (TUK == TUK_Friend || TUK == TUK_Reference) { 16633 SearchDC = PrevTagDecl->getDeclContext(); 16634 AS = AS_none; 16635 } 16636 } 16637 // If we get here we have (another) forward declaration or we 16638 // have a definition. Just create a new decl. 16639 16640 } else { 16641 // If we get here, this is a definition of a new tag type in a nested 16642 // scope, e.g. "struct foo; void bar() { struct foo; }", just create a 16643 // new decl/type. We set PrevDecl to NULL so that the entities 16644 // have distinct types. 16645 Previous.clear(); 16646 } 16647 // If we get here, we're going to create a new Decl. If PrevDecl 16648 // is non-NULL, it's a definition of the tag declared by 16649 // PrevDecl. If it's NULL, we have a new definition. 16650 16651 // Otherwise, PrevDecl is not a tag, but was found with tag 16652 // lookup. This is only actually possible in C++, where a few 16653 // things like templates still live in the tag namespace. 16654 } else { 16655 // Use a better diagnostic if an elaborated-type-specifier 16656 // found the wrong kind of type on the first 16657 // (non-redeclaration) lookup. 16658 if ((TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) && 16659 !Previous.isForRedeclaration()) { 16660 NonTagKind NTK = getNonTagTypeDeclKind(PrevDecl, Kind); 16661 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_tag_reference_non_tag) << PrevDecl << NTK 16662 << Kind; 16663 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at); 16664 Invalid = true; 16665 16666 // Otherwise, only diagnose if the declaration is in scope. 16667 } else if (!isDeclInScope(DirectPrevDecl, SearchDC, S, 16668 SS.isNotEmpty() || isMemberSpecialization)) { 16669 // do nothing 16670 16671 // Diagnose implicit declarations introduced by elaborated types. 16672 } else if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) { 16673 NonTagKind NTK = getNonTagTypeDeclKind(PrevDecl, Kind); 16674 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_tag_reference_conflict) << NTK; 16675 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) << PrevDecl; 16676 Invalid = true; 16677 16678 // Otherwise it's a declaration. Call out a particularly common 16679 // case here. 16680 } else if (TypedefNameDecl *TND = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 16681 unsigned Kind = 0; 16682 if (isa<TypeAliasDecl>(PrevDecl)) Kind = 1; 16683 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_tag_definition_of_typedef) 16684 << Name << Kind << TND->getUnderlyingType(); 16685 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) << PrevDecl; 16686 Invalid = true; 16687 16688 // Otherwise, diagnose. 16689 } else { 16690 // The tag name clashes with something else in the target scope, 16691 // issue an error and recover by making this tag be anonymous. 16692 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_redefinition_different_kind) << Name; 16693 notePreviousDefinition(PrevDecl, NameLoc); 16694 Name = nullptr; 16695 Invalid = true; 16696 } 16697 16698 // The existing declaration isn't relevant to us; we're in a 16699 // new scope, so clear out the previous declaration. 16700 Previous.clear(); 16701 } 16702 } 16703 16704 CreateNewDecl: 16705 16706 TagDecl *PrevDecl = nullptr; 16707 if (Previous.isSingleResult()) 16708 PrevDecl = cast<TagDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl()); 16709 16710 // If there is an identifier, use the location of the identifier as the 16711 // location of the decl, otherwise use the location of the struct/union 16712 // keyword. 16713 SourceLocation Loc = NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc; 16714 16715 // Otherwise, create a new declaration. If there is a previous 16716 // declaration of the same entity, the two will be linked via 16717 // PrevDecl. 16718 TagDecl *New; 16719 16720 if (Kind == TTK_Enum) { 16721 // FIXME: Tag decls should be chained to any simultaneous vardecls, e.g.: 16722 // enum X { A, B, C } D; D should chain to X. 16723 New = EnumDecl::Create(Context, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, 16724 cast_or_null<EnumDecl>(PrevDecl), ScopedEnum, 16725 ScopedEnumUsesClassTag, IsFixed); 16726 16727 if (isStdAlignValT && (!StdAlignValT || getStdAlignValT()->isImplicit())) 16728 StdAlignValT = cast<EnumDecl>(New); 16729 16730 // If this is an undefined enum, warn. 16731 if (TUK != TUK_Definition && !Invalid) { 16732 TagDecl *Def; 16733 if (IsFixed && cast<EnumDecl>(New)->isFixed()) { 16734 // C++0x: 7.2p2: opaque-enum-declaration. 16735 // Conflicts are diagnosed above. Do nothing. 16736 } 16737 else if (PrevDecl && (Def = cast<EnumDecl>(PrevDecl)->getDefinition())) { 16738 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_forward_ref_enum_def) 16739 << New; 16740 Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 16741 } else { 16742 unsigned DiagID = diag::ext_forward_ref_enum; 16743 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 16744 DiagID = diag::ext_ms_forward_ref_enum; 16745 else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 16746 DiagID = diag::err_forward_ref_enum; 16747 Diag(Loc, DiagID); 16748 } 16749 } 16750 16751 if (EnumUnderlying) { 16752 EnumDecl *ED = cast<EnumDecl>(New); 16753 if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<TypeSourceInfo*>()) 16754 ED->setIntegerTypeSourceInfo(TI); 16755 else 16756 ED->setIntegerType(QualType(EnumUnderlying.get<const Type*>(), 0)); 16757 ED->setPromotionType(ED->getIntegerType()); 16758 assert(ED->isComplete() && "enum with type should be complete"); 16759 } 16760 } else { 16761 // struct/union/class 16762 16763 // FIXME: Tag decls should be chained to any simultaneous vardecls, e.g.: 16764 // struct X { int A; } D; D should chain to X. 16765 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16766 // FIXME: Look for a way to use RecordDecl for simple structs. 16767 New = CXXRecordDecl::Create(Context, Kind, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, 16768 cast_or_null<CXXRecordDecl>(PrevDecl)); 16769 16770 if (isStdBadAlloc && (!StdBadAlloc || getStdBadAlloc()->isImplicit())) 16771 StdBadAlloc = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(New); 16772 } else 16773 New = RecordDecl::Create(Context, Kind, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, 16774 cast_or_null<RecordDecl>(PrevDecl)); 16775 } 16776 16777 // C++11 [dcl.type]p3: 16778 // A type-specifier-seq shall not define a class or enumeration [...]. 16779 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && (IsTypeSpecifier || IsTemplateParamOrArg) && 16780 TUK == TUK_Definition) { 16781 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_type_defined_in_type_specifier) 16782 << Context.getTagDeclType(New); 16783 Invalid = true; 16784 } 16785 16786 if (!Invalid && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && TUK == TUK_Definition && 16787 DC->getDeclKind() == Decl::Enum) { 16788 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_type_defined_in_enum) 16789 << Context.getTagDeclType(New); 16790 Invalid = true; 16791 } 16792 16793 // Maybe add qualifier info. 16794 if (SS.isNotEmpty()) { 16795 if (SS.isSet()) { 16796 // If this is either a declaration or a definition, check the 16797 // nested-name-specifier against the current context. 16798 if ((TUK == TUK_Definition || TUK == TUK_Declaration) && 16799 diagnoseQualifiedDeclaration(SS, DC, OrigName, Loc, 16800 isMemberSpecialization)) 16801 Invalid = true; 16802 16803 New->setQualifierInfo(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context)); 16804 if (TemplateParameterLists.size() > 0) { 16805 New->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, TemplateParameterLists); 16806 } 16807 } 16808 else 16809 Invalid = true; 16810 } 16811 16812 if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(New)) { 16813 // Add alignment attributes if necessary; these attributes are checked when 16814 // the ASTContext lays out the structure. 16815 // 16816 // It is important for implementing the correct semantics that this 16817 // happen here (in ActOnTag). The #pragma pack stack is 16818 // maintained as a result of parser callbacks which can occur at 16819 // many points during the parsing of a struct declaration (because 16820 // the #pragma tokens are effectively skipped over during the 16821 // parsing of the struct). 16822 if (TUK == TUK_Definition && (!SkipBody || !SkipBody->ShouldSkip)) { 16823 AddAlignmentAttributesForRecord(RD); 16824 AddMsStructLayoutForRecord(RD); 16825 } 16826 } 16827 16828 if (ModulePrivateLoc.isValid()) { 16829 if (isMemberSpecialization) 16830 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_specialization) 16831 << 2 16832 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ModulePrivateLoc); 16833 // __module_private__ does not apply to local classes. However, we only 16834 // diagnose this as an error when the declaration specifiers are 16835 // freestanding. Here, we just ignore the __module_private__. 16836 else if (!SearchDC->isFunctionOrMethod()) 16837 New->setModulePrivate(); 16838 } 16839 16840 // If this is a specialization of a member class (of a class template), 16841 // check the specialization. 16842 if (isMemberSpecialization && CheckMemberSpecialization(New, Previous)) 16843 Invalid = true; 16844 16845 // If we're declaring or defining a tag in function prototype scope in C, 16846 // note that this type can only be used within the function and add it to 16847 // the list of decls to inject into the function definition scope. 16848 if ((Name || Kind == TTK_Enum) && 16849 getNonFieldDeclScope(S)->isFunctionPrototypeScope()) { 16850 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16851 // C++ [dcl.fct]p6: 16852 // Types shall not be defined in return or parameter types. 16853 if (TUK == TUK_Definition && !IsTypeSpecifier) { 16854 Diag(Loc, diag::err_type_defined_in_param_type) 16855 << Name; 16856 Invalid = true; 16857 } 16858 } else if (!PrevDecl) { 16859 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_decl_in_param_list) << Context.getTagDeclType(New); 16860 } 16861 } 16862 16863 if (Invalid) 16864 New->setInvalidDecl(); 16865 16866 // Set the lexical context. If the tag has a C++ scope specifier, the 16867 // lexical context will be different from the semantic context. 16868 New->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 16869 16870 // Mark this as a friend decl if applicable. 16871 // In Microsoft mode, a friend declaration also acts as a forward 16872 // declaration so we always pass true to setObjectOfFriendDecl to make 16873 // the tag name visible. 16874 if (TUK == TUK_Friend) 16875 New->setObjectOfFriendDecl(getLangOpts().MSVCCompat); 16876 16877 // Set the access specifier. 16878 if (!Invalid && SearchDC->isRecord()) 16879 SetMemberAccessSpecifier(New, PrevDecl, AS); 16880 16881 if (PrevDecl) 16882 CheckRedeclarationInModule(New, PrevDecl); 16883 16884 if (TUK == TUK_Definition && (!SkipBody || !SkipBody->ShouldSkip)) 16885 New->startDefinition(); 16886 16887 ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, New, Attrs); 16888 AddPragmaAttributes(S, New); 16889 16890 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack. 16891 if (TUK == TUK_Friend) { 16892 // We might be replacing an existing declaration in the lookup tables; 16893 // if so, borrow its access specifier. 16894 if (PrevDecl) 16895 New->setAccess(PrevDecl->getAccess()); 16896 16897 DeclContext *DC = New->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 16898 DC->makeDeclVisibleInContext(New); 16899 if (Name) // can be null along some error paths 16900 if (Scope *EnclosingScope = getScopeForDeclContext(S, DC)) 16901 PushOnScopeChains(New, EnclosingScope, /* AddToContext = */ false); 16902 } else if (Name) { 16903 S = getNonFieldDeclScope(S); 16904 PushOnScopeChains(New, S, true); 16905 } else { 16906 CurContext->addDecl(New); 16907 } 16908 16909 // If this is the C FILE type, notify the AST context. 16910 if (IdentifierInfo *II = New->getIdentifier()) 16911 if (!New->isInvalidDecl() && 16912 New->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit() && 16913 II->isStr("FILE")) 16914 Context.setFILEDecl(New); 16915 16916 if (PrevDecl) 16917 mergeDeclAttributes(New, PrevDecl); 16918 16919 if (auto *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(New)) 16920 inferGslOwnerPointerAttribute(CXXRD); 16921 16922 // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, set the visibility of this 16923 // record. 16924 AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(New); 16925 16926 if (isMemberSpecialization && !New->isInvalidDecl()) 16927 CompleteMemberSpecialization(New, Previous); 16928 16929 OwnedDecl = true; 16930 // In C++, don't return an invalid declaration. We can't recover well from 16931 // the cases where we make the type anonymous. 16932 if (Invalid && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16933 if (New->isBeingDefined()) 16934 if (auto RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(New)) 16935 RD->completeDefinition(); 16936 return nullptr; 16937 } else if (SkipBody && SkipBody->ShouldSkip) { 16938 return SkipBody->Previous; 16939 } else { 16940 return New; 16941 } 16942 } 16943 16944 void Sema::ActOnTagStartDefinition(Scope *S, Decl *TagD) { 16945 AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD); 16946 TagDecl *Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD); 16947 16948 // Enter the tag context. 16949 PushDeclContext(S, Tag); 16950 16951 ActOnDocumentableDecl(TagD); 16952 16953 // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, set the visibility of this 16954 // record. 16955 AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(Tag); 16956 } 16957 16958 bool Sema::ActOnDuplicateDefinition(Decl *Prev, SkipBodyInfo &SkipBody) { 16959 if (!hasStructuralCompatLayout(Prev, SkipBody.New)) 16960 return false; 16961 16962 // Make the previous decl visible. 16963 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(SkipBody.Previous); 16964 return true; 16965 } 16966 16967 void Sema::ActOnObjCContainerStartDefinition(ObjCContainerDecl *IDecl) { 16968 assert(IDecl->getLexicalParent() == CurContext && 16969 "The next DeclContext should be lexically contained in the current one."); 16970 CurContext = IDecl; 16971 } 16972 16973 void Sema::ActOnStartCXXMemberDeclarations(Scope *S, Decl *TagD, 16974 SourceLocation FinalLoc, 16975 bool IsFinalSpelledSealed, 16976 bool IsAbstract, 16977 SourceLocation LBraceLoc) { 16978 AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD); 16979 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TagD); 16980 16981 FieldCollector->StartClass(); 16982 16983 if (!Record->getIdentifier()) 16984 return; 16985 16986 if (IsAbstract) 16987 Record->markAbstract(); 16988 16989 if (FinalLoc.isValid()) { 16990 Record->addAttr(FinalAttr::Create( 16991 Context, FinalLoc, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Keyword, 16992 static_cast<FinalAttr::Spelling>(IsFinalSpelledSealed))); 16993 } 16994 // C++ [class]p2: 16995 // [...] The class-name is also inserted into the scope of the 16996 // class itself; this is known as the injected-class-name. For 16997 // purposes of access checking, the injected-class-name is treated 16998 // as if it were a public member name. 16999 CXXRecordDecl *InjectedClassName = CXXRecordDecl::Create( 17000 Context, Record->getTagKind(), CurContext, Record->getBeginLoc(), 17001 Record->getLocation(), Record->getIdentifier(), 17002 /*PrevDecl=*/nullptr, 17003 /*DelayTypeCreation=*/true); 17004 Context.getTypeDeclType(InjectedClassName, Record); 17005 InjectedClassName->setImplicit(); 17006 InjectedClassName->setAccess(AS_public); 17007 if (ClassTemplateDecl *Template = Record->getDescribedClassTemplate()) 17008 InjectedClassName->setDescribedClassTemplate(Template); 17009 PushOnScopeChains(InjectedClassName, S); 17010 assert(InjectedClassName->isInjectedClassName() && 17011 "Broken injected-class-name"); 17012 } 17013 17014 void Sema::ActOnTagFinishDefinition(Scope *S, Decl *TagD, 17015 SourceRange BraceRange) { 17016 AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD); 17017 TagDecl *Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD); 17018 Tag->setBraceRange(BraceRange); 17019 17020 // Make sure we "complete" the definition even it is invalid. 17021 if (Tag->isBeingDefined()) { 17022 assert(Tag->isInvalidDecl() && "We should already have completed it"); 17023 if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag)) 17024 RD->completeDefinition(); 17025 } 17026 17027 if (auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag)) { 17028 FieldCollector->FinishClass(); 17029 if (RD->hasAttr<SYCLSpecialClassAttr>()) { 17030 auto *Def = RD->getDefinition(); 17031 assert(Def && "The record is expected to have a completed definition"); 17032 unsigned NumInitMethods = 0; 17033 for (auto *Method : Def->methods()) { 17034 if (!Method->getIdentifier()) 17035 continue; 17036 if (Method->getName() == "__init") 17037 NumInitMethods++; 17038 } 17039 if (NumInitMethods > 1 || !Def->hasInitMethod()) 17040 Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::err_sycl_special_type_num_init_method); 17041 } 17042 } 17043 17044 // Exit this scope of this tag's definition. 17045 PopDeclContext(); 17046 17047 if (getCurLexicalContext()->isObjCContainer() && 17048 Tag->getDeclContext()->isFileContext()) 17049 Tag->setTopLevelDeclInObjCContainer(); 17050 17051 // Notify the consumer that we've defined a tag. 17052 if (!Tag->isInvalidDecl()) 17053 Consumer.HandleTagDeclDefinition(Tag); 17054 17055 // Clangs implementation of #pragma align(packed) differs in bitfield layout 17056 // from XLs and instead matches the XL #pragma pack(1) behavior. 17057 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isOSAIX() && 17058 AlignPackStack.hasValue()) { 17059 AlignPackInfo APInfo = AlignPackStack.CurrentValue; 17060 // Only diagnose #pragma align(packed). 17061 if (!APInfo.IsAlignAttr() || APInfo.getAlignMode() != AlignPackInfo::Packed) 17062 return; 17063 const RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag); 17064 if (!RD) 17065 return; 17066 // Only warn if there is at least 1 bitfield member. 17067 if (llvm::any_of(RD->fields(), 17068 [](const FieldDecl *FD) { return FD->isBitField(); })) 17069 Diag(BraceRange.getBegin(), diag::warn_pragma_align_not_xl_compatible); 17070 } 17071 } 17072 17073 void Sema::ActOnObjCContainerFinishDefinition() { 17074 // Exit this scope of this interface definition. 17075 PopDeclContext(); 17076 } 17077 17078 void Sema::ActOnObjCTemporaryExitContainerContext(ObjCContainerDecl *ObjCCtx) { 17079 assert(ObjCCtx == CurContext && "Mismatch of container contexts"); 17080 OriginalLexicalContext = ObjCCtx; 17081 ActOnObjCContainerFinishDefinition(); 17082 } 17083 17084 void Sema::ActOnObjCReenterContainerContext(ObjCContainerDecl *ObjCCtx) { 17085 ActOnObjCContainerStartDefinition(ObjCCtx); 17086 OriginalLexicalContext = nullptr; 17087 } 17088 17089 void Sema::ActOnTagDefinitionError(Scope *S, Decl *TagD) { 17090 AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD); 17091 TagDecl *Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD); 17092 Tag->setInvalidDecl(); 17093 17094 // Make sure we "complete" the definition even it is invalid. 17095 if (Tag->isBeingDefined()) { 17096 if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag)) 17097 RD->completeDefinition(); 17098 } 17099 17100 // We're undoing ActOnTagStartDefinition here, not 17101 // ActOnStartCXXMemberDeclarations, so we don't have to mess with 17102 // the FieldCollector. 17103 17104 PopDeclContext(); 17105 } 17106 17107 // Note that FieldName may be null for anonymous bitfields. 17108 ExprResult Sema::VerifyBitField(SourceLocation FieldLoc, 17109 IdentifierInfo *FieldName, QualType FieldTy, 17110 bool IsMsStruct, Expr *BitWidth) { 17111 assert(BitWidth); 17112 if (BitWidth->containsErrors()) 17113 return ExprError(); 17114 17115 // C99 6.7.2.1p4 - verify the field type. 17116 // C++ 9.6p3: A bit-field shall have integral or enumeration type. 17117 if (!FieldTy->isDependentType() && !FieldTy->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) { 17118 // Handle incomplete and sizeless types with a specific error. 17119 if (RequireCompleteSizedType(FieldLoc, FieldTy, 17120 diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless)) 17121 return ExprError(); 17122 if (FieldName) 17123 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_not_integral_type_bitfield) 17124 << FieldName << FieldTy << BitWidth->getSourceRange(); 17125 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_not_integral_type_anon_bitfield) 17126 << FieldTy << BitWidth->getSourceRange(); 17127 } else if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(const_cast<Expr *>(BitWidth), 17128 UPPC_BitFieldWidth)) 17129 return ExprError(); 17130 17131 // If the bit-width is type- or value-dependent, don't try to check 17132 // it now. 17133 if (BitWidth->isValueDependent() || BitWidth->isTypeDependent()) 17134 return BitWidth; 17135 17136 llvm::APSInt Value; 17137 ExprResult ICE = VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(BitWidth, &Value, AllowFold); 17138 if (ICE.isInvalid()) 17139 return ICE; 17140 BitWidth = ICE.get(); 17141 17142 // Zero-width bitfield is ok for anonymous field. 17143 if (Value == 0 && FieldName) 17144 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_has_zero_width) << FieldName; 17145 17146 if (Value.isSigned() && Value.isNegative()) { 17147 if (FieldName) 17148 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_has_negative_width) 17149 << FieldName << toString(Value, 10); 17150 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_anon_bitfield_has_negative_width) 17151 << toString(Value, 10); 17152 } 17153 17154 // The size of the bit-field must not exceed our maximum permitted object 17155 // size. 17156 if (Value.getActiveBits() > ConstantArrayType::getMaxSizeBits(Context)) { 17157 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_too_wide) 17158 << !FieldName << FieldName << toString(Value, 10); 17159 } 17160 17161 if (!FieldTy->isDependentType()) { 17162 uint64_t TypeStorageSize = Context.getTypeSize(FieldTy); 17163 uint64_t TypeWidth = Context.getIntWidth(FieldTy); 17164 bool BitfieldIsOverwide = Value.ugt(TypeWidth); 17165 17166 // Over-wide bitfields are an error in C or when using the MSVC bitfield 17167 // ABI. 17168 bool CStdConstraintViolation = 17169 BitfieldIsOverwide && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 17170 bool MSBitfieldViolation = 17171 Value.ugt(TypeStorageSize) && 17172 (IsMsStruct || Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()); 17173 if (CStdConstraintViolation || MSBitfieldViolation) { 17174 unsigned DiagWidth = 17175 CStdConstraintViolation ? TypeWidth : TypeStorageSize; 17176 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_width_exceeds_type_width) 17177 << (bool)FieldName << FieldName << toString(Value, 10) 17178 << !CStdConstraintViolation << DiagWidth; 17179 } 17180 17181 // Warn on types where the user might conceivably expect to get all 17182 // specified bits as value bits: that's all integral types other than 17183 // 'bool'. 17184 if (BitfieldIsOverwide && !FieldTy->isBooleanType() && FieldName) { 17185 Diag(FieldLoc, diag::warn_bitfield_width_exceeds_type_width) 17186 << FieldName << toString(Value, 10) 17187 << (unsigned)TypeWidth; 17188 } 17189 } 17190 17191 return BitWidth; 17192 } 17193 17194 /// ActOnField - Each field of a C struct/union is passed into this in order 17195 /// to create a FieldDecl object for it. 17196 Decl *Sema::ActOnField(Scope *S, Decl *TagD, SourceLocation DeclStart, 17197 Declarator &D, Expr *BitfieldWidth) { 17198 FieldDecl *Res = HandleField(S, cast_or_null<RecordDecl>(TagD), 17199 DeclStart, D, static_cast<Expr*>(BitfieldWidth), 17200 /*InitStyle=*/ICIS_NoInit, AS_public); 17201 return Res; 17202 } 17203 17204 /// HandleField - Analyze a field of a C struct or a C++ data member. 17205 /// 17206 FieldDecl *Sema::HandleField(Scope *S, RecordDecl *Record, 17207 SourceLocation DeclStart, 17208 Declarator &D, Expr *BitWidth, 17209 InClassInitStyle InitStyle, 17210 AccessSpecifier AS) { 17211 if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) { 17212 const DecompositionDeclarator &Decomp = D.getDecompositionDeclarator(); 17213 Diag(Decomp.getLSquareLoc(), diag::err_decomp_decl_context) 17214 << Decomp.getSourceRange(); 17215 return nullptr; 17216 } 17217 17218 IdentifierInfo *II = D.getIdentifier(); 17219 SourceLocation Loc = DeclStart; 17220 if (II) Loc = D.getIdentifierLoc(); 17221 17222 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S); 17223 QualType T = TInfo->getType(); 17224 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 17225 CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D); 17226 17227 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(D.getIdentifierLoc(), TInfo, 17228 UPPC_DataMemberType)) { 17229 D.setInvalidType(); 17230 T = Context.IntTy; 17231 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T, Loc); 17232 } 17233 } 17234 17235 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(D.getDeclSpec()); 17236 17237 if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified()) 17238 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function) 17239 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17; 17240 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec()) 17241 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 17242 diag::err_invalid_thread) 17243 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 17244 17245 // Check to see if this name was declared as a member previously 17246 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = nullptr; 17247 LookupResult Previous(*this, II, Loc, LookupMemberName, 17248 ForVisibleRedeclaration); 17249 LookupName(Previous, S); 17250 switch (Previous.getResultKind()) { 17251 case LookupResult::Found: 17252 case LookupResult::FoundUnresolvedValue: 17253 PrevDecl = Previous.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>(); 17254 break; 17255 17256 case LookupResult::FoundOverloaded: 17257 PrevDecl = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(); 17258 break; 17259 17260 case LookupResult::NotFound: 17261 case LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation: 17262 case LookupResult::Ambiguous: 17263 break; 17264 } 17265 Previous.suppressDiagnostics(); 17266 17267 if (PrevDecl && PrevDecl->isTemplateParameter()) { 17268 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 17269 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(D.getIdentifierLoc(), PrevDecl); 17270 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 17271 PrevDecl = nullptr; 17272 } 17273 17274 if (PrevDecl && !isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, Record, S)) 17275 PrevDecl = nullptr; 17276 17277 bool Mutable 17278 = (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable); 17279 SourceLocation TSSL = D.getBeginLoc(); 17280 FieldDecl *NewFD 17281 = CheckFieldDecl(II, T, TInfo, Record, Loc, Mutable, BitWidth, InitStyle, 17282 TSSL, AS, PrevDecl, &D); 17283 17284 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 17285 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 17286 17287 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) 17288 NewFD->setModulePrivate(); 17289 17290 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && PrevDecl) { 17291 // Don't introduce NewFD into scope; there's already something 17292 // with the same name in the same scope. 17293 } else if (II) { 17294 PushOnScopeChains(NewFD, S); 17295 } else 17296 Record->addDecl(NewFD); 17297 17298 return NewFD; 17299 } 17300 17301 /// Build a new FieldDecl and check its well-formedness. 17302 /// 17303 /// This routine builds a new FieldDecl given the fields name, type, 17304 /// record, etc. \p PrevDecl should refer to any previous declaration 17305 /// with the same name and in the same scope as the field to be 17306 /// created. 17307 /// 17308 /// \returns a new FieldDecl. 17309 /// 17310 /// \todo The Declarator argument is a hack. It will be removed once 17311 FieldDecl *Sema::CheckFieldDecl(DeclarationName Name, QualType T, 17312 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 17313 RecordDecl *Record, SourceLocation Loc, 17314 bool Mutable, Expr *BitWidth, 17315 InClassInitStyle InitStyle, 17316 SourceLocation TSSL, 17317 AccessSpecifier AS, NamedDecl *PrevDecl, 17318 Declarator *D) { 17319 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo(); 17320 bool InvalidDecl = false; 17321 if (D) InvalidDecl = D->isInvalidType(); 17322 17323 // If we receive a broken type, recover by assuming 'int' and 17324 // marking this declaration as invalid. 17325 if (T.isNull() || T->containsErrors()) { 17326 InvalidDecl = true; 17327 T = Context.IntTy; 17328 } 17329 17330 QualType EltTy = Context.getBaseElementType(T); 17331 if (!EltTy->isDependentType() && !EltTy->containsErrors()) { 17332 if (RequireCompleteSizedType(Loc, EltTy, 17333 diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless)) { 17334 // Fields of incomplete type force their record to be invalid. 17335 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 17336 InvalidDecl = true; 17337 } else { 17338 NamedDecl *Def; 17339 EltTy->isIncompleteType(&Def); 17340 if (Def && Def->isInvalidDecl()) { 17341 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 17342 InvalidDecl = true; 17343 } 17344 } 17345 } 17346 17347 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address space 17348 if (T.hasAddressSpace() || T->isDependentAddressSpaceType() || 17349 T->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe()->isDependentAddressSpaceType()) { 17350 Diag(Loc, diag::err_field_with_address_space); 17351 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 17352 InvalidDecl = true; 17353 } 17354 17355 if (LangOpts.OpenCL) { 17356 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9b,r & OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - The following types cannot be 17357 // used as structure or union field: image, sampler, event or block types. 17358 if (T->isEventT() || T->isImageType() || T->isSamplerT() || 17359 T->isBlockPointerType()) { 17360 Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_type_struct_or_union_field) << T; 17361 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 17362 InvalidDecl = true; 17363 } 17364 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.c: bitfields are not supported, unless Clang extension 17365 // is enabled. 17366 if (BitWidth && !getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption( 17367 "__cl_clang_bitfields", LangOpts)) { 17368 Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_bitfields); 17369 InvalidDecl = true; 17370 } 17371 } 17372 17373 // Anonymous bit-fields cannot be cv-qualified (CWG 2229). 17374 if (!InvalidDecl && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !II && BitWidth && 17375 T.hasQualifiers()) { 17376 InvalidDecl = true; 17377 Diag(Loc, diag::err_anon_bitfield_qualifiers); 17378 } 17379 17380 // C99 6.7.2.1p8: A member of a structure or union may have any type other 17381 // than a variably modified type. 17382 if (!InvalidDecl && T->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 17383 if (!tryToFixVariablyModifiedVarType( 17384 TInfo, T, Loc, diag::err_typecheck_field_variable_size)) 17385 InvalidDecl = true; 17386 } 17387 17388 // Fields can not have abstract class types 17389 if (!InvalidDecl && RequireNonAbstractType(Loc, T, 17390 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 17391 AbstractFieldType)) 17392 InvalidDecl = true; 17393 17394 if (InvalidDecl) 17395 BitWidth = nullptr; 17396 // If this is declared as a bit-field, check the bit-field. 17397 if (BitWidth) { 17398 BitWidth = 17399 VerifyBitField(Loc, II, T, Record->isMsStruct(Context), BitWidth).get(); 17400 if (!BitWidth) { 17401 InvalidDecl = true; 17402 BitWidth = nullptr; 17403 } 17404 } 17405 17406 // Check that 'mutable' is consistent with the type of the declaration. 17407 if (!InvalidDecl && Mutable) { 17408 unsigned DiagID = 0; 17409 if (T->isReferenceType()) 17410 DiagID = getLangOpts().MSVCCompat ? diag::ext_mutable_reference 17411 : diag::err_mutable_reference; 17412 else if (T.isConstQualified()) 17413 DiagID = diag::err_mutable_const; 17414 17415 if (DiagID) { 17416 SourceLocation ErrLoc = Loc; 17417 if (D && D->getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc().isValid()) 17418 ErrLoc = D->getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(); 17419 Diag(ErrLoc, DiagID); 17420 if (DiagID != diag::ext_mutable_reference) { 17421 Mutable = false; 17422 InvalidDecl = true; 17423 } 17424 } 17425 } 17426 17427 // C++11 [class.union]p8 (DR1460): 17428 // At most one variant member of a union may have a 17429 // brace-or-equal-initializer. 17430 if (InitStyle != ICIS_NoInit) 17431 checkDuplicateDefaultInit(*this, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record), Loc); 17432 17433 FieldDecl *NewFD = FieldDecl::Create(Context, Record, TSSL, Loc, II, T, TInfo, 17434 BitWidth, Mutable, InitStyle); 17435 if (InvalidDecl) 17436 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 17437 17438 if (PrevDecl && !isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 17439 Diag(Loc, diag::err_duplicate_member) << II; 17440 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 17441 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 17442 } 17443 17444 if (!InvalidDecl && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 17445 if (Record->isUnion()) { 17446 if (const RecordType *RT = EltTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { 17447 CXXRecordDecl* RDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl()); 17448 if (RDecl->getDefinition()) { 17449 // C++ [class.union]p1: An object of a class with a non-trivial 17450 // constructor, a non-trivial copy constructor, a non-trivial 17451 // destructor, or a non-trivial copy assignment operator 17452 // cannot be a member of a union, nor can an array of such 17453 // objects. 17454 if (CheckNontrivialField(NewFD)) 17455 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 17456 } 17457 } 17458 17459 // C++ [class.union]p1: If a union contains a member of reference type, 17460 // the program is ill-formed, except when compiling with MSVC extensions 17461 // enabled. 17462 if (EltTy->isReferenceType()) { 17463 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt ? 17464 diag::ext_union_member_of_reference_type : 17465 diag::err_union_member_of_reference_type) 17466 << NewFD->getDeclName() << EltTy; 17467 if (!getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) 17468 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 17469 } 17470 } 17471 } 17472 17473 // FIXME: We need to pass in the attributes given an AST 17474 // representation, not a parser representation. 17475 if (D) { 17476 // FIXME: The current scope is almost... but not entirely... correct here. 17477 ProcessDeclAttributes(getCurScope(), NewFD, *D); 17478 17479 if (NewFD->hasAttrs()) 17480 CheckAlignasUnderalignment(NewFD); 17481 } 17482 17483 // In auto-retain/release, infer strong retension for fields of 17484 // retainable type. 17485 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(NewFD)) 17486 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 17487 17488 if (T.isObjCGCWeak()) 17489 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_attribute_weak_on_field); 17490 17491 // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as field types. 17492 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() && 17493 CheckPPCMMAType(T, NewFD->getLocation())) 17494 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 17495 17496 NewFD->setAccess(AS); 17497 return NewFD; 17498 } 17499 17500 bool Sema::CheckNontrivialField(FieldDecl *FD) { 17501 assert(FD); 17502 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "valid check only for C++"); 17503 17504 if (FD->isInvalidDecl() || FD->getType()->isDependentType()) 17505 return false; 17506 17507 QualType EltTy = Context.getBaseElementType(FD->getType()); 17508 if (const RecordType *RT = EltTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { 17509 CXXRecordDecl *RDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl()); 17510 if (RDecl->getDefinition()) { 17511 // We check for copy constructors before constructors 17512 // because otherwise we'll never get complaints about 17513 // copy constructors. 17514 17515 CXXSpecialMember member = CXXInvalid; 17516 // We're required to check for any non-trivial constructors. Since the 17517 // implicit default constructor is suppressed if there are any 17518 // user-declared constructors, we just need to check that there is a 17519 // trivial default constructor and a trivial copy constructor. (We don't 17520 // worry about move constructors here, since this is a C++98 check.) 17521 if (RDecl->hasNonTrivialCopyConstructor()) 17522 member = CXXCopyConstructor; 17523 else if (!RDecl->hasTrivialDefaultConstructor()) 17524 member = CXXDefaultConstructor; 17525 else if (RDecl->hasNonTrivialCopyAssignment()) 17526 member = CXXCopyAssignment; 17527 else if (RDecl->hasNonTrivialDestructor()) 17528 member = CXXDestructor; 17529 17530 if (member != CXXInvalid) { 17531 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && 17532 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && RDecl->hasObjectMember()) { 17533 // Objective-C++ ARC: it is an error to have a non-trivial field of 17534 // a union. However, system headers in Objective-C programs 17535 // occasionally have Objective-C lifetime objects within unions, 17536 // and rather than cause the program to fail, we make those 17537 // members unavailable. 17538 SourceLocation Loc = FD->getLocation(); 17539 if (getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(Loc)) { 17540 if (!FD->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) 17541 FD->addAttr(UnavailableAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, "", 17542 UnavailableAttr::IR_ARCFieldWithOwnership, Loc)); 17543 return false; 17544 } 17545 } 17546 17547 Diag(FD->getLocation(), getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ? 17548 diag::warn_cxx98_compat_nontrivial_union_or_anon_struct_member : 17549 diag::err_illegal_union_or_anon_struct_member) 17550 << FD->getParent()->isUnion() << FD->getDeclName() << member; 17551 DiagnoseNontrivial(RDecl, member); 17552 return !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11; 17553 } 17554 } 17555 } 17556 17557 return false; 17558 } 17559 17560 /// TranslateIvarVisibility - Translate visibility from a token ID to an 17561 /// AST enum value. 17562 static ObjCIvarDecl::AccessControl 17563 TranslateIvarVisibility(tok::ObjCKeywordKind ivarVisibility) { 17564 switch (ivarVisibility) { 17565 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown visitibility kind"); 17566 case tok::objc_private: return ObjCIvarDecl::Private; 17567 case tok::objc_public: return ObjCIvarDecl::Public; 17568 case tok::objc_protected: return ObjCIvarDecl::Protected; 17569 case tok::objc_package: return ObjCIvarDecl::Package; 17570 } 17571 } 17572 17573 /// ActOnIvar - Each ivar field of an objective-c class is passed into this 17574 /// in order to create an IvarDecl object for it. 17575 Decl *Sema::ActOnIvar(Scope *S, 17576 SourceLocation DeclStart, 17577 Declarator &D, Expr *BitfieldWidth, 17578 tok::ObjCKeywordKind Visibility) { 17579 17580 IdentifierInfo *II = D.getIdentifier(); 17581 Expr *BitWidth = (Expr*)BitfieldWidth; 17582 SourceLocation Loc = DeclStart; 17583 if (II) Loc = D.getIdentifierLoc(); 17584 17585 // FIXME: Unnamed fields can be handled in various different ways, for 17586 // example, unnamed unions inject all members into the struct namespace! 17587 17588 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S); 17589 QualType T = TInfo->getType(); 17590 17591 if (BitWidth) { 17592 // 6.7.2.1p3, 6.7.2.1p4 17593 BitWidth = VerifyBitField(Loc, II, T, /*IsMsStruct*/false, BitWidth).get(); 17594 if (!BitWidth) 17595 D.setInvalidType(); 17596 } else { 17597 // Not a bitfield. 17598 17599 // validate II. 17600 17601 } 17602 if (T->isReferenceType()) { 17603 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ivar_reference_type); 17604 D.setInvalidType(); 17605 } 17606 // C99 6.7.2.1p8: A member of a structure or union may have any type other 17607 // than a variably modified type. 17608 else if (T->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 17609 if (!tryToFixVariablyModifiedVarType( 17610 TInfo, T, Loc, diag::err_typecheck_ivar_variable_size)) 17611 D.setInvalidType(); 17612 } 17613 17614 // Get the visibility (access control) for this ivar. 17615 ObjCIvarDecl::AccessControl ac = 17616 Visibility != tok::objc_not_keyword ? TranslateIvarVisibility(Visibility) 17617 : ObjCIvarDecl::None; 17618 // Must set ivar's DeclContext to its enclosing interface. 17619 ObjCContainerDecl *EnclosingDecl = cast<ObjCContainerDecl>(CurContext); 17620 if (!EnclosingDecl || EnclosingDecl->isInvalidDecl()) 17621 return nullptr; 17622 ObjCContainerDecl *EnclosingContext; 17623 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPDecl = 17624 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 17625 if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isFragile()) { 17626 // Case of ivar declared in an implementation. Context is that of its class. 17627 EnclosingContext = IMPDecl->getClassInterface(); 17628 assert(EnclosingContext && "Implementation has no class interface!"); 17629 } 17630 else 17631 EnclosingContext = EnclosingDecl; 17632 } else { 17633 if (ObjCCategoryDecl *CDecl = 17634 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 17635 if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isFragile() || !CDecl->IsClassExtension()) { 17636 Diag(Loc, diag::err_misplaced_ivar) << CDecl->IsClassExtension(); 17637 return nullptr; 17638 } 17639 } 17640 EnclosingContext = EnclosingDecl; 17641 } 17642 17643 // Construct the decl. 17644 ObjCIvarDecl *NewID = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(Context, EnclosingContext, 17645 DeclStart, Loc, II, T, 17646 TInfo, ac, (Expr *)BitfieldWidth); 17647 17648 if (II) { 17649 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(S, II, Loc, LookupMemberName, 17650 ForVisibleRedeclaration); 17651 if (PrevDecl && isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, EnclosingContext, S) 17652 && !isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 17653 Diag(Loc, diag::err_duplicate_member) << II; 17654 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 17655 NewID->setInvalidDecl(); 17656 } 17657 } 17658 17659 // Process attributes attached to the ivar. 17660 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewID, D); 17661 17662 if (D.isInvalidType()) 17663 NewID->setInvalidDecl(); 17664 17665 // In ARC, infer 'retaining' for ivars of retainable type. 17666 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(NewID)) 17667 NewID->setInvalidDecl(); 17668 17669 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) 17670 NewID->setModulePrivate(); 17671 17672 if (II) { 17673 // FIXME: When interfaces are DeclContexts, we'll need to add 17674 // these to the interface. 17675 S->AddDecl(NewID); 17676 IdResolver.AddDecl(NewID); 17677 } 17678 17679 if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isNonFragile() && 17680 !NewID->isInvalidDecl() && isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) 17681 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivars_in_interface); 17682 17683 return NewID; 17684 } 17685 17686 /// ActOnLastBitfield - This routine handles synthesized bitfields rules for 17687 /// class and class extensions. For every class \@interface and class 17688 /// extension \@interface, if the last ivar is a bitfield of any type, 17689 /// then add an implicit `char :0` ivar to the end of that interface. 17690 void Sema::ActOnLastBitfield(SourceLocation DeclLoc, 17691 SmallVectorImpl<Decl *> &AllIvarDecls) { 17692 if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isFragile() || AllIvarDecls.empty()) 17693 return; 17694 17695 Decl *ivarDecl = AllIvarDecls[AllIvarDecls.size()-1]; 17696 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(ivarDecl); 17697 17698 if (!Ivar->isBitField() || Ivar->isZeroLengthBitField(Context)) 17699 return; 17700 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CurContext); 17701 if (!ID) { 17702 if (ObjCCategoryDecl *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CurContext)) { 17703 if (!CD->IsClassExtension()) 17704 return; 17705 } 17706 // No need to add this to end of @implementation. 17707 else 17708 return; 17709 } 17710 // All conditions are met. Add a new bitfield to the tail end of ivars. 17711 llvm::APInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), 0); 17712 Expr * BW = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy, DeclLoc); 17713 17714 Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(Context, cast<ObjCContainerDecl>(CurContext), 17715 DeclLoc, DeclLoc, nullptr, 17716 Context.CharTy, 17717 Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(Context.CharTy, 17718 DeclLoc), 17719 ObjCIvarDecl::Private, BW, 17720 true); 17721 AllIvarDecls.push_back(Ivar); 17722 } 17723 17724 namespace { 17725 /// [class.dtor]p4: 17726 /// At the end of the definition of a class, overload resolution is 17727 /// performed among the prospective destructors declared in that class with 17728 /// an empty argument list to select the destructor for the class, also 17729 /// known as the selected destructor. 17730 /// 17731 /// We do the overload resolution here, then mark the selected constructor in the AST. 17732 /// Later CXXRecordDecl::getDestructor() will return the selected constructor. 17733 void ComputeSelectedDestructor(Sema &S, CXXRecordDecl *Record) { 17734 if (!Record->hasUserDeclaredDestructor()) { 17735 return; 17736 } 17737 17738 SourceLocation Loc = Record->getLocation(); 17739 OverloadCandidateSet OCS(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 17740 17741 for (auto *Decl : Record->decls()) { 17742 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(Decl)) { 17743 if (DD->isInvalidDecl()) 17744 continue; 17745 S.AddOverloadCandidate(DD, DeclAccessPair::make(DD, DD->getAccess()), {}, 17746 OCS); 17747 assert(DD->isIneligibleOrNotSelected() && "Selecting a destructor but a destructor was already selected."); 17748 } 17749 } 17750 17751 if (OCS.empty()) { 17752 return; 17753 } 17754 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 17755 unsigned Msg = 0; 17756 OverloadCandidateDisplayKind DisplayKind; 17757 17758 switch (OCS.BestViableFunction(S, Loc, Best)) { 17759 case OR_Success: 17760 case OR_Deleted: 17761 Record->addedSelectedDestructor(dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(Best->Function)); 17762 break; 17763 17764 case OR_Ambiguous: 17765 Msg = diag::err_ambiguous_destructor; 17766 DisplayKind = OCD_AmbiguousCandidates; 17767 break; 17768 17769 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 17770 Msg = diag::err_no_viable_destructor; 17771 DisplayKind = OCD_AllCandidates; 17772 break; 17773 } 17774 17775 if (Msg) { 17776 // OpenCL have got their own thing going with destructors. It's slightly broken, 17777 // but we allow it. 17778 if (!S.LangOpts.OpenCL) { 17779 PartialDiagnostic Diag = S.PDiag(Msg) << Record; 17780 OCS.NoteCandidates(PartialDiagnosticAt(Loc, Diag), S, DisplayKind, {}); 17781 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 17782 } 17783 // It's a bit hacky: At this point we've raised an error but we want the 17784 // rest of the compiler to continue somehow working. However almost 17785 // everything we'll try to do with the class will depend on there being a 17786 // destructor. So let's pretend the first one is selected and hope for the 17787 // best. 17788 Record->addedSelectedDestructor(dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(OCS.begin()->Function)); 17789 } 17790 } 17791 } // namespace 17792 17793 void Sema::ActOnFields(Scope *S, SourceLocation RecLoc, Decl *EnclosingDecl, 17794 ArrayRef<Decl *> Fields, SourceLocation LBrac, 17795 SourceLocation RBrac, 17796 const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs) { 17797 assert(EnclosingDecl && "missing record or interface decl"); 17798 17799 // If this is an Objective-C @implementation or category and we have 17800 // new fields here we should reset the layout of the interface since 17801 // it will now change. 17802 if (!Fields.empty() && isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 17803 ObjCContainerDecl *DC = cast<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl); 17804 switch (DC->getKind()) { 17805 default: break; 17806 case Decl::ObjCCategory: 17807 Context.ResetObjCLayout(cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(DC)->getClassInterface()); 17808 break; 17809 case Decl::ObjCImplementation: 17810 Context. 17811 ResetObjCLayout(cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(DC)->getClassInterface()); 17812 break; 17813 } 17814 } 17815 17816 RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(EnclosingDecl); 17817 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRecord = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(EnclosingDecl); 17818 17819 if (CXXRecord && !CXXRecord->isDependentType()) 17820 ComputeSelectedDestructor(*this, CXXRecord); 17821 17822 // Start counting up the number of named members; make sure to include 17823 // members of anonymous structs and unions in the total. 17824 unsigned NumNamedMembers = 0; 17825 if (Record) { 17826 for (const auto *I : Record->decls()) { 17827 if (const auto *IFD = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(I)) 17828 if (IFD->getDeclName()) 17829 ++NumNamedMembers; 17830 } 17831 } 17832 17833 // Verify that all the fields are okay. 17834 SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 32> RecFields; 17835 17836 for (ArrayRef<Decl *>::iterator i = Fields.begin(), end = Fields.end(); 17837 i != end; ++i) { 17838 FieldDecl *FD = cast<FieldDecl>(*i); 17839 17840 // Get the type for the field. 17841 const Type *FDTy = FD->getType().getTypePtr(); 17842 17843 if (!FD->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) { 17844 // Remember all fields written by the user. 17845 RecFields.push_back(FD); 17846 } 17847 17848 // If the field is already invalid for some reason, don't emit more 17849 // diagnostics about it. 17850 if (FD->isInvalidDecl()) { 17851 EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 17852 continue; 17853 } 17854 17855 // C99 6.7.2.1p2: 17856 // A structure or union shall not contain a member with 17857 // incomplete or function type (hence, a structure shall not 17858 // contain an instance of itself, but may contain a pointer to 17859 // an instance of itself), except that the last member of a 17860 // structure with more than one named member may have incomplete 17861 // array type; such a structure (and any union containing, 17862 // possibly recursively, a member that is such a structure) 17863 // shall not be a member of a structure or an element of an 17864 // array. 17865 bool IsLastField = (i + 1 == Fields.end()); 17866 if (FDTy->isFunctionType()) { 17867 // Field declared as a function. 17868 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_field_declared_as_function) 17869 << FD->getDeclName(); 17870 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 17871 EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 17872 continue; 17873 } else if (FDTy->isIncompleteArrayType() && 17874 (Record || isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl))) { 17875 if (Record) { 17876 // Flexible array member. 17877 // Microsoft and g++ is more permissive regarding flexible array. 17878 // It will accept flexible array in union and also 17879 // as the sole element of a struct/class. 17880 unsigned DiagID = 0; 17881 if (!Record->isUnion() && !IsLastField) { 17882 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_flexible_array_not_at_end) 17883 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType() << Record->getTagKind(); 17884 Diag((*(i + 1))->getLocation(), diag::note_next_field_declaration); 17885 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 17886 EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 17887 continue; 17888 } else if (Record->isUnion()) 17889 DiagID = getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt 17890 ? diag::ext_flexible_array_union_ms 17891 : getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 17892 ? diag::ext_flexible_array_union_gnu 17893 : diag::err_flexible_array_union; 17894 else if (NumNamedMembers < 1) 17895 DiagID = getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt 17896 ? diag::ext_flexible_array_empty_aggregate_ms 17897 : getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 17898 ? diag::ext_flexible_array_empty_aggregate_gnu 17899 : diag::err_flexible_array_empty_aggregate; 17900 17901 if (DiagID) 17902 Diag(FD->getLocation(), DiagID) << FD->getDeclName() 17903 << Record->getTagKind(); 17904 // While the layout of types that contain virtual bases is not specified 17905 // by the C++ standard, both the Itanium and Microsoft C++ ABIs place 17906 // virtual bases after the derived members. This would make a flexible 17907 // array member declared at the end of an object not adjacent to the end 17908 // of the type. 17909 if (CXXRecord && CXXRecord->getNumVBases() != 0) 17910 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_flexible_array_virtual_base) 17911 << FD->getDeclName() << Record->getTagKind(); 17912 if (!getLangOpts().C99) 17913 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_c99_flexible_array_member) 17914 << FD->getDeclName() << Record->getTagKind(); 17915 17916 // If the element type has a non-trivial destructor, we would not 17917 // implicitly destroy the elements, so disallow it for now. 17918 // 17919 // FIXME: GCC allows this. We should probably either implicitly delete 17920 // the destructor of the containing class, or just allow this. 17921 QualType BaseElem = Context.getBaseElementType(FD->getType()); 17922 if (!BaseElem->isDependentType() && BaseElem.isDestructedType()) { 17923 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_flexible_array_has_nontrivial_dtor) 17924 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType(); 17925 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 17926 EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 17927 continue; 17928 } 17929 // Okay, we have a legal flexible array member at the end of the struct. 17930 Record->setHasFlexibleArrayMember(true); 17931 } else { 17932 // In ObjCContainerDecl ivars with incomplete array type are accepted, 17933 // unless they are followed by another ivar. That check is done 17934 // elsewhere, after synthesized ivars are known. 17935 } 17936 } else if (!FDTy->isDependentType() && 17937 RequireCompleteSizedType( 17938 FD->getLocation(), FD->getType(), 17939 diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless)) { 17940 // Incomplete type 17941 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 17942 EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 17943 continue; 17944 } else if (const RecordType *FDTTy = FDTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { 17945 if (Record && FDTTy->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) { 17946 // A type which contains a flexible array member is considered to be a 17947 // flexible array member. 17948 Record->setHasFlexibleArrayMember(true); 17949 if (!Record->isUnion()) { 17950 // If this is a struct/class and this is not the last element, reject 17951 // it. Note that GCC supports variable sized arrays in the middle of 17952 // structures. 17953 if (!IsLastField) 17954 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_variable_sized_type_in_struct) 17955 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType(); 17956 else { 17957 // We support flexible arrays at the end of structs in 17958 // other structs as an extension. 17959 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_flexible_array_in_struct) 17960 << FD->getDeclName(); 17961 } 17962 } 17963 } 17964 if (isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl) && 17965 RequireNonAbstractType(FD->getLocation(), FD->getType(), 17966 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 17967 AbstractIvarType)) { 17968 // Ivars can not have abstract class types 17969 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 17970 } 17971 if (Record && FDTTy->getDecl()->hasObjectMember()) 17972 Record->setHasObjectMember(true); 17973 if (Record && FDTTy->getDecl()->hasVolatileMember()) 17974 Record->setHasVolatileMember(true); 17975 } else if (FDTy->isObjCObjectType()) { 17976 /// A field cannot be an Objective-c object 17977 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_statically_allocated_object) 17978 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FD->getLocation(), "*"); 17979 QualType T = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(FD->getType()); 17980 FD->setType(T); 17981 } else if (Record && Record->isUnion() && 17982 FD->getType().hasNonTrivialObjCLifetime() && 17983 getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(FD->getLocation()) && 17984 !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !FD->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>() && 17985 (FD->getType().getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong || 17986 !Context.hasDirectOwnershipQualifier(FD->getType()))) { 17987 // For backward compatibility, fields of C unions declared in system 17988 // headers that have non-trivial ObjC ownership qualifications are marked 17989 // as unavailable unless the qualifier is explicit and __strong. This can 17990 // break ABI compatibility between programs compiled with ARC and MRR, but 17991 // is a better option than rejecting programs using those unions under 17992 // ARC. 17993 FD->addAttr(UnavailableAttr::CreateImplicit( 17994 Context, "", UnavailableAttr::IR_ARCFieldWithOwnership, 17995 FD->getLocation())); 17996 } else if (getLangOpts().ObjC && 17997 getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC && Record && 17998 !Record->hasObjectMember()) { 17999 if (FD->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 18000 FD->getType().isObjCGCStrong()) 18001 Record->setHasObjectMember(true); 18002 else if (Context.getAsArrayType(FD->getType())) { 18003 QualType BaseType = Context.getBaseElementType(FD->getType()); 18004 if (BaseType->isRecordType() && 18005 BaseType->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->hasObjectMember()) 18006 Record->setHasObjectMember(true); 18007 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 18008 BaseType.isObjCGCStrong()) 18009 Record->setHasObjectMember(true); 18010 } 18011 } 18012 18013 if (Record && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 18014 !shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD)) { 18015 QualType FT = FD->getType(); 18016 if (FT.isNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitialize()) { 18017 Record->setNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitialize(true); 18018 if (FT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() || 18019 Record->isUnion()) 18020 Record->setHasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion(true); 18021 } 18022 QualType::PrimitiveCopyKind PCK = FT.isNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopy(); 18023 if (PCK != QualType::PCK_Trivial && PCK != QualType::PCK_VolatileTrivial) { 18024 Record->setNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopy(true); 18025 if (FT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion() || Record->isUnion()) 18026 Record->setHasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion(true); 18027 } 18028 if (FT.isDestructedType()) { 18029 Record->setNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestroy(true); 18030 Record->setParamDestroyedInCallee(true); 18031 if (FT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() || Record->isUnion()) 18032 Record->setHasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion(true); 18033 } 18034 18035 if (const auto *RT = FT->getAs<RecordType>()) { 18036 if (RT->getDecl()->getArgPassingRestrictions() == 18037 RecordDecl::APK_CanNeverPassInRegs) 18038 Record->setArgPassingRestrictions(RecordDecl::APK_CanNeverPassInRegs); 18039 } else if (FT.getQualifiers().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak) 18040 Record->setArgPassingRestrictions(RecordDecl::APK_CanNeverPassInRegs); 18041 } 18042 18043 if (Record && FD->getType().isVolatileQualified()) 18044 Record->setHasVolatileMember(true); 18045 // Keep track of the number of named members. 18046 if (FD->getIdentifier()) 18047 ++NumNamedMembers; 18048 } 18049 18050 // Okay, we successfully defined 'Record'. 18051 if (Record) { 18052 bool Completed = false; 18053 if (CXXRecord) { 18054 if (!CXXRecord->isInvalidDecl()) { 18055 // Set access bits correctly on the directly-declared conversions. 18056 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator 18057 I = CXXRecord->conversion_begin(), 18058 E = CXXRecord->conversion_end(); I != E; ++I) 18059 I.setAccess((*I)->getAccess()); 18060 } 18061 18062 // Add any implicitly-declared members to this class. 18063 AddImplicitlyDeclaredMembersToClass(CXXRecord); 18064 18065 if (!CXXRecord->isDependentType()) { 18066 if (!CXXRecord->isInvalidDecl()) { 18067 // If we have virtual base classes, we may end up finding multiple 18068 // final overriders for a given virtual function. Check for this 18069 // problem now. 18070 if (CXXRecord->getNumVBases()) { 18071 CXXFinalOverriderMap FinalOverriders; 18072 CXXRecord->getFinalOverriders(FinalOverriders); 18073 18074 for (CXXFinalOverriderMap::iterator M = FinalOverriders.begin(), 18075 MEnd = FinalOverriders.end(); 18076 M != MEnd; ++M) { 18077 for (OverridingMethods::iterator SO = M->second.begin(), 18078 SOEnd = M->second.end(); 18079 SO != SOEnd; ++SO) { 18080 assert(SO->second.size() > 0 && 18081 "Virtual function without overriding functions?"); 18082 if (SO->second.size() == 1) 18083 continue; 18084 18085 // C++ [class.virtual]p2: 18086 // In a derived class, if a virtual member function of a base 18087 // class subobject has more than one final overrider the 18088 // program is ill-formed. 18089 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_multiple_final_overriders) 18090 << (const NamedDecl *)M->first << Record; 18091 Diag(M->first->getLocation(), 18092 diag::note_overridden_virtual_function); 18093 for (OverridingMethods::overriding_iterator 18094 OM = SO->second.begin(), 18095 OMEnd = SO->second.end(); 18096 OM != OMEnd; ++OM) 18097 Diag(OM->Method->getLocation(), diag::note_final_overrider) 18098 << (const NamedDecl *)M->first << OM->Method->getParent(); 18099 18100 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 18101 } 18102 } 18103 CXXRecord->completeDefinition(&FinalOverriders); 18104 Completed = true; 18105 } 18106 } 18107 } 18108 } 18109 18110 if (!Completed) 18111 Record->completeDefinition(); 18112 18113 // Handle attributes before checking the layout. 18114 ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, Record, Attrs); 18115 18116 // Check to see if a FieldDecl is a pointer to a function. 18117 auto IsFunctionPointer = [&](const Decl *D) { 18118 const FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(D); 18119 if (!FD) 18120 return false; 18121 QualType FieldType = FD->getType().getDesugaredType(Context); 18122 if (isa<PointerType>(FieldType)) { 18123 QualType PointeeType = cast<PointerType>(FieldType)->getPointeeType(); 18124 return PointeeType.getDesugaredType(Context)->isFunctionType(); 18125 } 18126 return false; 18127 }; 18128 18129 // Maybe randomize the record's decls. We automatically randomize a record 18130 // of function pointers, unless it has the "no_randomize_layout" attribute. 18131 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 18132 (Record->hasAttr<RandomizeLayoutAttr>() || 18133 (!Record->hasAttr<NoRandomizeLayoutAttr>() && 18134 llvm::all_of(Record->decls(), IsFunctionPointer))) && 18135 !Record->isUnion() && !getLangOpts().RandstructSeed.empty() && 18136 !Record->isRandomized()) { 18137 SmallVector<Decl *, 32> NewDeclOrdering; 18138 if (randstruct::randomizeStructureLayout(Context, Record, 18139 NewDeclOrdering)) 18140 Record->reorderDecls(NewDeclOrdering); 18141 } 18142 18143 // We may have deferred checking for a deleted destructor. Check now. 18144 if (CXXRecord) { 18145 auto *Dtor = CXXRecord->getDestructor(); 18146 if (Dtor && Dtor->isImplicit() && 18147 ShouldDeleteSpecialMember(Dtor, CXXDestructor)) { 18148 CXXRecord->setImplicitDestructorIsDeleted(); 18149 SetDeclDeleted(Dtor, CXXRecord->getLocation()); 18150 } 18151 } 18152 18153 if (Record->hasAttrs()) { 18154 CheckAlignasUnderalignment(Record); 18155 18156 if (const MSInheritanceAttr *IA = Record->getAttr<MSInheritanceAttr>()) 18157 checkMSInheritanceAttrOnDefinition(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record), 18158 IA->getRange(), IA->getBestCase(), 18159 IA->getInheritanceModel()); 18160 } 18161 18162 // Check if the structure/union declaration is a type that can have zero 18163 // size in C. For C this is a language extension, for C++ it may cause 18164 // compatibility problems. 18165 bool CheckForZeroSize; 18166 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 18167 CheckForZeroSize = true; 18168 } else { 18169 // For C++ filter out types that cannot be referenced in C code. 18170 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record); 18171 CheckForZeroSize = 18172 CXXRecord->getLexicalDeclContext()->isExternCContext() && 18173 !CXXRecord->isDependentType() && !inTemplateInstantiation() && 18174 CXXRecord->isCLike(); 18175 } 18176 if (CheckForZeroSize) { 18177 bool ZeroSize = true; 18178 bool IsEmpty = true; 18179 unsigned NonBitFields = 0; 18180 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator I = Record->field_begin(), 18181 E = Record->field_end(); 18182 (NonBitFields == 0 || ZeroSize) && I != E; ++I) { 18183 IsEmpty = false; 18184 if (I->isUnnamedBitfield()) { 18185 if (!I->isZeroLengthBitField(Context)) 18186 ZeroSize = false; 18187 } else { 18188 ++NonBitFields; 18189 QualType FieldType = I->getType(); 18190 if (FieldType->isIncompleteType() || 18191 !Context.getTypeSizeInChars(FieldType).isZero()) 18192 ZeroSize = false; 18193 } 18194 } 18195 18196 // Empty structs are an extension in C (C99 6.7.2.1p7). They are 18197 // allowed in C++, but warn if its declaration is inside 18198 // extern "C" block. 18199 if (ZeroSize) { 18200 Diag(RecLoc, getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ? 18201 diag::warn_zero_size_struct_union_in_extern_c : 18202 diag::warn_zero_size_struct_union_compat) 18203 << IsEmpty << Record->isUnion() << (NonBitFields > 1); 18204 } 18205 18206 // Structs without named members are extension in C (C99 6.7.2.1p7), 18207 // but are accepted by GCC. 18208 if (NonBitFields == 0 && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 18209 Diag(RecLoc, IsEmpty ? diag::ext_empty_struct_union : 18210 diag::ext_no_named_members_in_struct_union) 18211 << Record->isUnion(); 18212 } 18213 } 18214 } else { 18215 ObjCIvarDecl **ClsFields = 18216 reinterpret_cast<ObjCIvarDecl**>(RecFields.data()); 18217 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 18218 ID->setEndOfDefinitionLoc(RBrac); 18219 // Add ivar's to class's DeclContext. 18220 for (unsigned i = 0, e = RecFields.size(); i != e; ++i) { 18221 ClsFields[i]->setLexicalDeclContext(ID); 18222 ID->addDecl(ClsFields[i]); 18223 } 18224 // Must enforce the rule that ivars in the base classes may not be 18225 // duplicates. 18226 if (ID->getSuperClass()) 18227 DiagnoseDuplicateIvars(ID, ID->getSuperClass()); 18228 } else if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPDecl = 18229 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 18230 assert(IMPDecl && "ActOnFields - missing ObjCImplementationDecl"); 18231 for (unsigned I = 0, N = RecFields.size(); I != N; ++I) 18232 // Ivar declared in @implementation never belongs to the implementation. 18233 // Only it is in implementation's lexical context. 18234 ClsFields[I]->setLexicalDeclContext(IMPDecl); 18235 CheckImplementationIvars(IMPDecl, ClsFields, RecFields.size(), RBrac); 18236 IMPDecl->setIvarLBraceLoc(LBrac); 18237 IMPDecl->setIvarRBraceLoc(RBrac); 18238 } else if (ObjCCategoryDecl *CDecl = 18239 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 18240 // case of ivars in class extension; all other cases have been 18241 // reported as errors elsewhere. 18242 // FIXME. Class extension does not have a LocEnd field. 18243 // CDecl->setLocEnd(RBrac); 18244 // Add ivar's to class extension's DeclContext. 18245 // Diagnose redeclaration of private ivars. 18246 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CDecl->getClassInterface(); 18247 for (unsigned i = 0, e = RecFields.size(); i != e; ++i) { 18248 if (IDecl) { 18249 if (const ObjCIvarDecl *ClsIvar = 18250 IDecl->getIvarDecl(ClsFields[i]->getIdentifier())) { 18251 Diag(ClsFields[i]->getLocation(), 18252 diag::err_duplicate_ivar_declaration); 18253 Diag(ClsIvar->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 18254 continue; 18255 } 18256 for (const auto *Ext : IDecl->known_extensions()) { 18257 if (const ObjCIvarDecl *ClsExtIvar 18258 = Ext->getIvarDecl(ClsFields[i]->getIdentifier())) { 18259 Diag(ClsFields[i]->getLocation(), 18260 diag::err_duplicate_ivar_declaration); 18261 Diag(ClsExtIvar->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 18262 continue; 18263 } 18264 } 18265 } 18266 ClsFields[i]->setLexicalDeclContext(CDecl); 18267 CDecl->addDecl(ClsFields[i]); 18268 } 18269 CDecl->setIvarLBraceLoc(LBrac); 18270 CDecl->setIvarRBraceLoc(RBrac); 18271 } 18272 } 18273 } 18274 18275 /// Determine whether the given integral value is representable within 18276 /// the given type T. 18277 static bool isRepresentableIntegerValue(ASTContext &Context, 18278 llvm::APSInt &Value, 18279 QualType T) { 18280 assert((T->isIntegralType(Context) || T->isEnumeralType()) && 18281 "Integral type required!"); 18282 unsigned BitWidth = Context.getIntWidth(T); 18283 18284 if (Value.isUnsigned() || Value.isNonNegative()) { 18285 if (T->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType()) 18286 --BitWidth; 18287 return Value.getActiveBits() <= BitWidth; 18288 } 18289 return Value.getMinSignedBits() <= BitWidth; 18290 } 18291 18292 // Given an integral type, return the next larger integral type 18293 // (or a NULL type of no such type exists). 18294 static QualType getNextLargerIntegralType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T) { 18295 // FIXME: Int128/UInt128 support, which also needs to be introduced into 18296 // enum checking below. 18297 assert((T->isIntegralType(Context) || 18298 T->isEnumeralType()) && "Integral type required!"); 18299 const unsigned NumTypes = 4; 18300 QualType SignedIntegralTypes[NumTypes] = { 18301 Context.ShortTy, Context.IntTy, Context.LongTy, Context.LongLongTy 18302 }; 18303 QualType UnsignedIntegralTypes[NumTypes] = { 18304 Context.UnsignedShortTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy, 18305 Context.UnsignedLongLongTy 18306 }; 18307 18308 unsigned BitWidth = Context.getTypeSize(T); 18309 QualType *Types = T->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType()? SignedIntegralTypes 18310 : UnsignedIntegralTypes; 18311 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumTypes; ++I) 18312 if (Context.getTypeSize(Types[I]) > BitWidth) 18313 return Types[I]; 18314 18315 return QualType(); 18316 } 18317 18318 EnumConstantDecl *Sema::CheckEnumConstant(EnumDecl *Enum, 18319 EnumConstantDecl *LastEnumConst, 18320 SourceLocation IdLoc, 18321 IdentifierInfo *Id, 18322 Expr *Val) { 18323 unsigned IntWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth(); 18324 llvm::APSInt EnumVal(IntWidth); 18325 QualType EltTy; 18326 18327 if (Val && DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(Val, UPPC_EnumeratorValue)) 18328 Val = nullptr; 18329 18330 if (Val) 18331 Val = DefaultLvalueConversion(Val).get(); 18332 18333 if (Val) { 18334 if (Enum->isDependentType() || Val->isTypeDependent() || 18335 Val->containsErrors()) 18336 EltTy = Context.DependentTy; 18337 else { 18338 // FIXME: We don't allow folding in C++11 mode for an enum with a fixed 18339 // underlying type, but do allow it in all other contexts. 18340 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && Enum->isFixed()) { 18341 // C++11 [dcl.enum]p5: If the underlying type is fixed, [...] the 18342 // constant-expression in the enumerator-definition shall be a converted 18343 // constant expression of the underlying type. 18344 EltTy = Enum->getIntegerType(); 18345 ExprResult Converted = 18346 CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Val, EltTy, EnumVal, 18347 CCEK_Enumerator); 18348 if (Converted.isInvalid()) 18349 Val = nullptr; 18350 else 18351 Val = Converted.get(); 18352 } else if (!Val->isValueDependent() && 18353 !(Val = 18354 VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Val, &EnumVal, AllowFold) 18355 .get())) { 18356 // C99 6.7.2.2p2: Make sure we have an integer constant expression. 18357 } else { 18358 if (Enum->isComplete()) { 18359 EltTy = Enum->getIntegerType(); 18360 18361 // In Obj-C and Microsoft mode, require the enumeration value to be 18362 // representable in the underlying type of the enumeration. In C++11, 18363 // we perform a non-narrowing conversion as part of converted constant 18364 // expression checking. 18365 if (!isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, EnumVal, EltTy)) { 18366 if (Context.getTargetInfo() 18367 .getTriple() 18368 .isWindowsMSVCEnvironment()) { 18369 Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enumerator_too_large) << EltTy; 18370 } else { 18371 Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_enumerator_too_large) << EltTy; 18372 } 18373 } 18374 18375 // Cast to the underlying type. 18376 Val = ImpCastExprToType(Val, EltTy, 18377 EltTy->isBooleanType() ? CK_IntegralToBoolean 18378 : CK_IntegralCast) 18379 .get(); 18380 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 18381 // C++11 [dcl.enum]p5: 18382 // If the underlying type is not fixed, the type of each enumerator 18383 // is the type of its initializing value: 18384 // - If an initializer is specified for an enumerator, the 18385 // initializing value has the same type as the expression. 18386 EltTy = Val->getType(); 18387 } else { 18388 // C99 6.7.2.2p2: 18389 // The expression that defines the value of an enumeration constant 18390 // shall be an integer constant expression that has a value 18391 // representable as an int. 18392 18393 // Complain if the value is not representable in an int. 18394 if (!isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, EnumVal, Context.IntTy)) 18395 Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enum_value_not_int) 18396 << toString(EnumVal, 10) << Val->getSourceRange() 18397 << (EnumVal.isUnsigned() || EnumVal.isNonNegative()); 18398 else if (!Context.hasSameType(Val->getType(), Context.IntTy)) { 18399 // Force the type of the expression to 'int'. 18400 Val = ImpCastExprToType(Val, Context.IntTy, CK_IntegralCast).get(); 18401 } 18402 EltTy = Val->getType(); 18403 } 18404 } 18405 } 18406 } 18407 18408 if (!Val) { 18409 if (Enum->isDependentType()) 18410 EltTy = Context.DependentTy; 18411 else if (!LastEnumConst) { 18412 // C++0x [dcl.enum]p5: 18413 // If the underlying type is not fixed, the type of each enumerator 18414 // is the type of its initializing value: 18415 // - If no initializer is specified for the first enumerator, the 18416 // initializing value has an unspecified integral type. 18417 // 18418 // GCC uses 'int' for its unspecified integral type, as does 18419 // C99 6.7.2.2p3. 18420 if (Enum->isFixed()) { 18421 EltTy = Enum->getIntegerType(); 18422 } 18423 else { 18424 EltTy = Context.IntTy; 18425 } 18426 } else { 18427 // Assign the last value + 1. 18428 EnumVal = LastEnumConst->getInitVal(); 18429 ++EnumVal; 18430 EltTy = LastEnumConst->getType(); 18431 18432 // Check for overflow on increment. 18433 if (EnumVal < LastEnumConst->getInitVal()) { 18434 // C++0x [dcl.enum]p5: 18435 // If the underlying type is not fixed, the type of each enumerator 18436 // is the type of its initializing value: 18437 // 18438 // - Otherwise the type of the initializing value is the same as 18439 // the type of the initializing value of the preceding enumerator 18440 // unless the incremented value is not representable in that type, 18441 // in which case the type is an unspecified integral type 18442 // sufficient to contain the incremented value. If no such type 18443 // exists, the program is ill-formed. 18444 QualType T = getNextLargerIntegralType(Context, EltTy); 18445 if (T.isNull() || Enum->isFixed()) { 18446 // There is no integral type larger enough to represent this 18447 // value. Complain, then allow the value to wrap around. 18448 EnumVal = LastEnumConst->getInitVal(); 18449 EnumVal = EnumVal.zext(EnumVal.getBitWidth() * 2); 18450 ++EnumVal; 18451 if (Enum->isFixed()) 18452 // When the underlying type is fixed, this is ill-formed. 18453 Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_enumerator_wrapped) 18454 << toString(EnumVal, 10) 18455 << EltTy; 18456 else 18457 Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enumerator_increment_too_large) 18458 << toString(EnumVal, 10); 18459 } else { 18460 EltTy = T; 18461 } 18462 18463 // Retrieve the last enumerator's value, extent that type to the 18464 // type that is supposed to be large enough to represent the incremented 18465 // value, then increment. 18466 EnumVal = LastEnumConst->getInitVal(); 18467 EnumVal.setIsSigned(EltTy->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType()); 18468 EnumVal = EnumVal.zextOrTrunc(Context.getIntWidth(EltTy)); 18469 ++EnumVal; 18470 18471 // If we're not in C++, diagnose the overflow of enumerator values, 18472 // which in C99 means that the enumerator value is not representable in 18473 // an int (C99 6.7.2.2p2). However, we support GCC's extension that 18474 // permits enumerator values that are representable in some larger 18475 // integral type. 18476 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !T.isNull()) 18477 Diag(IdLoc, diag::warn_enum_value_overflow); 18478 } else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 18479 !isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, EnumVal, EltTy)) { 18480 // Enforce C99 6.7.2.2p2 even when we compute the next value. 18481 Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enum_value_not_int) 18482 << toString(EnumVal, 10) << 1; 18483 } 18484 } 18485 } 18486 18487 if (!EltTy->isDependentType()) { 18488 // Make the enumerator value match the signedness and size of the 18489 // enumerator's type. 18490 EnumVal = EnumVal.extOrTrunc(Context.getIntWidth(EltTy)); 18491 EnumVal.setIsSigned(EltTy->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType()); 18492 } 18493 18494 return EnumConstantDecl::Create(Context, Enum, IdLoc, Id, EltTy, 18495 Val, EnumVal); 18496 } 18497 18498 Sema::SkipBodyInfo Sema::shouldSkipAnonEnumBody(Scope *S, IdentifierInfo *II, 18499 SourceLocation IILoc) { 18500 if (!(getLangOpts().Modules || getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility) || 18501 !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 18502 return SkipBodyInfo(); 18503 18504 // We have an anonymous enum definition. Look up the first enumerator to 18505 // determine if we should merge the definition with an existing one and 18506 // skip the body. 18507 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(S, II, IILoc, LookupOrdinaryName, 18508 forRedeclarationInCurContext()); 18509 auto *PrevECD = dyn_cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(PrevDecl); 18510 if (!PrevECD) 18511 return SkipBodyInfo(); 18512 18513 EnumDecl *PrevED = cast<EnumDecl>(PrevECD->getDeclContext()); 18514 NamedDecl *Hidden; 18515 if (!PrevED->getDeclName() && !hasVisibleDefinition(PrevED, &Hidden)) { 18516 SkipBodyInfo Skip; 18517 Skip.Previous = Hidden; 18518 return Skip; 18519 } 18520 18521 return SkipBodyInfo(); 18522 } 18523 18524 Decl *Sema::ActOnEnumConstant(Scope *S, Decl *theEnumDecl, Decl *lastEnumConst, 18525 SourceLocation IdLoc, IdentifierInfo *Id, 18526 const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs, 18527 SourceLocation EqualLoc, Expr *Val) { 18528 EnumDecl *TheEnumDecl = cast<EnumDecl>(theEnumDecl); 18529 EnumConstantDecl *LastEnumConst = 18530 cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(lastEnumConst); 18531 18532 // The scope passed in may not be a decl scope. Zip up the scope tree until 18533 // we find one that is. 18534 S = getNonFieldDeclScope(S); 18535 18536 // Verify that there isn't already something declared with this name in this 18537 // scope. 18538 LookupResult R(*this, Id, IdLoc, LookupOrdinaryName, ForVisibleRedeclaration); 18539 LookupName(R, S); 18540 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>(); 18541 18542 if (PrevDecl && PrevDecl->isTemplateParameter()) { 18543 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 18544 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(IdLoc, PrevDecl); 18545 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 18546 PrevDecl = nullptr; 18547 } 18548 18549 // C++ [class.mem]p15: 18550 // If T is the name of a class, then each of the following shall have a name 18551 // different from T: 18552 // - every enumerator of every member of class T that is an unscoped 18553 // enumerated type 18554 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !TheEnumDecl->isScoped()) 18555 DiagnoseClassNameShadow(TheEnumDecl->getDeclContext(), 18556 DeclarationNameInfo(Id, IdLoc)); 18557 18558 EnumConstantDecl *New = 18559 CheckEnumConstant(TheEnumDecl, LastEnumConst, IdLoc, Id, Val); 18560 if (!New) 18561 return nullptr; 18562 18563 if (PrevDecl) { 18564 if (!TheEnumDecl->isScoped() && isa<ValueDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 18565 // Check for other kinds of shadowing not already handled. 18566 CheckShadow(New, PrevDecl, R); 18567 } 18568 18569 // When in C++, we may get a TagDecl with the same name; in this case the 18570 // enum constant will 'hide' the tag. 18571 assert((getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) && 18572 "Received TagDecl when not in C++!"); 18573 if (!isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl) && isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, CurContext, S)) { 18574 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(PrevDecl)) 18575 Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_redefinition_of_enumerator) << Id; 18576 else 18577 Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_redefinition) << Id; 18578 notePreviousDefinition(PrevDecl, IdLoc); 18579 return nullptr; 18580 } 18581 } 18582 18583 // Process attributes. 18584 ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, New, Attrs); 18585 AddPragmaAttributes(S, New); 18586 18587 // Register this decl in the current scope stack. 18588 New->setAccess(TheEnumDecl->getAccess()); 18589 PushOnScopeChains(New, S); 18590 18591 ActOnDocumentableDecl(New); 18592 18593 return New; 18594 } 18595 18596 // Returns true when the enum initial expression does not trigger the 18597 // duplicate enum warning. A few common cases are exempted as follows: 18598 // Element2 = Element1 18599 // Element2 = Element1 + 1 18600 // Element2 = Element1 - 1 18601 // Where Element2 and Element1 are from the same enum. 18602 static bool ValidDuplicateEnum(EnumConstantDecl *ECD, EnumDecl *Enum) { 18603 Expr *InitExpr = ECD->getInitExpr(); 18604 if (!InitExpr) 18605 return true; 18606 InitExpr = InitExpr->IgnoreImpCasts(); 18607 18608 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(InitExpr)) { 18609 if (!BO->isAdditiveOp()) 18610 return true; 18611 IntegerLiteral *IL = dyn_cast<IntegerLiteral>(BO->getRHS()); 18612 if (!IL) 18613 return true; 18614 if (IL->getValue() != 1) 18615 return true; 18616 18617 InitExpr = BO->getLHS(); 18618 } 18619 18620 // This checks if the elements are from the same enum. 18621 DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(InitExpr); 18622 if (!DRE) 18623 return true; 18624 18625 EnumConstantDecl *EnumConstant = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 18626 if (!EnumConstant) 18627 return true; 18628 18629 if (cast<EnumDecl>(TagDecl::castFromDeclContext(ECD->getDeclContext())) != 18630 Enum) 18631 return true; 18632 18633 return false; 18634 } 18635 18636 // Emits a warning when an element is implicitly set a value that 18637 // a previous element has already been set to. 18638 static void CheckForDuplicateEnumValues(Sema &S, ArrayRef<Decl *> Elements, 18639 EnumDecl *Enum, QualType EnumType) { 18640 // Avoid anonymous enums 18641 if (!Enum->getIdentifier()) 18642 return; 18643 18644 // Only check for small enums. 18645 if (Enum->getNumPositiveBits() > 63 || Enum->getNumNegativeBits() > 64) 18646 return; 18647 18648 if (S.Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_duplicate_enum_values, Enum->getLocation())) 18649 return; 18650 18651 typedef SmallVector<EnumConstantDecl *, 3> ECDVector; 18652 typedef SmallVector<std::unique_ptr<ECDVector>, 3> DuplicatesVector; 18653 18654 typedef llvm::PointerUnion<EnumConstantDecl*, ECDVector*> DeclOrVector; 18655 18656 // DenseMaps cannot contain the all ones int64_t value, so use unordered_map. 18657 typedef std::unordered_map<int64_t, DeclOrVector> ValueToVectorMap; 18658 18659 // Use int64_t as a key to avoid needing special handling for map keys. 18660 auto EnumConstantToKey = [](const EnumConstantDecl *D) { 18661 llvm::APSInt Val = D->getInitVal(); 18662 return Val.isSigned() ? Val.getSExtValue() : Val.getZExtValue(); 18663 }; 18664 18665 DuplicatesVector DupVector; 18666 ValueToVectorMap EnumMap; 18667 18668 // Populate the EnumMap with all values represented by enum constants without 18669 // an initializer. 18670 for (auto *Element : Elements) { 18671 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(Element); 18672 18673 // Null EnumConstantDecl means a previous diagnostic has been emitted for 18674 // this constant. Skip this enum since it may be ill-formed. 18675 if (!ECD) { 18676 return; 18677 } 18678 18679 // Constants with initalizers are handled in the next loop. 18680 if (ECD->getInitExpr()) 18681 continue; 18682 18683 // Duplicate values are handled in the next loop. 18684 EnumMap.insert({EnumConstantToKey(ECD), ECD}); 18685 } 18686 18687 if (EnumMap.size() == 0) 18688 return; 18689 18690 // Create vectors for any values that has duplicates. 18691 for (auto *Element : Elements) { 18692 // The last loop returned if any constant was null. 18693 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = cast<EnumConstantDecl>(Element); 18694 if (!ValidDuplicateEnum(ECD, Enum)) 18695 continue; 18696 18697 auto Iter = EnumMap.find(EnumConstantToKey(ECD)); 18698 if (Iter == EnumMap.end()) 18699 continue; 18700 18701 DeclOrVector& Entry = Iter->second; 18702 if (EnumConstantDecl *D = Entry.dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl*>()) { 18703 // Ensure constants are different. 18704 if (D == ECD) 18705 continue; 18706 18707 // Create new vector and push values onto it. 18708 auto Vec = std::make_unique<ECDVector>(); 18709 Vec->push_back(D); 18710 Vec->push_back(ECD); 18711 18712 // Update entry to point to the duplicates vector. 18713 Entry = Vec.get(); 18714 18715 // Store the vector somewhere we can consult later for quick emission of 18716 // diagnostics. 18717 DupVector.emplace_back(std::move(Vec)); 18718 continue; 18719 } 18720 18721 ECDVector *Vec = Entry.get<ECDVector*>(); 18722 // Make sure constants are not added more than once. 18723 if (*Vec->begin() == ECD) 18724 continue; 18725 18726 Vec->push_back(ECD); 18727 } 18728 18729 // Emit diagnostics. 18730 for (const auto &Vec : DupVector) { 18731 assert(Vec->size() > 1 && "ECDVector should have at least 2 elements."); 18732 18733 // Emit warning for one enum constant. 18734 auto *FirstECD = Vec->front(); 18735 S.Diag(FirstECD->getLocation(), diag::warn_duplicate_enum_values) 18736 << FirstECD << toString(FirstECD->getInitVal(), 10) 18737 << FirstECD->getSourceRange(); 18738 18739 // Emit one note for each of the remaining enum constants with 18740 // the same value. 18741 for (auto *ECD : llvm::drop_begin(*Vec)) 18742 S.Diag(ECD->getLocation(), diag::note_duplicate_element) 18743 << ECD << toString(ECD->getInitVal(), 10) 18744 << ECD->getSourceRange(); 18745 } 18746 } 18747 18748 bool Sema::IsValueInFlagEnum(const EnumDecl *ED, const llvm::APInt &Val, 18749 bool AllowMask) const { 18750 assert(ED->isClosedFlag() && "looking for value in non-flag or open enum"); 18751 assert(ED->isCompleteDefinition() && "expected enum definition"); 18752 18753 auto R = FlagBitsCache.insert(std::make_pair(ED, llvm::APInt())); 18754 llvm::APInt &FlagBits = R.first->second; 18755 18756 if (R.second) { 18757 for (auto *E : ED->enumerators()) { 18758 const auto &EVal = E->getInitVal(); 18759 // Only single-bit enumerators introduce new flag values. 18760 if (EVal.isPowerOf2()) 18761 FlagBits = FlagBits.zext(EVal.getBitWidth()) | EVal; 18762 } 18763 } 18764 18765 // A value is in a flag enum if either its bits are a subset of the enum's 18766 // flag bits (the first condition) or we are allowing masks and the same is 18767 // true of its complement (the second condition). When masks are allowed, we 18768 // allow the common idiom of ~(enum1 | enum2) to be a valid enum value. 18769 // 18770 // While it's true that any value could be used as a mask, the assumption is 18771 // that a mask will have all of the insignificant bits set. Anything else is 18772 // likely a logic error. 18773 llvm::APInt FlagMask = ~FlagBits.zextOrTrunc(Val.getBitWidth()); 18774 return !(FlagMask & Val) || (AllowMask && !(FlagMask & ~Val)); 18775 } 18776 18777 void Sema::ActOnEnumBody(SourceLocation EnumLoc, SourceRange BraceRange, 18778 Decl *EnumDeclX, ArrayRef<Decl *> Elements, Scope *S, 18779 const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs) { 18780 EnumDecl *Enum = cast<EnumDecl>(EnumDeclX); 18781 QualType EnumType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Enum); 18782 18783 ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, Enum, Attrs); 18784 18785 if (Enum->isDependentType()) { 18786 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Elements.size(); i != e; ++i) { 18787 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = 18788 cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(Elements[i]); 18789 if (!ECD) continue; 18790 18791 ECD->setType(EnumType); 18792 } 18793 18794 Enum->completeDefinition(Context.DependentTy, Context.DependentTy, 0, 0); 18795 return; 18796 } 18797 18798 // TODO: If the result value doesn't fit in an int, it must be a long or long 18799 // long value. ISO C does not support this, but GCC does as an extension, 18800 // emit a warning. 18801 unsigned IntWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth(); 18802 unsigned CharWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getCharWidth(); 18803 unsigned ShortWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getShortWidth(); 18804 18805 // Verify that all the values are okay, compute the size of the values, and 18806 // reverse the list. 18807 unsigned NumNegativeBits = 0; 18808 unsigned NumPositiveBits = 0; 18809 18810 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Elements.size(); i != e; ++i) { 18811 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = 18812 cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(Elements[i]); 18813 if (!ECD) continue; // Already issued a diagnostic. 18814 18815 const llvm::APSInt &InitVal = ECD->getInitVal(); 18816 18817 // Keep track of the size of positive and negative values. 18818 if (InitVal.isUnsigned() || InitVal.isNonNegative()) 18819 NumPositiveBits = std::max(NumPositiveBits, 18820 (unsigned)InitVal.getActiveBits()); 18821 else 18822 NumNegativeBits = std::max(NumNegativeBits, 18823 (unsigned)InitVal.getMinSignedBits()); 18824 } 18825 18826 // Figure out the type that should be used for this enum. 18827 QualType BestType; 18828 unsigned BestWidth; 18829 18830 // C++0x N3000 [conv.prom]p3: 18831 // An rvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying 18832 // type is not fixed can be converted to an rvalue of the first 18833 // of the following types that can represent all the values of 18834 // the enumeration: int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long 18835 // int, long long int, or unsigned long long int. 18836 // C99 6.4.4.3p2: 18837 // An identifier declared as an enumeration constant has type int. 18838 // The C99 rule is modified by a gcc extension 18839 QualType BestPromotionType; 18840 18841 bool Packed = Enum->hasAttr<PackedAttr>(); 18842 // -fshort-enums is the equivalent to specifying the packed attribute on all 18843 // enum definitions. 18844 if (LangOpts.ShortEnums) 18845 Packed = true; 18846 18847 // If the enum already has a type because it is fixed or dictated by the 18848 // target, promote that type instead of analyzing the enumerators. 18849 if (Enum->isComplete()) { 18850 BestType = Enum->getIntegerType(); 18851 if (BestType->isPromotableIntegerType()) 18852 BestPromotionType = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(BestType); 18853 else 18854 BestPromotionType = BestType; 18855 18856 BestWidth = Context.getIntWidth(BestType); 18857 } 18858 else if (NumNegativeBits) { 18859 // If there is a negative value, figure out the smallest integer type (of 18860 // int/long/longlong) that fits. 18861 // If it's packed, check also if it fits a char or a short. 18862 if (Packed && NumNegativeBits <= CharWidth && NumPositiveBits < CharWidth) { 18863 BestType = Context.SignedCharTy; 18864 BestWidth = CharWidth; 18865 } else if (Packed && NumNegativeBits <= ShortWidth && 18866 NumPositiveBits < ShortWidth) { 18867 BestType = Context.ShortTy; 18868 BestWidth = ShortWidth; 18869 } else if (NumNegativeBits <= IntWidth && NumPositiveBits < IntWidth) { 18870 BestType = Context.IntTy; 18871 BestWidth = IntWidth; 18872 } else { 18873 BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth(); 18874 18875 if (NumNegativeBits <= BestWidth && NumPositiveBits < BestWidth) { 18876 BestType = Context.LongTy; 18877 } else { 18878 BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(); 18879 18880 if (NumNegativeBits > BestWidth || NumPositiveBits >= BestWidth) 18881 Diag(Enum->getLocation(), diag::ext_enum_too_large); 18882 BestType = Context.LongLongTy; 18883 } 18884 } 18885 BestPromotionType = (BestWidth <= IntWidth ? Context.IntTy : BestType); 18886 } else { 18887 // If there is no negative value, figure out the smallest type that fits 18888 // all of the enumerator values. 18889 // If it's packed, check also if it fits a char or a short. 18890 if (Packed && NumPositiveBits <= CharWidth) { 18891 BestType = Context.UnsignedCharTy; 18892 BestPromotionType = Context.IntTy; 18893 BestWidth = CharWidth; 18894 } else if (Packed && NumPositiveBits <= ShortWidth) { 18895 BestType = Context.UnsignedShortTy; 18896 BestPromotionType = Context.IntTy; 18897 BestWidth = ShortWidth; 18898 } else if (NumPositiveBits <= IntWidth) { 18899 BestType = Context.UnsignedIntTy; 18900 BestWidth = IntWidth; 18901 BestPromotionType 18902 = (NumPositiveBits == BestWidth || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 18903 ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy; 18904 } else if (NumPositiveBits <= 18905 (BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth())) { 18906 BestType = Context.UnsignedLongTy; 18907 BestPromotionType 18908 = (NumPositiveBits == BestWidth || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 18909 ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy; 18910 } else { 18911 BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(); 18912 assert(NumPositiveBits <= BestWidth && 18913 "How could an initializer get larger than ULL?"); 18914 BestType = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; 18915 BestPromotionType 18916 = (NumPositiveBits == BestWidth || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 18917 ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy; 18918 } 18919 } 18920 18921 // Loop over all of the enumerator constants, changing their types to match 18922 // the type of the enum if needed. 18923 for (auto *D : Elements) { 18924 auto *ECD = cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(D); 18925 if (!ECD) continue; // Already issued a diagnostic. 18926 18927 // Standard C says the enumerators have int type, but we allow, as an 18928 // extension, the enumerators to be larger than int size. If each 18929 // enumerator value fits in an int, type it as an int, otherwise type it the 18930 // same as the enumerator decl itself. This means that in "enum { X = 1U }" 18931 // that X has type 'int', not 'unsigned'. 18932 18933 // Determine whether the value fits into an int. 18934 llvm::APSInt InitVal = ECD->getInitVal(); 18935 18936 // If it fits into an integer type, force it. Otherwise force it to match 18937 // the enum decl type. 18938 QualType NewTy; 18939 unsigned NewWidth; 18940 bool NewSign; 18941 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 18942 !Enum->isFixed() && 18943 isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, InitVal, Context.IntTy)) { 18944 NewTy = Context.IntTy; 18945 NewWidth = IntWidth; 18946 NewSign = true; 18947 } else if (ECD->getType() == BestType) { 18948 // Already the right type! 18949 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 18950 // C++ [dcl.enum]p4: Following the closing brace of an 18951 // enum-specifier, each enumerator has the type of its 18952 // enumeration. 18953 ECD->setType(EnumType); 18954 continue; 18955 } else { 18956 NewTy = BestType; 18957 NewWidth = BestWidth; 18958 NewSign = BestType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType(); 18959 } 18960 18961 // Adjust the APSInt value. 18962 InitVal = InitVal.extOrTrunc(NewWidth); 18963 InitVal.setIsSigned(NewSign); 18964 ECD->setInitVal(InitVal); 18965 18966 // Adjust the Expr initializer and type. 18967 if (ECD->getInitExpr() && 18968 !Context.hasSameType(NewTy, ECD->getInitExpr()->getType())) 18969 ECD->setInitExpr(ImplicitCastExpr::Create( 18970 Context, NewTy, CK_IntegralCast, ECD->getInitExpr(), 18971 /*base paths*/ nullptr, VK_PRValue, FPOptionsOverride())); 18972 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 18973 // C++ [dcl.enum]p4: Following the closing brace of an 18974 // enum-specifier, each enumerator has the type of its 18975 // enumeration. 18976 ECD->setType(EnumType); 18977 else 18978 ECD->setType(NewTy); 18979 } 18980 18981 Enum->completeDefinition(BestType, BestPromotionType, 18982 NumPositiveBits, NumNegativeBits); 18983 18984 CheckForDuplicateEnumValues(*this, Elements, Enum, EnumType); 18985 18986 if (Enum->isClosedFlag()) { 18987 for (Decl *D : Elements) { 18988 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(D); 18989 if (!ECD) continue; // Already issued a diagnostic. 18990 18991 llvm::APSInt InitVal = ECD->getInitVal(); 18992 if (InitVal != 0 && !InitVal.isPowerOf2() && 18993 !IsValueInFlagEnum(Enum, InitVal, true)) 18994 Diag(ECD->getLocation(), diag::warn_flag_enum_constant_out_of_range) 18995 << ECD << Enum; 18996 } 18997 } 18998 18999 // Now that the enum type is defined, ensure it's not been underaligned. 19000 if (Enum->hasAttrs()) 19001 CheckAlignasUnderalignment(Enum); 19002 } 19003 19004 Decl *Sema::ActOnFileScopeAsmDecl(Expr *expr, 19005 SourceLocation StartLoc, 19006 SourceLocation EndLoc) { 19007 StringLiteral *AsmString = cast<StringLiteral>(expr); 19008 19009 FileScopeAsmDecl *New = FileScopeAsmDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, 19010 AsmString, StartLoc, 19011 EndLoc); 19012 CurContext->addDecl(New); 19013 return New; 19014 } 19015 19016 void Sema::ActOnPragmaRedefineExtname(IdentifierInfo* Name, 19017 IdentifierInfo* AliasName, 19018 SourceLocation PragmaLoc, 19019 SourceLocation NameLoc, 19020 SourceLocation AliasNameLoc) { 19021 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, Name, NameLoc, 19022 LookupOrdinaryName); 19023 AttributeCommonInfo Info(AliasName, SourceRange(AliasNameLoc), 19024 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma); 19025 AsmLabelAttr *Attr = AsmLabelAttr::CreateImplicit( 19026 Context, AliasName->getName(), /*IsLiteralLabel=*/true, Info); 19027 19028 // If a declaration that: 19029 // 1) declares a function or a variable 19030 // 2) has external linkage 19031 // already exists, add a label attribute to it. 19032 if (PrevDecl && (isa<FunctionDecl>(PrevDecl) || isa<VarDecl>(PrevDecl))) { 19033 if (isDeclExternC(PrevDecl)) 19034 PrevDecl->addAttr(Attr); 19035 else 19036 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::warn_redefine_extname_not_applied) 19037 << /*Variable*/(isa<FunctionDecl>(PrevDecl) ? 0 : 1) << PrevDecl; 19038 // Otherwise, add a label atttibute to ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers. 19039 } else 19040 (void)ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.insert(std::make_pair(Name, Attr)); 19041 } 19042 19043 void Sema::ActOnPragmaWeakID(IdentifierInfo* Name, 19044 SourceLocation PragmaLoc, 19045 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 19046 Decl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 19047 19048 if (PrevDecl) { 19049 PrevDecl->addAttr(WeakAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, PragmaLoc, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 19050 } else { 19051 (void)WeakUndeclaredIdentifiers[Name].insert(WeakInfo(nullptr, NameLoc)); 19052 } 19053 } 19054 19055 void Sema::ActOnPragmaWeakAlias(IdentifierInfo* Name, 19056 IdentifierInfo* AliasName, 19057 SourceLocation PragmaLoc, 19058 SourceLocation NameLoc, 19059 SourceLocation AliasNameLoc) { 19060 Decl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, AliasName, AliasNameLoc, 19061 LookupOrdinaryName); 19062 WeakInfo W = WeakInfo(Name, NameLoc); 19063 19064 if (PrevDecl && (isa<FunctionDecl>(PrevDecl) || isa<VarDecl>(PrevDecl))) { 19065 if (!PrevDecl->hasAttr<AliasAttr>()) 19066 if (NamedDecl *ND = dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(PrevDecl)) 19067 DeclApplyPragmaWeak(TUScope, ND, W); 19068 } else { 19069 (void)WeakUndeclaredIdentifiers[AliasName].insert(W); 19070 } 19071 } 19072 19073 ObjCContainerDecl *Sema::getObjCDeclContext() const { 19074 return (dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCContainerDecl>(CurContext)); 19075 } 19076 19077 Sema::FunctionEmissionStatus Sema::getEmissionStatus(FunctionDecl *FD, 19078 bool Final) { 19079 assert(FD && "Expected non-null FunctionDecl"); 19080 19081 // SYCL functions can be template, so we check if they have appropriate 19082 // attribute prior to checking if it is a template. 19083 if (LangOpts.SYCLIsDevice && FD->hasAttr<SYCLKernelAttr>()) 19084 return FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted; 19085 19086 // Templates are emitted when they're instantiated. 19087 if (FD->isDependentContext()) 19088 return FunctionEmissionStatus::TemplateDiscarded; 19089 19090 // Check whether this function is an externally visible definition. 19091 auto IsEmittedForExternalSymbol = [this, FD]() { 19092 // We have to check the GVA linkage of the function's *definition* -- if we 19093 // only have a declaration, we don't know whether or not the function will 19094 // be emitted, because (say) the definition could include "inline". 19095 FunctionDecl *Def = FD->getDefinition(); 19096 19097 return Def && !isDiscardableGVALinkage( 19098 getASTContext().GetGVALinkageForFunction(Def)); 19099 }; 19100 19101 if (LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice) { 19102 // In OpenMP device mode we will not emit host only functions, or functions 19103 // we don't need due to their linkage. 19104 Optional<OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DevTypeTy> DevTy = 19105 OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::getDeviceType(FD->getCanonicalDecl()); 19106 // DevTy may be changed later by 19107 // #pragma omp declare target to(*) device_type(*). 19108 // Therefore DevTy having no value does not imply host. The emission status 19109 // will be checked again at the end of compilation unit with Final = true. 19110 if (DevTy) 19111 if (*DevTy == OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DT_Host) 19112 return FunctionEmissionStatus::OMPDiscarded; 19113 // If we have an explicit value for the device type, or we are in a target 19114 // declare context, we need to emit all extern and used symbols. 19115 if (isInOpenMPDeclareTargetContext() || DevTy) 19116 if (IsEmittedForExternalSymbol()) 19117 return FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted; 19118 // Device mode only emits what it must, if it wasn't tagged yet and needed, 19119 // we'll omit it. 19120 if (Final) 19121 return FunctionEmissionStatus::OMPDiscarded; 19122 } else if (LangOpts.OpenMP > 45) { 19123 // In OpenMP host compilation prior to 5.0 everything was an emitted host 19124 // function. In 5.0, no_host was introduced which might cause a function to 19125 // be ommitted. 19126 Optional<OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DevTypeTy> DevTy = 19127 OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::getDeviceType(FD->getCanonicalDecl()); 19128 if (DevTy) 19129 if (*DevTy == OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DT_NoHost) 19130 return FunctionEmissionStatus::OMPDiscarded; 19131 } 19132 19133 if (Final && LangOpts.OpenMP && !LangOpts.CUDA) 19134 return FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted; 19135 19136 if (LangOpts.CUDA) { 19137 // When compiling for device, host functions are never emitted. Similarly, 19138 // when compiling for host, device and global functions are never emitted. 19139 // (Technically, we do emit a host-side stub for global functions, but this 19140 // doesn't count for our purposes here.) 19141 Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget T = IdentifyCUDATarget(FD); 19142 if (LangOpts.CUDAIsDevice && T == Sema::CFT_Host) 19143 return FunctionEmissionStatus::CUDADiscarded; 19144 if (!LangOpts.CUDAIsDevice && 19145 (T == Sema::CFT_Device || T == Sema::CFT_Global)) 19146 return FunctionEmissionStatus::CUDADiscarded; 19147 19148 if (IsEmittedForExternalSymbol()) 19149 return FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted; 19150 } 19151 19152 // Otherwise, the function is known-emitted if it's in our set of 19153 // known-emitted functions. 19154 return FunctionEmissionStatus::Unknown; 19155 } 19156 19157 bool Sema::shouldIgnoreInHostDeviceCheck(FunctionDecl *Callee) { 19158 // Host-side references to a __global__ function refer to the stub, so the 19159 // function itself is never emitted and therefore should not be marked. 19160 // If we have host fn calls kernel fn calls host+device, the HD function 19161 // does not get instantiated on the host. We model this by omitting at the 19162 // call to the kernel from the callgraph. This ensures that, when compiling 19163 // for host, only HD functions actually called from the host get marked as 19164 // known-emitted. 19165 return LangOpts.CUDA && !LangOpts.CUDAIsDevice && 19166 IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee) == CFT_Global; 19167 } 19168